SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Amendment No. 4 to
Tender Offer Statement under Section 14(d)(1) or 13(e)(1)
Intevac, Inc.
6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes Due 2004
4661148AA6
Kevin Fairbairn
Copies to:
Herbert P. Fockler, Esq.
CALCULATION OF FILING FEE
|
||
|
||
Transaction Valuation(1) | Amount of Filing Fee(2) | |
|
||
$37,545,000.00
|
$3,454.14 | |
|
(1) | Estimated for the purpose of calculating the amount of the filing fee only. Intevac, Inc. is offering to exchange each $1,000 aggregate principal amount of its outstanding 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2004 (the Existing Notes) tendered for (a) $185 in cash and (b) $815 of its new 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2009 (the Exchange Notes). The estimated transaction value is the value of the maximum amount of Existing Notes that Intevac may receive from tendering holders in the exchange offer above, which value, calculated in accordance with Rule 0-11(b) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, is the book value as of April 30, 2002 of the Exchange Notes issued as above. The amount of the filing fee, calculated in accordance with the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, equals $92 for each $1,000,000 of value. |
(2) Previously paid.
o | Check the box if any part of the fee is offset as provided by Rule 0-11(a)(2) and identify the filing with which the offsetting fee was previously paid. Identify the previous filing by registration statement number, or the Form or Schedule and the date of its filing. |
o | Check the box if the filing relates solely to preliminary communications made before the commencement of a tender offer. |
Check the appropriate boxes below to designate any transactions to which the statement relates: |
o | third-party tender offer subject to Rule 14d-1. |
x | issuer tender offer subject to Rule 13e-4. |
o | going-private transaction subject to Rule 13e-3. |
o | amendment to Schedule 13D under Rule 13d-2 |
Check the following box if the filing is a final amendment reporting the results of the tender offer: o
Item 12. Exhibits. | ||||||||
SIGNATURE | ||||||||
EXHIBIT INDEX | ||||||||
EXHIBIT (A)(1)(A) | ||||||||
EXHIBIT (A)(1)(B) | ||||||||
EXHIBIT (A)(1)(C) | ||||||||
EXHIBIT (A)(1)(D) | ||||||||
EXHIBIT (A)(1)(E) | ||||||||
EXHIBIT (D)(2) |
This Amendment No. 4 to a Tender Offer Statement on Schedule TO (the Statement) amends and supplements the Statement originally filed by Intevac, Inc., a California corporation (Intevac or the Company), on May 8, 2002, as amended on May 24, 2002, June 6, 2002 and June 14, 2002, in connection with its offer to exchange (the Exchange Offer) each $1,000 aggregate principal amount of its outstanding 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2004 (the Existing Notes) tendered for (a) $185 in cash and (b) $815 of its new 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2009 (the Exchange Notes). As of the date of this amendment, $37,545,000 principal amount of Existing Notes are outstanding. The Exchange Offer is subject to the terms and conditions set forth in the Offering Circular dated June 21, 2002 (the Offering Circular) and the related letter of transmittal (which, as either may be amended or supplemented from time to time, together constitute the Disclosure Documents).
The information in the Disclosure Documents, including all schedules and annexes to the Disclosure Documents, is incorporated by reference in answer to the items required in the Statement, except as otherwise indicated. Except as amended by this amendment and the revised Disclosure Documents, all of the terms of the Exchange Offer and all disclosure set forth in the Statement remain unchanged.
Item 4. | Terms of the Transaction. |
Item 4 is hereby amended and restated as follows:
(a) The information set forth in the sections of the Offering Circular titled Summary Term Sheet, Capitalization, Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Data, The Exchange Offer, Description of Exchange Notes, Description of Existing Notes, Book-Entry System The Depository Trust Company and U.S. Federal Income Tax Consequences are incorporated herein by reference.
(b) Norman H. Pond, our chairman of the Board, Edward Durbin, a director of the Company and Chief Operating Officer of Foster City, LLC, an entity which holds approximately 46.4% of our outstanding Common Stock, and Charles B. Eddy III, our Vice President, Finance and Administration, Chief Financial Officer, Treasurer and Secretary individually own $1,490,000, $980,000 and $50,000, respectively, and together own $2,520,000 of our Existing Notes, or 6.7% of the aggregate outstanding principal amount. They have agreed to tender all of their Existing Notes.
Item 5. | Past Contracts, Transactions, Negotiations and Agreements. |
Item 5 is hereby amended and restated as follows:
(e) The information set forth above in Item 4(b) and in the sections of the Offering Circular titled Financing Strategy, Description of Exchange Notes, and Description of Existing Notes, are incorporated herein by reference. The Company has entered into an employment agreement with Kevin Fairbairn, our President and Chief Executive Officer, which provides that the vesting of Mr. Fairbairns options may accelerate upon a change of control of the Company. The Exchange Offer would not be considered a change of control of the Company. Except as described in the Offering Circular and other than the respective Indentures governing the Existing Notes and Exchange Notes, which are filed as exhibits to this Schedule TO, no agreement, arrangement or understanding exists between Intevac (including any person specified in Instruction C of this Schedule TO) and any other person with respect to any Existing Notes or Exchange Notes.
Item 7. Source and Amount of Funds or Other Consideration.
Item 7 is hereby amended and restated as follows:
(a) Intevac expects to obtain the cash required to consummate the Exchange Offer, up to the maximum of $6,945,825 if all of the Existing Notes are tendered, from current cash reserves.
(b) All financial conditions required for issuance of new securities and cash pursuant to the Exchange Offer have been satisfied.
(d) Not applicable.
1
Item 12. | Exhibits. |
Item 12 hereby is amended and restated as follows:
Exhibit | ||||
No. | Description | |||
|
|
|||
(a)(1)(a) | Offering Circular dated June 21, 2002.(1) | |||
(a)(1)(b) | Letter of Transmittal.(1) | |||
(a)(1)(c) | Letter to Broker-Dealers.(1) | |||
(a)(1)(d) | Letter to Clients.(1) | |||
(a)(1)(e) | Notice of Guaranteed Delivery.(1) | |||
(a)(1)(f) | Guidelines for Certification of Taxpayer Identification Number on Substitute IRS Form W-9.(2) | |||
(a)(5)(a) | Press release dated May 8, 2002.(2) | |||
(a)(5)(b) | Investor Presentation.(2) | |||
(a)(5)(c) | Press release dated June 6, 2002.(3) | |||
(a)(5)(d) | Press release dated June 20, 2002.(4) | |||
(d)(1) | Indenture, dated as of February 15, 1997, between Intevac and State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A.(5) | |||
(d)(2) | Form of Indenture to be dated as of the closing date of the Exchange Offer by and between Intevac and State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A.(1) |
(1) | Filed herewith. |
(2) | Incorporated by reference to Intevacs Tender Offer Statement on Schedule T-O (file no. 5-48450, filed on May 8, 2002). |
(3) | Incorporated by reference to Intevacs Tender Offer Statement Amendment No. 2 on Schedule T-O (file no. 5-48450) filed on June 6, 2002). |
(4) | Incorporated by reference to Intevacs written communication relating to an issuer on Schedule TO-C (filed on June 20, 2002). |
(5) | Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to Intevacs Registration Statement on Form S-3 (file no. 333-24275). |
2
SIGNATURE
After due inquiry and to the best of my knowledge and belief, I certify that the information set forth in this Amendment No. 4 to Schedule TO is true, complete and correct.
INTEVAC, INC. |
By: | /s/ KEVIN FAIRBAIRN |
|
|
Name: Kevin Fairbairn | |
Title: President and Chief Executive Officer |
Date: June 21, 2002
EXHIBIT INDEX
Exhibit | ||||
No. | Description | |||
|
|
|||
(a)(1)(a) | Offering Circular dated June 21, 2002.(1) | |||
(a)(1)(b) | Letter of Transmittal.(1) | |||
(a)(1)(c) | Letter to Broker-Dealers.(1) | |||
(a)(1)(d) | Letter to Clients.(1) | |||
(a)(1)(e) | Notice of Guaranteed Delivery.(1) | |||
(a)(1)(f) | Guidelines for Certification of Taxpayer Identification Number on Substitute IRS Form W-9.(2) | |||
(a)(5)(a) | Press release dated May 8, 2002.(2) | |||
(a)(5)(b) | Investor Presentation.(2) | |||
(a)(5)(c) | Press release dated June 6, 2002.(3) | |||
(a)(5)(d) | Press release dated June 20, 2002(4) | |||
(d)(1) | Indenture, dated as of February 15, 1997, between Intevac and State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A.(5) | |||
(d)(2) | Form of Indenture to be dated as of the closing date of the Exchange Offer by and between Intevac and State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A.(1) |
(1) | Filed herewith. |
(2) | Incorporated by reference to Intevacs Tender Offer Statement on Schedule T-O (file no. 5-48450, filed on May 8, 2002). |
(3) | Incorporated by reference to Intevacs Tender Offer Statement Amendment No. 2 on Schedule T-O (file no. 5-48450) filed on June 6, 2002). |
(4) | Incorporated by reference to Intevacs written communication relating to an issuer on Schedule TO-C (filed on June 20, 2002). |
(5) | Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to Intevacs Registration Statement on Form S-3 (file no. 333-24275). |
OFFERING CIRCULAR
The exchange offers expiration date is 12:00 midnight, Eastern Time, July 9, 2002, unless extended or earlier terminated by Intevac, Inc.
Exchange Offer
Under this exchange offer, Intevac, Inc. is offering to exchange for each $1,000 principal amount of its 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2004, which we refer to as the existing notes, the following:
$185 in cash, and
| $815 of our new 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2009, which we refer to as the exchange notes. |
The exchange notes will be issued in denominations of $1,000 principal amount or integral multiples thereof. We will pay cash for any fractional portion of an exchange note that is less than $1,000 principal amount as a result of the exchange, after aggregating all notes tendered.
See Risk Factors beginning on page 9 for a discussion of risks that you should consider before tendering your existing notes.
IMPORTANT
If you hold your existing notes through a broker, dealer or other similar nominee, you must contact that nominee if you desire to tender your existing notes. If you hold your existing notes yourself, you must complete and sign the letter of transmittal included with this document in accordance with the instructions set forth in the letter of transmittal and this offering circular, and mail or deliver it, together with the certificates for the tendered existing notes and any other required documents, to State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A., our exchange agent.
Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or passed upon the adequacy or accuracy of this offering circular. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.
The exchange offer is being made in reliance upon an exemption from registration provided by Section 3(a)(9) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and similar exemptions from registration provided by certain state securities laws.
The date of this offering circular is June 21, 2002.
You should rely only on the information contained in this offering circular. We have not authorized anyone to provide you with different information. We are not making an offer of the exchange notes in any state where the offer is not permitted. You should not assume that the information provided in the offering circular is accurate as of any date other than the date as of which it is shown, or if no date is otherwise indicated, the date of this offering circular. This offering circular summarizes various documents and other information. Those summaries are qualified in their entirety by reference to the documents and information to which they relate.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Page | ||||
|
||||
Summary Term Sheet
|
1 | |||
Risk Factors
|
9 | |||
Forward-Looking Statements
|
16 | |||
Use of Proceeds
|
17 | |||
Price Range of Common Stock
|
17 | |||
Trading Market for Existing Notes
|
17 | |||
Dividend Policy
|
17 | |||
Capitalization
|
18 | |||
Selected Consolidated Financial Data
|
19 | |||
Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Data
|
21 | |||
Business
|
23 | |||
Financing Strategy
|
27 | |||
The Exchange Offer
|
29 | |||
Description of Exchange Notes
|
36 | |||
Description of Existing Notes
|
47 | |||
Book-Entry System The Depository
Trust Company
|
58 | |||
Description of Capital Stock
|
60 | |||
U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations
|
61 | |||
Where You Can Find Additional Information
|
66 | |||
Annual Report on Form 10K
|
Appendix A | |||
Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q
|
Appendix B | |||
Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A
|
Appendix C | |||
Tender Offer Statement on Schedule TO
|
Appendix D | |||
Amendment No. 2 to Tender Offer Statement on
Schedule TO
|
Appendix E | |||
Amendment No. 4 to Tender Offer Statement on
Schedule TO
|
Appendix F |
Our logo and certain titles and logos of our products mentioned in this offering circular are our service marks or trademarks. Each trademark or service mark appearing in this offering circular is the property of its respective holder.
SUMMARY TERM SHEET
This summary highlights certain information from this offering circular and may not contain all of the information that is important to you. We urge you to read this entire offering circular, including the documents attached to or accompanying this offering circular.
Investment in the exchange notes involves risks. See under the caption entitled Risk Factors for a discussion of risks you should consider carefully before participating in the exchange offer.
Under this exchange offer, Intevac, Inc. is offering to exchange for each $1,000 principal amount of its existing notes the following:
| $185 in cash, and | |
| $815 of our exchange notes. |
The exchange notes will be issued in denominations of $1,000 principal amount or integral multiples thereof. We will pay cash for any fractional portion of an exchange note that is less than $1,000 principal amount as a result of the exchange, after aggregating all notes tendered.
We will pay any interest that has accrued on the existing notes that are tendered and exchanged to the date of completion of the exchange offer.
The exchange offer is conditioned on at least $30 million principal amount of existing notes being tendered.
The following are some of the questions you may have as a holder of the existing notes and the answers to those questions.
Who is making the exchange offer?
Intevac, Inc., a California corporation, is making the exchange offer. We design, manufacture and sell complex capital equipment used to manufacture products such as flat panel displays, thin-film disks and electro-optical devices (Equipment Division) and are developing highly sensitive electro-optical devices and systems that we intend to manufacture and sell (Photonics Division). For a detailed description of our business, please see the section of this offering circular entitled Business. Our headquarters are located at 3560 Bassett Street, Santa Clara, CA 95054, and our telephone number is (408) 986-9888. Our common stock is traded on the Nasdaq National Market under the symbol IVAC. For further information about us, please see the section of this offering circular entitled Where You Can Find Additional Information.
Why are we amending the terms of our amended exchange offer?
After we amended the terms of our original exchange offer in our offering circular dated June 6, 2002 (the Amended Offer), we orally contacted representatives of the holders of a substantial portion of the existing notes to ensure that they were aware of the terms of the Amended Offer. In the course of these conversations, these representatives acknowledged that they were aware of the terms of the Amended Offer but indicated that they would not accept the terms of such Amended Offer, and suggested some additional modifications that would likely make the Amended Offer more acceptable to them. After considering their suggestions, we determined to change the terms of the Amended Offer as indicated in this offering circular. These holders of existing notes have not committed to accept the terms of the new revised exchange offer outlined in this offering circular.
In response to our Amended Offer, approximately $4.5 million in aggregate principal amount of existing notes were tendered, or approximately 12% of the total outstanding existing notes, in the Amended Offer that was scheduled to expire at 12:00 midnight, Eastern Time, on June 19, 2002, which was less than the $30 million minimum principal amount of existing notes required to be tendered under the terms of the Amended Offer.
1
Why are we making the exchange offer?
We are offering to exchange the existing notes for a combination of cash and exchange notes to extend the time that we have to pay the debt represented by the exchange notes and to reduce the aggregate principal amount of existing notes outstanding. We are undertaking this exchange offer to restructure our debt obligations. The outstanding principal amount of $37.5 million of existing notes will require us to make principal and interest payments through the maturity date of March 1, 2004 that are significantly in excess of our $14.5 million balance of cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments at March 30, 2002. We do not expect that we will be able to generate sufficient additional funds from operations to repay the existing notes at maturity.
If we are not successful in our efforts to restructure our debt obligations, including because the response to the exchange offer is too limited, or if we are otherwise unable to extend the maturities of our debt obligations, we will have to undertake other financing or refinancing alternatives. Even if we are successful with this exchange offer, we may also attempt to undertake other financing alternatives to obtain additional cash to fund our future operations. See the section of this offering circular entitled Financing Strategy.
The exchange of a substantial portion of the existing notes will also provide us with additional time to capitalize on the prospects for our Photonics business. We believe this business will not reach its full potential by the March 1, 2004 maturity date of the existing notes.
What effect will the exchange offer have on our debt?
If we are successful in having holders tender at least $30 million principal amount of existing notes, which is the minimum amount required to be tendered in the exchange offer, we will not have to repay the exchange notes until the March 1, 2009 maturity date, rather than the March 1, 2004 maturity date for the existing notes.
The maintenance of sufficient cash for our ongoing operations is critical to our future success and is subject to a number of factors, including our ability to generate cash from operations and our satisfaction of other, non-debt obligations. Even if the exchange offer is successful and we extend the maturity of a substantial portion of our debt to March 1, 2009, our cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments of approximately $14.5 million as of March 30, 2002 will be reduced by the amount of cash paid in the exchange offer. If all the existing notes are submitted and accepted in the exchange offer, we will be required to pay approximately $7.0 million in cash in the exchange offer. As a result, we may need to undertake other financing alternatives to obtain additional cash to fund our future operations. See the section of this offering circular entitled Financing Strategy. However, until our results of operations improve, we may not have access to new capital in the public or private markets on terms favorable to us, if at all.
What amount of existing notes are sought in the exchange offer?
We are seeking to exchange all of our existing notes currently outstanding.
What consideration are we offering to issue in exchange for your existing notes?
In the exchange offer, we are offering to exchange for each $1,000 aggregate principal amount of the existing notes the following:
| $185 cash, and | |
| $815 of our exchange notes. |
The exchange notes will be issued in denominations of $1,000 principal amount or integral multiples thereof. We will pay cash for any fractional portion of an exchange note that is less than $1,000 principal amount as a result of the exchange, after aggregating all notes tendered.
We will pay any interest that has accrued on the existing notes that are tendered and exchanged to the date of the completion of the exchange offer.
2
The exchange offer is conditioned on at least $30 million principal amount of existing notes being tendered.
Is Intevac making a recommendation as to whether you should tender your existing notes?
No. We are not making any recommendation regarding whether you should tender your existing notes. As a result, you must make your own determination in consultation with your financial and legal advisors as to whether to tender your existing notes for exchange.
What are the terms of the exchange notes?
The exchange notes issued will accrue interest at a rate of 6 1/2% per year on the principal amount, payable twice a year on each March 1 and September 1, beginning September 1, 2002. The exchange notes will mature March 1, 2009. The exchange notes will be unsecured obligations of Intevac, subordinated in right of payment to all of its existing and future senior debt, but senior to the existing notes. The initial conversion price of the exchange notes will be $7.00 per share, subject to adjustment as described under the caption Description of Exchange Notes Conversion. The exchange notes also contain a provision that allows us, at our option, to automatically convert some or all of the exchange notes on or prior to maturity if the closing price of our common stock has exceeded 150% of the conversion price for at least 20 trading days in any period of 30 consecutive trading days ending within five trading days prior to the mailing of the notice of automatic conversion.
Do you have to tender all of your existing notes to participate in this exchange offer?
You do not have to tender all of your existing notes to participate in this exchange offer.
When are the exchange notes redeemable?
The exchange notes are redeemable at any time on or after March 1, 2005 at our option, in whole or in part, on not less than 15 but no more than 60 days notice at 100% of the principal amount of the exchange notes, plus accrued, but unpaid, interest to, but excluding, the redemption date.
How will the exchange notes rank?
The exchange notes will be unsecured obligations of Intevac, subordinated under the exchange notes indenture in right of payment to all existing and future senior debt of Intevac, but senior to any existing notes that are not exchanged for the exchange notes. Please see the section of this offering circular entitled Description of Exchange Notes Subordination of Exchange Notes and Definitions for a description of what constitutes senior debt under the exchange notes indenture. As of March 30, 2002, we had no senior debt.
Will the exchange notes provide for any repurchase rights in the event of a change of control, a termination of trading involving Intevac or any other event?
Unlike holders of existing notes who have the right to require us to repurchase the existing notes upon the occurrence of either a change of control of Intevac or a termination of trading of our common stock, holders of exchange notes will have the right to require us to repurchase their exchange notes only if a change of control of Intevac occurs or on or prior to the distribution to all of the holders of our common stock of the capital stock of a subsidiary that at the time constitutes our Photonics business, if such a distribution occurs.
Will the exchange notes be listed?
The exchange notes will not be listed for trading on any national securities exchange or authorized to be quoted in any inter-dealer quotation system of any national securities association. We do not intend to apply for either listing or quotation of the exchange notes.
3
What risks should you consider in deciding whether or not to tender your existing notes?
In deciding whether to participate in the exchange offer, you should carefully consider the discussion of risks and uncertainties affecting our business described in the section of this offering circular entitled Risk Factors, and the documents we attach to this offering circular.
Is our financial condition relevant to your decision to tender in the exchange offer?
Yes, we continue to face significant challenges and limitations as a result of a prolonged slowdown in demand for capital equipment used to manufacture, thin-film disks. As we discuss above, the principal reason for the exchange offer is to extend the maturity of our debt and to reduce the total amount of our debt outstanding. Even if we are successful with the exchange offer, our cash position will be reduced by the amount of cash paid in the exchange offer and we may need to undertake other financing alternatives to obtain additional cash to fund our future operations. See the section of this offering circular entitled Financing Strategy. However, until our results of operations improve, we may not have access to new capital in the public or private markets on terms favorable to us, if at all.
If you decide to tender your existing notes, will you have to pay any fees or commissions in the exchange offer to Intevac or the exchange agent?
No. We will be responsible for all expenses related to the exchange offer. As a result, you are not required to pay any brokerage commissions, other fees or expenses to the exchange agent or Intevac.
If you decide not to tender your existing notes, how will the exchange offer affect your existing notes?
Once the exchange offer is completed, any of your existing notes that are not tendered and exchanged in the exchange offer will be subordinated to the exchange notes. If the minimum principal amount of $30 million of existing notes that we are seeking is submitted for exchange in the exchange offer, the liquidity of your existing notes that remain outstanding after completion of the exchange offer could be adversely affected.
Will Intevac receive any cash proceeds from the exchange offer?
No. We will not receive any cash proceeds from the exchange offer.
Will you receive accrued interest on the existing notes that you tender for exchange?
Yes. On all existing notes that are tendered and exchanged in the exchange offer, we will pay accrued and unpaid interest as of the date the exchange notes are issued upon completion of the exchange.
What are the conditions to completion of the exchange offer?
The exchange offer is conditioned on at least $30 million principal amount of existing notes being tendered. In addition, the completion of the exchange offer shall remain subject to a number of customary conditions, some of which we may waive. If any of these conditions are not satisfied, we will not be obligated to accept and exchange any properly tendered existing notes. Prior to the expiration date of the exchange offer, we reserve the right to amend the exchange offer for any or no reason. See under the caption The Exchange Offer Conditions to the Completion of the Exchange Offer.
When is the exchange offer expected to close?
The exchange offer is expected to close promptly following the expiration date of the exchange offer.
Will the exchange notes be freely tradable?
The exchange offer is being made to you in reliance on an exemption from registration provided by Section 3(a)(9) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended. The exchange notes to be issued in the exchange offer neither have been, nor will be, registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission, or SEC. The exchange notes that you receive in the exchange offer and any common stock issuable upon conversion of the
4
How do you tender your existing notes?
To tender existing notes pursuant to the exchange offer, you must properly complete and duly execute and submit to the exchange agent the letter of transmittal, the existing notes that you are tendering for exchange, if you hold them in certificated form, and any other documents required by the letter of transmittal or comply with the requisite Depository Trust Company, or DTC, procedures for book-entry transfer described under the caption The Exchange Offer Procedures for Tendering Existing Notes.
How long do you have to decide whether to tender?
The expiration date for the exchange offer is 12:00 midnight, Eastern Time, July 9, 2002, unless we extend the expiration date of the exchange offer by issuing a press release by 9:00 a.m., Eastern Time, on the next business day after the scheduled expiration date. You must tender your existing notes prior to the expiration date if you want to participate.
How do you withdraw tendered existing notes? Until what time can you withdraw tendered existing notes?
You may withdraw tenders of existing notes at any time on or prior to the expiration date by following the procedures described under the caption The Exchange Offer Withdrawal Rights and Non-Acceptance.
Properly withdrawn existing notes may be retendered at any time on or prior to the expiration date by following one of the procedures described in this offering circular under the caption The Exchange Offer Procedures for Tendering Existing Notes.
If we extend the expiration date of the exchange offer, we will also extend your right to withdraw tenders of existing notes.
When will you receive your cash and exchange notes?
Subject to the terms and conditions described in this offering circular, we will accept all existing notes that are validly tendered and not withdrawn on or prior to the expiration date. We will pay the cash consideration and issue the exchange notes promptly following the expiration date of the exchange offer upon our determination that the conditions to the exchange offer have been fulfilled.
What happens if your existing notes are not accepted for payment?
If we decide for any reason not to accept any existing notes for exchange, the existing notes will be returned to the registered holder, at our expense, promptly after the expiration or termination of the exchange offer. In the case of existing notes tendered by book entry transfer into the exchange agents account at DTC, any withdrawn or unaccepted existing notes will be credited to the tendering holders account at DTC. For further information, see the discussion in this offering circular under the caption The Exchange Offer Withdrawal Rights and Non-Acceptance.
Will the exchange notes be issued in global form?
All exchange notes issued in the exchange offer will be global securities and will be deposited with a custodian. You will not receive certificates for exchange notes. Your beneficial interests in the exchange notes will be evidenced only through records maintained in book-entry form by DTC and its participants. For further information, please see the section of this offering circular entitled Book-Entry System The Depository Trust Company.
5
How will you receive your cash consideration in connection with the exchange offer?
We will deposit the cash consideration for the exchange offer with the exchange agent prior to the closing date of the exchange offer. The closing date will promptly follow the expiration date of the exchange offer. If you hold your existing notes in physical certificates, the exchange agent will deliver to you a check in the amount of your cash consideration. If you hold your existing notes in global form through DTC, the exchange agent will pay DTC the aggregate amount of cash consideration to be delivered in exchange for all existing notes held in global form tendered and accepted in the exchange offer, and you will receive your portion of that cash consideration pursuant to the applicable procedures established by DTC and its participants.
What is the process if you beneficially own existing notes that are registered in the name of a broker, dealer, commercial bank, trust company or other nominee?
If you beneficially own existing notes that are registered in the name of a broker, dealer, commercial bank, trust company or other nominee and you wish to tender your existing notes in the exchange offer, you should promptly contact the person in whose name the existing notes are registered and instruct that person to tender on your behalf. If you wish to tender in the exchange offer on your own behalf, prior to completing and executing the letter of transmittal and delivering your existing notes, you must either make appropriate arrangements to register ownership of the existing notes in your name or obtain a properly completed bond power from the person in whose name the existing notes are registered.
How will you be taxed for U.S. federal income tax purposes?
Please see the section of this offering circular entitled U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations.
The tax consequences to you of the exchange offer will depend on your individual circumstances. You should consult your tax advisor for a full understanding of these tax consequences.
Who can you talk to if you have questions about the exchange offer?
If you have questions regarding the information in this offering circular or the terms of the exchange offer, please contact Charles Eddy at Intevac. If you have questions regarding the procedure for tendering your existing notes or require assistance in tendering your existing notes, please contact our exchange agent, State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A. You can find the addresses and telephone numbers of Charles Eddy at Intevac and the exchange agent on the back cover of this offering circular.
Where can you obtain additional copies of the exchange offer materials?
You can obtain additional copies of this offering circular and the other exchange offer materials by contacting the exchange agent at the phone number and address listed on the back cover of this offering circular.
6
Comparison of the New Consideration and the
Existing Notes
The following is a brief summary of the terms of
the new consideration and the existing notes. For a more
complete description of the exchange notes, see
Description of Exchange Notes.
$185 in cash for each $1,000 principal amount of
existing notes tendered in the exchange.
None.
Exchange Notes
Existing Notes
$815 of exchange notes for each $1,000 principal
amount of existing notes. The exchange notes will be issued in
principal amounts of $1,000, and we will pay cash for any
fractional portion of an exchange note that is less than $1,000
principal amount as a result of the exchange, after aggregating
all notes tendered.
None.
Up to $30,599,000 aggregate principal amount of
6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2009.
$37,545,000 aggregate principal amount of
6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2004. The
existing notes are issued in principal amounts of $1,000.
Intevac, Inc.
Intevac, Inc.
March 1, 2009
March 1, 2004
Interest on the exchange notes will be payable at
a rate of 6 1/2% per year, payable March 1 and September 1
of each year.
Interest on the existing notes is payable at a
rate of 6 1/2% per year, payable March 1 and September 1 of
each year.
The exchange notes will be convertible at any
time by the holder prior to maturity at a conversion price of
$7.00 per share, subject to adjustment.
The existing notes are convertible at any time by
the holder prior to maturity at a conversion price of $20.625
per share, subject to adjustment.
We may elect to automatically convert some or all
of the exchange notes on or prior to maturity if the closing
price of our common stock has exceeded 150% of the conversion
price for at least 20 trading days during any period of 30
consecutive trading days ending within five trading days prior
to the date of mailing of the notice of automatic conversion.
None.
The exchange notes will be subordinated to all of
our senior debt and will be senior in right of payment to our
existing notes. As of March 30, 2002, we had no senior debt.
The existing notes are subordinated to all of our
senior debt and will be subordinated in right of payment to the
exchange notes. As of March 30, 2002, we had no senior debt.
7
We may redeem the exchange notes on or after
March 1, 2005 at any time, in whole or in part, on not less
than 15 but no more than 60 days notice, at 100% of the
principal amount of the exchange notes, plus accrued and unpaid
interest, if any, to, but excluding, the redemption date.
We may redeem the existing notes at any time, in
whole or in part, on not less than 15 but no more than 60
days notice, at the redemption prices set forth in this
offering circular, plus accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to
the redemption date.
You may require us to repurchase all or part of
your exchange notes upon the occurrence of a transaction that
results in a change of control of Intevac at a repurchase price
equal to 101% of the outstanding principal amount of the
exchange notes being repurchased, plus any accrued and unpaid
interest.
You may require us to repurchase all or part of
your existing notes upon the occurrence of a transaction that
results in a change of control of Intevac or a termination of
trading of our common stock at a repurchase price equal to 101%
of the outstanding principal amount of the existing notes being
repurchased, plus any accrued and unpaid interest.
You may require us to repurchase all or part of
your exchange notes on a repurchase date that is on or prior to
any distribution to all of the holders of our common stock of
the capital stock of a subsidiary that at the time constitutes
our Photonics business at a repurchase price equal to 100% of
the outstanding principal amount of the exchange notes being
repurchased, plus any accrued and unpaid interest to the
repurchase date. We will provide holders 90 days
notice by mail of the repurchase date and the repurchase right
arising from such a distribution.
None.
The exchange notes are expected to trade in the
over-the-counter market.
The existing notes trade in the over-the-counter
market.
8
RISK FACTORS
This exchange offer involves a high degree of risk. You should carefully consider the following risks before making a decision to participate in the exchange offer. You should also refer to the other information set forth in this offering circular, including the documents attached to or accompanying this offering circular. The risks described below are not the only ones we face. Additional risks not currently known to us or that we currently believe to be immaterial may also adversely affect our business. If any of these risks occur, our business and operating results could be harmed and the value of your investment could be significantly reduced. Some risks that could cause our results to vary are discussed below.
We have $37.5 million of existing notes outstanding that will mature in 2004.
We issued $57.5 million in principal amount of existing notes in February 1997, thus substantially increasing our ratio of long-term debt to total capitalization (shareholders equity plus long-term debt). Holders of existing notes may convert their existing notes into our common stock at a conversion price of $20.625 per share, which is substantially above the last reported sale price of our common stock of $4.12 per share on June 20, 2002. As a result, holders of existing notes are unlikely to convert their existing notes into common stock, unless the market price of our common stock increases to a price greater than the conversion price of the existing notes. In 1999 and 2001, we spent $11.9 million to repurchase $20.0 million aggregate principal amount of the existing notes. The currently outstanding principal amount of $37.5 million of existing notes will require us to make principal and interest payments through the maturity date of March 1, 2004 that are significantly in excess of our $14.5 million balance of cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments at March 30, 2002. Even if we meet our operating forecasts, we do not expect to generate enough cash to repay the currently outstanding aggregate principal amount of the existing notes on their March 1, 2004 maturity date. As a result, we are conducting this exchange offer to extend the maturity date of our debt and to reduce the total amount of our debt outstanding, while improving our ability to attract new debt or equity investors.
Our ability to meet our debt payment obligations depends upon our future operating performance and cash flow.
Our ability to make scheduled debt payments, even if the exchange offer is successful, depends on our future operating performance and cash flow. Our operating performance and cash flow, in part, are subject to business, financial and economic factors beyond our control.
Our significant amount of debt could have a negative effect on us and our security holders.
Our significant amount of debt could harm Intevac and holders of our common stock and existing notes, and any exchange notes issued in the exchange offer, in many ways, including:
| reducing the funds available to finance our business operations and for other corporate purposes because a portion of our cash flow from operations must be dedicated to the payment of principal and interest on our debt; | |
| impairing our ability to obtain additional financing for working capital, capital expenditures, acquisitions or general corporate purposes; | |
| increasing our vulnerability to increases in interest rates; | |
| placing us at a competitive disadvantage because we are substantially more leveraged than certain of our competitors; | |
| hindering our ability to adjust rapidly to changing market conditions; and | |
| making us more vulnerable financially in the event of a further downturn in general economic conditions or in our business. |
9
We may undertake significant additional financing transactions in order to maintain sufficient cash to conduct our operations.
Even if the exchange offer is successfully completed and holders tender at least $30 million principal amount of existing notes, which is the minimum amount of existing notes required to be tendered in the exchange offer, our cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments of approximately $14.5 million as of March 30, 2002 will be reduced by the amount of cash paid in the exchange offer. If all the existing notes are submitted and accepted in the exchange offer, we will be required to pay approximately $7.0 million in cash in the exchange offer. As a result, we may need to obtain additional financing to fund our future operations. We may seek to raise additional funds through a variety of alternative sources, including the sale of additional securities or from other financing arrangements or assets sales. Our board of directors has from time to time considered a number of possible transactions. Such transactions might include:
| attempting to raise additional equity through public or private offerings, | |
| attempting to raise additional debt financing, | |
| undertaking a rights offering to obtain financing from our existing shareholders, | |
| selling off a portion of our assets to raise additional capital, or | |
| obtaining a line of credit. |
We may undertake one or more of these transactions shortly following completion of the exchange offer. We currently have no binding commitments or plans with regard to any other financing alternatives other than the proposed transactions described under the caption Financing Strategy. We do not know whether we will be able to complete any of these transactions on a timely basis, on terms satisfactory to us, or at all. For example, we may not have access to new capital in the public or private markets until our results of operations improve, if at all. In addition, some of these transactions may result in significant dilution to our existing security holders or impairment of their rights. Nonetheless, if we are unable to complete one or more of these transactions, our ability to maintain our ongoing operations, and to pay principal and interest in cash on the exchange notes or existing notes when due, may be jeopardized.
The majority of our new products address new and emerging markets.
We have invested heavily in the development of products that address new markets. The Equipment Division has developed a flexible deposition tool and a rapid thermal processing tool to address growing segments of the FPD equipment market intended to displace products offered by competing manufacturers. The Photonics Divisions LIVAR ® target identification system and low-cost low-light level camera products are designed to offer significantly improved capability relative to any products currently offered in the marketplace. Additionally, the Photonics Division is entering a new market for Intevac with its photodiodes for fiber optic communication systems. Failure of these products to perform as intended or to successfully penetrate these new markets and develop into profitable product lines will have an adverse effect on our business.
Demand for capital equipment is cyclical.
Our Equipment Division sells capital equipment to capital intensive industries, which sell commodity products such as flat panel displays and disk drives. These industries operate with high fixed costs. When demand for these commodity products exceeds capacity, then demand for new capital equipment such as ours tends to be amplified. When supply of these commodity products exceeds demand then the demand for new capital equipment such as ours tends to be depressed. The cyclical nature of the capital equipment industry means that in some years sales of new systems by us will be unusually high, and that in other years sales of new systems by us will be severely depressed. We are currently in a period where sales of new systems for disk production are depressed. Failure to anticipate or respond quickly to the industry business cycle has had, and could continue to have, an adverse effect on our business.
10
Our Equipment business is subject to rapid technical change.
Our ability to remain competitive requires substantial investments in research and development. The failure to develop, manufacture and market new systems, or to enhance existing systems, will have an adverse effect on our business. From time to time, we have experienced delays in the introduction of, and technical difficulties with, some of our systems and enhancements. Our success in developing and selling equipment will depend upon a variety of factors, including our ability to accurately predict future customer requirements, technological advances, cost of ownership, our introduction of new products on schedule, cost-effective manufacturing and product performance in the field. Our new product decisions and development commitments must anticipate continuously evolving industry requirements significantly in advance of sales. Any failure to accurately predict customer requirements and to develop new generations of products to meet those requirements would have an adverse effect on our business.
Our products are complex, constantly evolving and are often designed and manufactured to individual customer requirements that require additional engineering.
Our Equipment Division products have a large number of components and are highly complex. We may experience delays and technical and manufacturing difficulties in future introductions or volume production of new systems or enhancements. In addition, some of the systems that we manufacture must be customized to meet specific customer site or operating requirements. We have limited manufacturing capacity and engineering resources and may be unable to complete the development, manufacture and shipment of these products, or to meet the required technical specifications for these products in a timely manner. Such delays could lead to rescheduling of orders in backlog, or in extreme situations, to cancellation of orders. In addition, we may incur substantial unanticipated costs early in a products life cycle, such as increased engineering, manufacturing, installation and support costs, that we may be unable to pass on to the customer. In some instances, we depend upon a sole supplier or a limited number of suppliers for complex components or sub-assemblies utilized in our products. Any of these factors could adversely affect our business.
Our Photonics Division does not yet generate significant revenues from product sales.
To date, the activities of our Photonics Division have concentrated on the development of its technology and prototype products that demonstrate this technology. Revenues for this division have been derived primarily from research and development contracts funded by the United States Government and its contractors and our Photonics Division has yet to earn an annual profit. We continue to develop standard photonics products for sale to military and commercial customers. The Photonics Division will require substantial additional investment in sales and marketing, in product development and in additional production facilities to support the planned transition to volume sales of photonics products to military and commercial customers. There can be no assurance that we will succeed in these activities and generate significant sales of products based on our photonics technology or that if the holders of a significant amount of existing notes do not participate in the exchange offer, that we will have adequate funds to pursue the full potential of our photonic products.
The sales of our equipment products are dependent on substantial capital investment by our customers.
The purchase of our systems, and the purchase of other related equipment and facilities, requires extremely large capital expenditures by our customers. These costs are far in excess of the cost of our systems alone. The magnitude of such capital expenditures requires that our customers have access to large amounts of capital and that they are willing to invest that capital over long periods of time to be able to purchase our equipment. Some of our customers, particularly those that would otherwise purchase our disk manufacturing products, may not be willing, or able, to make the magnitude of capital investment required.
Rapid increases in areal density are reducing the number of thin-film disks required per disk drive.
Over the past few years the amount of data that can be stored on a single thin-film computer disk has been increasing at approximately 100% per year. Although the number of disk drives produced has continued
11
Our competitors are large and well financed and competition is intense.
We experience intense competition in the Equipment Division. For example, our equipment products experience competition worldwide from competitors including Anelva Corporation, Ulvac Japan, Ltd. and Unaxis Holdings, Ltd., each of which have sold substantial numbers of systems worldwide. Anelva, Ulvac and Unaxis all have substantially greater financial, technical, marketing, manufacturing and other resources than we do. There can be no assurance that our competitors will not develop enhancements to, or future generations of, competitive products that will offer superior price or performance features or that new competitors will not enter our markets and develop such enhanced products.
Given the lengthy sales cycle and the significant investment required to integrate equipment into the manufacturing process, we believe that once a manufacturer has selected a particular suppliers equipment for a specific application, that manufacturer generally relies upon that suppliers equipment and frequently will continue to purchase any additional equipment for that application from the same supplier. Accordingly, competition for customers in the equipment industry is intense, and suppliers of equipment may offer substantial pricing concessions and incentives to attract new customers or retain existing customers.
Our business depends on the integrity of our intellectual property rights.
There can be no assurance that:
| any of our pending or future patent applications will be allowed or that any of the allowed applications will issue as patents; | |
| any of our patents will not be invalidated, deemed unenforceable, circumvented or challenged; | |
| the rights granted under our patents will provide competitive advantages to us; | |
| any of our pending or future patent applications will issue with claims of the scope sought by us, if at all; | |
| others will not develop similar products, duplicate our products or design around our patents; or | |
| patent rights, intellectual property laws or our agreements will adequately protect our intellectual property rights. |
Failure to adequately protect our intellectual property rights could have an adverse effect upon our business.
From time to time, we have received claims that we are infringing third parties intellectual property rights. There can be no assurance that third parties will not in the future claim infringement by us with respect to current or future patents, trademarks, or other proprietary rights relating to our disk sputtering systems, flat panel manufacturing equipment or other products. Any present or future claims, with or without merit, could be time-consuming, result in costly litigation, cause product shipment delays or require us to enter into royalty or licensing agreements. Such royalty or licensing agreements, if required, may not be available on terms acceptable to us, or at all. Any of the foregoing could have an adverse effect upon our business.
Our operating results fluctuate significantly.
Over the last nine quarters our operating loss as a percentage of net revenues has fluctuated between approximately 59% and 1% of net revenues. Over the same period our sales per quarter have fluctuated between $23.6 million and $5.9 million. We anticipate that our sales and operating margins will continue to fluctuate. As a result, period-to-period comparisons of our results of operations are not necessarily meaningful and should not be relied upon as indications of future performance.
12
Operating costs in northern California are high.
Our operations are located in Santa Clara, California. The cost of living in northern California is extremely high, which increases both the cost of doing business and the cost and difficulty of recruiting new employees. Our operating results depend in significant part upon our ability to effectively manage costs and to retain and attract qualified management, engineering, marketing, manufacturing, customer support, sales and administrative personnel. The failure to control costs and to attract and retain qualified personnel could have an adverse effect on our business.
Business interruptions could adversely affect our business.
Our operations are vulnerable to interruption by fire, earthquake, power loss, telecommunications failure and other events beyond our control. Additionally, the costs of electricity and natural gas have increased significantly. Any further cost increases will impact our ability to achieve profitability.
A majority of our sales are to international customers.
Sales and operating activities outside of the United States are subject to inherent risks, including fluctuations in the value of the United States dollar relative to foreign currencies, tariffs, quotas, taxes and other market barriers, political and economic instability, restrictions on the export or import of technology, potentially limited intellectual property protection, difficulties in staffing and managing international operations and potentially adverse tax consequences. We earn a significant portion of our revenue from international sales, and there can be no assurance that any of these factors will not have an adverse effect on our business.
We generally quote and sell our products in US dollars. However, for some Japanese customers, we quote and sell our products in Japanese yen. From time to time, we enter into foreign currency contracts in an effort to reduce the overall risk of currency fluctuations to our business. However, there can be no assurance that the offer and sale of products denominated in foreign currencies, and the related foreign currency hedging activities will not adversely affect our business.
Our two principal competitors for disk sputtering equipment are based in foreign countries and have cost structures based on foreign currencies. Accordingly, currency fluctuations could cause our products to be more, or less, competitive than our competitors products. Currency fluctuations will decrease, or increase, our cost structure relative to those of our competitors, which could impact our competitive position.
We expect the market price of our common stock, existing notes and exchange notes to be volatile.
The market price of our common stock has experienced both significant increases in valuation, and significant decreases in valuation, over short periods of time. We believe that factors such as announcements of developments related to our business, fluctuations in our operating results, failure to meet securities analysts expectations, general conditions in the disk drive and thin-film media manufacturing industries and the worldwide economy, announcements of technological innovations, new systems or product enhancements by us or our competitors, fluctuations in the level of cooperative development funding, acquisitions, changes in governmental regulations, developments in patents or other intellectual property rights and changes in our relationships with customers and suppliers could cause the price of our common stock to continue to fluctuate substantially. In addition, in recent years the stock market in general, and the market for small capitalization and high technology stocks in particular, has experienced extreme price fluctuations that have often been unrelated to the operating performance of affected companies. Any of these factors could adversely affect the market price of our common stock and the market price of the existing notes and exchange notes that are convertible into such common stock.
We routinely evaluate acquisition candidates and other diversification strategies.
We have completed multiple acquisitions as part of our efforts to expand and diversify our business. For example, our business was initially acquired from Varian Associates in 1991. Additionally, we acquired our current gravity lubrication, CSS test equipment and rapid thermal processing product lines in three
13
We use hazardous materials.
We are subject to a variety of governmental regulations relating to the use, storage, discharge, handling, emission, generation, manufacture, treatment and disposal of toxic or otherwise hazardous substances, chemicals, materials or waste. Any failure to comply with current or future regulations could result in substantial civil penalties or criminal fines being imposed on us or our officers, directors or employees, suspension of production, alteration of our manufacturing process or cessation of operations. Such regulations could require us to acquire expensive remediation or abatement equipment or to incur substantial expenses to comply with environmental regulations. Any failure by us to properly manage the use, disposal or storage of, or adequately restrict the release of, hazardous or toxic substances could subject us to significant liabilities.
Our directors and executive officers control a majority of our outstanding common stock.
Based on the number of shares of our common stock outstanding as of March 30, 2002, our directors and their affiliates and our executive officers, in the aggregate, beneficially own a majority of the outstanding shares of common stock. These shareholders, acting together, are able to effectively control all matters requiring approval by our shareholders, including the election of a majority of the directors and approval of significant corporate transactions. Two of our directors also hold in the aggregate 6.6% of the outstanding existing notes.
The exchange notes are subordinated to our senior debt, but senior in payment to the existing notes.
The exchange notes will be unsecured and subordinated in right of payment to our senior debt under the exchange notes indenture although the exchange notes are senior to the existing notes. As a result of such subordination, in the event of our liquidation or insolvency, a payment default with respect to senior debt, a covenant default with respect to designated senior debt or acceleration of the exchange notes due to an event of default, our assets will be available to pay obligations on the exchange notes only after all senior debt has been paid in full, and there may not be sufficient assets remaining to pay amounts due on any or all of the exchange notes then outstanding. Neither we nor our subsidiaries are prohibited under the exchange note indenture from incurring debt. As of March 30, 2002, we had no senior debt.
Neither the indenture governing the existing notes nor the indenture governing the exchange notes contains any financial performance covenants.
Neither the indenture governing the existing notes nor the indenture governing the exchange notes contains any financial performance covenants. Consequently, we will not be required under either indenture to meet any financial tests, such as those that measure our working capital, interest coverage, fixed charge coverage or net worth, to comply with the terms of the indentures.
We may not have the financial resources to repurchase the existing notes or exchange notes in the event of a transaction resulting in a change of control, the termination of trading of our common stock or a distribution of the capital stock of a subsidiary constituting our Photonics business.
We may be unable to repurchase the existing notes or exchange notes in the event of a transaction that results in a change in control or, in the case of the existing notes, if a termination of trading of our common stock occurs, or, in the case of the exchange notes, a distribution to all of the holders of our common stock of the
14
There may not be a public market for the existing notes or the exchange notes.
An active trading market for the existing notes does not exist, and an active trading market for the exchange notes may not develop after the consummation of the exchange offer. The exchange notes may not be liquid, which could affect your ability to sell your exchange notes or to determine the price at which you may be able to sell your exchange notes. Future trading prices of the exchange notes will depend upon many factors including, among other things, prevailing interest rates, our operating results, the price of the common stock and the market for similar securities. If a substantial portion of the existing notes is exchanged in the exchange offer, the liquidity of the remaining outstanding existing notes may be further reduced.
The exchange notes may not be rated or may receive a lower rating than anticipated.
We believe it is unlikely that the exchange notes will be rated. However, if one or more rating agencies rate the exchange notes and assign the exchange notes a rating lower than the rating expected by investors, or reduce the rating of the exchange notes in the future, the market price of the exchange notes and our common stock may be adversely affected.
If we automatically convert the exchange notes, you should be aware that there is a substantial risk that the price of our common stock could fluctuate from the date on which we elect to automatically convert to the conversion date.
We may elect to automatically convert the exchange notes on or prior to maturity if the closing price of our common stock has exceeded 150% of the conversion price for at least 20 trading days during any period of 30 trading days ending within five trading days prior to the notice of automatic conversion. You should be aware that there is a substantial risk that the price of our common stock could fluctuate between the date when we first elect to automatically convert the exchange notes by issuing the notice of automatic conversion and the automatic conversion date.
Adjustments to the conversion price of the exchange notes could result in tax liability.
The terms of the exchange notes allow for changes in the conversion price in particular circumstances. A change in conversion price that allows you to receive more shares of common stock on conversion may increase your proportionate interest in our earnings and profits or assets. In that case, you would be treated as
15
FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
This offering circular contains forward-looking statements which involve risks and uncertainties. Words such as believes, expects, anticipates and the like indicate forward-looking statements. Intevacs actual results may differ materially from those discussed in the forward-looking statements. Factors that might cause such a difference include, but are not limited to, the risk factors set forth elsewhere in this offering circular and in other documents Intevac files from time to time with the Securities and Exchange Commission, including Intevacs Annual Report on Form 10-K, Form 10-Qs and Form 8-Ks. Except as otherwise required by law, Intevac undertakes no obligation to update its forward-looking statements.
16
USE OF PROCEEDS
We will not receive any proceeds from the
exchange offer.
PRICE RANGE OF COMMON STOCK
Our common stock commenced trading on the Nasdaq
National Market November 21, 1995 and is traded under the
symbol IVAC. As of March 30, 2002, there were
approximately 2,000 holders of record of our common stock. The
following table sets forth for the periods indicated the high
and low closing sale prices for our common stock as reported on
the Nasdaq National Market.
High
Low
$
8.000
$
3.500
4.625
2.688
7.090
3.313
5.130
3.130
$
5.890
$
3.500
5.950
4.400
4.980
1.950
4.240
2.380
$
4.390
$
2.380
5.110
3.650
TRADING MARKET FOR EXISTING NOTES
Although the existing notes trade in the over-the-counter market, there is only limited trading of the existing notes.
DIVIDEND POLICY
We currently anticipate that we will continue to retain our earnings, if any, for use in the operation of our business and do not expect to pay cash dividends on our capital stock in the foreseeable future.
17
CAPITALIZATION
The following table sets forth cash and cash equivalents, long term debt and the unaudited consolidated capitalization of Intevac:
| at March 30, 2002; and | |
| at March 30, 2002 as adjusted to give effect to the issuance of the exchange notes and the payment of cash in the exchange offer, based on the assumption that all of the outstanding existing notes had been exchanged on March 30, 2002 pursuant to the terms of the exchange offer, and the payment of expenses related to the exchange offer. |
To the extent that less than all of the existing
notes are validly tendered and accepted in the exchange offer,
cash and cash equivalents would increase, the amounts attributed
to the exchange notes would decrease and the amounts attributed
to the existing notes would increase. The financial data at
March 30, 2002 in the following table is derived from our
unaudited financial statements for the quarter ended
March 30, 2002. This table should be read in conjunction
with our consolidated financial statements, related notes and
other information included in or attached to this offering
circular.
March 30, 2002
Actual
As Adjusted
(in thousands)
(unaudited)
$
14,464
$
6,918
$
37,545
$
30,599
19,237
19,237
135
135
(19,951
)
(20,500
)
(579
)
(1,128
)
$
36,966
$
29,471
(1) | The reduction in cash and cash equivalents reflects $6,946,000 of cash paid to the noteholders upon the assumed exchange of $37,545,000 of the existing notes and $600,000 cash paid as transaction costs in connection with this exchange offer. |
The $6,918,000 as adjusted cash balance excludes the effect of an anticipated approximately $6,000,000 refund of Federal income taxes that the Company expects to receive during the third quarter of 2002. The anticipated refund is related to 1996, 1997 and 1998 taxes previously paid by the Company. Although the Company expects to receive the entire amount, the exact timing and amount of the refund is subject to Internal Revenue Service review. | |
(2) | Outstanding shares exclude the shares reserved for issuance upon conversion of the exchange notes, shares reserved for issuance upon conversion of the existing notes, 2,079,251 shares issuable under our employee stock option plan and 237,585 shares issuable under our employee stock purchase plan. |
18
SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA
The following selected financial data should be
read in conjunction with our consolidated financial statements,
related notes and other financial information included or
attached to this offering circular. The consolidated statement
of operations data for the fiscal years ended December 31,
2001 and 2000 and the consolidated balance sheet data as of
December 31, 2001 and 2000 are derived from the audited
consolidated financial statements included or attached to this
offering circular. The consolidated statements of operations
data for the fiscal years ended December 31, 1999, 1998,
and 1997 and the consolidated balance sheet data as of
December 31, 1999, 1998 and 1997 are derived from the
audited consolidated financial statements previously filed with
the SEC. The consolidated statement of operations data for the
three months ended March 30, 2002 and March 31, 2001
and the consolidated balance sheet data as of March 30,
2002 are derived from our unaudited consolidated financial
statements included or attached to this offering circular. In
the opinion of management, our unaudited consolidated financial
statements have been prepared on a basis consistent with our
audited consolidated financial statements and reflect
adjustments, consisting only of normal recurring adjustments,
necessary for the fair presentation of our results of operations
and financial position for the periods presented. These results
are not necessarily indicative of the results that may be
expected for future periods.
Three Months Ended
Year Ended December 31,
March 31,
March 30,
1997
1998
1999
2000
2001
2001
2002
(unaudited)
(in thousands, except per share data)
$
133,207
$
95,975
$
42,962
$
36,049
$
51,484
$
10,005
$
6,670
91,255
71,717
40,410
34,059
41,729
6,605
5,707
41,952
24,258
2,552
1,990
9,755
3,400
963
10,716
12,473
14,136
10,576
14,478
3,496
3,129
11,399
10,879
7,226
4,415
6,745
1,669
1,710
1,088
3,069
(638
)
299
22,414
24,710
24,431
14,353
21,223
5,165
4,839
19,538
(452
)
(21,879
)
(12,363
)
(11,468
)
(1,765
)
(3,876
)
(3,581
)
(4,187
)
(3,711
)
(3,033
)
(2,912
)
(738
)
(667
)
3,268
3,176
3,632
3,072
1,065
(1,292
)
185
19,225
(1,463
)
(21,958
)
(12,324
)
(13,315
)
(3,795
)
(4,358
)
6,728
(882
)
(8,344
)
4,424
(2,214
)
12,497
(581
)
(13,614
)
(12,324
)
(17,739
)
(3,795
)
(2,144
)
1,005
3,844
803
$
12,497
$
424
$
(9,770
)
$
(12,324
)
$
(16,936
)
$
(3,795
)
$
(2,144
)
$
1.00
$
(0.05
)
$
(1.16
)
$
(1.04
)
$
(1.48
)
$
(0.32
)
$
(0.18
)
$
1.00
$
0.04
$
(0.83
)
$
(1.04
)
$
(1.42
)
$
(0.32
)
$
(0.18
)
12,514
12,052
11,777
11,803
11,955
11,896
12,041
$
0.94
$
(0.05
)
$
(1.16
)
$
(1.04
)
$
(1.48
)
$
(0.32
)
$
(0.18
)
$
0.94
$
0.03
$
(0.83
)
$
(1.04
)
$
(1.42
)
$
(0.32
)
$
(0.18
)
15,835
12,354
11,777
11,803
11,955
11,896
12,041
19
At December 31,
At
March 30,
1997
1998
1999
2000
2001
2002
(unaudited)
(in thousands)
$
71,142
$
60,916
$
40,895
$
38,403
$
18,157
$
14,464
78,025
77,774
51,579
41,093
27,160
26,359
147,794
122,976
94,382
83,936
60,165
61,296
59,480
59,461
43,188
41,245
37,545
37,545
42,435
40,436
29,623
17,804
1,408
(579
)
5.4x
0.7x
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
(1) | Computed by dividing earnings by fixed charges. For the purposes of computing the ratio of earnings to fixed charges, earnings consist of income (loss) before provision for income taxes plus fixed charges. Fixed charges consist of interest expense, amortization of debt discount and issuance costs on all indebtedness, and the estimated portion of rental expense deemed by Intevac to be representative of the interest factor of rental payments under operating leases. For the years ended December 31, 1998, 1999, 2000 and 2001, earnings from continuing operations were not sufficient to cover fixed charges by $1,463,000, $21,958,000, $12,324,000 and $13,315,000, respectively. For the three months ended March 30, 2002, earnings from continuing operations were not sufficient to cover fixed charges by $4,358,000. |
20
UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA
The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial data and accompanying notes are presented to reflect the impact of the exchange offer on our consolidated statements of operations for the year ended December 31, 2001 and for the three months ended March 30, 2002 as if the exchange offer had been effected at January 1, 2001 and January 1, 2002, respectively.
The pro forma adjustments are based upon available information and upon certain assumptions that we believe are reasonable. The unaudited pro forma consolidated financial data should be read in conjunction with our unaudited consolidated financial statements set forth in our Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarterly period ended March 30, 2002 and our audited consolidated financial statements set forth in our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2001, each of which is attached as an appendix, and Capitalization and Selected Consolidated Financial Data, included in this offering circular.
The unaudited pro forma financial data is
presented for illustrative purposes only and is not indicative
of our future financial position or future results of operations
after completion of this exchange offering or our future
financial position or future results of operations that would
have occurred if the exchange offering had been consummated as
of the dates described above.
Year Ended December 31, 2001
Three Months Ended March 30, 2002
As
As
Reported
Adjustments
Pro Forma
Reported
Adjustments
Pro Forma
(in thousands, except per share data)
$
51,484
$
$
51,484
$
6,670
$
$
6,670
41,729
41,729
5,707
5,707
9,755
9,755
963
963
14,478
14,478
3,129
3,129
6,745
6,745
1,710
1,710
21,223
21,223
4,839
4,839
(11,468
)
(11,468
)
(3,876
)
(3,876
)
(2,912
)
(225
)
(3,137
)
(667
)
(454
)
(1,121
)
1,065
1,065
185
185
(13,315
)
(225
)
(13,540
)
(4,358
)
(454
)
(4,812
)
4,424
4,424
(2,214
)
(2,214
)
(17,739
)
(225
)
(17,964
)
(2,144
)
(454
)
(2,598
)
803
803
$
(16,936
)
$
(225
)
$
(17,161
)
$
(2,144
)
$
(454
)
$
(2,598
)
21
Year Ended December 31, 2001
Three Months Ended March 30, 2002
As
As
Reported
Adjustments
Pro Forma
Reported
Adjustments
Pro Forma
(in thousands, except per share data)
$
(1.48
)
$
(1.50
)
$
(0.18
)
$
(0.22
)
$
(1.42
)
$
(1.44
)
$
(0.18
)
$
(0.22
)
11,955
11,955
12,041
12,041
The impact of the exchange offer on the Balance
Sheet at March 30, 2002 is presented as if the exchange
offer had been effective March 30, 2002.
At March 30, 2002
As Reported
Adjustments
Pro Forma
(in thousands)
$
14,464
$
(7,546
)
$
6,918
26,359
(7,546
)
18,813
61,296
(7,495
)
53,801
37,545
(6,946
)
30,599
(579
)
(549
)
(1,128
)
N/A
N/A
$
(0.05
)
$
(0.09
)
Assumptions and Footnotes:
(1) | The reduction in cash and cash equivalents reflects $6,946,000 of cash paid to the noteholders upon the assumed exchange of $37,545,000 of the existing notes and $600,000 cash paid as transaction costs in connection with this exchange offer. |
(2) | In addition to the $7,546,000 reduction in cash, unamortized debt issuance costs of $438,000 will be eliminated in connection with the extinguishment of the $37,545,000 of existing notes. Debt issuance cost of $489,000 related to this offering will be capitalized and amortized over the life of the exchange notes. |
(3) | The decrease in shareholders equity consists of the elimination of the debt issuance costs relating to $37,545,000 of existing notes and the write-off of $111,000 of debt issuance costs related to the cash portion of this offering. |
(4) | Computed by dividing earnings by fixed charges. For the purposes of computing the ratio of earnings to fixed charges, earnings consist of income (loss) before provision for income taxes plus fixed charges. Fixed charges consist of interest expense, amortization of debt discount and issuance costs on all indebtedness, and the estimated portion of rental expense deemed by the Company to be representative of the interest factor of rental payments under operating leases. For the three months ended March 30, 2002, pro forma earnings from continuing operations were not sufficient to cover fixed charges by $4,812,000. |
22
BUSINESS
Our businesses are the design, manufacture and sale of complex capital equipment used to manufacture products such as flat panel displays, thin-film disks and electro-optical devices (Equipment) and the development of highly sensitive electro-optical devices and systems (Photonics).
Systems sold by the Equipment Division are typically used to deposit highly engineered thin-films of material on a substrate, or to modify the characteristics and properties of thin-films already deposited on a substrate. Systems manufactured by the Equipment Division generally utilize proprietary manufacturing techniques and processes and operate under high levels of vacuum. The systems are designed for high-volume continuous operation and use precision robotics, computerized controls and complex software programs to fully automate and control the production process. Products manufactured with these systems include color cell phone displays, automotive displays, computer monitors, and thin-film disks for computer hard disk drives. The Equipment Division has also designed ultra-high vacuum automated equipment for the manufacture of low-cost low-light level cameras developed by the Photonics Division and for sale to other manufacturers of electro-optical devices. The Equipment Division recorded sales of $42.7 million in 2001, an increase from $28.8 million in 2000. Equipment Division revenues in 2001 resulted primarily from the sales of new flat panel display, or FPD, manufacturing systems and technology upgrades, spare parts and consumables for upgrades to disk and manufacturing equipment.
The Photonics Division is developing electro-optical devices and systems that permit highly sensitive detection of photons in the visible and short wave infrared portions of the spectrum. This development work is aimed at creating new products for both military and industrial applications. Products include LIVAR® systems for positive target identification at long range, low-cost low-light-level cameras for use in security and military applications and photodiodes for use in high-speed fiber optic systems. Photonics Division sales increased to $8.8 million in 2001 from $7.3 million in 2000 and consisted primarily of contract research and development. The Photonics Division has completed approximately $30 million of government-sponsored research and development since 1994.
We were incorporated in California in 1991. Our principal office is located at 3560 Bassett Street, Santa Clara, California 95054, and our telephone number is (408) 986-9888. Our world wide web address is http://www.intevac.com. Information on our web site does not constitute part of this offering circular.
Equipment
Technology and Strategy |
The Equipment Divisions systems utilize sophisticated vacuum process technologies that are integrated with precision robotics and automated process and system controls. Our systems are designed for high volume manufacturing applications and are commonly operated 24 hours a day 7 days a week with high uptime. Process technologies include physical vapor deposition, chemical vapor deposition, fast cooling, rapid thermal processing, lubrication and ultra high vacuum level processing. Our Equipment Divisions strategy is to expand into growing equipment markets where its existing technology base can be leveraged to reduce the cost of entry and participation in those markets. For example, the deposition and rapid thermal processing equipment developed to address the FPD market and the equipment developed to manufacture Photonics Division low-cost low-light level cameras incorporate many of the manufacturing technologies previously developed by us for high volume manufacturing of thin-film disks and night vision devices.
Deposition Equipment for Flat Panel Display Manufacturing |
The manufacture of several types of flat panel displays, such as active matrix liquid crystal displays, requires the deposition of thin-film layers of different materials onto a glass substrate. Our D-STAR® sputtering systems are designed to uniformly coat thin films on substrates as large as a meter square. Deposition materials include metals such as aluminum and chromium (used as conductors), indium tin oxide (used as transparent conductors) and complex oxides of materials such as magnesium (used in plasma displays), tantalum and silicon. Process modules are positioned around a central handling module designed to
23
Rapid Thermal Processing Equipment for Flat Panel Display Manufacturing |
Our rapid thermal processing, or RTP, systems rapidly modify the characteristics of thin films deposited on glass substrates used in the manufacture of flat panel displays. Our patented RTP technology enables manufacturers to change the properties of these thin-films by thermally processing the film layer at temperatures that would otherwise distort or destroy the underlying glass substrate. The RTP system employs rapid transient heating, rather than bulk substrate heating, which provides lower cost of ownership and higher throughput as compared to furnace and laser processing techniques. In transient heating, a uniform line of radiation is focused onto a moving substrate, which brings only a narrow stripe of the substrate up to peak process temperature at any time. The substrate remains undistorted because the large majority of its area is relatively cool and acts to stabilize the overall panel. Our RTP systems are typically used for thin-film activation after ion implant in the manufacture of low temperature polysilicon displays. Our RTP system customers include Sanyo, Sharp, Sony, Toppoly and a joint venture of Sony and Toyota.
Equipment for Disk Manufacturing |
We have delivered approximately 110 Intevac MDP-250® disk manufacturing systems to customers including Fuji Electric, Fujitsu Limited, Hitachi, Komag, Maxtor, Mitsubishi, Nippon Sheet Glass, Seagate Technology, Sony and Trace Storage Technology. Our systems are used by disk manufacturers to apply thin layers of undercoats, magnetic alloys and protective overcoats to both aluminum and glass thin-film disks used in computer hard disk drives. We believe that our systems are used to manufacture approximately half the worldwide supply of these disks. The mechanical design of the MDP-250 family has characteristics similar to the cluster tools widely used in semiconductor manufacturing in that each of the twelve process stations is separately vacuum pumped and vacuum isolated. The MDP-250 does not require a carrier or pallet to transport disks through the system. Rather, disks are automatically loaded into the system from cassettes, processed, and then automatically returned to a cassette. A number of process station options are offered, including multiple options for the deposition of thin-films and carbon overcoats, heating stations, cooling stations and cleaning stations. Furthermore, these twelve process stations can be easily reconfigured to accommodate process changes.
The rapid increase in areal density in computer memory storage is requiring the thin-films deposited by our MDP-250 series of equipment to become more complex. This complexity is leading to the need for both new process capabilities and a need for more than twelve process stations. We continue to develop new process capabilities for the installed base of systems. These new capabilities include processes that permit the deposition of ultra-thin diamond-like carbon overcoats, vapor lubrication and, currently in development, multi-layer sources and soft underlayer sources necessary for perpendicular recording. To answer the need for more process stations, we introduced the MDP-200, a modular upgrade that allows manufacturers to seamlessly integrate additional process stations onto their MDP-250 systems. The MDP-200 provides the capability to process disks through process stations serially or in parallel, which provides manufacturers flexibility to integrate process steps with different process times. We also developed a suite of system upgrades (MDP-250B+ Upgrades) that allow manufacturers to upgrade the vacuum level, speed and control systems of their installed base of MDP-250 systems.
The process and system technologies that we developed for our MDP-250 systems have been designed to be backwards compatible and, in many cases, field installable. We believe that the primary demand for disk manufacturing equipment in the next few years will be for upgrades to the installed base of systems, rather than for sales of new systems to add capacity. Our strategy is to provide our customers with a cost-effective solution that significantly upgrades and extends the capabilities of their installed base of equipment.
24
Electron Beam Processing Equipment |
In December 1999, we implemented a plan to terminate our electron beam product line. The plan included the delivery of the three electron beam systems on order, closure of the Hayward facility where the systems were manufactured and a $1.6 million charge related to the plan. In March 2000, we sold the electron beam business to Quemex Technology, Ltd. and Quemex assumed responsibility for our Hayward facility. We retained rights to the three systems on order, which were subsequently sold during 2000 and 2001.
Photonics
History |
Our Photonics products have been developed by a team that initially began working together in the 1980s in the Varian central research labs and night vision business unit. When we were formed in 1991, we acquired Varians night vision business and related Varian central research lab activities and technology. The central research lab group became part of the R&D department for our night vision business and continued to develop our photocathode technology. In 1995, we sold our night vision business to Litton Industries. However, the technical team from the night vision business that was sold remained with us and formed the Photonics Division. Since 1995 the Photonics Division has been further developing its technology, with the majority of its activities being funded by research and development contracts from the United States Government and its contractors. During this period the Photonics Division has also worked collaboratively with other research organizations, including Stanford University, Lawrence Livermore National Laboratory and The Charles Stark Draper Laboratory.
Technology and Strategy |
The Photonics Division develops and manufactures compact electro-optical devices that permit highly sensitive detection of photons in the visible and short wave infrared portions of the spectrum. One of these sensors is an Electron Bombarded Charge Coupled Device, or EBCCD, which was originally developed under a cost-sharing Technology Development Agreement with the Defense Advanced Research Projects Agency, or DARPA, from 1996 to 1998.
The sensor has a transparent glass window on one side through which photons are focused onto a photocathode grown on the vacuum side of the window. When photons strike the photocathode through the window, electrons are emitted into the vacuum. These electrons are then electrically accelerated through the vacuum and strike a charge coupled device, or CCD, imager, which in turn outputs a high resolution, low noise video signal. These devices are extraordinarily sensitive to infrared light with frequencies just beyond the visible spectrum and are used in our LIVAR target identification system.
A second type of sensor incorporates the same basic technology described above. However, the module contains a Complementary Metal-Oxide-Semiconductor, or CMOS, imager instead of a CCD chip. This Electron Bombarded Active Pixel Sensor, or EBAPS TM , imager development was initially funded under a cost sharing project awarded to Intevac by the National Institute of Standards and Technology, or NIST.
Both of these sensors offer high sensitivity and high resolution, and work well in the visible as well as the near infrared range of the spectrum. The output is high-resolution video, rather than the low-resolution direct view green imagery produced by traditional night vision devices. This high-resolution video allows the user to avoid having to hold the device directly to the eyes and permits remote viewing and image processing. We believe these sensors have capability and features not possible with the direct view night vision devices currently in use by the military.
LIVAR Target Identification System: |
We integrated our EBCCD sensor with a laser illuminator to create the Laser Illuminated Viewing and Ranging system, or LIVAR. The LIVAR system is similar to RADAR, but with a number of improvements. The illuminator is an eye safe laser, rather than a longer wavelength microwave source. In addition, the
25
The potential benefit of the LIVAR system is clear for military conflicts like those in Kosovo and Afghanistan. In these military conflicts, the U.S. military would prefer for aircraft to operate at high altitudes where they are relatively safe from ground launched missile attacks to reduce the number of casualties to U.S. servicemen, while at the same time reducing civilian casualties and damage to other untargeted assets. However, these goals are mutually exclusive unless capability exists for positively identifying targets from long ranges that is offered by the LIVAR system.
Currently the military uses several means for target location and identification including Forward-looking InfraRed, or FLIR, and radar systems. While these systems can sense targets at relatively long ranges, the resolution is poor, making positive identification difficult or impossible. The LIVAR system complements the existing FLIR and radar technology and enables long range target identification in addition to target sensing.
The first military program planning the widespread deployment of LIVAR was approved late in 2001. Intevac is under contract for the development phase of the program and volume production is expected to commence in late 2003. In February 2002 we delivered a portable LIVAR targeting and surveillance system to the U.S. Army.
Low Cost Low Light Level Cameras |
Todays low light level cameras, derived from military night vision technology, are too expensive for most commercial applications. Our objective is to reduce this cost to $1,000 per camera, a cost at which we believe that large available markets for commercial security cameras, law enforcement and traditional military night vision tubes could be addressed. We are currently developing this low light level video camera with National Semiconductor under a program sponsored by NIST. The NIST program involves the development of a CMOS chip that integrates an active pixel imaging sensor with camera electronics by National Semiconductor, photocathode design, product integration and packaging and development of low cost manufacturing processes by our Photonics Division, and development of ultra-high vacuum automated processing and assembly equipment by our Equipment Division. We plan to begin commercial sales late in 2002.
Photodiodes for Fiber Optic Communications |
Photodiodes are an essential part of todays fiber optic communication systems. These systems transmit huge volumes of data at high speed in the form of light pulses transmitted down a thin fiber optic strand. A critical element of these systems is the photodiode that converts light pulses from the fiber optic into electrical signals. We applied our patented technology to the development of 10 gigabit per second and 40 gigabit per second Indium Gallium Arsenide Indium Phosphide photodiodes. These photodiodes offer significant advantages over conventional Indium Gallium Arsenide detectors by combining high operating speed, good responsivity, low dark current and high output. Intevac began furnishing samples of these devices in die form to fiber optic system component manufacturers during 2001.
26
FINANCING STRATEGY
We issued $57.5 million aggregate principal amount of existing notes in a private placement in 1997. The existing notes are convertible into our common stock at a conversion price of $20.625 per share. We have repurchased and retired $20.0 million of the existing notes since the issue date. We currently have $37.5 million aggregate principal amount of existing notes outstanding.
The outstanding principal amount of existing notes will require us to make principal and interest payments through the maturity date of March 1, 2004 that are significantly in excess of our $14.5 million balance of cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments at March 30, 2002. We do not expect that we will be able to generate sufficient funds from operations prior to maturity to repay the existing notes. As a result, we have commenced this exchange offer to exchange for each $1,000 principal amount of the existing notes $185 in cash and $815 of exchange notes. The exchange notes will be issued in denominations of $1,000 principal amount or integral multiples thereof. We will pay cash for any fractional portion of an exchange note that is less than $1,000 principal amount. See The Exchange Offer Terms of the Exchange Offer; Period for Tendering Existing Notes.
If we are successful in having holders tender at least $30 million principal amount of existing notes, which is the minimum amount required to be tendered in the exchange offer, we will not have to repay the exchange notes until the March 1, 2009 maturity date, rather than the March 1, 2004 maturity date for the existing notes, and we will reduce the total amount of our debt outstanding.
Even if the exchange offer is successfully completed, our cash, cash equivalents and short-term investments of approximately $14.5 million as of March 30, 2002 will be reduced by the amount of cash paid in the exchange offer. If all the existing notes are submitted and accepted in the exchange offer, we will be required to pay approximately $7.0 million in cash in the exchange offer. The maintenance of sufficient cash for our ongoing operations is critical to our future success and is subject to a number of factors, including our ability to generate cash from operations and our satisfaction of other, non-debt obligations. Even if the exchange offer is successful and we extend the maturity of a substantial portion of our debt, we may also attempt to undertake other financing alternatives to obtain additional cash to fund our future operations. However, until our results of operations improve, we may not have access to new capital in the public or private markets on terms favorable to us, if at all.
We currently have no binding commitments or plans with regard to other financing alternatives except as described below. Nonetheless, our board of directors has considered a number of other possible transactions, and we may undertake one or more of them after the completion of the exchange offer. These transactions might include:
| attempting to raise additional equity through public or private offerings, | |
| attempting to raise additional debt financing, | |
| undertaking a rights offering to obtain financing from our existing shareholders, | |
| selling a portion of our assets to raise additional capital, or | |
| obtaining a line of credit. |
We may undertake one or more of these transactions shortly following completion of the exchange offer. The determination of which, when and whether to undertake any of these transaction will depend on a number of factors, including the amount of existing notes tendered in the exchange offer and our boards estimate of our prospects for future revenues and generation of cash from operations.
One transaction that has been considered is a $5 million investment in Intevac by Mill Creek Systems LLC, an affiliate of Foster City LLC, which currently holds approximately 46% of our outstanding stock. Under the current proposed terms for the transaction, Mill Creek would lend us $5 million. This loan would be represented by a promissory note due 2012 that bears interest at 8% per annum for the first five years, then at
27
You should carefully review the matters described under Risk Factors to understand the risks affecting our ability to successfully complete the exchange offer and secure additional financing.
28
THE EXCHANGE OFFER
General
We are making the exchange offer to you in reliance on the exemption from registration provided by Section 3(a)(9) of the Securities Act. The exchange notes offered for exchange have not been and will not be registered with the SEC. The exchange notes that you receive in the exchange offer and any of our shares of common stock issuable upon conversion of the exchange notes should be freely tradable, except by persons who are considered our affiliates, as that term is defined in the Securities Act, or in some cases by persons who hold existing notes that were previously held by an affiliate of ours.
Terms of the Exchange Offer; Period for Tendering Existing Notes
This offering circular and the enclosed letter of transmittal set forth the terms and conditions of the following exchange offer, which is subject to the terms and conditions described in this offering circular.
Under this exchange offer, we are offering to exchange for each $1,000 principal amount of existing notes the following:
| $185 in cash, and | |
| $815 of exchange notes. |
The exchange notes will be issued in denominations of $1,000 principal amount or integral multiples thereof. We will pay cash for any fractional portion of an exchange note that is less than $1,000 principal amount as a result of the exchange, after aggregating all notes tendered.
We will pay interest that has accrued on the existing notes that are tendered and exchanged to the date of completion of the exchange offer.
The exchange offer is conditioned on at least $30 million principal amount of existing notes being tendered.
We expressly reserve the right to amend the exchange offer for any or no reason at any time prior to the expiration date and to not accept for exchange any existing notes in the exchange offer if any of the conditions described below under the caption Conditions to the Completion of the Exchange Offer are not satisfied. If we exercise any such right, we will give oral or written notice thereof to the exchange agent as promptly as practicable. If the exchange offer is amended in a manner determined by us to constitute a material change, we will promptly disclose such amendment or waiver in a manner reasonably calculated to inform the holders of the existing notes of such amendment or waiver and in accordance with applicable law.
This exchange offer is being extended to all holders of existing notes. As of the date of this offering circular, $37.5 million aggregate principal amount of existing notes are outstanding. This offering circular and the enclosed letter of transmittal are being sent to all holders of existing notes known to us. Approximately $4.5 million in aggregate principal amount of the existing notes, or approximately 12% of the total outstanding existing notes, were tendered in response to our Amended Offer that was scheduled to expire at 12:00 midnight, Eastern Time, on June 19, 2002, which was less than the minimum condition of $30 million principal amount of existing notes required to be tendered under the terms of the Amended Offer. The exchange offer will now expire at 12:00 midnight, Eastern Time, July 9, 2002 as a result of the new amendment outlined in this offering circular. We refer to this date and, if applicable, any date marking the extension of this date, as the expiration date in this offering circular. Subject to the conditions listed below, and assuming that we have not previously elected to amend in any respect the exchange offer for any reason or no reason, in our sole and absolute discretion, we will accept for exchange all existing notes that are properly tendered on or prior to the expiration date and not withdrawn as permitted below. See the section of this offering circular captioned Conditions to the Completion of the Exchange Offer. The form and terms of the exchange notes are described in this offering circular under the caption Description of Exchange Notes.
29
We expressly reserve the absolute right, at any time and from time to time, to extend, subject to applicable law, the period during which the exchange offer is open and thereby delay acceptance for exchange of any existing notes. If we elect to extend the period of time during which the exchange offer is open, we will give you oral or written notice of the extension and delay, as described below. If we extend the expiration date, we will also extend your right to withdraw tenders of existing notes until such extended expiration date. We will return to the registered holder, at our expense, any existing notes not accepted for exchange promptly after the expiration or termination of the exchange offer. In the case of an extension, we will issue a press release or other public announcement no later than 9:00 a.m., Eastern Time, on the next business day after the previously scheduled expiration date.
The minimum period during which the exchange offer will remain open following material changes in the terms for such exchange offer or in the information concerning such exchange offer (other than a change in the consideration being offered by us or a change in amount of existing notes sought) will depend on the facts and circumstances of such change, including the relative materiality of the terms or information changes. If we modify the amount of existing notes being sought in the exchange offer or the consideration being offered by us for the existing notes in the exchange offer, the exchange offer will remain open for at least ten business days from the date of notice of such modification. If any term of the exchange offer is amended in a manner that we determine constitutes a material change adversely affecting any holder of existing notes, we will promptly disclose the amendment in a manner reasonably calculated to inform holders of our existing notes of such amendment, and we will extend the exchange offers period so that at least five business days, or such longer period as may be required by the tender offer rules, remain after such change.
At the time the exchange notes are issued on the closing date of the exchange offer, we will pay to holders of the existing notes tendered for exchange all interest that is due and payable on such existing notes as of the closing date for the exchange offer. Interest on the exchange notes will begin to accrue as of the closing date.
Procedures for Tendering Existing Notes
To tender existing notes pursuant to the exchange offer, the exchange agent must receive prior to the expiration date at its address set forth on the back cover of this offering circular:
| with respect to existing notes held in certificated form, a properly completed and duly executed letter of transmittal and any other documents required by the letter of transmittal and the certificates for the existing notes being tendered, and | |
| with respect to beneficial interests in existing notes held in global form, delivery of such existing notes pursuant to the procedures for book-entry transfer described below as well as a confirmation of such delivery including an agents message, as defined below. |
By signing the letter of transmittal or delivering an agents message pursuant to DTCs Automatic Tender Offer Program, or ATOP, procedures, you will be deemed to have made the representations and warranties contained in the letter of transmittal in connection with your decision to participate in the exchange offer. The tender by a holder of existing notes will constitute an agreement between such holder and us in accordance with the terms and subject to the conditions set forth herein and in the applicable letter of transmittal.
The exchange agent will make a request to establish an account with respect to the existing notes at DTC for purposes of the exchange offer within two business days after the date of this offering circular. Any financial institution that is a DTC participant may make book-entry delivery of existing notes by causing DTC to transfer such existing notes into the exchange agents account at DTC in accordance with DTCs ATOP procedures. Although delivery of a holders existing notes may be effected through book-entry transfer at DTC, DTC, at the direction of the participant for such holders beneficial interest, must, in any case, transmit an agents message and any other required documents to the exchange agent at the address set forth on the back cover page of this offering circular. The exchange agent must receive the agents message and the other required documents on or prior to the expiration date. The term agents message means a message, transmitted by DTC and received by the exchange agent, that forms part of a book-entry confirmation of delivery and states that DTC has received an express acknowledgment from a participant tendering the
30
The method of delivery of existing notes and letter of transmittal and all other required documents is at your option and risk, and the delivery will be deemed made only when actually received by the exchange agent. If delivery is by mail, we recommend that registered mail, properly insured, with return receipt requested, be used. In all cases, you should allow sufficient time to assure timely delivery. No existing notes, letters of transmittal or other required documents should be sent to Intevac. You must deliver all existing notes that you wish to tender, as well as all letters of transmittal and other documents, to the exchange agent at its address set forth on the back cover of this offering circular.
If you beneficially own existing notes that are registered in the name of a broker, dealer, commercial bank, trust company or other nominee and you wish to tender your existing notes in the exchange offer, you should promptly contact the person in whose name the existing notes are registered and instruct that person to tender on your behalf. If you wish to tender in the exchange offer on your own behalf, prior to completing and executing the letter of transmittal, and delivering your existing notes, you must either make appropriate arrangements to register ownership of the existing notes in your name or obtain a properly completed bond power from the person in whose name the existing notes are registered.
Signatures on the letter of transmittal or a notice of withdrawal, as the case may be, must be guaranteed by a member firm of a registered national securities exchange or of the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc., a commercial bank or trust company having an office or correspondent in the United States, or an eligible guarantor institution within the meaning of Rule 17Ad-15 under the Exchange Act (each, an Eligible Institution) unless the existing notes tendered pursuant thereto are tendered:
| by a registered holder of existing notes who has not completed the section entitled Special Issuance Instructions or Special Delivery Instructions on the applicable letter of transmittal or | |
| for the account of an Eligible Institution. |
If the letter of transmittal is signed by trustees, executors, administrators, guardians, attorneys-in-fact, officers of corporations or others acting in a fiduciary or representative capacity, such person should so indicate when signing, and, unless waived by us, evidence satisfactory to us of their authority to so act must be submitted with such letter of transmittal.
All questions as to the validity, form, eligibility, time of receipt, acceptance and withdrawal of the tendered existing notes will be determined by us in our sole and absolute discretion, which determination will be final and binding. We reserve the absolute right to reject any and all existing notes not properly tendered or any tenders of existing notes that, if accepted for exchange, would, in the opinion of our counsel, be unlawful. We also reserve the absolute right to waive any defects or irregularities or conditions of tender as to particular existing notes. Our interpretation of the terms and conditions of the exchange offer, including the instructions in the letter of transmittal, will be final and binding on all parties. Unless waived, any defects or irregularities in connection with tenders of existing notes must be cured within such time as we shall determine. None of us, the exchange agent, or any other person shall be under any duty to give notification of defects or irregularities with respect to tenders of existing notes, nor shall we or any of them incur any liability for failure to give such notification. Tenders of existing notes will not be deemed to have been made until such irregularities have been cured or waived. Any existing notes received by the exchange agent that are not properly tendered and as to which the defects or irregularities have not been cured or waived will be returned, at our expense, by the exchange agent to such holder, unless otherwise provided in the letter of transmittal, as soon as practicable following the expiration date.
31
Guaranteed Delivery Procedures
If you desire to tender your existing notes and you cannot complete the procedures for book-entry transfer set forth above on a timely basis, you may still tender your existing notes if:
| your tender is made through an eligible institution, | |
| prior to the expiration date, the exchange agent received from the eligible institution a properly completed and duly executed letter of transmittal, or a facsimile of such letter of transmittal or an agents message pursuant to DTCs ATOP system, and notice of guaranteed delivery, substantially in the form provided by us, by facsimile transmission, mail or hand delivery that: |
(a) | sets forth the name and address of the holder of existing notes and the amount of the existing notes tendered, | |
(b) | states that the tender is being made thereby, and | |
(c) | guarantees that within three trading days after the expiration date certificates for the existing notes tendered or a book-entry confirmation of delivery and any other documents required by the letter of transmittal, if any, will be deposited by the eligible institution with the exchange agent; and |
| certificates for the existing notes tendered or book-entry confirmation of delivery and all other documents, if any, required by the letter of transmittal are received by the exchange agent within three trading days after the expiration date. |
Acceptance of Existing Notes for Exchange; Delivery of Exchange Notes and Payment
Subject to our right to amend the exchange offer at any time in our sole and absolute discretion prior to the expiration date, and upon satisfaction or waiver of all of the conditions to the exchange offer, all existing notes validly tendered and not withdrawn will be accepted, and we will pay the cash to be paid in the exchange offer and issue the exchange notes after the expiration date of the exchange offer. See Conditions to the Completion of the Exchange Offer. For purposes of the exchange offer, existing notes shall be deemed to have been accepted as validly tendered for exchange only when, as and if we have given oral or written notice thereof to the exchange agent. Any existing notes that we acquire pursuant to the exchange offer will be retired. The exchange notes will be issued only in denominations of $1,000 and integral multiples of $1,000, and we will pay cash in the exchange offer for any fractional portion of an exchange note that is less than $1,000 principal amount.
Payment of any cash consideration for existing notes that are accepted for exchange pursuant to the exchange offer and any accrued interest on existing notes will be made only after timely receipt by the exchange agent of:
| certificates for such notes or a timely book-entry confirmation of delivery of such notes into the exchange agents account at DTC; | |
| a properly completed and duly executed letter of transmittal (or an agents message instead of the letter of transmittal); and | |
| all other required documents. |
If any tendered existing notes are not accepted for any reason set forth under the caption Conditions to the Completion of the Exchange Offer, such unaccepted or unexchanged existing notes will be returned without expense to the tendering holder, if in certificated form, or credited to an account maintained with DTC promptly after the expiration or termination of the exchange offer.
32
Withdrawal Rights and Non-Acceptance
You may withdraw tenders of existing notes at any time on or prior to the expiration date, as defined above. For a withdrawal of a tender to be effective, a written notice of withdrawal must be received by the exchange agent on or prior to the expiration date at the address set forth on the back cover of this offering circular. Any such notice of withdrawal must:
| specify the name of the holder that tendered the existing notes to be withdrawn; | |
| identify the existing notes to be withdrawn, including the principal amount of such existing notes; | |
| in the case of existing notes tendered by book-entry transfer, specify the number of the account at DTC from which the existing notes were tendered and specify the name and number of the account at DTC to be credited with the withdrawn existing notes and otherwise comply with the procedures of DTC; | |
| contain a statement that such holder is withdrawing its election to have such existing notes exchanged for exchange notes; | |
| be signed by the holder in the same manner as the original signature on the letter of transmittal by which such existing notes were tendered, including any required signature guarantees, or be accompanied by documents of transfer to have the trustee with respect to the existing notes register the transfer of such existing notes in the name of the person withdrawing the tender; and | |
| specify the name in which such existing notes are registered, if different from the person who tendered such notes. |
In addition, you may withdraw any tendered existing notes after July 3, 2002, unless we have accepted your existing notes for exchange.
All questions as to the validity, form, eligibility and time of receipt of such notice will be determined by us in our sole and absolute discretion, and our determination shall be final and binding on all parties. Any existing notes so withdrawn will be deemed not to have been validly tendered for exchange for purposes of the exchange offer. Any existing notes that have been tendered for exchange but are not exchanged for any or no reason will be returned to the tendering holder thereof, at our expense, in the case of physically tendered existing notes, or credited to an account maintained with DTC for the existing notes (in the case of book-entry transfer) as soon as practicable after withdrawal, rejection of tender or termination of the exchange offer. Properly withdrawn existing notes may be retendered by following one of the procedures described under the caption Procedures for Tendering Existing Notes above at any time prior to the expiration date.
Conditions to the Completion of the Exchange Offer
We will not accept existing notes for exchange pursuant to the exchange offer and may terminate, not complete or extend the exchange offer if either one of the following conditions is not met:
| at least $30 million principal amount of existing notes are tendered by holders in the exchange offer, or | |
| the Form T-3 with respect to the exchange notes indenture is not effective under the Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as amended, prior to the expiration date. |
We may not accept existing notes for exchange and may terminate or not complete the exchange offer if:
| any action, proceeding or litigation seeking to enjoin, make illegal or delay completion of the exchange offer or otherwise relating in any manner to the exchange offer is instituted or threatened; | |
| any order, stay, judgment or decree is issued by any court, government, governmental authority or other regulatory or administrative authority and is in effect, or any statute, rule, regulation, governmental order or injunction shall have been proposed, enacted, enforced or deemed applicable to the exchange offer, any of which would or might restrain, prohibit or delay completion of the exchange offer or impair the contemplated benefits of the exchange offer to us; |
33
| any of the following occurs and the adverse effect of such occurrence shall, in our reasonable judgment, be continuing: |
- | any general suspension of trading in, or limitation on prices for, securities on any national securities exchange or in the over-the-counter market in the United States; | |
- | any extraordinary or material adverse change in U.S. financial markets generally, including, without limitation, a decline of at least 10% in either the Dow Jones Industrial Average, the NASDAQ Index or the Standard & Poors 500 Index from the date of commencement of the exchange offer; | |
- | a declaration of a banking moratorium or any suspension of payments in respect of banks in the United States; | |
- | any limitation, whether or not mandatory, by any governmental entity on, or any other event that would reasonably be expected to materially adversely affect, the extension of credit by banks or other lending institutions; | |
- | a commencement of a war or other national or international calamity directly or indirectly involving the United States, which would reasonably be expected to affect materially or adversely, or to delay materially, the completion of the exchange offer; or | |
- | if any of the situations described above existed at the time of commencement of the exchange offer and that situation deteriorates materially after commencement of the exchange offer; |
| any tender or exchange offer, other than this exchange offer by us, with respect to some or all of our outstanding common stock or any merger, acquisition or other business combination proposal involving us shall have been proposed, announced or made by any person or entity; | |
| any event or events occur that have resulted or may result, in our reasonable judgment, in an actual or threatened material adverse change in our business condition, income, operations, or prospects and our subsidiaries, taken as a whole; or | |
| as the term group is used in Section 13(d)(3) of the Exchange Act: |
- | any person, entity or group acquires more than 5% of our outstanding shares of common stock, other than a person, entity or group which had publicly disclosed such ownership with the SEC prior to the date of commencement of the exchange offer; | |
- | any such person, entity or group which had publicly disclosed such ownership prior to such date shall acquire additional common stock constituting more than 2% of our outstanding shares; or | |
- | any new group shall have been formed that beneficially owns more than 5% of our outstanding shares of common stock that in our judgment in any such case, and regardless of the circumstances, makes it inadvisable to proceed with the exchange offer or with such acceptance for exchange of existing notes. |
If any of the above events occur, we may:
| terminate the exchange offer and promptly return all tendered existing notes to tendering holders; | |
| complete and/or extend the exchange offer and, subject to your withdrawal rights, retain all tendered existing notes until the extended exchange offer expires; | |
| amend the terms of the exchange offer; or | |
| waive any unsatisfied condition and, subject to any requirement to extend the period of time during which the exchange offer is open, complete the exchange offer. |
We may assert these conditions with respect to the exchange offer regardless of the circumstances giving rise to them. All conditions to the exchange offer, other than those dependent upon receipt of necessary government approvals, must be satisfied or waived by us before the expiration of the exchange offer. We may waive any condition in whole or in part at any time in our discretion. Our failure to exercise our rights under
34
Management Participation in the Exchange Offer
Norman H. Pond, chairman of our board of directors, who owns approximately 9% of our common stock, Edward Durbin, one of our directors and the chief operating officer of Foster City LLC, which holds approximately 46% of our common stock, and Charles B. Eddy, our chief financial officer, who owns approximately 1% of our common stock, own, respectively, $1,490,000, $980,000 and $50,000 principal amount of existing notes. These holders have agreed to tender all of their existing notes in the exchange offer.
Exchange Agent
State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A., has been appointed the exchange agent for the exchange offer. Letters of transmittal and any correspondence in connection with the exchange offer should be sent or delivered by each holder of existing notes or a beneficial owners broker, dealer, commercial bank, trust company or other nominee to the exchange agent at the address set forth on the back cover of this offering circular and in the letter of transmittal. We will pay the exchange agent reasonable and customary fees for its services and will reimburse it for its reasonable out-of-pocket expenses in connection therewith.
Fees and Expenses
The exchange offer is being made by us in reliance on the exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, afforded by Section 3(a)(9) thereof. We, therefore, will not pay any commission or other remuneration to any broker, dealer, salesman or other person for soliciting tenders of the existing notes. Our officers, directors and employees may solicit tenders from holders of existing notes and will answer inquiries concerning the exchange offer, but they will not receive additional compensation for soliciting tenders or answering any such inquiries. We have not retained any dealer manager or other agent to solicit tenders or make recommendations with respect to the exchange offer. The exchange agent will mail solicitation materials on our behalf. We will pay the exchange agent customary fees for its services, reimburse the exchange agent for its reasonable out-of-pocket expenses incurred in connection with the provision of these services and pay other expenses, including fees and expenses of the trustee under the indenture, filing fees, blue sky fees and printing and distribution expenses. We will also reimburse reasonable expenses incurred by brokers and dealers in forwarding this offering circular and the other materials in connection with the exchange offer to the holders of the existing notes. No broker, dealer, commercial bank or trust company has been authorized to act as our agent for purposes of the exchange offer or solicit holders of existing notes to submit their existing notes in the exchange offer.
Additionally, we will pay all transfer taxes, if any, applicable to the exchange of existing notes pursuant to the exchange offer. If, however, exchange notes are to be issued in the name of any person other than the registered holder of the existing notes exchanged therefor or if for existing notes that are registered in the name of any person other than the person signing the letter of transmittal, or if a transfer tax is imposed for any reason other than the exchange of existing notes pursuant to the exchange offer, then the amount of any such transfer taxes imposed on the registered holder or any other persons will be payable by the holder of the existing notes that are exchanged. If satisfactory evidence of payment of such taxes or exemption therefrom is not submitted with the letter of transmittal, the amount of such transfer taxes will be billed directly to such holder of the existing notes that are exchanged or withheld from the cash consideration due such holder pursuant to the exchange offer.
Recommendation
We are not making any recommendation regarding whether you should tender your existing notes, and, accordingly, you must make your own determination as to whether to tender your existing notes for exchange.
35
DESCRIPTION OF EXCHANGE NOTES
General
The exchange notes will be issued pursuant to an exchange notes indenture, dated as of the closing date of the exchange offer, between us and State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A., as exchange notes trustee. The following summarizes some, but not all, of the provisions of the exchange notes indenture. You should refer to the actual terms of the exchange notes and the exchange notes indenture for the definitive terms and conditions. As used in this section of the offering circular, the words Intevac, we, us or our do not include any current or future subsidiary of Intevac.
The exchange notes are unsecured obligations of Intevac. The exchange notes are subordinate in right of payment to all of our existing and future senior debt and will be senior in right of payment to our existing notes. Neither we nor our subsidiaries are limited or prohibited from incurring or issuing other indebtedness or securities under the exchange notes indenture. The exchange notes indenture does not contain any financial covenants.
Principal, Maturity and Interest
The exchange notes will bear interest from the closing date of the exchange offer at the annual rate of 6 1/2%. The exchange notes will mature March 1, 2009.
Interest on the exchange notes will be payable semiannually March 1 and September 1 of each year, commencing September 1, 2002. The record dates for the payment of interest will be the February 15 or August 15 immediately preceding the interest payment date. Interest will be computed on the basis of a 360-day year comprising twelve 30-day months.
We will maintain an office or agency in New York, New York for payment of interest and principal on the exchange notes. We may, at our option, pay interest by check mailed to the holders of the exchange notes at their addresses listed in the register of holders. However, a holder of exchange notes of more than $2,000,000 in principal amount of exchange notes will be paid by wire transfer in immediately available funds at the election of the holder. Until otherwise designated by us, our office or agency in New York will be the office or agency of the exchange notes trustee. The exchange notes will be issued in registered form, without coupons. The exchange notes are in denominations of $1,000 and integral multiples of $1,000.
Optional Redemption
We may redeem the exchange notes at our option, in whole or in part, at any time on or after March 1, 2005, upon not less than 15 nor more than 60 days prior notice by mail at 100% of the principal amount of the exchange notes plus accrued and unpaid interest to, but excluding, interest to the redemption date. However, holders of record on the record date will receive interest due on an interest payment date.
If less than all of the exchange notes are to be redeemed, the exchange notes trustee will select the exchange notes to be redeemed in compliance with the requirements of any principal national securities exchange on which the exchange notes are listed, or, if the exchange notes are not so listed, on a pro rata basis. No exchange notes of $1,000 shall be redeemed in part. We will mail a redemption notice by first class mail at least 15 but not more than 60 days before the redemption date to you at your registered address. If any exchange note is to be redeemed in part only, the notice of redemption shall state the portion of the principal amount of the exchange notes to be redeemed. If a portion of your exchange notes is selected for partial redemption and you convert a portion of these exchange notes, the converted portion shall be deemed to be taken from the portion selected for redemption. A new exchange note in principal amount equal to the unredeemed portion will be issued in your name upon cancellation of the original exchange note. On and after the redemption date, interest ceases to accrue on the exchange notes called for redemption.
Mandatory Redemption
We are not required to make mandatory redemption or sinking fund payments on the exchange notes.
36
Repurchase at the Option of Holders upon a Change in Control
If change of control occurs, you will have the right at your option to require us to repurchase all or any part of your exchange notes pursuant to the change of control offer described below at a change of control payment equal to 101% of the principal amount of the exchange notes, together with accrued and unpaid interest to the change of control payment date. We will mail a notice to each holder within 30 days following a change of control stating:
| that the change of control offer is being made pursuant to the exchange notes indenture and that all exchange notes properly tendered will be accepted for payment; | |
| the change of control payment and the change of control payment date, which shall be no earlier than 30 days nor later than 40 days from the date the notice is mailed; | |
| that any exchange notes not tendered will continue to accrue interest; | |
| that, unless we default in the payment of the change of control payment, all exchange notes accepted for payment pursuant to the change of control offer shall cease to accrue interest after the change of control payment date; | |
| that if you elect to have your exchange notes purchased pursuant to a change of control offer, you will be required to surrender the exchange notes, with the form entitled Option of Holder to Elect Purchase on the reverse of the exchange notes completed, to the paying agent at the address specified in the notice prior to the close of business on the third business day preceding the change of control payment date; | |
| that you will be entitled to withdraw your election if the paying agent receives, not later than the close of business on the second business day preceding the change of control payment date, a transmission setting forth your name, the principal amount of exchange notes delivered for purchase and a statement that you are withdrawing your election to have your exchange notes purchased; and | |
| that if your exchange notes are being purchased only in part, you will be issued new exchange notes equal in principal amount to the unpurchased portion of the exchange notes surrendered, which unpurchased portion must be equal to $1,000 in principal amount or a multiple of $1,000. |
We will comply with the requirements of Rules 13e-4 and 14e-1 under the Exchange Act and any other securities laws and regulations to the extent these laws and regulations are applicable to the repurchase of the exchange notes in connection with a change of control.
If you have tendered your notes for payment on the change of control payment date we will:
| accept for payment exchange notes tendered pursuant to the change of control offer; | |
| deposit with the paying agent an amount equal to the change of control payment for all accepted exchange notes; and | |
| deliver the accepted exchange notes to the exchange notes trustee together with an officers certificate stating the exchange notes accepted by us. |
The paying agent will promptly mail to you or deposit with DTC the purchase price for your exchange notes accepted in the tender. The exchange notes trustee will then promptly authenticate and mail to you a new exchange note equal in principal amount to any unpurchased portion of the surrendered exchange notes. We will publicly announce the results of the change of control offer on or as soon as practicable after the change of control payment date.
The exchange notes indenture does not contain any other provisions that permit you to require us to repurchase or redeem the exchange notes in the event of a takeover, recapitalization or similar restructuring, except as described above with respect to a change of control.
This change of control purchase feature may make more difficult or discourage a takeover of us and the removal of the incumbent management. We are not, however, aware of any specific effort to accumulate
37
We could, in the future, enter into transactions that would not be change of controls under the exchange notes indenture but that could increase the amount of our outstanding indebtedness or otherwise affect our capital structure or credit ratings. Any payment of the change of control payment will be subordinated to the prior payment of senior debt as designated under the caption Subordination of Exchange Notes below.
If a change of control were to occur, we may not have sufficient financial resources to pay the repurchase price for all tendered exchange notes. Any future debt we may incur may contain restrictions that prohibit the repurchase of the exchange notes upon a change of control. We may then be required to obtain the consent of the holders of this future debt before repurchasing the exchange notes. Any failure to obtain this consent would prohibit us from repurchasing the exchange notes. We will also be prohibited from repurchasing the exchange notes under the subordination provisions of the indenture if there exists a payment default on senior debt or we have received a payment blockage notice under the exchange notes indenture. If we fail to repurchase the exchange notes following a change of control, there would be an event of default under the exchange notes indenture, whether or not the repurchase is permitted by the subordination provisions of the exchange notes indenture. Any default under the exchange notes indenture may then result in a default under any of our other debt. In addition, the occurrence of a change of control may cause an event of default under our other debt. As a result, any repurchase of the exchange notes would, absent a waiver, be prohibited under the subordination provisions of the exchange notes indenture until the senior debt is paid in full.
A change of control will be deemed to have occurred when:
| any person or group (as such terms are used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) of the Exchange Act) other than a permitted holder is or becomes the beneficial owner (as defined in Rules 13d-3 and 13d-5 under the Exchange Act) of shares representing more than 50% of the combined voting power of the then outstanding securities entitled to vote generally in elections of our directors (voting stock), | |
| we consolidate with or merge into any other corporate entity, or any other corporate entity merges into us, and, in the case of any such transaction, our outstanding common stock is reclassified into or exchanged for any other property or security, unless our shareholders immediately before such transaction own, directly or indirectly immediately following such transaction, at least a majority of the combined voting power of the outstanding voting securities of the corporation resulting from such transaction in substantially the same proportion as their ownership of the voting stock immediately before such transaction, | |
| we convey, transfer or lease all or substantially all of our assets, unless such conveyance, transfer or lease is to a corporate entity and our shareholders immediately before such conveyance, transfer or lease own, directly or indirectly immediately following such transaction, at least a majority of the combined voting power of the corporate entity to which such assets are so conveyed, transferred or leased in the same proportion as their ownership of the voting stock immediately before such transaction, or | |
| any time the continuing directors do not constitute a majority of our board of directors or, if applicable, a successor corporate entity to us. |
However, a change of control shall not be deemed to have occurred if at least 90% of the consideration, excluding cash payments for fractional shares, in the transaction or transactions constituting the change of control consists of shares of common stock that are, or upon issuance will be, traded on a United States national securities exchange or approved for trading on an established automated over-the-counter trading market in the United States.
38
continuing directors means, as of any date of determination, any member of our board of directors who:
| was a member of such board of directors on the date of the exchange notes indenture, or | |
| was nominated for election or elected to such board of directors with the approval of a majority of the continuing directors who were members of such board at the time of such nomination or election. |
permitted holder means Foster City LLC, any subsidiary or affiliate thereof, the legal representatives of any of the foregoing, or any person of which any of the foregoing, individually or collectively beneficially own (as defined in Rules 13d-3 and 13d-5 under the Exchange Act) voting Securities representing at least a majority of the total voting power of all classes of capital stock of such person (exclusive of any matters as to which class voting rights exist).
The definition of change of control includes a phrase relating to the conveyance, transfer or lease of all or substantially all of our assets. There is no precise established definition of the phrase substantially all under applicable law. As a result, your ability to require us to repurchase your exchange notes as a result of a conveyance, transfer or lease of less than all of our assets may be uncertain.
Repurchase at the Option of Holders upon the Distribution of the Capital Stock of our Photonics Business
If we declare or make any dividend or other distribution to all of the holders of our common stock of shares of capital stock of any subsidiary that at the time constitutes our Photonics business, which event we refer to as a Triggering Distribution, we will be obligated to make an offer to repurchase all of the outstanding exchange notes at 100% of the principal amount of the outstanding exchange notes, plus accrued but unpaid interest to the repurchase date, which repurchase date shall be on or prior to the distribution date of the Triggering Distribution, or if such repurchase date is not a business day, the next succeeding business day. We will be required to repurchase on the repurchase date all exchange notes that have been properly tendered by holders of exchange notes on or prior to the close of business on the business day prior to the repurchase date. We will provide holders 90 days notice by mail of the repurchase date and the repurchase right arising from the Triggering Distribution.
Conversion
You will have the right at any time prior to maturity to convert your exchange notes into shares of our common stock at a conversion price of $7.00 per share, subject to adjustment as described below. If an exchange note is called for redemption, your conversion right will terminate at the close of business on the business day immediately preceding the date fixed for redemption. Except as described below, no adjustment will be made on conversion of any of your exchange notes for accrued interest or dividends. If you convert your exchange notes after a record date for the payment of interest and prior to the next succeeding interest payment date, you must pay funds equal to the interest payable on such succeeding interest payment date on your converted principal amount, unless the exchange notes have been called for redemption. No fractional shares will be issued upon conversion but a cash adjustment will be made for any fractional interest.
The conversion price is subject to adjustment upon the occurrence of:
(1) the issuance of shares of our common stock as a dividend or distribution on our common stock; | |
(2) the subdivision or combination of our outstanding common stock; | |
(3) the issuance, to substantially all holders of our common stock, of rights or warrants to subscribe for or purchase our common stock, or securities convertible into common stock, at a price less than the current market price; | |
(4) the distribution of shares of our capital stock, rights, warrants, evidences of indebtedness or other assets to all holders of our common stock, but excluding: |
| dividends or distributions for which an adjustment may otherwise made pursuant to clause (1) or (3) above; and |
39
| dividends or distributions paid exclusively in cash; |
(5) the distribution or dividend of cash to all holders of our common stock in an aggregate amount that, together with (A) the aggregate of any other distributions of cash that did not trigger a conversion price adjustment to all holders of our common stock within the 12 months preceding the date fixed for determining the shareholders entitled to such distribution and (B) all excess payments in respect of each tender offer or other negotiated transaction by us or any of our subsidiaries for our common stock concluded within the preceding 12 months not triggering a conversion price adjustment, exceeds 15% of our market capitalization; and | |
(6) the payment of an excess payment in respect of a tender offer or other negotiated transaction by us or any of our subsidiaries for our common stock if the aggregate amount of such excess payment together with the aggregate amount of cash distributions made within the preceding 12 months not triggering a conversion price adjustment and all excess payments in respect of each tender offer or other negotiated transaction by us or any of our subsidiaries for our common stock concluded within the preceding 12 months not triggering a conversion price adjustment exceeds 15% of our market capitalization. |
In the event we distribute to substantially all holders of our common stock rights to subscribe for additional shares of our capital stock referred to in clause (4) above, we may provide that you will receive upon conversion of your existing notes an appropriate number of such rights or warrants instead of making any adjustment in the conversion price. If rights, warrants or options for which an adjustment is made pursuant to clauses (3) or (4) above expire unexercised, the conversion price will be readjusted to take into account the actual number of such warrants, rights or options which were exercised. We will not make any adjustment to the conversion price until cumulative adjustments amount to one percent or more of the conversion price.
If we implement a shareholder rights plan, such rights plan must provide that upon conversion of the exchange notes the holders will receive, in addition to the common stock issuable upon such conversion, such rights, whether or not such rights have separated from the common stock at the time of such conversion.
If we:
| reclassify or change our outstanding common stock, other than changes resulting from a subdivision or combination, or | |
| consolidate with or merge into any person, or | |
| sell or convey all or substantially all of our property or business as an entirety, |
then the exchange notes will become convertible into the kind and amount of securities, cash or other assets which you would have owned immediately after the transaction if you had converted the exchange notes immediately before the effective date of the transaction.
The current market price for our common stock on any date shall be deemed to be the average of the daily market prices for the shorter of:
| 30 consecutive business days ending on the last full trading day on the exchange or market referred to in determining the daily market prices prior to the time of determination, or | |
| the period commencing on the date next succeeding the first public announcement of the issuance of such rights or warrants or such distribution through such last full trading day prior to the time of determination. |
excess payment means the excess of:
| the aggregate of the cash and fair market value of other consideration paid by us or any of our subsidiaries with respect to the shares acquired in the tender offer or other negotiated transaction over | |
| the market value of such acquired shares after giving effect to the completion of the tender offer or other negotiated transaction. |
40
We may reduce the conversion price by any amount for any period of at least 20 days if our board of directors has made a determination that this reduction in the conversion price would be in the best interests of Intevac, which determination shall be conclusive. We will give at least 15 days notice of any such reduction in the conversion price. In addition, we may, at our option, reduce the conversion price if our board of directors deems it advisable to avoid or diminish any income tax to holders of common stock resulting from any dividend or distribution of stock or from any event treated as such for income tax purposes. See U.S. Federal Income Tax Considerations.
Automatic Conversion
We may elect to convert some or all of the exchange notes on or prior to maturity if the closing price of our common stock has exceeded 150% of the conversion price for at least 20 trading days out of any period of 30 consecutive trading days within five trading days prior to the date of mailing of the notice of automatic conversion.
Subordination of Exchange Notes
The exchange notes are subordinate in right of payment to all senior debt and will be senior in right of payment to the existing notes. See Definitions for a detailed definition of senior debt under the exchange notes indenture. As of March 30, 2002, we had no senior debt. Neither we nor our subsidiaries are limited from incurring senior debt or other indebtedness or liabilities under the exchange notes indenture.
Payments on the exchange notes will be subordinated in right of payment to the prior payment in full of all our senior debt. We may not make any payment of principal, premium, if any, or interest on the exchange notes or redeem, purchase or otherwise acquire any of the exchange notes unless:
| full payment of amounts then due on all senior debt have been made, and | |
| at the time of and after giving effect to such payment, redemption, purchase or other acquisition, there shall not exist any default on any senior debt that shall not have been cured or waived and that shall have resulted in the full amount of the senior debt being declared due and payable. |
In addition, if any holders of any designated senior debt notify us and the trustee pursuant to a payment blockage notice of the occurrence of a default allowing them to accelerate the maturity of the designated senior debt, we may not make any payment on the exchange notes or purchase or redeem or otherwise acquire any of the exchange notes for the payment blockage period commencing on the date notice is received and ending on the earlier of:
| the date on which such event of default shall have been cured or waived, or | |
| 180 days from the date notice is received. |
We may resume payments on the exchange notes after the end of payment blockage period unless the holders or the representatives of the designated senior debt shall have accelerated its maturity. Holders of designated senior debt shall not be able to deliver more than one payment blockage notice in any consecutive 360-day period, irrespective of the number of defaults on senior debt during this period.
Upon any distribution of our assets in connection with our dissolution, winding-up, liquidation or reorganization or acceleration, all senior debt must be paid in full before the holders of the exchange notes are entitled to any payments.
If payment of the exchange notes is accelerated because of an event of default, we or the trustee shall promptly notify the holders of senior debt and their representatives of the acceleration of the exchange notes. We may not make any payments on the exchange notes until five days after such holders of senior debt or their representatives receive notice of such acceleration. Thereafter, we may make payments on the exchange notes only if the subordination provisions of the exchange notes indenture otherwise permit payment at that time.
As a result of these subordination provisions, in the event of our insolvency, holders of the exchange notes may recover ratably less than our general creditors.
41
Merger, Consolidation or Sale of Assets
We may not consolidate or merge with or into, whether or not we are the surviving corporation, any person, or sell, assign, transfer, lease, convey or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of our properties or assets under the exchange notes indenture unless:
| (A) we are the surviving or continuing corporate entity or (B) the corporate entity formed by or surviving any such consolidation or merger, if other than us, or the corporate entity which acquires by sale, assignment, transfer, lease, conveyance or other disposition our properties and assets is a corporate entity organized or existing under the laws of the United States, any state of the United States or the District of Columbia; | |
| the corporate entity formed by or surviving any such consolidation or merger, if other than us, or the corporate entity to which such sale, assignment, transfer, lease, conveyance or other disposition will have been made assumes all our obligations under the exchange notes and the exchange notes indenture; | |
| immediately after such transaction no default or event of default exists; and | |
| we or such corporate entity shall have delivered an officers certificate and an opinion of counsel to the exchange notes trustee stating that the transaction and the supplemental exchange notes indenture comply with the exchange notes indenture and that all conditions precedent in the exchange notes indenture relating to the transaction have been satisfied. |
Payments for Consent
Neither we nor any of our subsidiaries will pay any consideration to any holder of any exchange notes for any consent, waiver or amendment of the exchange notes indenture unless such consideration is paid to all holders of the exchange notes that consent, waive or agree to amend in the time frame set forth in the solicitation documents.
Reports
Whether or not required by the rules and regulations of the Commission, so long as any exchange notes are outstanding, we will file with the Commission and, if requested by any holder of exchange notes, furnish to such holder all quarterly and annual financial information required to be contained in a filing with the Commission on Forms 10-Q and 10-K. This quarterly and annual financial information would include a Managements Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations and, with respect to the annual consolidated financial statements only, a report on the financial statements by our independent auditors.
Events of Default and Remedies
Each of the following will constitute an event of default under the exchange notes indenture:
(1) we default for 30 days in the payment when due of interest on the exchange notes; | |
(2) we default in payment when due of principal on the exchange notes; | |
(3) we default in the payment of the change of control event payment in respect of the exchange notes on the change of control payment date, whether or not such payment is prohibited by the subordination provisions of the exchange notes indenture; | |
(4) we fail to provide timely notice of a change of control; | |
(5) we fail for 60 days after notice to comply with any other covenants and agreements contained in the exchange notes indenture or the exchange notes; | |
(6) we or one of our subsidiaries defaults under any mortgage, indenture or instrument under which there may be issued or by which there may be secured or evidenced any indebtedness for money borrowed |
42
by us or any of our subsidiaries or the payment of which is guaranteed by us or any of our subsidiaries, whether such indebtedness or guarantee now exists or is created after the date on which the exchange notes are first authenticated and issued, which default (A) is a payment default caused by a failure to pay when due principal or interest on such indebtedness within the grace period provided in such indebtedness (which failure continues beyond any applicable grace period) or (B) results in the acceleration of such indebtedness prior to its express maturity and, in each case, the principal amount of any such indebtedness, together with the principal amount of any other such indebtedness under which there has been a payment default or the maturity of which has been so accelerated, aggregates $10 million or more; | |
(7) we or one of our subsidiaries fails to pay final judgments aggregating in excess of $10 million, which judgments are not stayed within 60 days after their entry, other than any judgment as to which a reputable insurance company has accepted full liability; and | |
(8) certain events of bankruptcy or insolvency with respect to us or any of our material subsidiaries. |
If any event of default occurs and is continuing, the exchange notes trustee or the holders of at least 25% in principal amount of the outstanding exchange notes may declare all the exchange notes immediately due and payable. However, in an event of default arising from bankruptcy or insolvency with respect to us, all outstanding exchange notes will become immediately due and payable. Holders of the exchange notes may not enforce the exchange notes indenture or the exchange notes except as provided in the exchange notes indenture. Holders of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding exchange notes may direct the exchange notes trustee in its exercise of any exchange note trust or power, subject to certain limitations. The exchange notes trustee may withhold from holders of the exchange notes notice of any continuing default or event of default if it determines that withholding notice is in their interest, except a default or event of default relating to the payment of principal or interest.
The holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of outstanding exchange notes may waive any existing default or event of default under the exchange notes indenture except a continuing default or event of default in the payment of the principal, interest or designated event payment on the exchange notes.
We are required to deliver to the exchange notes trustee annually a statement regarding compliance with the exchange notes indenture. We are also required to deliver to the exchange notes trustee a notice specifying any default or event of default upon becoming aware of it.
Transfer and Exchange
A holder may transfer or exchange notes in accordance with the exchange notes indenture. The registrar and the exchange notes trustee may require a holder to furnish appropriate endorsements and transfer documents. We may require a holder to pay any taxes and fees required by law or permitted by the exchange notes indenture in connection with any transfer of the exchange notes. We are not required to exchange or register the transfer of:
| any exchange note during the 15-day period immediately preceding any selection of exchange notes to be redeemed, | |
| any exchange note or portion thereof selected for redemption, or | |
| any exchange note or portion thereof surrendered for repurchase and not withdrawn in connection with a change of control. |
The registered holder of an exchange note will be treated as its owner for all purposes.
Amendment, Supplement and Waiver
The holders of at least a majority in principal amount of the outstanding exchange notes may amend or supplement the exchange notes indenture or the exchange notes. The holders of a majority in principal amount
43
However, without the consent of each holder an amendment or waiver may not:
| reduce the percentage of exchange notes whose holders must consent to an amendment, supplement or waiver, | |
| reduce the principal of or change the fixed maturity of any exchange note or alter the provisions with respect to the redemption of the exchange notes, | |
| reduce the rate of or change the time for payment of interest on any exchange note, | |
| waive a default in the payment of principal of or interest on any exchange notes, except a rescission of acceleration of the exchange notes by the holders of at least a majority in aggregate principal amount of the exchange notes and a waiver of the payment default that resulted from such acceleration, | |
| make any exchange note payable in money other than in U.S. dollars, | |
| waive a redemption payment with respect to any exchange note, | |
| impair the right to convert the exchange notes into common stock, | |
| modify the conversion provisions or subordination provisions of the exchange notes indenture in a manner adverse to the holders of the exchange notes, or | |
| make any change in the foregoing amendment and waiver provisions. |
We and the exchange notes trustee may amend or supplement the exchange notes indenture or the exchange notes without the consent of any holder of exchange notes to:
| cure any ambiguity, defect or inconsistency, | |
| provide for uncertificated exchange notes, | |
| provide for the assumption of our obligations in the event of a merger or consolidation, | |
| make any change that would provide any additional rights or benefits to the holders of the exchange notes or that does not adversely affect the legal rights under the exchange notes indenture of any such holder, or | |
| to comply with requirements of the Commission in order to qualify, or maintain the qualification of, the exchange notes indenture under the Trust Indenture Act. |
Concerning the Exchange Notes Trustee
An affiliate of the exchange notes trustee is also the transfer agent for our common stock.
The holders of a majority in principal amount of the then outstanding exchange notes will have the right to direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for exercising any remedy available to the exchange notes trustee, subject to certain exceptions. The exchange notes indenture provides that, in case an event of default shall occur which shall not be cured, the exchange notes trustee will be required, in the exercise of its power, to use the degree of care of a prudent man in the conduct of his own affairs. Subject to such provisions, the exchange notes trustee will be under no obligation to exercise any of its rights or powers under the exchange notes indenture at the request of any holder of exchange notes unless such holder shall have offered to the exchange notes trustee security and indemnity satisfactory to it against any loss, liability or expense.
44
Definitions
Set forth below are some of the defined terms used in the exchange notes indenture. We refer you to the exchange notes indenture for a full disclosure of all these defined terms, including any other capitalized terms that we use in this description that we do not define in this description.
default means any event that is or, with the passage of time or the giving of notice or both, would be an event of default.
designated senior debt means any senior debt which, at the date of determination, has an aggregate principal amount outstanding of, or commitments to lend up to, more than $10.0 million and is specifically designated by us in the instrument evidencing or defining such senior debt as designated senior debt for purposes of the indenture.
GAAP means generally accepted accounting principles set forth in the opinions and pronouncements of the Accounting Principles Board of the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants and statements and pronouncements of the Financial Accounting Standards Board or in such other statements by such other entity as may be approved by a significant segment of the accounting profession of the United States, which are in effect from time to time.
guarantee means a guarantee, direct or indirect, in any manner, including, without limitation, letters of credit and reimbursement agreements, of all or any part of any indebtedness, other than by endorsement of negotiable instruments for collection in the ordinary course of business.
indebtedness means:
(1) all of our obligations for borrowed money, including, but not limited to, any indebtedness secured by a security interest, mortgage or other lien on our assets which is |
| given to secure all or part of the purchase price, whether given to the vendor of such property or to another, or | |
| existing on property at the time of its acquisition, |
(2) all of our obligations evidenced by a note, debenture, bond or other written instrument, | |
(3) all of our obligations under a lease required to be capitalized on the balance sheet of the lessee under GAAP, | |
(4) all of our obligations under any lease or related document, including a purchase agreement, which provides that we are contractually obligated to purchase or to cause a third party to purchase the leased property, | |
(5) all of our obligations with respect to letters of credit, loans, bank guarantees or bankers acceptances, | |
(6) all of our obligations with respect to debt secured by a mortgage, pledge, lien, encumbrance, charge or adverse claim affecting title or resulting in an encumbrance to which the property or assets of such entity are subject, whether or not the secured obligation thereby shall have been assumed or guaranteed by or shall otherwise be our legal liability, | |
(7) all of our obligations in respect of the balance of deferred and unpaid purchase price of any property or assets, | |
(8) all of our obligations under interest rate, currency or credit swap agreements, cap, floor and collar agreements, spot and forward contracts and similar agreements and arrangements, | |
(9) any and all deferrals, renewals, extensions, refinancings and refundings of, or amendments, modifications or supplements to, any of the foregoing, and | |
(10) all of our obligations of the type described in clauses (1) through (9) above assumed by or guaranteed in any manner by us or in effect guaranteed by us through an agreement to purchase, |
45
contingent or otherwise, and our obligations under any such assumptions, guarantees or other such arrangements. |
material subsidiary means any or our subsidiaries which is significant subsidiary as defined in Rule 1-02(w) of Regulation S-X under the Securities Act and the Exchange Act (as such Regulation is in effect on the date hereof).
obligations means any principal, interest, penalties, fees, indemnifications, reimbursements, damages and other liabilities payable under the documentation governing any indebtedness.
representative means the trustee, agent or any representative for an issue of senior debt.
senior debt means the principal of, premium, if any, interest and liquidated damages, if any, on, and fees, costs and expenses in connection with, and other amounts due on, our indebtedness, whether outstanding on the date of the indenture or thereafter created, incurred, assumed or guaranteed by us. Senior debt includes, with respect to the obligations described above, interest accruing, pursuant to the terms of such senior debt, on or after the filing of any petition in bankruptcy or for reorganization relating to us, whether or not post-filing interest is allowed in such proceeding, at the rate specified in the instrument governing the relevant obligation.
However, senior debt shall not include:
| any indebtedness that expressly provides that such indebtedness is not senior in right of payment to the exchange notes; | |
| indebtedness of or amounts owed by us for compensation to employees, or for goods, services or materials purchased in the ordinary course of business; | |
| any liability for Federal, state, local or other taxes owed or owing by us; | |
| our indebtedness to one of our subsidiaries; | |
| the exchange notes; or | |
| the existing notes. |
subsidiary means any corporation, association or other business entity of which more than 50% of the total voting power of shares of capital stock entitled, without regard to the occurrence of any contingency, to vote in the election of directors, managers or exchange notes trustees thereof is at the time owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by any person or one or more of the other subsidiaries of that person or a combination thereof.
46
DESCRIPTION OF EXISTING NOTES
General
The existing notes were issued pursuant to an indenture dated as of February 15, 1997, between us and State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A., as trustee. The following summarizes some, but not all, of the provisions of the indenture. You should refer to the actual terms of the existing notes and the indenture for the definitive terms and conditions. As used in this section of the offering circular, the words Intevac, we, us or our do not include any current or future subsidiary of Intevac.
The existing notes are unsecured obligations of Intevac. The existing notes are subordinated in right of payment to all of our existing and future senior debt. Neither we nor our subsidiaries are limited or prohibited from incurring or issuing other indebtedness or securities under the indenture. The indenture does not contain any financial covenants.
Principal, Maturity and Interest
The existing notes bear interest at the annual rate of 6 1/2% and mature March 1, 2004.
Interest on the existing notes is payable semiannually March 1 and September 1 of each year. The record dates for the payment of interest are the February 15 or August 15 immediately preceding the interest payment date. Interest is computed on the basis of a 360-day year comprised of twelve 30-day months. Interest on the existing notes accrues from the most recent date to which interest has been paid.
We maintain an office or agency in New York, New
York for payment of interest and principal on the existing
notes. We may, at our option, pay interest by check mailed to
the holders of the existing notes at their addresses listed in
the register of holders. However, a holder of existing notes of
more than $2,000,000 in principal amount of existing notes will
be paid by wire transfer in immediately available funds at the
election of the holder. Until otherwise designated by us, our
office or agency in New York will be the office or agency of the
trustee. The existing notes have been issued in registered form,
without coupons. The existing notes are in denominations of
$1,000 and multiples of $1,000.
Optional Redemption
We may redeem the existing notes at our option,
in whole or in part, at any time on or after March 3, 2000,
upon not less than 15 nor more than 60 days prior notice
by mail at the following redemption prices expressed as
percentages of the principal amount:
Period
Redemption Price
101.857
%
100.929
%
and 100% at March 1, 2004. We will pay accrued interest to the redemption date. However, holders of record on the record date will receive interest due on an interest payment date.
If less than all of the existing notes are to be redeemed, the trustee will select the existing notes to be redeemed in compliance with the requirements of any principal national securities exchange on which the existing notes are listed, or, if the existing notes are not so listed, on a pro rata basis. No existing notes of $1,000 shall be redeemed in part. We will mail a redemption notice by first class mail at least 15 but not more than 60 days before the redemption date to you at your registered address. If any existing note is to be redeemed in part only, the notice of redemption shall state the portion of the principal amount of the existing notes to be redeemed. If a portion of your existing notes is selected for partial redemption and you convert a portion of these existing notes, the converted portion shall be deemed to be taken from the portion selected for redemption. A new existing note in principal amount equal to the unredeemed portion will be issued in your name upon cancellation of the original existing note. On and after the redemption date, interest ceases to accrue on the existing notes called for redemption.
47
Mandatory Redemption
We are not required to make mandatory redemption or sinking fund payments on the existing notes.
Repurchase at the Option of Holders
Upon the occurrence of a designated event, you will have the right at your option to require us to repurchase all or any part of your existing notes pursuant to the designated event offer described below at a designated event payment equal to 101% of the principal amount of the existing notes, together with accrued and unpaid interest to the designated event payment date. We will mail a notice to each holder within 30 days following any designated event stating:
| that the designated event offer is being made pursuant to the indenture and that all existing notes tendered will be accepted for payment; | |
| the designated event payment and the designated event payment date, which shall be no earlier than 30 days nor later than 40 days from the date the notice is mailed; | |
| that any existing notes not tendered will continue to accrue interest; | |
| that, unless we default in the payment of the designated event payment, all existing notes accepted for payment pursuant to the designated event offer shall cease to accrue interest after the designated event payment date; | |
| that if you elect to have your existing notes purchased pursuant to a designated event offer, you will be required to surrender the existing notes, with the form entitled Option of Holder to Elect Purchase on the reverse of the existing notes completed, to the paying agent at the address specified in the notice prior to the close of business on the third business day preceding the designated event payment date; | |
| that you will be entitled to withdraw your election if the paying agent receives, not later than the close of business on the second business day preceding the designated event payment date, a transmission setting forth your name, the principal amount of existing notes delivered for purchase and a statement that you are withdrawing your election to have your existing notes purchased; and | |
| that if your existing notes are being purchased only in part, you will be issued new existing notes equal in principal amount to the unpurchased portion of the existing notes surrendered, which unpurchased portion must be equal to $1,000 in principal amount or a multiple of $1,000. |
We will comply with the requirements of Rules 13e-4 and 14e-1 under the Exchange Act and any other securities laws and regulations to the extent these laws and regulations are applicable to the repurchase of the existing notes in connection with a designated event.
On the designated event payment date we will:
| accept for payment existing notes tendered pursuant to the designated event offer; | |
| deposit with the paying agent an amount equal to the designated event payment for all tendered existing notes; and | |
| deliver the accepted existing notes to the trustee together with an officers certificate stating the existing notes tendered to us. |
The paying agent will promptly mail to you the purchase price for your existing notes accepted in the tender. The trustee will then promptly authenticate and mail to you a new existing note equal in principal amount to any unpurchased portion of the surrendered existing notes. We will publicly announce the results of the designated event offer on or as soon as practicable after the designated event payment date.
The indenture does not contain any other provisions that permit you to require us to repurchase or redeem the existing notes in the event of a takeover, recapitalization or similar restructuring, except as described above with respect to a designated event.
48
This designated event purchase feature may make more difficult or discourage a takeover of us and the removal of the incumbent management. We are not, however, aware of any specific effort to accumulate shares of our common stock or to obtain control of us by means of a merger, tender offer, solicitation or otherwise. In addition, the designated event purchase feature is not part of a plan by management to adopt a series of anti-takeover provisions.
We could, in the future, enter into transactions that would not be a designated event under the indenture but that could increase the amount of our outstanding indebtedness or otherwise affect our capital structure or credit ratings. Any payment of the designated event payment will be subordinated to the prior payment of senior debt as described under Subordination of Existing Notes below.
If a designated event were to occur, we may not have sufficient financial resources to pay the repurchase price for all tendered existing notes. Any future debt we may incur may contain restrictions that prohibit the repurchase of the designated notes upon a designated event. We may then be required to obtain the consent of the holders of this debt before repurchasing the existing notes. Any failure to obtain this consent would prohibit us from repurchasing the existing notes. We will also be prohibited from repurchasing the existing notes under the subordination provisions of the indenture if there exists a payment default on senior debt or we have received a payment blockage notice under the indenture. If we fail to repurchase the existing notes following a designated event, there would be an event of default under the indenture, whether or not the repurchase is permitted by the subordination provisions of the indenture. Any default under the indenture may then result in a default under any of our other debt. In addition, the occurrence of a designated event may cause an event of default under our other debt. As a result, any repurchase of the existing notes would, absent a waiver, be prohibited under the subordination provisions of the indenture until the senior debt is paid in full.
A designated event will be deemed to have occurred upon a change of control or a termination of trading.
A change of control will be deemed to have occurred when:
| any person or group (as such terms are used in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) of the Exchange Act) is or becomes the beneficial owner (as defined in Rules 13d-3 and 13d-5 under the Exchange Act) of shares representing more than 50% of the combined voting power of the then outstanding securities entitled to vote generally in elections of our directors (voting stock), | |
| we consolidate with or merge into any other corporation, or any other corporation merges into us, and, in the case of any such transaction, our outstanding common stock is reclassified into or exchanged for any other property or security, unless our shareholders immediately before such transaction own, directly or indirectly immediately following such transaction, at least a majority of the combined voting power of the outstanding voting securities of the corporation resulting from such transaction in substantially the same proportion as their ownership of the voting stock immediately before such transaction, | |
| we convey, transfer or lease all or substantially all of our assets, unless such conveyance, transfer or lease is to a corporation and our shareholders immediately before such conveyance, transfer or lease own, directly or indirectly immediately following such transaction, at least a majority of the combined voting power of the corporation to which such assets are so conveyed, transferred or leased in the same proportion as their ownership of the voting stock immediately before such transaction, or | |
| any time the continuing directors do not constitute a majority of our board of directors or, if applicable, a successor corporation to us. |
However, a change of control shall not be deemed to have occurred if at least 90% of the consideration, excluding cash payments for fractional shares, in the transaction or transactions constituting the change of control consists of shares of common stock that are, or upon issuance will be, traded on a United States national securities exchange or approved for trading on an established automated over-the-counter trading market in the United States.
49
continuing directors means, as of any date of determination, any member of our board of directors who:
| was a member of such board of directors on the date of the indenture, or | |
| was nominated for election or elected to such board of directors with the approval of a majority of the continuing directors who were members of such board at the time of such nomination or election. |
A termination of trading will be deemed to have occurred if our common stock is neither listed for trading on a United States national securities exchange nor approved for trading on an established automated over-the-counter trading market in the United States.
The definition of change of control includes a phrase relating to the conveyance, transfer or lease of all or substantially all of our assets. There is no precise established definition of the phrase substantially all under applicable law. As a result, your ability to require us to repurchase your existing notes as a result of a conveyance, transfer or lease of less than all of our assets may be uncertain.
Conversion
You will have the right at any time prior to maturity to convert your existing notes into shares of our common stock at a conversion price of $20.625 per share, subject to adjustment as described below. If an existing note is called for redemption, your conversion right will terminate at the close of business on the business day immediately preceding the date fixed for redemption. Except as described below, no adjustment will be made on conversion of any of your existing notes for accrued interest or dividends. If you convert your existing notes after a record date for the payment of interest and prior to the next succeeding interest payment date, you must pay funds equal to the interest payable on such succeeding interest payment date on your converted principal amount, unless the existing notes have been called for redemption. No fractional shares will be issued upon conversion but a cash adjustment will be made for any fractional interest.
The conversion price is subject to adjustment upon the occurrence of:
(1) the issuance of shares of our common stock as a dividend or distribution on our common stock; | |
(2) the subdivision or combination of our outstanding common stock; | |
(3) the issuance, to substantially all holders of our common stock, of rights or warrants to subscribe for or purchase our common stock, or securities convertible into common stock, at a price less than the current market price; | |
(4) the distribution of shares of our capital stock, rights, warrants, evidences of indebtedness or other assets to all holders of our common stock, but excluding: |
| dividends or distributions for which an adjustment may otherwise made pursuant to clause (1) or (3) above; and | |
| dividends or distributions paid exclusively in cash; |
(5) the distribution or dividend of cash to all holders of our common stock in an aggregate amount that, together with (A) the aggregate of any other distributions of cash that did not trigger a conversion price adjustment to all holders of our common stock within the 12 months preceding the date fixed for determining the shareholders entitled to such distribution and (B) all excess payments in respect of each tender offer or other negotiated transaction by us or any of our subsidiaries for our common stock concluded within the preceding 12 months not triggering a conversion price adjustment, exceeds 15% of our market capitalization; and | |
(6) the payment of an excess payment in respect of a tender offer or other negotiated transaction by us or any of our subsidiaries for our common stock if the aggregate amount of such excess payment together with the aggregate amount of cash distributions made within the preceding 12 months not triggering a conversion price adjustment and all excess payments in respect of each tender offer or other negotiated transaction by us or any of our subsidiaries for our common stock concluded within the |
50
preceding 12 months not triggering a conversion price adjustment exceeds 15% of our market capitalization. |
In the event we distribute to substantially all holders of our common stock rights or warrants to subscribe for additional shares of our capital stock referred to in clause (4) above, we may provide that you will receive upon conversion of your existing notes an appropriate number of such rights or warrants instead of making any adjustment in the conversion price. If the rights, warrants or options for which and adjustment is made pursuant to clauses (3) or (4) above expire unexercised, the conversion price will be readjusted to take into account the actual number of such warrants, rights or options which were exercised. We will not make any adjustment to the conversion price until cumulative adjustments amount to one percent or more of the conversion price.
If we implement a shareholder rights plan, such rights plan must provide that upon conversion of the existing notes the holders will receive, in addition to the common stock issuable upon such conversion, such rights, whether or not such rights have separated from the common stock at the time of such conversion.
If we:
| reclassify or change our outstanding common stock, other than changes resulting from a subdivision or combination, or | |
| consolidate with or merge into any person, or | |
| sell or convey all or substantially all of our property or business as an entirety, |
then the existing notes will become convertible into the kind and amount of securities, cash or other assets which you would have owned immediately after the transaction if you had converted the existing notes immediately before the effective date of the transaction.
The current market price for our common stock on any date shall be deemed to be the average of the daily market prices for the shorter of:
| 30 consecutive business days ending on the last full trading day on the exchange or market referred to in determining the daily market prices prior to the time of determination, or | |
| the period commencing on the date next succeeding the first public announcement of the issuance of such rights or warrants or such distribution through such last full trading day prior to the time of determination. |
excess payment means the excess of:
| the aggregate of the cash and fair market value of other consideration paid by us or any of our subsidiaries with respect to the shares acquired in the tender offer or other negotiated transaction over | |
| the market value of such acquired shares after giving effect to the completion of the tender offer or other negotiated transaction. |
We may reduce the conversion price by any amount for any period of at least 20 days if our board of directors has made a determination that this reduction in the conversion price would be in the best interests of Intevac, which determination shall be conclusive. We will give at least 15 days notice of any such reduction in the conversion price. In addition, we may, at our option, reduce the conversion price if our board of directors deems it advisable to avoid or diminish any income tax to holders of common stock resulting from any dividend or distribution of stock or from any event treated as such for income tax purposes. See Federal Income Tax Considerations.
Subordination of Existing Notes
The existing notes are subordinate in right of payment to all senior debt. As of March 30, 2002, we had no senior debt. See Definitions for a detailed definition of senior debt under the exchange notes indenture.
51
Payments on the existing notes will be subordinated in right of payment to the prior payment in full of all our senior debt. We may not make any payment of principal, premium, if any, or interest on the existing notes or redeem, purchase or otherwise acquire any of the existing notes unless:
| full payment of amounts then due on all senior debt have been made or provided for, and | |
| at the time of and after giving effect to such payment, redemption, purchase or other acquisition, there shall not exist any default on any senior debt that shall not have been cured or waived and that shall have resulted in the full amount of the senior debt being declared due and payable. |
In addition, if any holders of any designated senior debt notify us and the trustee pursuant to a payment blockage notice of the occurrence of a default allowing them to accelerate the maturity of the designated senior debt, we may not make any payment on the existing notes or purchase or redeem or otherwise acquire any of the existing notes for the payment blockage period commencing on the date notice is received and ending on the earlier of:
| the date on which such event of default shall have been cured or waived, or | |
| 180 days from the date notice is received. |
We may resume payments on the existing notes after the end of payment blockage period unless the holders or the representatives of the designated senior debt shall have accelerated its maturity. Holders of designated senior debt shall not be able to deliver more than one payment blockage notice in any consecutive 360-day period, irrespective of the number of defaults on senior debt during this period.
Upon any distribution of our assets in connection with our dissolution, winding-up, liquidation or reorganization or acceleration, all senior debt must be paid in full before the holders of the existing notes are entitled to any payments.
If payment of the existing notes is accelerated because of an event of default, we or the trustee shall promptly notify the holders of senior debt and their representatives of the acceleration of the existing notes. We may not make any payments on the existing notes until five days after such holders of senior debt or their representatives receive notice of such acceleration. Thereafter, we may make payments on the existing notes only if the subordination provisions of the indenture otherwise permit payment at that time.
As a result of these subordination provisions, in the event of our insolvency, holders of the existing notes may recover ratably less than our general creditors.
Merger, Consolidation or Sale of Assets
We may not consolidate or merge with or into (whether or not we are the surviving corporation) any person, or sell, assign, transfer, lease, convey or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of our properties or assets under the indenture unless:
| (A) we are the surviving or continuing corporation or (B) the person formed by or surviving any such consolidation or merger, if other than us, or the person which acquires by sale, assignment, transfer, lease, conveyance or other disposition our properties and assets is a corporation organized or existing under the laws of the United States, any state of the United States or the District of Columbia; | |
| the entity or person formed by or surviving any such consolidation or merger, if other than us, or the person to which such sale, assignment, transfer, lease, conveyance or other disposition will have been made assumes all our obligations under the existing notes and the indenture; | |
| the sale, assignment, transfer, lease, conveyance or other disposition of all or substantially all of our properties or assets shall be as an entirety or substantially as an entirety to one person and this person shall have assumed all our obligations under the existing notes and the indenture; |
52
| immediately after such transaction no default or event of default exists; and | |
| we or such person shall have delivered an officers certificate and an opinion of counsel to the trustee stating that the transaction and the supplemental indenture comply with the indenture and that all conditions precedent in the indenture relating to the transaction have been satisfied. |
Payments for Consent
Neither we nor any of our subsidiaries will pay any consideration to any holder of any existing notes for any consent, waiver or amendment of the indenture unless such consideration is paid to all holders of the existing notes that consent, waive or agree to amend in the time frame set forth in the solicitation documents.
Reports
Whether or not required by the rules and regulations of the Commission, so long as any existing notes are outstanding, we will file with the Commission and, if requested by any holder of existing notes, furnish to such holder all quarterly and annual financial information required to be contained in a filing with the Commission on Forms 10-Q and 10-K. This quarterly and annual financial information would include a Managements Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations and, with respect to the annual consolidated financial statements only, a report on the financial statements by our independent auditors.
Events of Default and Remedies
Each of the following will constitute an event of default under the indenture:
(1) we default for 30 days in the payment when due of interest on the existing notes; | |
(2) we default in payment when due of principal on the existing notes; | |
(3) we default in the payment of the designated event payment in respect of the existing notes on the designated event payment date, whether or not such payment is prohibited by the subordination provisions of the indenture; | |
(4) we fail to provide timely notice of a designated event; | |
(5) we fail for 60 days after notice to comply with any other covenants and agreements contained in the indenture or the existing notes; | |
(6) we or one of our subsidiaries defaults under any mortgage, indenture or instrument under which there may be issued or by which there may be secured or evidenced any indebtedness for money borrowed by us or any of our subsidiaries or the payment of which is guaranteed by us or any of our subsidiaries, whether such indebtedness or guarantee now exists or is created after the date on which the existing notes are first authenticated and issued, which default (A) is a payment default caused by a failure to pay when due principal or interest on such indebtedness within the grace period provided in such indebtedness (which failure continues beyond any applicable grace period) or (B) results in the acceleration of such indebtedness prior to its express maturity and, in each case, the principal amount of any such indebtedness, together with the principal amount of any other such indebtedness under which there has been a payment default or the maturity of which has been so accelerated, aggregates $10 million or more; | |
(7) we or one of our subsidiaries fails to pay final judgments aggregating in excess of $10 million, which judgments are not stayed within 60 days after their entry, other than any judgment as to which a reputable insurance company has accepted full liability; and | |
(8) certain events of bankruptcy or insolvency with respect to us or any of our material subsidiaries. |
If any event of default occurs and is continuing, the trustee or the holders of at least 25% in principal amount of the outstanding existing notes may declare all the existing notes immediately due and payable. However, in an event of default arising from bankruptcy or insolvency with respect to us or any material subsidiary under (8) above, all outstanding existing notes will become immediately due and payable. Holders
53
The holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of outstanding existing notes may waive any existing default or event of default under the indenture except a continuing default or event of default in the payment of the principal, interest or designated event payment on the existing notes.
We are required to deliver to the trustee annually a statement regarding compliance with the indenture. We are also required to deliver to the trustee a notice specifying any default or event of default upon becoming aware of it.
Transfer and Exchange
A holder may transfer or exchange existing notes in accordance with the indenture. The registrar and the trustee may require a holder to furnish appropriate endorsements and transfer documents. We may require a holder to pay any taxes and fees required by law or permitted by the indenture in connection with any transfer of the existing notes. We are not required to exchange or register the transfer of:
| any existing note for a period of 15 days next preceding any selection of existing notes to be redeemed, | |
| any existing note or portion thereof selected for redemption, or | |
| any existing note or portion thereof surrendered for repurchase and not withdrawn in connection with a designated event. |
The registered holder of an existing note will be treated as its owner for all purposes.
Amendment, Supplement and Waiver
The holders of at least a majority in principal amount of the outstanding existing notes may amend or supplement the indenture or the existing notes. The holders of a majority in principal amount of the outstanding existing notes may also waive any existing default or compliance with any provision of the indenture or the existing notes.
However, without the consent of each holder an amendment or waiver may not:
| reduce the amount of existing notes whose holders must consent to an amendment, supplement or waiver, | |
| reduce the principal of or change the fixed maturity of any existing note or alter the provisions with respect to the redemption of the existing notes, | |
| reduce the rate of or change the time for payment of interest on any existing note, | |
| waive a default in the payment of principal of or interest on any existing notes, except a rescission of acceleration of the existing notes by the holders of at least a majority in aggregate principal amount of the existing notes and a waiver of the payment default that resulted from such acceleration, | |
| make any existing note payable in money other than that stated in U.S. dollars, | |
| waive a redemption payment with respect to any existing note, | |
| impair the right to convert the existing notes into common stock, | |
| modify the conversion or subordination provisions of the indenture in a manner adverse to the holders of the existing notes, or | |
| make any change in the foregoing amendment and waiver provisions. |
54
We and the trustee may amend or supplement the indenture or the existing notes without the consent of any holder of existing notes to:
| cure any ambiguity, defect or inconsistency, | |
| provide for uncertificated existing notes, | |
| provide for the assumption of our obligations in the event of a merger or consolidation, | |
| make any change that would provide any additional rights or benefits to the holders of the existing notes or that does not adversely affect the legal rights under the indenture of any such holder, or | |
| to comply with requirements of the Commission in order to qualify, or maintain the qualification of, the indenture under the Trust indenture Act. |
Concerning the Trustee
An affiliate of the trustee is also the transfer agent for our common stock.
The holders of a majority in principal amount of the then outstanding existing notes will have the right to direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for exercising any remedy available to the trustee, subject to certain exceptions. The indenture provides that, in case an event of default shall occur which shall not be cured, the trustee will be required, in the exercise of its power, to use the degree of care of a prudent man in the conduct of his own affairs. Subject to such provisions, the trustee will be under no obligation to exercise any of its rights or powers under the indenture at the request of any holder of existing notes unless such holder shall have offered to the trustee security and indemnity satisfactory to it against any loss, liability or expense.
Definitions
Set forth below are some of the defined terms used in the indenture. We refer you to the indenture for a full disclosure of all these defined terms, including any other capitalized terms that we use in this description that we do not define in this description.
capital stock means any and all shares, interests, participations, rights or other equivalents of equity interests in any entity, including, without limitation, corporate stock and partnership interests.
default means any event that is or, with the passage of time or the giving of notice or both, would be an event of default.
designated senior debt means any senior debt which, at the date of determination, has an aggregate principal amount outstanding of, or commitments to lend up to, at least $10.0 million and is specifically designated by us in the instrument evidencing or governing such senior debt as designated senior debt for purposes of the indenture.
GAAP means generally accepted accounting principles set forth in the opinions and pronouncements of the Accounting Principles Board of the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants and statements and pronouncements of the Financial Accounting Standards Board or in such other statements by such other entity as may be approved by a significant segment of the accounting profession of the United States, which are in effect from time to time.
guarantee means a guarantee, direct or indirect, in any manner, including, without limitation, letters of credit and reimbursement agreements, of all or any part of any indebtedness, other than by endorsement of negotiable instruments for collection in the ordinary course of business.
55
indebtedness means:
(1) all of our obligations for borrowed money, including, but not limited to, any indebtedness secured by a security interest, mortgage or other lien on our assets which is |
| given to secure all or part of the purchase price, whether given to the vendor of such property or to another, or | |
| existing on property at the time of its acquisition, |
(2) all of our obligations evidenced by a note, debenture, bond or other written instrument, | |
(3) all of our obligations under a lease required to be capitalized on the balance sheet of the lessee under GAAP, | |
(4) all of our obligations under any lease or related document, including a purchase agreement which provides that we are contractually obligated to purchase or to cause a third party to purchase the leased property, | |
(5) all of our obligations with respect to letters of credit, bank guarantees or bankers acceptances, | |
(6) all of our obligations with respect to indebtedness secured by a mortgage, pledge, lien, encumbrance, charge or adverse claim affecting title or resulting in an encumbrance to which the property or assets of such person are subject, whether or not the secured obligation thereby shall have been assumed or guaranteed by or shall otherwise be our legal liability, | |
(7) all of our obligations in respect of the balance of deferred and unpaid purchase price of any property or assets, | |
(8) all of our obligations under interest rate, currency or credit swap agreements, cap, floor and collar agreements, spot and forward contracts and similar agreements and arrangements, | |
(9) any and all deferrals, renewals, extensions, refinancings and refundings of, or amendments, modifications or supplements to, any of the foregoing, and | |
(10) all of our obligations of the type described in clauses (1) through (9) above assumed by or guaranteed in any manner by us or in effect guaranteed by us through an agreement to purchase, contingent or otherwise, and our obligations under any such assumptions, guarantees or other such arrangements. |
material subsidiary means any or our subsidiaries which is significant subsidiary as defined in Rule 1-02(w) of Regulation S-X under the Securities Act and the Exchange Act (as such Regulation is in effect on the date hereof).
obligations means any principal, interest, penalties, fees, indemnifications, reimbursements, damages and other liabilities payable under the documentation governing any indebtedness.
representative means the trustee, agent or any representative for an issue of senior debt.
senior debt means the principal of, premium, if any, interest and liquidated damages, if any, on, and fees, costs and expenses in connection with, and other amounts due on, our indebtedness, whether outstanding on the date of the indenture or thereafter created, incurred, assumed or guaranteed by us. Senior debt includes, with respect to the obligations described above, interest accruing, pursuant to the terms of such senior debt, on or after the filing of any petition in bankruptcy or for reorganization relating to us, whether or not post-filing interest is allowed in such proceeding, at the rate specified in the instrument governing the relevant obligation.
However, senior debt shall not include:
| any indebtedness that expressly provides that such indebtedness is not senior in right of payment to the existing notes; |
56
| indebtedness of or amounts owed by us for compensation to employees, or for goods, services or materials purchased in the ordinary course of business; | |
| our indebtedness to one of our subsidiaries; | |
| any liability for Federal, state, local or other taxes owed or owing by us; or | |
| the existing notes. |
subsidiary means any corporation, association or other business entity of which more than 50% of the total voting power of shares of capital stock entitled, without regard to the occurrence of any contingency, to vote in the election of directors, managers or trustees thereof is at the time owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by any person or one or more of the other subsidiaries of that person or a combination thereof.
57
BOOK-ENTRY SYSTEM THE DEPOSITORY TRUST COMPANY
The exchange notes will be evidenced by global securities initially deposited with The Depository Trust Company, or DTC, and registered in the name of Cede & Co., as DTCs nominee. Except as set forth below, the global securities may be transferred only to another nominee of DTC or to a successor of DTC or its nominee.
Holders of exchange notes to be issued in the exchange offer may hold their interests in the global securities directly through DTC or indirectly through organizations which are participants in DTC (called participants). Transfers among participants will be effected in the ordinary way in accordance with DTCs rules and will be settled in clearinghouse funds. The laws of some states require that some persons take physical delivery of securities in definitive form. As a result, holders may be unable to transfer beneficial interests in the global securities to those persons.
Holders that are not participants may beneficially own interests in the global securities held by DTC only through participants or indirect participants, including banks, brokers, dealers, trust companies and other parties that clear through or maintain a custodial relationship with a participant. So long as Cede & Co., as the nominee of DTC, is the registered owner of the global security, Cede & Co. will be considered the sole holder of the global securities for all purposes. Except as provided below, owners of beneficial interests in the global securities will not:
| be entitled to have certificates registered in their names. | |
| be entitled to receive physical delivery of certificates in definitive form, and | |
| be considered registered holders. |
We will make payments of interest, principal, redemption price or repurchase price of the global security for the exchange notes to Cede & Co., the nominee for DTC, as the registered holder of the global security for the exchange notes. We will make these payments by wire transfer of immediately available funds. Neither we, the trustee nor any paying agent will have any responsibility or liability for:
| records or payments on beneficial ownership interests in the global securities; or | |
| maintaining, supervising or reviewing any records relating to those beneficial ownership interests. |
We have been informed that DTCs practice is to credit participants accounts on the payment date. These payments will be made in amounts proportionate to participants beneficial interests in the exchange notes. Payments by participants to owners of beneficial interests in the exchange notes represented by the global security held through participants will be the responsibility of those participants.
We will send any redemption or automatic conversion notices to Cede & Co. We understand that if less than all of the exchange notes are being redeemed or automatically converted, DTCs practice is to determine by lot the amount of the holdings of each participant to be redeemed or converted. We also understand that neither DTC nor Cede & Co. will consent or vote with respect to the exchange notes. We have been advised that under its usual procedures, DTC will mail an omnibus proxy to us as soon as possible after the record date. The omnibus proxy assigns Cede & Co.s consenting or voting rights to those participants to whose accounts the exchange notes are credited on the record date identified in a listing attached to the omnibus proxy.
A person having a beneficial interest in exchange notes represented by global securities may be unable to pledge that interest to persons or entities that do not participate in DTC system, or to take other actions in respect of that interest, because that interest is not represented by a physical certificate.
DTC has advised us that it is:
| a limited purpose trust company organized under the laws of the State of New York; | |
| a member of the Federal Reserve System; |
58
| a clearing corporation within the meaning of the Uniform Commercial Code, and | |
| a clearing agency registered pursuant to the provisions of Section 17A of the Exchange Act. |
DTC was created to hold securities for its participants and to facilitate the clearance and settlement of securities transactions between participants through electronic book-entry changes to accounts of its participants. Some of the participants, together with other entities, own DTC. Indirect access to DTCs book-entry system is available to others such as banks, brokers, dealers and trust companies that clear through, or maintain a custodial relationship with a participant, either directly or indirectly.
DTC is under no obligation to perform or continue to perform the above procedures. DTC may discontinue these at any time. If DTC is at any time unwilling or unable to continue as the depositary for the exchange notes and a successor depositary is not appointed by us within 90 days, we will cause such exchange notes to be issued in definitive form in exchange for their global securities.
59
DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK
General
Our authorized capital stock consists of 50,000,000 shares of common stock, no par value per share and 10,000,000 shares of undesignated preferred stock, no par value per share. As of May 31, 2002, there were 12,060,003 shares of common stock issued and outstanding and no shares of preferred stock issued and outstanding.
Common Stock
The holders of common stock are entitled to one vote per share on all matters to be voted upon by the shareholders. Subject to preferences that may be applicable to any outstanding preferred stock, the holders of common stock are entitled to receive ratably dividends, if any, as may be declared from time to time by our board of directors out of legally available funds. In the event of our liquidation, dissolution or winding up, the holders of common stock are entitled to share ratably in all assets remaining after payment of liabilities, subject to the prior liquidation rights of the preferred stock, if any, then outstanding. The common stock has no preemptive or conversion rights or other subscription rights. There are no redemption or sinking fund provisions applicable to the common stock. All outstanding shares of common stock are fully paid and non-assessable.
Undesignated Preferred Stock
Our board of directors has the authority to issue any undesignated shares of preferred stock in one or more series and to fix the price, rights, preferences, privileges and restrictions of the preferred stock including dividend rights, dividend rates, conversion rights, voting rights, terms of redemption, redemption prices, liquidation preferences and the number of shares constituting any series or the designation of such series, without any further vote or action by the shareholders. The issuance of preferred stock may have the effect of delaying, deferring or preventing a change in control of Intevac without further action by the shareholders. The issuance of preferred stock with voting and conversion rights may adversely affect the voting power of the holders of common stock, including the loss of voting control to others.
Articles of Incorporation and Bylaws
Our Articles of Incorporation authorize the issuance of preferred stock on terms that our Board of Directors has the authority to fix at the time of issuance. Our Articles and Bylaws do not provide for cumulative voting. Our Bylaws also require that any action taken by shareholders must be effected at a duly called annual or special meeting of shareholders and may not be effected by written consent without a meeting. These provisions of our Articles of Incorporation and Bylaws could discourage potential acquisition proposals and could delay or prevent a change in control of Intevac. These provisions are also intended to enhance the likelihood of continuity and stability in the composition of our Board of Directors and in the policies formulated by our Board of Directors and to discourage certain types of transactions that may involve an actual or threatened change of control of Intevac. These provisions are designed to reduce our vulnerability to an unsolicited acquisition proposal. Such provisions, alone or in combination, could have the effect of discouraging others from making tender offers for our shares and, as a consequence, they also may inhibit fluctuations in the market price of our shares that could result from actual or rumored takeover attempts. Such provisions also may have the effect of preventing changes in our management.
Transfer Agent and Registrar
The transfer agent and registrar for the common stock is EquiServe Trust Company, N.A.
60
U.S. FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSIDERATIONS
This section describes the material U.S. federal income tax considerations relating to the exchange offer and the ownership and disposition of exchange notes or common stock into which the exchange notes may be converted. This section does not provide a complete analysis of all potential tax considerations that may be relevant to particular holders of existing notes because of their specific circumstances or because they are subject to special rules. In particular, the discussion does not address the tax considerations relevant to holders that are foreign persons or entities. The information provided below is based on existing authorities. These authorities may change, or the Internal Revenue Service may interpret the existing authorities differently. In either case, the tax consequences of the exchange offer or of owning or disposing of exchange notes or common stock could differ from those described below. This section does not describe the effect of the federal estate and gift tax laws on noteholders or the effects of any applicable foreign, state, or local laws.
Holders of existing notes considering participation in the exchange offer should consult their own tax advisors regarding the application of the U.S. federal income tax laws to their particular situations and the consequences of federal estate or gift tax laws, foreign, state, or local laws, and tax treaties.
The Exchange Offer
The tax consequences of the exchange of existing notes for exchange notes and cash will depend on whether the existing notes and the exchange notes are securities, as the federal income tax laws use that term. In general, the classification of a debt instrument as a security depends on the extent to which the instrument represents an investment in the issuers business. At one extreme, short-term notes backed by adequate security are not securities because the fortunes of the issuers business will have relatively little effect on the holders return. At the other extreme, unsecured, long-term notes issued by a corporation to enable it to fund the development or expansion of its business are securities, because the holders return does depend significantly on the fortunes of the issuers business. The existing authorities do not draw a clear line along this continuum. Each case turns on its own facts, and no prior cases or rulings involve facts that are the same in all material respects as the facts surrounding the exchange offer. Therefore, inherent uncertainty exists regarding whether the existing notes and exchange notes are securities for tax purposes. We believe, however, that, in light of our current financial position, the exchange notes are very likely securities. Our financial position was stronger when the existing notes were issued. Therefore, the classification of the existing notes as securities is more uncertain than the classification of the exchange notes. Nonetheless, we believe that the existing notes are also securities for tax purposes.
Assuming that both the existing notes and the exchange notes are securities, a holder that realizes an economic gain on the exchange will be required to recognize that gain for tax purposes only to the extent of the cash received by the holder in the exchange. A holder that realizes an economic loss on the exchange will not be allowed to deduct that loss. A holders tax basis in its exchange notes will equal the holders tax basis in the existing notes surrendered in the exchange, reduced by the amount of cash received and increased by the amount of any gain recognized on the exchange. The holders holding period for the exchange notes will include the period during which the holder held the existing notes surrendered in the exchange.
A holders economic (or realized) gain or loss on the exchange will be measured by the difference between the value of the consideration received by the holder and the holders tax basis in his existing notes (which will generally equal the amount the holder paid for the existing notes). The value assigned to the exchange notes for tax purposes (referred to as their issue price) will depend on whether public trading of the existing notes provides a reliable basis for determining their fair market value. If so, the issue price of the exchange notes will be derived from the value of the existing notes surrendered in exchange for the exchange notes. If public trading of the existing notes has been insufficient to provide a reliable estimate of their fair market value, the issue price of the exchange notes will be their face amount. Although trading in the existing notes has been relatively thin, we believe that the trading data produce a more reliable estimate of value than an assumption that the exchange notes are worth their face amount. Therefore, we believe that the issue price of the exchange notes for tax purposes should be the value of the existing notes surrendered in the exchange, as determined by market trading. Specifically, the value of exchange notes with a principal amount of $815
61
If it were determined that the trading of the existing notes does not provide a reliable basis for determining their fair market value, the exchange notes would be assigned an issue price equal to their face amount. In that case, the value of the consideration received by holders of existing notes could exceed the value derived from trading in the existing notes. Holders then would be treated as realizing a greater economic gain (or reduced economic loss) than if the issue price of the exchange notes were determined based on trading in the existing notes. A holder that is subject to tax on an increased amount of gain in the exchange, however, would be required to recognize a smaller amount of interest income over the term of the exchange notes, as described below under Tax Treatment of Ownership and Disposition of Exchange Notes Taxation of Interest.
Any gain recognized by a holder on the exchange would generally be capital gain, and would be long-term capital gain if the holder held his existing notes for more than one year. Long-term capital gains recognized by noncorporate taxpayers are subject to tax at lower rates than the rates that apply to ordinary income. If a holder acquired his existing notes at a discount to their face amount, any gain recognized by the holder would be treated as ordinary income in an amount equal to that portion of the holders market discount that accrued during the period between the holders purchase of the existing notes and the date of the exchange.
If it were determined that either the existing notes or the exchange notes are not securities for federal income tax purposes, holders that realize an economic loss on the exchange would be allowed to deduct that loss, while holders that realize an economic gain would be required to recognize that gain in full in accordance with the rules discussed above even if it exceeds the cash received in the exchange. In such a case, a holders tax basis in the exchange notes would equal their issue price. The holders holding period for the exchange notes would begin on the day after the exchange.
Tax Treatment of Ownership and Disposition of Exchange Notes
Taxation of Interest |
If the issue price of the exchange notes is derived from trading in the existing notes, the value of the exchange notes may be less than their face amount. In that case, the holders of exchange notes would receive a greater amount at maturity than the initial value of the notes. Any excess of the amount paid on the maturity of exchange notes over their initial value will be treated for tax purposes as additional interest income (referred to as original issue discount or OID) that will accrue over the term of the exchange notes. Holders will generally be required to recognize any OID as it accrues (regardless of the holders normal method of tax accounting), in addition to recognizing income as a result of coupon interest as it is paid or accrued (in accordance with the holders normal method of tax accounting). A holder that realizes an economic loss on the exchange but is not allowed to deduct that loss may not be required to recognize the full amount of OID that accrues on the exchange notes. Such a holder will have a tax basis in his exchange notes that exceeds their initial value. For such a holder, some or all of the OID will reflect a return of the holders remaining investment. Therefore, the holder will be allowed to exclude from income all or a part of the OID that accrues on the exchange notes. On the other hand, if the holder is allowed to deduct his economic loss (because either the existing notes or the exchange notes do not qualify as securities for federal income tax purposes), then the holder would be required to include in income the full amount of OID as it accrues.
Upon the occurrence of a change of control, holders may require us to redeem the exchange notes at a price equal to 101% of their principal amount. In such an event, the holder would receive an even greater premium above the initial value of exchange notes. Contingent payments such as these can be disregarded in computing OID, however, when there is only a remote chance that they will be made. Because we believe that it is remote that a change of control would occur that would allow holders to have the exchange notes redeemed at a premium, we will ignore this possibility in computing OID on the exchange notes.
If the public trading of the existing notes were determined to be insufficient to provide a reliable measure of fair market value, and the exchange notes were assigned an issue price equal to their face amount, holders
62
Constructive Distributions |
The terms of the exchange notes allow for changes in the conversion price of the notes in certain circumstances. A change in conversion price that allows noteholders to receive more shares of common stock on conversion may increase the noteholders proportionate interests in our earnings and profits or assets. In that case, the noteholders would be treated as though they received a dividend in the form of our stock. Such a constructive stock dividend could be taxable to the noteholders, although they would not actually receive any cash or other property. A potentially taxable constructive stock dividend would result, for example, if the conversion price is adjusted to compensate noteholders for distributions of cash or property to our shareholders. Not all changes in conversion price that allow noteholders to receive more stock on conversion, however, increase the noteholders proportionate interests in Intevac. For instance, a change in conversion price could simply prevent the dilution of the noteholders interests upon a stock split or other change in capital structure. Changes of this type, if made by a bona fide, reasonable adjustment formula, are not treated as constructive stock dividends. Any potentially taxable constructive stock dividends resulting from a change to, or failure to change, the conversion price would be treated like dividends paid in cash or other property. The constructive dividends would result in ordinary income to the recipient, to the extent of our current or accumulated earnings and profits, with any excess treated as a tax-free return of capital or as capital gain. See Tax Treatment of Ownership and Disposition of Common Stock Dividends, below.
Sale, Exchange or Redemption of the Exchange Notes |
A noteholder will generally recognize capital gain or loss if the holder disposes of an exchange note in a sale, redemption or exchange other than a conversion of the exchange note into common stock. The holders gain or loss will equal the difference between the proceeds received by the holder and the holders adjusted tax basis in the exchange note. The proceeds received by the holder will include the amount of any cash and the fair market value of any other property received for the exchange note. The holders adjusted tax basis in the exchange note will equal the holders initial basis, determined as described above under The Exchange Offer, increased by the amount of OID included in the holders income during the period that the holder held his exchange note. The portion of any proceeds that is attributable to accrued interest will not be taken into account in computing the holders gain or loss. Instead, that portion will be recognized as ordinary interest income to the extent that the holder has not previously included the accrued interest in income. The gain or loss recognized by a holder on a disposition of an exchange note will be treated as capital except to the extent that the holder acquired his existing notes at a discount to their face amount and realized an economic gain on the exchange of existing notes for exchange notes but was not required to recognize that gain. The amount of any unrecognized gain on the exchange would be treated as market discount. Any gain recognized by the holder on a disposition of the exchange note would be treated as ordinary income in the amount of that market discount that accrued during the time that the holder held the exchange notes. Any capital gain or loss recognized by a holder on a disposition of exchange notes would be long-term capital gain or loss if the holders holding period for the exchange note is more than one year. As noted above under The Exchange Offer, the holders holding period for the exchange note should include the period during which the holder held his existing note.
Conversion of the Exchange Notes |
A holder generally will not recognize any income, gain or loss on converting an exchange note into common stock. If the holder receives cash in lieu of a fractional share of stock, however, the holder would be treated as if he received the fractional share and then had the fractional share redeemed for the cash. The
63
Tax Treatment of Ownership and Disposition of Common Stock
Dividends |
If, after converting an exchange note into common stock, a holder receives a distribution in respect of that stock, the distribution will be treated as a dividend, taxable to the holder as ordinary income, to the extent it is paid from our current or accumulated earnings and profits. If the distribution exceeds our current and accumulated profits, the excess will be treated first as a tax-free return of the holders investment, up to the holders basis in his common stock. Any remaining excess will be treated as capital gain. If the holder is a U.S. corporation, it would generally be able to claim a deduction equal to a portion of any dividends received.
Sale of Common Stock |
A holder will generally recognize capital gain or loss on a sale or exchange of common stock. The holders gain or loss will equal the difference between the proceeds received by the holder and the holders adjusted tax basis in the stock. The gain or loss recognized by a holder on a sale or exchange of stock will be long-term capital gain or loss if the holders holding period for the stock is more than one year. As explained above under The Exchange Offer, and Tax Treatment of Ownership and Disposition of Exchange Notes Conversion of the Exchange Notes, a holders holding period for stock received on a conversion of exchange notes should include the period during which the holder held his exchange notes and also the period during which the holder held the existing notes that he surrendered in exchange for the exchange notes. If a holder acquired his existing notes at a discount to their face amount, and realized an economic gain on the exchange of existing notes for exchange notes but was not required to recognize that gain, the unrecognized gain would be treated as market discount. Any market discount that accrued during the period that the holder held the exchange notes would carry over from the exchange notes to the common stock received on conversion of the exchange notes. To the extent of any such market discount, any gain recognized by a holder on a sale or exchange of common stock would be treated as ordinary income rather than capital gain.
Backup Withholding and Information Reporting
The Code and the Treasury regulations require those who make specified payments to report the payments to the IRS. Among the specified payments are interest, dividends, and proceeds paid by brokers to their customers. The required information returns enable the IRS to determine whether the recipient properly included the payments in income. This reporting regime is reinforced by backup withholding rules. These rules require the payors to withhold tax from payments subject to information reporting if the recipient fails to cooperate with the reporting regime by failing to provide his taxpayer identification number to the payor, furnishing an incorrect identification number, or repeatedly failing to report interest or dividends on his returns. The withholding tax rate is currently 30 percent, but will be reduced to 29 percent effective January 1, 2004, and to 28 percent effective January 1, 2006. The information reporting and backup withholding rules do not apply to payments to corporations.
Payments of interest or dividends to individual holders of exchange notes or common stock will generally be subject to information reporting, and will be subject to backup withholding unless the holder provides us or our paying agent with a correct taxpayer identification number.
Payments made by a broker to a holder of exchange notes or common stock upon a sale of the exchange notes or common stock will generally be subject to information reporting and backup withholding. If, however, the sale is made through a foreign office of a U.S. broker, the sale will be subject to information reporting but not backup withholding. If the sale is made through a foreign office of a foreign broker, the sale will generally not be subject to either information reporting or backup withholding. This exception may not apply, however, if the foreign broker is owned or controlled by U.S. persons, or is engaged in a U.S. trade or business.
64
Any amounts withheld from a payment to a holder of exchange notes or common stock under the backup withholding rules can be credited against any U.S. federal income tax liability of the holder.
Each prospective investor should consult its own tax advisor regarding the particular U.S. federal, state, local, and foreign tax consequences of the exchange offer and of holding and disposing of exchange notes, common stock, including the consequences of any proposed change in applicable laws.
65
WHERE YOU CAN FIND ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
We file reports, proxy statements and other information with the Commission, in accordance with the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. You may read and copy our reports, proxy statements and other information filed by us at the public reference facilities of the Commission in Washington, D.C. and Chicago, Illinois. Please call the Commission at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information about the public reference rooms. Our reports, proxy statements and other information filed with the Commission are available to the public over the Internet at the Commissions World Wide Web site at http://www.sec.gov.
Our Annual Report on Form 10-K for our fiscal year ended December 31, 2001 is attached as Appendix A hereto, our Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 30, 2002 is attached as Appendix B hereto, our Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A, filed March 27, 2002 is attached as Appendix C hereto, our Tender Offer Statement on Schedule TO, filed May 8, 2002 is attached as Appendix D hereto, Amendment No. 2 to our Tender Offer Statement on Schedule TO, filed June 6, 2002 is attached as Appendix E hereto and Amendment No. 4 to our Tender Offer Statement on Schedule TO, filed June 20, 2002 is attached as Appendix F hereto. Such Appendices are considered to be part of this offering circular.
You may request a copy of these filings, at no cost, by writing or telephoning us at the following address:
Mr. Charles Eddy, Vice President
You should rely only on the information contained in this offering circular. We have not authorized anyone else to provide you with different information. You should not assume that the information provided in this offering circular is accurate as of any date other than the date as of which it is shown, or if no date is otherwise indicated, the date of this offering circular and neither the delivery of this offering circular nor the offering, sale or delivery of any exchange notes and warrants shall create any implication that the information contained in this offering circular is correct at any time after the date of this offering circular No representation is made to any offeree or purchaser of the exchange notes regarding the legality of an investment in the exchange notes by the offeree or purchaser under any applicable legal investment or similar laws or regulations. The contents of this offering circular are not to be construed as legal, business or tax advice. You should consult your own attorney, business advisor and tax advisor as to legal, business or tax advice with respect to the exchange offer.
66
APPENDIX A
ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 10-K
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Form 10-K
(Mark One)
|
||
þ
|
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR
15(d)
OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 |
|
For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2001 | ||
or | ||
o
|
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR
15(d)
OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 |
|
For the transition period from to |
Commission file number 0-26946
94-3125814
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
(I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)
Registrants telephone number, including
area code: (408) 986-9888
Securities registered pursuant to
Section 12(b) of the Act: None
Title of each class
Name of each Exchange on which registered
None
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant: (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes þ No o
Indicate by a check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrants knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K. þ
The aggregate market value of voting stock held by non-affiliates of the Registrant, as of February 21, 2002 was approximately $13,791,000 (based on the closing price for shares of the Registrants Common Stock as reported by the Nasdaq National Market System for the last trading day prior to that date). Shares of Common Stock held by each executive officer, director, and holder of 5% or more of the outstanding Common Stock have been excluded in that such persons may be deemed to be affiliates. This determination of affiliate status is not necessarily a conclusive determination for other purposes.
On February 20, 2002 approximately 12,060,003 shares of the Registrants Common Stock, no par value, were outstanding.
DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE.
Portions of the Registrants Proxy Statement for the 2002 Annual Meeting of Shareholders are incorporated by reference into Part III. Such proxy statement will be filed within 120 days after the end of the fiscal year covered by this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
This Annual Report on Form 10-K contains forward-looking statements which involve risks and uncertainties. Words such as believes, expects, anticipates and the like indicate forward-looking statements. Intevacs actual results may differ materially from the results discussed in the forward-looking statements for a variety of reasons, including those set forth under Certain Factors Which May Affect Future Operating Results.
PART I
Item 1. Business
Overview
Intevac, Inc.s businesses are the design, manufacture and sale of complex capital equipment used to manufacture products such as flat panel displays, thin-film disks and electro-optical devices (Equipment) and the development of highly sensitive electro-optical devices and systems (Photonics).
Systems sold by the Equipment Division are typically used to deposit highly engineered thin-films of material on a substrate, or to modify the characteristics and properties of thin-films already deposited on a substrate. Systems manufactured by the Equipment Division generally utilize proprietary manufacturing techniques and processes and operate under high levels of vacuum. The systems are designed for high-volume continuous operation and use precision robotics, computerized controls and complex software programs to fully automate and control the production process. Products manufactured with these systems include color cell phone displays, automotive displays, computer monitors, and thin-film disks for computer hard disk drives. The Equipment Division has also designed ultra-high vacuum automated equipment for the manufacture of low-cost low-light level cameras developed by the Photonics Division and for sale to other manufacturers of electro-optical devices. The Equipment Division recorded sales of $42.7 million in 2001, an increase from $28.8 million in 2000. Equipment Division revenues in 2001 resulted primarily from the sales of new flat panel display (FPD) manufacturing systems and technology upgrades, spare parts and consumables for disk manufacturing equipment.
The Photonics Division is developing electro-optical devices and systems that permit highly sensitive detection of photons in the visible and short wave infrared portions of the spectrum. This development work is aimed at creating new products for both military and industrial applications. Products include LIVAR® systems for positive target identification at long range, low-cost low-light-level cameras for use in security and military applications and photodiodes for use in high-speed fiber optic systems. Photonics Division sales increased to $8.8 million in 2001 from $7.3 million in 2000 and consisted primarily of contract research and development. The Photonics Division has completed approximately $30 million of government-sponsored research and development since 1994.
Equipment
Technology and Strategy |
The Equipment Divisions systems utilize sophisticated vacuum process technologies that are integrated with precision robotics and automated process and system controls. The Companys systems are designed for high volume manufacturing applications and are commonly operated 24 hours a day 7 days a week with high uptime. Process technologies include physical vapor deposition, chemical vapor deposition, fast cooling, rapid thermal processing and ultra high vacuum level processing. Intevacs equipment strategy is to expand into growing equipment markets where its existing technology base can be leveraged to reduce the cost of entry and participation in those markets. For example, the deposition and rapid thermal processing equipment developed to address the FPD market and the equipment developed to manufacture Photonics Division low-cost low-light level cameras, incorporate many of the manufacturing technologies previously developed by the Company for high volume manufacturing of thin-film disks and night vision devices.
1
Deposition Equipment for Flat Panel Display Manufacturing |
The manufacture of several types of flat panel displays, such as active matrix liquid crystal displays, require the deposition of thin-film layers of different materials onto a glass substrate. Intevacs D-Star sputtering systems are designed to uniformly coat thin films on substrates as large as a meter square. Deposition materials include metals such as aluminum and chromium (used as conductors), indium tin oxide (used as transparent conductors) and complex oxides of materials such as magnesium (used in plasma displays), tantalum and silicon. Process modules are positioned around a central handling module designed to provide high throughput. Up to four back-to-back modules, each containing two vacuum isolated chambers, can be attached directly to the central handler unit. Additional back-to-back modules may also be attached in series to provide further process flexibility and capacity. Typically one module is devoted to load/unload and the remaining positions are configured as dedicated process stations. Substrates are loaded into the system with a robot and then held on edge in a vertical orientation as they are processed. Vertical substrate handling allows for a relatively small footprint system, optimizes particulate control and reduces flexing of the substrate.
Rapid Thermal Processing Equipment for Flat Panel Display Manufacturing |
Intevacs rapid thermal processing (RTP) systems rapidly modify the characteristics of thin films deposited on glass substrates used in the manufacture of flat panel displays. Intevacs patented RTP technology enables manufacturers to change the properties of these thin-films by thermally processing the film layer at temperatures that would otherwise distort or destroy the underlying glass substrate. The RTP system employs rapid transient heating, rather than bulk substrate heating, which provides lower cost of ownership and higher throughput as compared to furnace and laser processing techniques. In transient heating, a uniform line of radiation is focused onto a moving substrate, which brings only a narrow stripe of the substrate up to peak process temperature at any time. The substrate remains undistorted because the large majority of its area is relatively cool and acts to stabilize the overall panel. Intevacs RTP systems are typically used for thin-film activation after ion implant in the manufacture of low temperature polysilicon displays. Intevacs RTP system customers include Sanyo, Sharp, Sony, Toppoly and a joint venture of Sony and Toyota.
Equipment for Disk Manufacturing |
Intevac has delivered approximately 110 of its MDP-250 disk manufacturing systems to customers including Fuji Electric, Fujitsu Limited, Hitachi, Komag, Maxtor, Mitsubishi, Nippon Sheet Glass, Seagate Technology, Sony and Trace Storage Technology. Intevacs systems are used by disk manufacturers to apply thin layers of undercoats, magnetic alloys and protective overcoats to both aluminum and glass thin-film disks used in computer hard disk drives. The Company believes that Intevac systems are used to manufacture approximately half the worldwide supply of these disks. The mechanical design of the MDP-250 family has characteristics similar to the cluster tools widely used in semiconductor manufacturing in that each of the twelve process stations is separately vacuum pumped and vacuum isolated. The MDP-250 does not require a carrier or pallet to transport disks through the system. Rather, disks are automatically loaded into the system from cassettes, processed, and then automatically returned to the cassette. A number of process station options are offered, including multiple options for the deposition of thin-films and carbon overcoats, heating stations, cooling stations and cleaning stations. Furthermore, these twelve process stations can be easily reconfigured to accommodate process changes.
The rapid increase in areal density in computer memory storage is requiring the thin-films deposited by our MDP-250 series of equipment to become more complex. This complexity is leading to the need for both new process capabilities and a need for more than twelve process stations. Intevac continues to develop new process capabilities for its installed base of systems. These new capabilities include processes that permit the deposition of ultra-thin diamond-like carbon overcoats, vapor lubrication and, currently in development, multi-layer sources and soft underlayer sources necessary for perpendicular recording. To answer the need for more process stations, Intevac introduced the MDP-200, a modular add-on system that allows manufacturers to seamlessly integrate additional process stations onto their MDP-250 system. The MDP-200 provides the capability to process disks through process stations serially or in parallel, giving manufacturers flexibility to integrate process steps with different process times. Intevac has also developed a suite of system upgrades
2
The process and system technologies that Intevac developed for its MDP-250 systems have been designed to be backwards compatible and, in many cases, field installable. Intevac believes that the primary demand for disk manufacturing equipment for the next few years will be for upgrades to the installed base of systems, rather than for sales of new systems to add capacity. Intevacs strategy is to provide its customers with a cost-effective solution that significantly upgrades and extends the capabilities of their installed base of equipment.
Electron Beam Processing Equipment |
In December 1999, Intevac implemented a plan to terminate its electron beam product line. The plan included the delivery of the three electron beam systems on order, closure of the Hayward facility where the systems were manufactured and a $1.6 million charge related to the plan. In March 2000, the Company sold the electron beam business to Quemex Technology, Ltd. and Quemex assumed responsibility for Intevacs Hayward facility. Intevac retained rights to the three systems on order, which were subsequently sold during 2000 and 2001.
Photonics
History |
Intevacs Photonics products have been developed by a team that initially began working together in the 1980s in the Varian central research labs and night vision business unit. When Intevac was formed in 1991, it acquired Varians night vision business, and the related Varian central research lab activities and technology. The central research lab group became part of the R&D department for Intevacs night vision business and continued to develop Intevacs photocathode technology. In 1995, Intevac sold its night vision business to Litton Industries. However, the technical team remained at Intevac and formed the Photonics Division. Since 1995 the Photonics Division has been further developing its technology, with the majority of its activities being funded by R&D contracts from the United States Government and its contractors. During this period the Photonics Division has also worked collaboratively with other research organizations, including Stanford University, Lawrence Livermore National Laboratory and The Charles Stark Draper Laboratory.
Technology and Strategy |
The Photonics Division develops and manufactures compact electro-optical devices that permit highly sensitive detection of photons in the visible and short wave infrared portions of the spectrum. One of these sensors is an Electron Bombarded Charge Coupled Device (EBCCD) which was originally developed under a cost-sharing Technology Development Agreement with the Defense Advanced Research Projects Agency (DARPA) from 1996 to 1998.
The sensor has a transparent glass window on one side through which photons are focused onto a photocathode grown on the vacuum side of the window. When photons strike the photocathode through the window, electrons are emitted into the vacuum. These electrons are then electrically accelerated through the vacuum and strike a charge coupled device (CCD) imager, which in turn outputs a high resolution, low noise video signal. These devices are extraordinarily sensitive to infrared light with frequencies just beyond the visible spectrum and are used in the Companys LIVAR target identification system.
A second type of sensor incorporates the same basic technology described above; however, the module contains a Complementary Metal-Oxide-Semiconductor (CMOS) imager instead of a CCD chip. This Electron Bombarded Active Pixel Sensor (EBAPS TM ) imager development was initially funded under a cost sharing project awarded to Intevac by the National Institute of Standards and Technology (NIST).
Both of these sensors offer both high sensitivity and high resolution and work well in the visible as well as the near infrared range of the spectrum. The output is high-resolution video, rather than the low-resolution direct view green imagery produced by traditional night vision devices. This frees the user from having to hold
3
LIVAR Target Identification System: |
Intevac integrated its EBCCD sensor with a laser illuminator to create its Laser Illuminated Viewing and Ranging system (LIVAR). The LIVAR system is similar to RADAR, but with a number of improvements. The illuminator is an eye safe laser, rather than a longer wavelength microwave source, and the reflected signal is displayed as a digital video image, rather than as a blip. This enables real time, high-resolution imagery for target identification at much longer ranges than was previously possible.
The potential benefit of the LIVAR system is clear for military conflicts like those in Kosovo and Afghanistan. In such conflicts, casualties to US servicemen are politically unacceptable, and it is preferable for aircraft to operate at high altitudes where they are relatively safe from ground launched missile attacks. It is also unacceptable to inflict collateral damage to the other sides civilians or to other untargeted assets. However, these goals are mutually exclusive unless capability exists for positively identifying targets from long ranges.
Currently the military uses several means for target location and identification including forward-looking infrared (FLIR) systems and RADAR. While these systems can sense targets at relatively long ranges, the resolution is poor, and positive identification is difficult, or impossible. The LIVAR system complements the existing FLIR and RADAR technology and enables long range target identification in addition to target sensing.
The first military program planning the widespread deployment of LIVAR was approved late in 2001. Intevac is under contract for the development phase of the program and volume production is expected to commence in late 2003. In February 2002 Intevac delivered a portable LIVAR targeting and surveillance system to the U.S. Army.
Low Cost Low Light Level Cameras |
Todays low light level cameras, derived from military night vision technology, are too expensive for most commercial applications. Intevacs objective is to reduce this cost to $1,000 per camera, a cost at which the Company believes that large available markets for commercial security cameras, law enforcement and traditional military night vision tubes could be addressed. Intevac is currently developing this low light level video camera with National Semiconductor under a program sponsored by NIST. The NIST program involves the development of a CMOS chip that integrates an active pixel imaging sensor with camera electronics by National Semiconductor, photocathode design, product integration and packaging and development of low cost manufacturing processes by Intevacs Photonics Division, and development of ultra-high vacuum automated processing and assembly equipment by Intevacs Equipment Division. Intevac plans to begin commercial sales late in 2002.
Photodiodes for Fiber Optic Communications |
Photodiodes are an essential part of todays fiber optic communication systems. These systems transmit huge volumes of data at high speed in the form of light pulses transmitted down a thin fiber optic strand. A critical element of these systems is the photodiode that converts light pulses from the fiber optic into electrical signals. Intevac has applied its patented technology to the development of 10 gigabit per second and 40 gigabit per second Indium Gallium Arsenide Indium Phosphide photodiodes. These photodiodes offer significant advantages over conventional Indium Gallium Arsenide detectors by combining high operating speed, good responsivity, low dark current, and high output. Intevac began furnishing samples of these devices in die form to fiber optic system component manufacturers during 2001.
4
Competition
We believe that the principal competitive factors affecting the markets for our products include price, product performance and functionality, integration and manageability of products, customer support and service, reputation and reliability. Intevacs equipment products experience intense competition worldwide from competitors including Anelva Corporation, Ulvac Japan, Ltd. and Unaxis Holdings, Ltd., each of which have sold substantial numbers of systems worldwide. Anelva, Ulvac and Unaxis all have substantially greater financial, technical, marketing, manufacturing and other resources than Intevac. There can be no assurance that Intevacs competitors will not develop enhancements to, or future generations of, competitive products that offer superior price or performance features or that new competitors will not enter Intevacs markets and develop such enhanced products.
Given the lengthy sales cycle and the significant investment required to integrate equipment into the manufacturing process, Intevac believes that once a manufacturer has selected a particular suppliers equipment for a specific application, that manufacturer generally relies upon that suppliers equipment and frequently will continue to purchase any additional equipment for that application from the same supplier. Accordingly, competition for customers in the equipment industry is intense, and suppliers of equipment may offer substantial pricing concessions and incentives to attract new customers or retain existing customers.
Intevac believes that its Photonics products are significantly differentiated from and offer significant advantages over other competing products and technologies and that the Company has favorable patent protection for much of its Photonics technology. However, the Company believes that competitors will arise for its Photonics products, and that these competitors may have greater resources than the Company.
Research and Development
Intevacs products serve markets characterized by rapid technological change and evolving industry standards. Intevac routinely invests substantial amounts in research and development and expects to continue an active development program. Intevacs research and development expenses were $14.5 million, $10.6 million and $14.1 million, respectively, in 2001, 2000 and 1999. Research and development expenses represented 28%, 29% and 33%, respectively, of net revenues in 2001, 2000 and 1999. Intevac expects that research and development spending will decline during 2002 as the result of the completion during 2001 of the majority of the design activities related to development of the D-STAR, RTP and MDP-200 platforms.
Research and development expenses do not include costs of $8.0 million, $6.0 million and $5.9 million in 2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively, related to Photonics contract research and development which are included in cost of goods sold. Research and development expenses also do not include costs of $0.5 million, $0.7 million and $1.1 million incurred by Intevac in 2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively, and reimbursed under the terms of research and development cost sharing agreements related to development of disk and flat panel manufacturing equipment.
Sales Channel, Customers and Marketing
Domestic sales are made by the Companys direct sales force, whereas international sales are made by distributors and representatives that provide services such as sales, installation, warranty and customer support. The Company also has a subsidiary in Singapore to support customers in Southeast Asia. Through the second quarter of 2000, Intevac marketed its flat panel manufacturing equipment to the Far East through its Japanese joint venture, IMAT. During the third quarter of 2000 the Company and its joint venture partner, Matsubo, transferred IMATs activities and employees to Matsubo, which became a distributor of the Companys flat panel products, and shut down the operations of IMAT.
The selling process for Intevacs equipment products is often a multi-level and long-term process involving individuals from marketing, engineering, operations, customer service and senior management. The process involves making samples for the prospective customer and responding to individual needs for moderate levels of machine customization. Installing and integrating new equipment requires a substantial investment by a customer. Sales of Intevacs systems depend, in significant part, upon the decision of a prospective
5
The selling process for Intevacs Photonics business primarily involves the solicitation of contracts and subcontracts from government agencies and from government contractors and subcontractors. Some contracts are bid at a fixed price, some contracts are bid at cost plus a fee and some contracts are bid on a cost-sharing basis. The sales process involves government procurement regulations and is dependant on the continuing availability of government funding for the Companys research programs. Future production orders for Intevacs military products depend on the government funding of weapons systems that will utilize Intevac products such as LIVAR.
Historically, a significant portion of the Companys revenues in any particular period have been attributable to sales to a limited number of customers. In 2001, Equipment sales through Matsubo, the Companys Japanese distributor, accounted for 49% of net revenues. In 2000, MMC Technology, Seagate, Westt and Matsubo each accounted for more than 10% of Intevacs consolidated revenues and in aggregate accounted for 56% of net revenues. In 1999, Matsubo, Seagate and Lockheed Martin each accounted for more than 10% of Intevacs consolidated revenues and in aggregate accounted for 66% of net revenues. Intevacs largest customers change from period to period and it is expected that sales of its products to relatively few customers will continue to account for a high percentage of its net revenues in the foreseeable future.
Foreign sales accounted for 73% of revenues in 2001, 27% of revenues in 2000 and 60% of revenues in 1999. The majority of Intevacs foreign sales are to companies in the Far East and Intevac anticipates that sales to customers in the Far East will continue to be a significant portion of its Equipment revenues.
Customer Support
Intevac provides process and applications support, customer training, installation, start-up assistance and emergency service support to its customers. Process and applications support is provided by Intevacs equipment process engineers who also visit customers at their plants to assist in process development projects. Intevac conducts training classes for process engineers, machine operators and machine service personnel. Additional training is also given during the machine installation. Installation and start up support is generally provided within the United States by the Intevac customer service organization. This group also assists with the installation and start up of systems in overseas locations as required.
Intevac generally provides a one-year warranty on its equipment. During this warranty period any necessary non-consumable parts are supplied and installed. Intevac employees provide field service support primarily in the United States, Singapore and Malaysia. In other countries, field service support is provided by Intevacs distributors and sales representatives, supplemented by Intevac factory support. Intevac and its distributors stock consumables and spare parts to support the installed base of systems. These parts are available on a 24-hour per day basis.
Manufacturing
All of Intevacs manufacturing is conducted at its facility in Santa Clara, California. Intevacs Equipment manufacturing operations include electromechanical assembly, mechanical and vacuum assembly, fabrication of the sputter sources and system assembly, alignment and testing. Intevacs Photonics manufacturing operations include growth of advanced photocathodes and assembly of complex vacuum devices under clean room conditions utilizing a number of advanced processing techniques. Intevac makes extensive use of the infrastructure serving the semiconductor equipment business. Intevac purchases vacuum pumps, valves, instrumentation and fittings, power supplies, printed wiring board assemblies, computers and control circuitry and custom mechanical parts made by forging, machining and welding. Intevac has a well-equipped
6
Intevacs manufacturing strategy is to operate with low fixed costs, to produce high quality, cost-effective systems and low cost replacement parts and to be able to respond effectively to changes in volume. To do this, Intevac currently designs its products to use standard parts where possible. Intevac performs manufacturing activities that add value or that require unique technology or specialized knowledge and, taking advantage of its Silicon Valley location, utilizes subcontractors to perform other manufacturing activities.
Backlog
Intevacs backlog was $30.6 million and $42.1 million at December 31, 2001 and December 31, 2000, respectively. Intevac includes in its backlog only those customer orders for systems, component parts and contract research and development for which it has accepted signed purchase orders with assigned delivery dates. The equipment requirements of Intevacs customers cannot be determined with accuracy, and therefore Intevacs backlog at any certain date may not be indicative of future demand for Intevacs products.
The reduction in backlog was primarily due to a reduction in the number of FPD deposition systems on order. The Company delivered 5 systems in 2001 and has 1 system in backlog at December 31, 2001. Intevacs backlog at December 31, 2001 is mostly scheduled for delivery or customer acceptance during the first half of 2002.
Patents and Licensing
Intevac currently holds 36 patents issued in the United States and 22 patents issued in foreign countries, and has patent applications pending in the United States and foreign countries. Of the 36 U.S. patents, 12 relate to disk equipment, 12 relate to flat panel equipment and 12 relate to photonics. Four foreign patents relate to disk equipment, 5 relate to flat panel equipment and 13 relate to photonics. In addition, Intevac has the right to utilize certain patents under licensing arrangements with Litton Industries, Stanford University, Lawrence Livermore Laboratories and Alum Rock Technology.
Employees
At December 31, 2001, Intevac had 183 employees, including 7 contract employees. 84 of these employees were in research and development, 67 in manufacturing, and 32 in administration, customer support and marketing.
Certain Factors Which May Affect Future Operating Results
$37.5 Million of convertible notes are outstanding and will mature in 2004. |
In connection with the sale of $57.5 million of its 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes Due 2004 (the Convertible Notes) in February 1997, Intevac incurred a substantial increase in the ratio of long-term debt to total capitalization (shareholders equity plus long-term debt). At the noteholders option, the Convertible Notes may be exchanged, prior to maturity, into Intevac common shares at a price of $20.625 per share, which is substantially above current market price. During 2001 and 1999 Intevac spent a total of $11.9 million to repurchase $20.0 million of the Convertible Notes. The $37.5 million of the Convertible Notes that remain outstanding as of December 31, 2001 commit Intevac to substantial principal and interest obligations that are significantly in excess of the Companys $18.2 million cash balance at December 31, 2001. Intevac may, from time to time, repurchase and retire additional Convertible Notes prior to their maturity date.
The degree to which Intevac is leveraged could have an adverse effect on Intevacs ability to obtain additional financing for working capital, acquisitions or other purposes, and could make it more vulnerable to industry downturns and competitive pressures. Intevacs ability to meet its debt service obligations will be dependent on Intevacs future performance, which will be subject to financial, business and other factors affecting the operations of Intevac, many of which are beyond its control. In the event that the Companys noteholders do not choose to exchange their Convertible Notes for Intevac common stock prior to the
7
The majority of Intevacs new products address new and emerging markets. |
Intevac has invested heavily in the development of products that address new markets. The Equipment Division has developed a flexible deposition tool and a rapid thermal processing tool to address growing segments of the FPD equipment market that are intended to displace products offered by competing manufacturers. The Photonics Divisions LIVAR target identification system and low-cost low-light level camera products are designed to offer significantly improved capability relative to any products currently offered in the marketplace. Additionally, the Photonics Division is entering a new market for the Company with its photodiodes for fiber optic communication systems. Failure of these products to perform as intended or to successfully penetrate these new markets and develop into profitable product lines will have an adverse effect on Intevacs business.
Demand for capital equipment is cyclical. |
Intevacs sells capital equipment to capital intensive industries, which sell commodity products such as flat panel displays and disk drives. These industries operate with high fixed costs. When demand for these commodity products exceeds capacity, then demand for new capital equipment such as Intevacs tends to be amplified. When supply of these commodity products exceeds capacity, then demand for new capital equipment such as Intevacs tends to be depressed. The cyclical nature of the capital equipment industry means that in some years sales of new systems by the Company will be unusually high, and that in other years sales of new systems by the Company will be severely depressed. Failure to anticipate or respond quickly to the industry business cycle could have an adverse effect on Intevacs business.
The Equipment Business is subject to rapid technical change. |
Intevacs ability to remain competitive requires substantial investments in research and development. The failure to develop, manufacture and market new systems, or to enhance existing systems, will have an adverse effect on Intevacs business. From time to time in the past, Intevac has experienced delays in the introduction of, and technical difficulties with, some of its systems and enhancements. Intevacs future success in developing and selling equipment will depend upon a variety of factors, including accurate prediction of future customer requirements, technology advances, cost of ownership, introduction of new products on schedule, cost-effective manufacturing and product performance in the field. Intevacs new product decisions and development commitments must anticipate continuously evolving industry requirements significantly in advance of sales. Any failure to accurately predict customer requirements and to develop new generations of products to meet those requirements would have an adverse effect on Intevacs business.
Our products are complex, constantly evolving and are often designed and manufactured to individual customer requirements that require additional engineering. |
Intevacs Equipment Division products have a large number of components and are highly complex. Intevac may experience delays and technical and manufacturing difficulties in future introductions or volume production of new systems or enhancements. In addition, some of the systems built by Intevac must be customized to meet individual customer site or operating requirements. Intevac has limited manufacturing capacity and engineering resources and may be unable to complete the development, manufacture and shipment of its products, or to meet the required technical specifications for its products in a timely manner. Such delays could lead to rescheduling of orders in backlog, or in extreme situations, to cancellation of orders. In addition, Intevac may incur substantial unanticipated costs early in a products life cycle, such as increased engineering, manufacturing, installation and support costs which may not be able to be passed on to the customer. In some instances, Intevac is dependent upon a sole supplier or a limited number of suppliers for
8
The Photonics Business does not yet generate significant revenues from product sales. |
To date the activities of the Photonics Division have concentrated on the development of its technology and prototype products that demonstrate this technology. Revenues have been derived primarily from research and development contracts funded by the United States Government and its contractors. The Company continues to develop standard Photonics products for sale to military and commercial customers. The Photonics Division will require substantial further investment in sales and marketing, in product development and in additional production facilities to support the planned transition to volume sales of Photonics products to military and commercial customers. There can be no assurance that the Company will succeed in these activities and generate significant sales of products based on its Photonics technology.
The sales of our Equipment products are dependent on substantial capital investment by our customers. |
The purchase of Intevacs systems, along with the purchase of other related equipment and facilities, requires extremely large capital expenditures by our customers. These costs are far in excess of the cost of the Intevac systems alone. The magnitude of such capital expenditures requires that our customers have access to large amounts of capital and that they be willing to invest that capital over long periods of time to be able to purchase our equipment. Some of our customers may not be willing, or able, to make the magnitude of capital investment required.
Rapid increases in areal density are reducing the number of thin-film disks required per disk drive. |
Over the past few years the amount of data that can be stored on a single thin-film computer disk has been increasing at approximately 100% per year. Although the number of disk drives produced has continued to increase each year, the growth in areal density has resulted in a reduction in the number of disks required per disk drive. TrendFocus, a market research firm specializing in the disk drive industry, projects that the number of thin-film disks used worldwide declined in 2001 from 2000 levels and are expected to remain at the same level in 2002. Without a significant technological change or an increase in the number of disks required, Intevacs disk equipment sales are largely limited to upgrades of existing systems, rather than capacity expansion or system replacement.
Our competitors are large and well financed and competition is intense. |
Intevac experiences intense competition in the Equipment Division. For example, Intevacs equipment products experience competition worldwide from competitors including Anelva Corporation, Ulvac Japan, Ltd. and Unaxis Holdings, Ltd., each of which have sold substantial numbers of systems worldwide. Anelva, Ulvac and Unaxis all have substantially greater financial, technical, marketing, manufacturing and other resources than Intevac. There can be no assurance that Intevacs competitors will not develop enhancements to, or future generations of, competitive products that will offer superior price or performance features or that new competitors will not enter Intevacs markets and develop such enhanced products.
Given the lengthy sales cycle and the significant investment required to integrate equipment into the manufacturing process, Intevac believes that once a manufacturer has selected a particular suppliers equipment for a specific application, that manufacturer generally relies upon that suppliers equipment and frequently will continue to purchase any additional equipment for that application from the same supplier. Accordingly, competition for customers in the equipment industry is intense, and suppliers of equipment may offer substantial pricing concessions and incentives to attract new customers or retain existing customers.
9
Intevacs business is dependent on its intellectual property. |
There can be no assurance that:
| any of Intevacs pending or future patent applications will be allowed or that any of the allowed applications will be issued as patents, or | |
| any patent owned by Intevac will not be invalidated, deemed unenforceable, circumvented or challenged, or | |
| the rights granted under our patents will provide competitive advantages to Intevac, or | |
| any of Intevacs pending or future patent applications will be issued with claims of the scope sought by Intevac, if at all, or | |
| others will not develop similar products, duplicate Intevacs products or design around the patents owned by Intevac, or | |
| patent rights, intellectual property laws or Intevacs agreements will adequately protect Intevacs intellectual property rights. |
Failure to adequately protect Intevacs intellectual property rights could have an adverse effect upon Intevacs business.
From time to time Intevac has received claims that it is infringing third parties intellectual property rights. There can be no assurance that third parties will not in the future claim infringement by Intevac with respect to current or future patents, trademarks, or other proprietary rights relating to Intevacs disk sputtering systems, flat panel manufacturing equipment or other products. Any present or future claims, with or without merit, could be time-consuming, result in costly litigation, cause product shipment delays or require Intevac to enter into royalty or licensing agreements. Such royalty or licensing agreements, if required, may not be available on terms acceptable to Intevac, or at all. Any of the foregoing could have an adverse effect upon Intevacs business.
Our operating results fluctuate significantly. |
Over the last eight quarters Intevacs operating loss as a percentage of net revenues has fluctuated between approximately (59%) and (1%) of net revenues. Over the same period sales per quarter have fluctuated between $23.6 million and $5.9 million. Intevac anticipates that its sales and operating margins will continue to fluctuate. As a result, period-to-period comparisons of its results of operations are not necessarily meaningful and should not be relied upon as indications of future performance.
Operating costs in northern California are high. |
Intevacs operations are located in Santa Clara, California. The cost of living in northern California is extremely high, which increases both the cost of doing business and the cost and difficulty of recruiting new employees. Intevacs operating results depend in significant part upon its ability to effectively manage costs and to retain and attract qualified management, engineering, marketing, manufacturing, customer support, sales and administrative personnel. The failure to control costs and to attract and retain qualified personnel could have an adverse effect on Intevacs business.
Business interruptions could adversely affect our business. |
Intevacs operations are vulnerable to interruption by fire, earthquake, power loss, telecommunications failure and other events beyond our control. Additionally, the costs of electricity and natural gas have increased significantly. Any further cost increases will impact the Companys ability to achieve profitability.
10
A majority of our sales are to international customers. |
Sales and operating activities outside of the United States are subject to inherent risks, including fluctuations in the value of the United States dollar relative to foreign currencies, tariffs, quotas, taxes and other market barriers, political and economic instability, restrictions on the export or import of technology, potentially limited intellectual property protection, difficulties in staffing and managing international operations and potentially adverse tax consequences. Intevac earns a significant portion of its revenue from international sales, and there can be no assurance that any of these factors will not have an adverse effect on Intevacs business.
Intevac generally quotes and sells its products in US dollars. However, in some cases, Intevac has quoted and sold its products in Japanese Yen. In those cases Intevac may enter into foreign currency contracts in an effort to reduce the overall risk of currency fluctuations to Intevacs business. However, there can be no assurance that the offer and sale of products denominated in foreign currencies, and the related foreign currency hedging activities will not adversely affect Intevacs business.
Intevacs two principal competitors for disk sputtering equipment are based in foreign countries and have cost structures based on foreign currencies. Accordingly, currency fluctuations could cause Intevacs products to be more, or less, competitive than its competitors products. Currency fluctuations will decrease, or increase, Intevacs cost structure relative to those of its competitors, which could impact Intevacs competitive position.
Intevacs stock price is volatile. |
Intevacs stock price has experienced both significant increases in valuation, and significant decreases in valuation, over short periods of time. Intevac believes that factors such as announcements of developments related to Intevacs business, fluctuations in Intevacs operating results, failure to meet securities analysts expectations, general conditions in the disk drive and thin-film media manufacturing industries and the worldwide economy, announcements of technological innovations, new systems or product enhancements by Intevac or its competitors, fluctuations in the level of cooperative development funding, acquisitions, changes in governmental regulations, developments in patents or other intellectual property rights and changes in Intevacs relationships with customers and suppliers could cause the price of Intevacs Common Stock to continue to fluctuate substantially. In addition, in recent years the stock market in general, and the market for small capitalization and high technology stocks in particular, has experienced extreme price fluctuations which have often been unrelated to the operating performance of affected companies. Any of these factors could adversely affect the market price of Intevacs Common Stock.
Intevac routinely evaluates acquisition candidates and other diversification strategies. |
Intevac has completed multiple acquisitions as part of its efforts to expand and diversify its business. For example, Intevacs business was initially acquired from Varian Associates in 1991. Additionally, Intevac acquired its current gravity lubrication, CSS test equipment and rapid thermal processing product lines in three acquisitions. Intevac also acquired its RPC electron beam processing business in late 1997, and subsequently closed this business. Intevac intends to continue to evaluate new acquisition candidates and diversification strategies. Any acquisition will involve numerous risks, including difficulties in the assimilation of the acquired companys employees, operations and products, uncertainties associated with operating in new markets and working with new customers, and the potential loss of the acquired companys key employees. Additionally, unanticipated expenses, difficulties and consequences may be incurred relating to the integration of technologies, research and development, and administrative functions. Any future acquisitions may result in potentially dilutive issuance of equity securities, acquisition related write-offs and the assumption of debt and contingent liabilities. Any of the above factors could adversely affect Intevacs business.
Intevac uses hazardous materials. |
Intevac is subject to a variety of governmental regulations relating to the use, storage, discharge, handling, emission, generation, manufacture, treatment and disposal of toxic or otherwise hazardous substances, chemicals, materials or waste. Any failure to comply with current or future regulations could result
11
A majority of the Common Stock outstanding is controlled by the directors and executive officers of Intevac. |
Based on the shares outstanding on December 31, 2001, the current directors and their affiliates and executive officers, in the aggregate, beneficially own a majority of the outstanding shares of Common Stock. These shareholders, acting together, are able to effectively control all matters requiring approval by the shareholders of Intevac, including the election of a majority of the directors and approval of significant corporate transactions. The Companys directors also hold 7% of the outstanding Convertible Notes.
Item 2. Properties
Intevac leases its 119,583 square foot facility in Santa Clara, California. The lease for this building expires in March 2007. Intevac has an option to extend the lease for an additional five-year period, with a monthly base rent to be negotiated by Intevac and the lessor. If Intevac and the lessor are unable to reach agreement with respect to such monthly base rent, an appraisal process set forth in the lease will determine the monthly base rent for the extension. Intevac also leases a facility of approximately 2,400 square feet in Singapore to house the Singapore customer support organization. This lease expires in December 2002. Intevac believes that its current facilities are suitable and adequate for its current and foreseeable operations. Intevac operates with one full manufacturing shift and one partial manufacturing shift. Intevac believes that it currently has sufficient productive capacity to meet its current needs.
Item 3. Legal Proceedings
On June 12, 1996 two Australian Army Black Hawk Helicopters collided in midair during nighttime maneuvers. Eighteen Australian servicemen perished and twelve were injured. The Company was named as a defendant in a lawsuit related to this crash. The lawsuit was filed in Stamford, Connecticut Superior Court on June 10, 1999 by Mark Durkin, the administrator of the estates of the deceased crewmembers, the injured crewmembers and the spouses of the deceased and/or injured crewmembers. Included in the suits allegations are assertions that the crash was caused by defective night vision goggles. The suit names three US manufacturers of military night vision goggles, of which Intevac was one. The suit also names the manufacturer of the pilots helmets, two manufacturers of night vision system test equipment and the manufacturer of the helicopter. The suit claims damages for 13 personnel killed in the crash, 5 personnel injured in the crash and spouses of those killed or injured. It is known that the Australian Army established a Board of Inquiry to investigate the accident and that the Board of Inquiry concluded that the accident was not caused by defective night vision goggles.
On July 27, 2000 the Connecticut Superior Court disallowed the defendants motion to dismiss the lawsuit. That decision was appealed to the Connecticut Supreme Court. On October 30, 2001 the Connecticut Supreme Court reversed the Superior Courts decision and remanded the case to the trial court with the direction to grant the defendants motions to dismiss the suit subject to conditions already agreed to by the defendants. These conditions agreed to by the defendants include (1) consenting to jurisdiction in Australia; (2) accepting service of process in connection with an action in Australia; (3) making their personnel and records available for litigation in Australia; (4) waiving any applicable statutes of limitation in Australia up to six months from the date of dismissal of this action or for such other reasonable time as may be required as a condition of dismissing this action; (5) satisfying any judgement that may be entered against them in Australia; and (6) consenting to the reopening of the action in Connecticut in the event the above conditions are not met as to any proper defendant in the action. At this time, the plaintiffs have not chosen to
12
On June 12, 2001 the Company filed a complaint in Santa Clara County Superior Court, State of California, against Intarsia Corporation. The complaint related to Intarsias cancellation of an order for a customized sputtering system and sought damages of at least $3.3 million. On July 26, 2001 Intarsia filed a cross-complaint against the Company in the Santa Clara County Superior Court. On August 14, 2001, the Company filed a demurrer to the cross-complaint, and on October 11, 2001, Intarsia filed an amended cross-complaint. The amended cross-complaint included allegations of fraud, negligent misrepresentation, breach of contract and breach of covenant of good faith and fair dealing, and sought damages in the amount of $349,000 plus additional relief as may have been deemed appropriate by the court. On February 1, 2002 the Company and Intarsia executed a stipulation for settlement which resolved the matter. The terms of the stipulation will not result in any material effect on the Companys financial results.
Item 4. Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security-Holders
No matters were submitted to a vote of security-holders during the fourth quarter of the fiscal year covered by this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND DIRECTORS
Certain information about Intevacs
directors and executive officers is listed below:
Mr. Pond
is a
founder of Intevac and has served as Chairman of the Board since
February 1991. Mr. Pond served as President and Chief
Executive Officer from February 1991 until July 2000 and again
from September 2001 through January 2002. Before joining
Intevac, from 1988 to 1990, Mr. Pond served as President
and Chief Operating Officer of Varian Associates, Inc., a
publicly held manufacturer of semiconductor, communication,
defense and medical products where he was responsible for
overall management of Varians operations. From 1984 to
1988, Mr. Pond was President of Varians Electron
Device and Systems Group and became a Director of Varian in
1986. Mr. Pond holds a BS in physics from the University of
Missouri at Rolla and a MS in physics from the University of
California at Los Angeles.
Mr. Fairbairn
joined Intevac as President and Chief
Executive Officer in January 2002 and was appointed a Director
of the Company in February 2002. Before joining Intevac, from
July 1985 to January 2002, Mr. Fairbairn was employed by
Applied Materials, most recently as Vice-President and General
Manager of the Conductor Etch Organization with responsibility
for the Silicon and Metal Etch Divisions. From 1996 to 1999,
Mr. Fairbairn was General Manager of Applieds Plasma
Enhanced Chemical Vapor Deposition
13
Mr. Aebi
has
served as President of the Photonics Division since July 2000.
Mr. Aebi served as General Manager of the Photonics
Division since May 1995 and was elected as a Vice President of
the Company in September 1995. From 1988 through 1994,
Mr. Aebi was the Engineering Manager of the Companys
night vision business, where he was responsible for new product
development in the areas of advanced photocathodes and image
intensifiers. Mr. Aebi holds a BS in physics and an MS in
electrical engineering from Stanford University.
Mr. Eddy
has
served as Vice President, Finance and Administration, Chief
Financial Officer, Treasurer and Secretary of Intevac since
April 1991. Mr. Eddy served as Chief Financial Officer of
Videonics, Inc., a manufacturer of consumer video editing
equipment, from 1987 to 1991 and served as Chief Financial
Officer of Parallel Computers, Inc., a startup computer company,
from 1983 to 1987. Mr. Eddy was with Intel Corporation from
1974 to 1983 where he served in a variety of positions,
including controller and plant manager. Mr. Eddy holds a BS
in engineering science from the University of Virginia and a MBA
from Dartmouth College.
Mr. Durbin
has
served as a Director of Intevac since February 1991.
Mr. Durbin joined Kaiser Aerospace and Electronics
Corporation, a privately held manufacturer of electronic and
electro-optical systems, in 1975 and served as Vice Chairman
with responsibility for marketing and business development until
January 2001. Mr. Durbin holds a BS in electrical
engineering from The Cooper Union and a MS in electrical
engineering from the Polytechnic Institute of Brooklyn.
Mr. Farinsky
has served as a Director of Intevac
since May 2001. Mr. Farinsky has been an investor and
consultant since he retired as a corporate financial executive
in 1991. From 1987 to 1991 he was Executive Vice President and
Chief Financial Officer of Ashton-Tate Corporation. Prior to
joining Ashton-Tate, he held executive management positions at
the Bank of British Columbia, Dysan Corporation, Kaiser
Resources, Ltd, Kaiser Industries Corporation, Mattel, Inc. and
Teledyne, Inc. Mr. Farinsky holds a BS in business
administration from the University of San Francisco and is a
Certified Public Accountant licensed in California, but is not
engaged in public practice. Mr. Farinsky is also a director
of Broadcom Corporation.
Dr. Hempstead
has served as a Director of Intevac
since March 1997 and served as Chief Operating Officer of
Intevac from April 1996 through June 1999. Before joining
Intevac, Dr. Hempstead served as Executive Vice President
of Censtor Corp., a manufacturer of computer disk drive heads
and disks, from November 1994 to February 1996. He was a
self-employed consultant from 1989 to November 1994.
Dr. Hempstead is currently Chief Technology Officer at
Veeco Instruments. Dr. Hempstead holds a BS and MS in
electrical engineering from Massachusetts Institute of
Technology and a Ph.D. in physics from the University of
Illinois.
Dr. Lambeth
has
served as a Director of Intevac since May 1996. Dr. Lambeth
has been Professor of both Electrical and Computer Engineering
and Material Science Engineering at Carnegie Mellon University
since 1989. Dr. Lambeth was Associate Director of the Data
Storage Systems at Carnegie Mellon University from 1989 to 1999.
Since 1988, Dr. Lambeth has been the owner of Lambeth
Systems, an engineering consulting and research firm. From 1973
to 1988, Dr. Lambeth worked at Eastman Kodak Companys
Research Laboratories, most recently as the head of the Magnetic
Materials Laboratory. Dr. Lambeth holds a BS in electrical
engineering from the University of Missouri and a Ph.D. in
physics from the Massachusetts Institute of Technology.
Dr. Smead
has
served as a Director of Intevac since February 1991.
Dr. Smead joined Kaiser Aerospace and Electronics
Corporation (Kaiser) in 1974 and served as
Kaisers President from 1974 until October 1997.
Dr. Smead served as President and Chairman of the Board of
Directors of K Systems, Inc., Kaisers parent company, from
1977 until October 1997. Dr. Smead served as Chairman of
the Board of Directors of Kaiser until December 1999.
Dr. Smead resigned as a director of Kaiser and its
subsidiaries in December 2000. Dr. Smead holds a BS in
electrical engineering from the University of Colorado, a MS in
electrical engineering from the University of Washington and a
Ph.D. in electrical engineering from Purdue University.
14
PART II
Item 5.
Market
for Registrants Common Equity and Related Shareholder
Matters
Intevacs Common Stock commenced trading on
the Nasdaq National Market on November 21, 1995 and is
traded under the symbol IVAC. As of
December 31, 2001, there were approximately 2,000 holders
of record of the Common Stock. The following table sets forth
for the periods indicated the high and low closing sale prices
for the Common Stock as reported on the Nasdaq National Market.
Dividend Policy
Intevac currently anticipates that it will retain
its earnings, if any, for use in the operation of its business
and does not expect to pay cash dividends on its capital stock
in the foreseeable future.
15
Item 6.
Selected
Consolidated Financial Data
The following selected financial data of Intevac
is qualified by reference to and should be read in conjunction
with the consolidated financial statements of Intevac, including
the notes thereto, and Managements Discussion and Analysis
of Financial Condition and Results of Operations, each appearing
elsewhere in this report.
16
Item 7.
Managements
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations
The following discussion and analysis contains
forward-looking statements which involve risks and
uncertainties. Words such as believes,
expects, anticipates and the like
indicate forward-looking statements. Intevacs actual
results may differ materially from the results discussed in the
forward-looking statements for a variety of reasons, including
those set forth under Certain Factors Which May Affect
Future Operating Results and should be read in conjunction
with the Consolidated Financial Statements and related Notes
contained elsewhere in this Annual Report on
Form 10-K.
Critical Accounting Policies and
Estimates
Managements discussion and analysis of our
financial condition and results of operations are based upon our
consolidated financial statements, which have been prepared in
accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the
United States of America (US GAAP). We review
the accounting policies we use in reporting our financial
results on a regular basis. The preparation of these financial
statements requires us to make estimates and judgments that
affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and
expenses and related disclosure of contingent assets and
liabilities. On an ongoing basis, we evaluate our estimates,
including those related to revenue recognition, accounts
receivable, inventories, income taxes, warranty obligations,
long-lived assets, contingencies and litigation. We base our
estimates on historical experience and on various other
assumptions that are believed to be reasonable under the
circumstances, the results of which form the basis for making
judgments about the carrying value of assets and liabilities.
Results may differ from these estimates due to actual outcomes
being different from those on which we based our assumptions.
These estimates and judgments are reviewed by management on an
ongoing basis. The Audit Committee and our auditors review
significant estimates and judgements at the end of each quarter
prior to the public release of our financial results.
Our significant accounting policies are described
in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements included
in Item 8 of this Form 10-K. We believe the following
critical accounting policies affect the more significant
judgments and estimates made in the preparation of our
consolidated financial statements.
Revenue Recognition
Intevac recognizes revenue using the
guidance from SEC Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 101
Revenue Recognition in Financial Statements.
Intevacs revenue recognition policy requires that there be
persuasive evidence of a sales contract, that the price is
fixed, that title has transferred, that product payment is not
contingent on any factors and is reasonably assured, and that
the Company has completed all the material tasks and
deliverables required by the contract.
Revenues for systems are recognized upon customer
acceptance. For large deposition and RTP systems shipped through
a distributor, revenue is typically recognized after the
distributor has accepted the system at Intevacs factory
and the system has been shipped. For large deposition and RTP
systems sold direct to end customers, revenue is recognized
after installation and acceptance of the system at the customer
site. When the Company believes that there may be higher than
normal end user installation and acceptance issues for systems
shipped through a distributor, such as when the first unit of a
newly designed system is delivered, then the Company defers
revenue recognition until the distributors customer has
also accepted the system. Revenues for technology upgrades,
spare parts, consumable and prototype products built by the
Photonics Division are generally recognized upon shipment.
Service and maintenance contract revenue, which to date has been
insignificant, is recognized ratably over applicable contract
periods or as the service is performed.
The Company performs best efforts research and
development work under various research contracts. Revenue on
these contracts is recognized in accordance with contract terms,
typically as costs are incurred. Typically, for each contract,
the Company commits to perform certain research and development
efforts up to an agreed upon amount. In connection with these
contracts, the Company receives funding on an incremental basis
up to a ceiling. Some of these contracts are cost sharing in
nature, where Intevac is reimbursed for a portion of the total
costs expended. In addition, the Company has, from time to time,
negotiated with a third party to fund a portion of the
Companys costs in return for a joint interest to the
Companys rights at the end of the contract. In the event a
particular contract over-runs its agreed upon amount, the
Company may be liable for the additional costs.
17
Inventories
Intevac makes provisions for potentially excess and obsolete
inventory based on backlog and forecasted demand. However, order
backlog is subject to revisions, cancellations, and
rescheduling. Actual demand will inevitably differ from
forecasted demand due to a number of factors. For example, the
thin-film disk industry has suffered from over capacity and poor
financial results, which has led to industry consolidation.
Consolidation can lead to the availability of used equipment
that competes at very low prices with the Companys
products. Financial stress and consolidation in the
Companys customer base can also lead to the cancellation
of orders for products after the Company has incurred
substantial costs related to those orders. Such problems have
resulted, and may continue to result, in excess and obsolete
inventory, and the provision of related reserves.
Warranty
The Companys standard warranty is twelve months from
customer acceptance. During this warranty period any necessary
non-consumable parts are supplied and installed. A provision for
the estimated warranty cost is recorded at the time revenue is
recognized.
Valuation of long-lived and intangible assets
and goodwill
We assess the
impairment of identifiable intangibles, long-lived assets and
goodwill whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate
that the carrying value may not be recoverable. Factors we
consider important which could trigger an impairment review
include the following:
When we determine that the carrying value of
long-lived assets, intangibles or goodwill may not be
recoverable based upon the existence of one or more of the above
indicators of impairment, we measure any impairment based on a
projected discounted cash flow method using a discount rate
determined by our management to be commensurate with the risk
inherent in our current business model.
Results of Operations
Net revenues.
Net
revenues consist primarily of sales of equipment used to
manufacture flat panel displays, equipment used to manufacture
thin-film disks, related equipment and system components, and
contract research and development related to the development of
electro-optical devices and systems. Net revenues totaled
$51.5 million, $36.0 million and $43.0 million in
2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively.
Equipment revenues totaled $42.7 million,
$28.8 million and $36.0 million in 2001, 2000 and
1999, respectively. Equipment revenues increased in 2001 due to
an increase in sales of flat panel manufacturing systems,
partially offset by a decrease in sales of disk manufacturing
systems, disk system upgrades and components. Equipment revenues
decreased in 2000 from 1999 primarily due to a decrease in sales
of disk manufacturing systems, and to a lesser extent flat panel
manufacturing systems, partially offset by increased sales of
disk system upgrades and components. Intevac believes that the
market for FPD deposition equipment has significant growth
potential. The Company delivered five of its D-STAR deposition
systems during 2001 and at the end of 2001 had backlog for
upgrades to the five systems and one new D-STAR. Nonetheless,
the Company will need to broaden its customer base and secure
additional D-STAR orders during the first half of 2002 to be
able increase D-STAR sales in 2002. Additionally, the market for
the Companys disk manufacturing equipment continues to
face over-capacity and is undergoing consolidation. Future
growth in this market will depend on the overall health of the
industry, the availability of used equipment and technical
obsolescence of the installed base of systems.
Photonics revenues totaled $8.8 million,
$7.2 million and $7.0 million in 2001, 2000 and 1999,
respectively. Photonics revenues increased in 2001 over 2000 as
the result of increased revenues from contract
18
Intevacs backlog of orders at
December 31, 2001 was $30.6 million as compared to a
December 31, 2000 backlog of $42.1 million. The
reduction in backlog was primarily due to a reduction in the
number of FPD deposition systems on order. Most of
Intevacs backlog at December 31, 2001 is scheduled
for either customer acceptance or delivery during the first half
of 2002. The Company needs to book substantial orders with
delivery scheduled in the second half of 2002 to cause 2002
sales to meet or exceed 2001 sales.
Significant portions of the Companys
revenues in any particular period have been attributable to
sales to a limited number of customers. In 2001, Equipment sales
through Matsubo, the Companys Japanese distributor,
accounted for 49% of net revenues. In 2000, MMC Technology,
Seagate, Westt and Matsubo each accounted for more than 10% of
Intevacs consolidated revenues and in aggregate accounted
for 56% of net revenues. In 1999, Matsubo, Seagate and Lockheed
Martin each accounted for more than 10% of Intevacs
consolidated revenues and in aggregate accounted for 66% of net
revenues. The Companys largest customers tend to change
from period to period as a function of each customers
plans to renovate or to expand production capacity.
International sales totaled $37.3 million,
$9.6 million and $25.7 million in 2001, 2000 and 1999,
respectively. International sales accounted for 73%, 27% and 60%
of net revenues in 2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively. The
increase in international sales in 2001 over 2000 was primarily
due to an increase in net revenues from flat panel manufacturing
systems. The decrease in international sales from 1999 to 2000
was primarily due to a decrease in net revenues from disk
manufacturing equipment. Substantially all of Intevacs
international sales are to customers in the Far East.
Gross margin.
Cost
of net revenues consists primarily of purchased materials,
fabrication, assembly, test and installation labor and overhead,
warranty costs, royalties, provisions for inventory reserves,
scrap and costs attributable to contract research and
development. Gross margin was 19%, 6% and 6% in 2001, 2000 and
1999, respectively.
Gross margin in the Equipment Division was 23%,
12% and 7% in 2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively. Equipment gross
margin improved in 2001, but was tempered by high initial costs
to manufacture Intevacs redesigned flat panel
manufacturing systems and establishment of $2.4 million of
inventory reserves related to a cancelled order for a custom
flat panel system. 2001 Equipment gross margin excluding the
effect of the inventory reserve would have been 29%. Equipment
gross margin in 2000 was negatively impacted by establishment of
$5.1 million of reserves related to slow moving equipment
inventory and a $0.8 million write-off of goodwill related to
electronically swept source technology, which was acquired in
1996 and subsequently abandoned. 2000 Equipment gross margin
excluding the effect of these two items would have been 32%.
Gross margin in 1999 was adversely impacted by the
under-absorption of manufacturing overhead due to low
manufacturing volume, the sale of four used disk sputtering
systems at heavily discounted prices, high initial costs of two
new systems, write-down of RPC inventory related to the plan to
discontinue RPC operations, payment of $0.5 million as part
of the settlement of a patent claim and establishment of a
$0.4 million cost to market reserve on a used MDP-250B disk
sputtering system remaining in inventory.
Gross margin in the Photonics Division was (2%),
(8%) and 7% in 2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively. Photonics
gross margins in 2001 and 2000 have been negatively impacted by
a significant portion of revenue being derived from cost-sharing
research and development contracts versus fully funded research
and development contracts in years prior to 2000. The Company
expects that Photonics gross margins will fluctuate based on the
relative mix of sales derived from prototype products, from
fully funded research and development contracts and from
cost-shared research and development contracts.
19
Research and development.
Research and development expense
consists primarily of prototype materials, salaries and related
costs of employees engaged in ongoing research, design and
development activities for flat panel manufacturing equipment,
disk manufacturing equipment and research by the Photonics
Division. Company funded research and development expense
totaled $14.5 million, $10.6 million and
$14.1 million in 2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively. The
increase from 2000 to 2001 was primarily the result of increased
expenses related to the development and redesign of flat panel
manufacturing equipment and, to a lesser extent, the development
of Photonics products. The decrease from 1999 to 2000 was
primarily the result of lower expenses related to the
development of disk manufacturing equipment.
Research and development expenses do not include
costs of $8.0 million, $6.0 million and
$5.9 million in 2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively, related
to Photonics contract research and development which are
included in cost of goods sold. Research and development
expenses also do not include costs of $0.5 million,
$0.7 million and $1.1 million incurred by Intevac in
2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively, and reimbursed under the
terms of research and development cost sharing agreements
related to development of disk and flat panel manufacturing
equipment.
Selling, general and administrative.
Selling, general and administrative
expense consists primarily of selling, marketing, customer
support, financial, travel, management, legal and professional
services and bad debt expense. Domestic sales are made by the
Companys direct sales force, whereas international sales
are made by distributors and representatives that provide
services such as sales, installation, warranty and customer
support. The Company also has a subsidiary in Singapore to
support customers in Southeast Asia. Through the second quarter
of 2000, Intevac marketed its flat panel manufacturing equipment
to the Far East through its Japanese joint venture, IMAT. During
the third quarter of 2000 the Company and its joint venture
partner, Matsubo, transferred IMATs activities and
employees to Matsubo, which became a distributor of the
Companys flat panel products, and shut down the operations
of IMAT.
Selling, general and administrative expense
totaled $6.7 million, $4.4 million and
$7.2 million in 2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively,
representing 13%, 12% and 17% of net revenue. The increase from
2000 to 2001 was primarily due to a $1.5 million credit to
bad debt expense recognized in 2000. The primary reasons for the
decrease from 1999 to 2000 were the $1.5 million credit to
bad debt expense and a $1.2 million reduction in expense
from 1999 related to elimination of the electron beam processing
equipment product line.
Restructuring and other expense (gain).
Restructuring and other expense (gain)
was ($0.6) million and $3.1 million in 2000 and 1999,
respectively.
During the fourth quarter of 1999, the Company
adopted a plan to discontinue operations at its RPC
Technologies, Inc. electron beam processing equipment subsidiary
and to close RPCs facility in Hayward, California and
incurred a charge of $1.6 million in 1999 related to this
plan. The employment of 26 employees was terminated as a
result. In the first quarter of 2000, Intevac sold certain
assets of the RPC Technologies, Inc. subsidiary to Quemex
Technology. Proceeds from the sale included a cash payment,
assumption of the Hayward facility lease and the assumption of
certain other liabilities. Excluded from the sale were two
previously leased systems and three completed systems remaining
in inventory. The Company was able to reverse the portions of
the restructuring reserve established to provide for future
rents due on the facility and for the closure of the facility.
However, since Intevac retained ownership of the two leased
systems, the Company established an equivalent reserve to
provide for any residual value at the end of the leases.
During the third quarter of 1999, the Company
adopted an expense reduction plan that included closing one of
the buildings at its Santa Clara facility and a reduction in
force of 7 employees. The Company incurred a charge of
$2.2 million in 1999 related to the expense reduction plan.
In the fourth quarter of 1999, $0.1 million of the
restructuring reserve was reversed due to lower than expected
costs on the closure of the facility. During the first quarter
of 2000, the Company vacated the building and negotiated a lease
termination for that space with its landlord, which released the
Company from the obligation to pay any rent after April 30,
2000. As a result, the Company reversed $0.6 million of the
restructuring reserve during the first quarter of 2000. During
the third quarter of 2000, the Company completed all activities
related to closing the vacated portion of the building and
reversed the remaining $23,000 of the restructuring reserve.
20
During the first quarter of 1999, the Company
implemented a reduction in force of 27 employees and
incurred a charge of $0.1 million related to severance
costs for the affected employees.
Interest expense.
Interest expense consists primarily of
interest on the Convertible Notes issued in the first quarter of
1997, and, to a lesser extent, interest on approximately
$2.0 million of long-term debt related to the purchase of
Cathode Technology in 1996. Interest expense totaled
$2.9 million, $3.0 million and $3.7 million in
2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively. The decline in interest
expense was primarily the result of the repurchase by Intevac of
$3.7 million and $16.3 million of the Convertible
Notes during 2001 and 1999, respectively, and, to a lesser
extent, the repayment of the Cathode Technology debt in January
2001.
Interest income and other, net.
Interest income and other, net totaled
$1.1 million, $3.1 million and $3.6 million in
2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively. Interest income and other,
net in 2001 consisted of $1.2 million of interest income on
investments, $0.4 million of dividends on Intevacs
interest in 601 California Avenue LLC, a $0.8 million loss
on the disposition of Pacific Gas and Electric commercial paper
and $0.3 million of early payment discounts and other
income. Interest income and other, net in 2000 consisted of
$2.3 million of interest income on investments,
$0.4 million of dividends on Intevacs interest in 601
California Avenue LLC, $0.2 million of gains on foreign
currency forward contracts and $0.2 million of early
payment discounts and other income. Interest income and other,
net in 1999 consisted of $2.1 million of interest income on
Intevacs investments, $1.1 million of dividends on
Intevacs interest in 601 California Avenue LLC, and
$0.5 million of gains on foreign currency forward contracts.
6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes Due
2004.
In 2001, Intevac repurchased
$3.7 million of its Convertible Notes and recognized a gain
of $0.8 million, net of applicable taxes. In 1999, Intevac
repurchased $16.3 million of its Convertible Notes from
which it recognized a gain of $3.8 million, net of
applicable taxes.
Provision for (benefit from) income taxes.
In 2001, the Company recorded
$5.0 million of income tax expense to provide additional
valuation allowance against deferred tax assets. The
Companys net deferred tax assets totaled zero at
December 31, 2001 net of a $16.9 million valuation
allowance.
Intevacs estimated effective tax rate for
2000 was 0%. The Company did not accrue a tax benefit during
2000 due to the inability to realize additional refunds from
loss carry-backs. The Companys net deferred tax assets
totaled $7.7 million at December 31, 2000, net of a
$3.6 million valuation allowance established due to the
uncertainty of realizing certain tax credits and loss
carry-forwards.
For the year ended December 31, 1999,
Intevac recorded an $8.3 million tax benefit provision,
computed at a 38% annual tax rate, on a pretax loss from
continuing operations of $22.0 million. Intevacs 1999
effective tax rate differed from the applicable statutory rates
primarily due to benefits from tax-exempt interest income, which
were partially offset by nondeductible goodwill amortization.
Liquidity and Capital Resources
Operating activities in 2001 used cash of
$11.7 million, primarily due to the net loss incurred,
which was partially offset by depreciation, amortization and an
increase in the valuation allowance against deferred tax assets.
Investing activities in 2001 provided cash of $28.9 million
as a result of the net sale of investments, which was partially
offset by the purchase of property and equipment. Financing
activities in 2001 used cash of $3.7 million due to the
repurchase of a portion of the Convertible Notes and the
repayment of the Cathode Technology debt, partially offset by
the sale of Intevacs stock to employees under its stock
option and employee stock purchase plans.
At December 31, 2001, Intevac had
$18.2 million of cash and cash equivalents. Intevac intends
to undertake approximately $4.0 million in capital
expenditures during the next 12 months and believes the
existing cash and cash equivalent balances will be sufficient to
meet its cash requirements for the next twelve months.
Intevac has incurred operating losses each year
since 1998 and the Company cannot predict with certainty when it
will return to profitability. We anticipate generating positive
cash flow during the 2002 fiscal year, but that is dependent on
continued growth in the business and our continued ability to
obtain advances
21
Item 7A.
Quantitative
and Qualitative Disclosure About Market Risk
Interest rate risk.
The table below presents principal
amounts and related weighted-average interest rates by year of
maturity for the Companys debt obligations.
Foreign exchange risk.
From time to time, the Company enters
into foreign currency forward exchange contracts to hedge
anticipated foreign currency transaction, translation and
re-measurement exposures. The objective of these contracts is to
minimize the impact of foreign currency exchange rate movements
on the Companys operating results. At December 31,
2001, the Company did not have any foreign currency forward
exchange contracts.
22
Item 8.
Financial
Statements and Supplementary Data
INTEVAC, INC.
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
CONTENTS
23
REPORT OF GRANT THORNTON LLP, INDEPENDENT
AUDITORS
The Board of Directors and Shareholders
We have audited the accompanying consolidated
balance sheets of Intevac, Inc. as of December 31, 2001 and
2000 and the related consolidated statements of operations and
comprehensive loss, shareholders equity and cash flows for
each of the two years in the period ended December 31,
2001. Our audits also included the 2000 and 2001 data in the
financial statement schedule listed in the Index at
Item 14(a). These financial statements and schedule are the
responsibility of the Companys management. Our
responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial
statements and schedule based on our audits.
We conducted our audits in accordance with
auditing standards generally accepted in the United States of
America. Those standards require that we plan and perform the
audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial
statements are free of material misstatements. An audit includes
examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and
disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant
estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall
financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits
provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
In our opinion, the consolidated financial
statements referred to above present fairly, in all material
respects, the consolidated financial position of Intevac, Inc.
at December 31, 2001 and 2000, and the consolidated results
of its operations and its cash flows for each of the two years
in the period ended December 31, 2001, in conformity with
accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of
America. Also, in our opinion, the 2000 and 2001 data in the
related financial statement schedule, when considered in
relation to the basic financial statements taken as a whole,
presents fairly in all material respects the information set
forth therein.
San Jose, California
24
REPORT OF ERNST & YOUNG LLP, INDEPENDENT
AUDITORS
The Board of Directors and Shareholders
We have audited the accompanying consolidated
statements of operations and comprehensive loss,
shareholders equity and cash flows for the year ended
December 31, 1999. Our audit also included the 1999 data in
the financial statement schedule listed in the Index at
Item 14(a). These financial statements and schedule are the
responsibility of the Companys management. Our
responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial
statements and schedule based on our audit.
We conducted our audit in accordance with
auditing standards generally accepted in the United States.
Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to
obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial
statements are free of material misstatements. An audit includes
examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and
disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes
assessing the accounting principles used and significant
estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall
financial statement presentation. We believe that our audit
provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
In our opinion, the consolidated financial
statements referred to above present fairly, in all material
respects, the consolidated results of operations of Intevac,
Inc. and its cash flows for the year ended December 31,
1999, in conformity with accounting principles generally
accepted in the United States. Also, in our opinion, the 1999
data in the related financial statement schedule, when
considered in relation to the basic financial statements taken
as a whole, presents fairly in all material respects the
information set forth therein.
San Jose, California
25
INTEVAC, INC.
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
See accompanying notes.
26
INTEVAC, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS AND
COMPREHENSIVE LOSS
See accompanying notes.
27
INTEVAC, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF SHAREHOLDERS
EQUITY
See accompanying notes.
28
INTEVAC, INC.
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH
FLOWS
See accompanying notes.
29
INTEVAC, INC.
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS
1. Business and
Nature of Operations
Intevac, Inc.s businesses are the design,
manufacture and sale of complex capital equipment used to
manufacture products such as flat panel displays and thin-film
disks (Equipment) and the development of highly
sensitive electro-optical devices and systems
(Photonics).
Systems sold by the Equipment Division are
typically used to deposit highly engineered thin-films of
material on a substrate, or to modify the characteristics and
properties of thin-films already deposited on a substrate.
Systems manufactured by the Equipment Division generally utilize
proprietary manufacturing techniques and processes and operate
under high levels of vacuum. The systems are designed for
high-volume continuous operation and use precision robotics,
computerized controls and complex software programs to fully
automate and control the production process. Products
manufactured with these systems include color cell phone
displays, automotive displays, computer monitors and disks for
computer hard disk drives. The Equipment Division has also
designed ultra high vacuum automated equipment for Photonics to
be used for the future manufacture of low-cost low-light-level
cameras.
The Photonics Division is developing
electro-optical devices and systems that permit highly sensitive
detection of photons in the visible and short wave infrared
portions of the spectrum. This development work is aimed at
creating new products for both military and industrial
applications. Products include LIVAR systems for positive target
identification at long range, low-cost low-light-level cameras
for use in security and military applications and photodiodes
for use in high-speed fiber optic systems.
During the fourth quarter of 1999, the Company
adopted a plan to discontinue its electron beam processing
equipment product line and to close the facility in Hayward,
California where that equipment was built.
2. Summary of
Significant Accounting Policies
The consolidated financial statements include the
accounts of Intevac and its wholly owned subsidiaries. All
inter-company transactions and balances have been eliminated.
Intevac recognizes revenue using the guidance
from SEC Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 101 Revenue
Recognition in Financial Statements. Intevacs
revenue recognition policy requires that there be persuasive
evidence of a sales contract, that the price is fixed, that
title has transferred, that product payment is not contingent on
any factors and is reasonably assured, and that the Company has
completed all the material tasks and deliverables required by
the contract.
Systems and
components
Revenues for
systems are recognized upon customer acceptance. For large
deposition and RTP systems shipped through a distributor,
revenue is typically recognized after the distributor has
accepted the system at Intevacs factory and the system has
been shipped. For large deposition and RTP systems sold direct
to end customers, revenue is recognized after installation and
acceptance of the system at the customer site. When the Company
believes that there may be higher than normal end user
installation and acceptance issues for systems shipped through a
distributor, such as when the first unit of a newly designed
system is delivered, then the Company defers revenue recognition
until the distributors customer has also accepted the
system. Revenues for technology upgrades, spare parts,
consumable and prototype products built by the Photonics
Division are generally recognized upon shipment.
Service and
Maintenance
Service and
maintenance contract revenue, which to date has been
insignificant, is recognized ratably over applicable contract
periods or as services are performed.
30
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
Technology
Development
The Company
performs best efforts research and development work under
various research contracts. Revenue on these contracts is
recognized in accordance with contract terms, typically as costs
are incurred. Typically, for each contract, the Company commits
to perform certain research and development efforts up to an
agreed upon amount. In connection with these contracts, the
Company receives funding on an incremental basis up to a
ceiling. Upon completion of each contract, each party will
typically receive certain rights to the technical and computer
software data developed under the contract. Some of these
contracts are cost sharing in nature, where Intevac is
reimbursed for a portion of the total costs expended. In
addition, the Company has, from time to time, negotiated with a
third party to fund a portion of the Companys costs in
return for a joint interest to the Companys rights at the
end of the contract. In the event a particular contract
over-runs its agreed upon amount, the Company may be liable for
the additional costs.
Net revenues and related cost of net revenues
associated with these contracts were $7,885,000 and $9,782,000,
respectively for 2001, $5,975,000 and $7,090,000, respectively
for 2000, and $7,067,000 and $7,071,000, respectively for 1999.
The Companys standard warranty is twelve
months from customer acceptance. During this warranty period any
necessary non-consumable parts are supplied and installed. A
provision for the estimated warranty cost is recorded upon
customer acceptance for systems and upon shipment for non-system
products.
The Company makes payments to agents and
representatives under agreements related to international sales
in return for obtaining orders and providing installation and
warranty services. These payments to agents and representatives
are included in selling, general and administrative expenses.
These amounts totaled approximately $141,000, $0 and $0 for the
years ended December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively.
Customer advances generally represent
nonrefundable deposits invoiced by the Company in connection
with receiving customer purchase orders and other events
preceding acceptance of systems. Customer advances related to
products that have not been shipped to customers, and included
in accounts receivable were $857,000 and $2,719,000 at
December 31, 2001 and 2000, respectively.
The Company considers all highly liquid
investments with a maturity of three months or less when
purchased to be cash equivalents.
Short-term investments consist principally of
highly rated debt instruments with maturities generally between
one and twelve months and are carried at fair value. These
investments are typically short-term in nature and therefore
bear minimal risk.
Management determines the appropriate
classification of debt securities at the time of purchase and
reevaluates such designation as of each balance sheet date. At
December 31, 2000, all debt securities were classified as
available-for-sale under Statement of Financial Accounting
Standards No. 115 Accounting for Certain Investments
in Debt and Equity Securities. Securities classified as
available-for-sale are reported at fair market value with the
related unrealized gains and losses included in retained
earnings. Realized gains and losses and declines in value judged
to be other-than-temporary on available-for-sale securities are
included in other income and expenses. The cost of securities
sold is based on the specific identification method.
31
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
Cash and cash equivalents represent cash accounts
and money market funds. Short-term investments of $33,787,000 at
December 31, 2000 consisted primarily of investments in
commercial paper and market auction rate bonds. Fair values are
based on quoted market prices. The amount of unrealized gain or
loss was not significant at December 31, 2000 and 1999.
Gross realized gains and losses for the years ended
December 31, 2000 and 1999 were not significant.
We assess the impairment of identifiable
intangibles, long-lived assets and goodwill whenever events or
changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value may
not be recoverable. Factors we consider important which could
trigger an impairment review include the following:
When we determine that the carrying value of
long-lived assets, intangibles or goodwill may not be
recoverable based upon the existence of one or more of the above
indicators of impairment, we measure any impairment based on a
projected discounted cash flow method using a discount rate
determined by our management to be commensurate with the risk
inherent in our current business model. In 2000, the Company
determined that the intangible assets related to the purchase of
Cathode Technology Corporation (Cathode) and Lotus
Technologies, Inc. had become impaired. At December 31,
2000 the remaining goodwill related to those purchases,
amounting to $1,056,000, was written off.
The Company may enter into foreign currency
forward exchange contracts to hedge certain of its foreign
currency transaction, translation and re-measurement exposures.
The Companys accounting policies for some of these
instruments are based on the Companys designation of such
instruments as hedging transactions. Instruments not designated
as a hedge transaction will be marked to market at
the end of each accounting period. The criteria the Company uses
for designating an instrument as a hedge include effectiveness
in exposure reduction and one-to-one matching of the derivative
financial instrument to the underlying transaction being hedged.
Gains and losses on foreign currency forward exchange contracts
that are designated and effective as hedges of existing
transactions are recognized in income in the same period as
losses and gains on the underlying transactions are recognized
and generally offset.
During fiscal 2000 and 1999, the Company entered
into yen denominated foreign currency forward exchange contracts
to hedge anticipated yen denominated sales. The Company did not
designate these foreign currency forward contracts as hedge
transactions; therefore, the contracts were marked to
market. As of December 31, 2001, the Company had no
foreign currency forward exchange contracts outstanding. In
fiscal 2000 the Company realized gains of $111,000 related to
foreign currency forward exchange contracts, and in fiscal 1999
the Company recorded transaction losses of $251,000 related to
foreign currency forward exchange contracts.
While the notional amounts of foreign exchange
contracts are often used to express the volume of these
transactions, the potential accounting loss on these
transactions if all counterparties failed to perform is limited
32
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
to the amounts, if any, by which the
counterparties obligations exceed the Companys
obligation to the counterparties.
The carrying amount of the short-term financial
instruments (cash and cash equivalents, short-term investments,
accounts receivable and certain other liabilities) approximates
fair value due to the short-term maturity of those instruments.
Based on the quoted market prices for the same or similar issues
or on the current rates offered for debt of the same remaining
maturities, the fair value of the $37.5 million of
outstanding Convertible Notes as of December 31, 2001 is
$20.1 million.
Inventories for systems and components are stated
at the lower of standard cost or market. Inventories consist of
the following:
Intevac makes provisions for potentially excess
and obsolete inventory based on backlog and forecasted demand.
However, order backlog is subject to revisions, cancellations,
and rescheduling. Actual demand will inevitably differ from
forecasted demand due to a number of factors. For example, the
thin-film disk industry has suffered from over capacity and poor
financial results, which has led to industry consolidation.
Consolidation can lead to the availability of used equipment
that competes at very low prices with the Companys
products. Financial stress and consolidation in the
Companys customer base can also lead to the cancellation
of orders for products after the Company has incurred
substantial costs related to those orders. Such problems have
resulted, and may continue to result, in excess and obsolete
inventory, and the provision of related reserves. Inventory
reserves included in the above table were $12.7 million at
December 31, 2001 and $8.7 million at
December 31, 2000.
Equipment and leasehold improvements are carried
at cost less allowances for accumulated depreciation and
amortization. Gains and losses on dispositions are reflected in
the consolidated statements of operations.
Depreciation for machinery and equipment is
computed using the straight-line method over the estimated
useful lives of the assets, which are generally three to seven
years. Amortization of leasehold improvements is computed using
the shorter of the remaining terms of the leases or the
estimated economic useful lives of the improvements.
The Company amortizes intangible assets on a
straight-line basis over the estimated useful lives, which range
from two to seven years.
33
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
SFAS No. 130, Reporting Comprehensive
Income requires unrealized gains or losses on the
Companys available-for-sale securities and the foreign
currency translation adjustments, which prior to the adoption
were reported separately in shareholders equity, to be
included in other comprehensive income. As of December 31,
2001, the $122,000 balance of accumulated other comprehensive
income is comprised entirely of accumulated foreign currency
translation adjustments. There was no accumulated other
comprehensive income as of December 31, 2000 or 1999.
The Company accounts for its stock option plans
and its employee stock purchase plan in accordance with
provisions of the Accounting Principles Boards Opinion
No. 25 (APB 25), Accounting For
Stock Issued to Employees. SFAS 123, Accounting
for Stock Based Compensation provides a fair value-based
alternative to APB 25. The Company is continuing to account
for its employee stock plans in accordance with the provisions
of APB 25. Under APB 25, because the exercise prices
of the Companys stock options granted to employees equal
the market prices of the underlying stock on the date of grant,
no compensation expense is recognized.
Certain prior year amounts in the Consolidated
Financial Statements have been reclassified to conform to 2001
presentation.
The following table sets forth the computation of
basic and diluted loss per share:
34
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
The preparation of financial statements in
conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the
United States of America requires management to make estimates
and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and
liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities
at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts
of revenue and expenses during the reporting period. Actual
results inevitably will differ from those estimates, and such
differences may be material to the financial statements.
In June 2001, the Financial Accounting Standards
Board (FASB) issued Statement of Financial
Accounting Standards (SFAS) No. 141,
Business Combinations. Under SFAS 141, all
business combinations are to be accounted for using the purchase
method. SFAS 141 is effective for all business combinations
initiated after June 30, 2001.
In August 2001, the FASB issued SFAS
No. 144, Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of
Long-Lived Assets. SFAS 144 requires that one
accounting model be used for long-lived assets to be disposed of
by sale, whether previously held and used or newly acquired.
SFAS 144 is effective for financial statements issued for
fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2001, and interim
periods within those fiscal years. The Company believes that the
adoption of SFAS 144 will not have a material effect on its
consolidated financial statements.
3. Concentrations
Financial instruments that potentially subject
the Company to significant concentrations of credit risk consist
of cash equivalents, short-term investments, accounts receivable
and foreign exchange forward contracts. The Company generally
invests its excess cash in money market funds and in commercial
paper, which have contracted maturities generally within one
year. By policy, the Companys investments in commercial
paper, certificates of deposit, Eurodollar time deposits, or
bankers acceptances are rated A1/P1 or better. In 2001,
the Company recorded a loss of $803,000 on its investment in
commercial paper issued by Pacific Gas & Electric.
The Companys largest customers tend to
change from period to period as a function of each
customers plans to renovate, or expand production
capacity. Historically, a significant portion of the
Companys revenues in any particular period have been
attributable to sales to a limited number of customers. In 2001,
one customer accounted for 49% of the Companys
consolidated net revenues. In 2000, four customers accounted for
17%, 16%, 12% and 11%, respectively, of the Companys
consolidated revenues and in aggregate accounted for 56% of net
revenues. In 1999 three customers accounted for 34%, 21% and
11%, respectively, of the Companys consolidated revenues
and in aggregate accounted for 66% of net revenues. The Company
35
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
performs credit evaluations of its
customers financial conditions and requires deposits on
system orders but does not generally require collateral or other
security to support customer receivables.
Flat panel and disk manufacturing equipment
together contributed a significant portion of the Companys
revenues in 2001, while disk manufacturing equipment alone
contributed a significant portion of the Companys revenues
in 2000 and 1999. The Company expects that its ability to
maintain or expand its current levels of revenues and to return
to profitability in the future will depend upon its success in
enhancing its existing systems and developing and manufacturing
competitive flat panel and disk manufacturing equipment and its
success in developing other products such as photonics devices
and systems.
4. Equity
Investments
In 1995, the Company entered into a Limited
Liability Company Operating Agreement (the Operating
Agreement), which expires December 31, 2015, with
601 California Avenue LLC (the LLC), a
California limited liability company formed and owned by the
Company and certain shareholders of the Company at that time.
Under the Operating Agreement, the Company transferred its
leasehold interest in the site of the Companys
discontinued night vision business (the Site) in
exchange for a preferred share in the LLC with a face value of
$3,900,000. The Company is accounting for the investment under
the cost method and has recorded its investment in the LLC at
$2,431,000, which represents the Companys historical
carrying value of the leasehold interest in the Site. The
preferred share in the LLC pays a 10% annual cumulative
preferred dividend.
During 1996, the LLC formed a joint venture with
Stanford University (the Stanford JV) to develop the
property. The project was completed and leased in August 1998.
The Company received dividends of $390,000, $390,000 and
$1,077,000 from the LLC in 2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively.
The dividends received during 1999 consisted of the annual
$390,000 dividend plus the cumulative dividends earned in prior
years. As of December 31, 2001 all outstanding cumulative
dividends on the preferred share had been paid. These dividends
are included in other income and expense.
On June 27, 1997, the Company entered into
an agreement with Matsubo to form a joint venture responsible
for the sales and service of Intevacs flat panel display
equipment in Japan and other Asian countries. The Company
invested $436,000 for 49% of the voting stock of the joint
venture. The joint venture was accounted for by the equity
method. Gains and losses related to the Companys share of
the joint venture were reflected in other income and expense,
net on the consolidated statements of income. The Companys
equity in the net income or (loss) of IMAT, Inc. was
($125,000) and $15,000 in 2000 and 1999, respectively. During
the third quarter of 2000, the Company and its joint venture
partner, Matsubo, transferred IMATs activities and
employees to Matsubo and terminated the operations of IMAT.
5. Commitments
The Company leases certain facilities under
non-cancelable operating leases that expire at various times up
to 2007. The facility leases require the Company to pay for all
normal maintenance costs. The lease for the primary facility in
Santa Clara includes an option to extend the lease for an
additional five-year period.
36
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
Future minimum rental payments under these leases
at December 31, 2001 are as follows (in thousands):
Gross rental expense was approximately
$2,993,000, $1,596,000 and $2,652,000 for the years ended
December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999, respectively. Offsetting
rental expense for the periods ending December 31, 2000 and
1999 was sublease income of $62,000 and $238,000, respectively.
6. Employee
Benefit Plan
In 1991, the Company established a defined
contribution retirement plan with 401(k) plan features. The plan
covers all United States employees eighteen years and older.
Employees may make contributions by a percentage reduction in
their salaries, not to exceed the statutorily prescribed annual
limit. The Company made cash contributions of $301,000, $123,000
and $170,000 for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2000
and 1999, respectively. Employees may choose among eleven
investment options for their contributions and their share of
the Company contributions, and they are able to move funds
between investment options at any time. Administrative expenses
relating to the plan are insignificant.
7. Notes
Payable
In 1996, the Company issued notes related to the
purchase of Cathode. The notes bore interest at 5.58% compounded
monthly and payable quarterly. Principal payments on the note
were made quarterly based on unit sales of the Cathode sputter
sources. The remaining balance on the notes was paid in full in
January 2001.
8. Convertible
Notes
During the first quarter of 1997, the Company
completed an offering of $57.5 million of its 6 1/2%
Convertible Subordinated Notes (the Convertible
Notes), which mature March 1, 2004. Interest is
payable each March 1st and September 1st. The notes are
convertible into shares of the Companys common stock at
$20.625 per share. Expenses associated with the offering of
approximately $2.3 million were deferred. Such expenses are
being amortized to interest expense over the term of the notes.
During 2001, the Company repurchased $3,700,000,
face value, of its Convertible Notes. The repurchase resulted in
a gain of $803,000 (net of income taxes). During 1999, the
Company repurchased $16,255,000, face value, of its Convertible
Notes. The repurchase resulted in a gain of $3,844,000 (net of
income taxes).
9. Segment
Reporting
Intevac, Inc. has two reportable operating
segments: Equipment and Photonics. The Companys Equipment
Division sells complex capital equipment used in the
manufacturing of flat panel displays and thin-film disks. The
Companys Photonics Division is developing devices and
systems utilizing electron sources that permit highly sensitive
detection of photons in the visible and the short-wave infrared
spectrum.
37
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
Included in corporate activities are general
corporate expenses, the equity in net loss of equity investee
(see Note 4), amortization expenses related to certain
intangible assets and the reversal in 2000 of a portion of a
restructuring reserve established in September 1999, less an
allocation of corporate expenses to operating units equal to 1%
of net revenues. Assets of corporate activities include
unallocated cash and short-term investments, deferred income tax
assets (which were written off in 2001) and certain intangibles
and other assets.
The Company evaluates performance and allocates
resources based on profit or loss from operations before
interest, other income and expense and income taxes. The
accounting policies of the reportable segments are the same as
those described in the summary of significant accounting
policies.
38
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
10. Shareholders
Equity
The Companys Articles of Incorporation
authorize 10,000,000 shares of Preferred Stock. The Board of
Directors has the authority to issue the Preferred Stock in one
or more series and to fix the price, rights, preferences,
privileges and restrictions thereof, including dividend rights,
dividend rates, conversion rights, voting rights, terms of
redemption, redemption prices, liquidation preferences and the
number of shares constituting any series or the designation of
such series, without further vote or action by the shareholders.
The Board of Directors approved the 1991 Stock
Option/ Stock Issuance Plan (the 1991 Plan) in 1991.
The maximum number of shares that may be issued over the term of
the 1991 Plan is 2,666,667 shares.
The 1991 Plan is divided into two separate
components: the Option Grant Program and the Stock Issuance
Program. Under the Option Grant Program, the Company may grant
either incentive stock options or nonqualified options or
implement stock appreciation rights provisions at the discretion
of the Board of Directors. Exercisability, option price, and
other terms are determined by the Board of Directors, but the
option price shall not be less than 85% and 100% of the fair
market value for nonqualified options and incentive stock
options, respectively, as determined by the Board of Directors.
Options granted under the 1991 Plan are immediately exercisable;
however, unexercised options and shares purchased upon the
exercise of the options are subject to vesting over a five-year
period. The Company may repurchase shares that are not vested.
No shares were subject to repurchase at December 31, 2001,
2000 and 1999.
39
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
In 1995, the Board of Directors approved adoption
of (i) the 1995 Stock Option/ Stock Issuance Plan (the
1995 Plan) under which employees, non-employee
directors and consultants may be granted stock options to
purchase stock or issued shares of stock at not less than 85% of
fair market value on the grant/ issuance date; and (ii) the
Employee Stock Purchase Plan. The 1995 Plan, as amended in 2000,
serves as the successor equity incentive program to the
Companys 1991 Plan. Upon adoption of the 1995 Plan, all
shares available for issuance under the 1991 Plan were
transferred to the 1995 Plan. As of December 31, 2001,
2,079,251 shares of common stock are authorized for future
issuance under the 1995 Plan. Options granted under the 1995
Plan are exercisable upon vesting and generally vest over a
five-year period. Options currently expire no later than ten
years from the date of grant.
Options to purchase 1,062,742, 878,157 and
692,457 shares were vested at December 31, 2001, 2000 and
1999, respectively.
Pro forma information regarding net income and
earnings per share is required by SFAS 123, which also requires
that the information be determined as if the Company has
accounted for its employee stock options granted subsequent to
December 31, 1994 under the fair value method of this
Statement. The fair value for these options was estimated at the
date of grant using a Black-Scholes multiple option pricing
model with the following weighted average assumptions for 2001,
2000 and 1999, respectively: risk-free interest rates of 3.03%,
5.17% and 6.15%; dividend yields of 0.0%, 0.0% and 0.0%;
volatility factors of the expected market price of the
Companys common stock of 0.946, 0.936 and 0.855; and a
weighted-average expected life of the option of 0.25, 0.25 and
0.25 years beyond each respective vesting period.
The Black-Scholes option valuation model was
developed for use in estimating the fair value of traded options
which have no vesting restrictions and are fully transferable.
In addition, option models require the input of highly
subjective assumptions including the expected stock price
volatility. Because the Companys employee stock options
have characteristics significantly different from those of
traded options, and because changes in the subjective
assumptions can materially affect the fair value estimate, in
managements opinion, the existing models do not
necessarily provide a reliable single measure of the fair value
of its employee stock options.
Under the 1995 Employee Stock Purchase Plan, as
amended in 1999, (the ESPP), the Company is
authorized to issue up to 1,000,000 shares of common stock to
participating employees. Under the terms of the ESPP, employees
can choose to have up to 10% of their annual base earnings
withheld to purchase the Companys common stock. The
purchase price of the stock is 85% of the lower of the
subscription date fair market value or the purchase date fair
market value. Approximately 70% of eligible employees have
participated in the ESPP. Under the ESPP, the Company sold
118,904, 108,784 and 122,325 shares to employees in 2001, 2000
and 1999, respectively. As of December 31, 2001, 293,696
shares remained reserved for issuance under the ESPP. The
Company does not recognize compensation cost related to employee
purchase rights under the Plan. To comply with the pro forma
reporting requirements of SFAS 123, compensation cost is
estimated for the fair value of the employees purchase
rights using the Black-Scholes model with the following
assumptions for those rights granted in 2001, 2000 and 1999,
respectively: risk-free interest rates of 1.93%, 5.36% and
5.78%; dividend yield of 0.0%, 0.0% and 0.0%; expected
volatility of 0.946, 0.936 and 0.855; and an expected life of
2.00, 2.00 and 1.99 years (the offering period ends
July 31, 2003 for the subscription period that began in
August 2001). The weighted average fair value of those purchase
rights granted in 2001, 2000 and 1999 were $2.47, $2.78 and
$2.94, respectively per share.
Had compensation cost for the Companys
stock-based compensation plans been determined based on the fair
value at the grant dates for awards under those plans consistent
with the method of SFAS 123, the
40
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
Companys net loss and earnings per share
would have been reduced to the pro forma amounts indicated below:
A summary of the Companys stock option
activity and related information for the years ended
December 31 follows:
Outstanding and Exercisable by Price Range as
of December 31, 2001
41
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
11. Income
Taxes
The provision for (benefit from) income taxes on
income from continuing operations consists of the following (in
thousands):
The tax benefits associated with exercises of
nonqualified stock options and disqualifying dispositions of
stock acquired through the incentive stock option and employee
stock purchase plans reduced taxes currently payable for 2001,
2000 and 1999 as shown above by $0, $29,000 and $22,000,
respectively. Such benefits were credited to additional paid-in
capital when realized.
Deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effects
of temporary differences between losses reported and the
carrying amounts of assets and liabilities for financial
reporting purposes and the amounts used for income tax purposes.
Significant components of the Companys deferred tax assets
computed in accordance with SFAS 109 are as follows (in
thousands):
42
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
The valuation allowance increased by $10,551,000
and $3,605,000 during 2001 and 2000, respectively, due to the
uncertainty of realizing certain tax credit and loss
carry-forwards, and other deferred tax assets. The Federal and
State NOL carry-forwards of $17,831,000 and $7,607,000 expire at
various dates through 2021 and 2011, respectively, if not
previously utilized. The AMT credit carry-forwards do not expire.
A reconciliation of the income tax provision on
income from continuing operations at the federal statutory rate
of 35% to the income tax provision at the effective tax rate is
as follows (in thousands):
12. Research and
Development Cost Sharing Agreements
The Company entered into an agreement with a
Japanese company to perform best efforts joint research and
development work. The nature of the project is to develop a
glass-coating machine to be used in the production of flat panel
displays. The Company was funded for one-half of the actual
costs of the project up to a ceiling of $9,450,000. At
December 31, 1999, the Company had received the entire
amount under the contract. Qualifying costs of approximately
$3,108,000 and $1,467,000 for the years ended December 31,
2000 and 1999, respectively, were incurred on this project,
resulting in offsets against research and development costs of
approximately $583,000 and $736,000 in 2000 and 1999,
respectively. As of December 31, 2000, the entire advance
had been applied to qualifying costs.
Upon completion of the research and development
work, if successful, each party will receive certain
manufacturing and marketing rights for separate regions of the
world. The agreement also calls for certain royalty payments by
each party to the other party, based on production and sales.
The royalty rate will be 5% for each party.
13. Restructuring
and Other
During the fourth quarter of 1999, the Company
adopted a plan to discontinue operations at its RPC
Technologies, Inc. electron beam processing equipment subsidiary
and to close RPCs facility in Hayward, California and
incurred a charge of $1,639,000 in 1999 related to this plan.
The employment of 26 employees was terminated. The
significant components of this charge included $679,000 for
inventory write-downs which were charged to cost of sales,
$264,000 for fixed asset write-offs, $200,000 for closure of the
facility, $163,000 for employee severance costs, $161,000 for
future rent due on the facility and $152,000 for write-off of
intangibles. In the first quarter of 2000, Intevac sold certain
assets of the RPC Technologies, Inc. subsidiary to Quemex
Technology. Proceeds from the sale included a cash payment,
assumption of the Hayward facility lease and the assumption of
certain other liabilities. Excluded from the sale were two
previously leased systems and three completed systems remaining
in inventory. The Company was able to reverse the portions of
the restructuring reserve established to provide for future
rents due on the facility and for the closure of the facility.
However, since Intevac retained ownership of the two leased
systems, the Company established an equivalent reserve to
provide for any residual value at the end of the leases. Of the
three systems in inventory,
43
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
two were included in 2000 revenues and one is
included in 2001 revenues. One of the two leased systems was
sold to the lessee in 2001.
During the third quarter of 1999, the Company
adopted an expense reduction plan that included closing one of
the buildings at its Santa Clara facility and a reduction in
force of 7 employees. The Company incurred a charge of
$2,225,000 in 1999 related to the expense reduction plan. The
significant components of this charge included $873,000 for
future rent due on the building (net of expected sublease
income), $160,000 for costs associated with operating the
building through May 2000 and $1,192,000 for the write-off of
leasehold improvements and other costs associated with
restructuring. In the fourth quarter of 1999, $97,000 of the
restructuring reserve was reversed due to lower than expected
costs on the closure of the facility. During the first quarter
of 2000, the Company vacated the building and negotiated a lease
termination for that space with its landlord, which released the
Company from the obligation to pay any rent after April 30,
2000. As a result, the Company reversed $615,000 of the
restructuring reserve during the first quarter of 2000. During
the third quarter of 2000, the Company completed all activities
related to closing the building. As a result, the Company
reversed the remaining $23,000 of the restructuring reserve
during the third quarter of 2000.
During the first quarter of 1999, the Company
implemented a reduction in force of 17 employees. The reductions
took place at the Companys facilities in Santa Clara,
California. The Company incurred a charge of $115,000 in 1999
related to severance costs for the affected employees. As of
December 31, 1999, all of the severance had been paid.
The following table displays the activity in the
building closure restructuring reserve, established in the third
quarter of 1999, and in the RPC operation discontinuance
restructuring reserve, established in the fourth quarter of
1999, through December 31, 2000.
44
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
14. Other Accrued
Liabilities
15. Quarterly
Consolidated Results of Operations (Unaudited)
45
The information required by this item is included
under the caption Ratification of Independent Public
Auditors in the Companys Proxy Statement for the
2002 Annual Meeting of Shareholders and is incorporated herein
by reference.
PART III
Item 10.
Directors
and Officers of the Registrant
The information required by this item relating to
the Companys directors and nominees and disclosure
relating to compliance with Section 16(a) of the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934 is included under the captions
Election of Directors and Compliance with
Section 16(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934
in the Companys Proxy Statement for the 2002 Annual
Meeting of Shareholders and is incorporated herein by reference.
The information required by this item relating to the
Companys executive officers and key employees is included
under the caption Executive Officers and Directors
under Item 4 in Part I of this Annual Report on
Form 10-K.
Item 11.
Executive
Compensation
The information required by this item is included
under the caption Executive Compensation and Related
Information in the Companys Proxy Statement for the
2002 Annual Meeting of Shareholders and is incorporated herein
by reference.
Item 12.
Security
Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and
Management
The information required by this item is included
under the caption Ownership of Securities in the
Companys Proxy Statement for the 2002 Annual Meeting of
Shareholders and is incorporated herein by reference.
Item 13.
Certain
Relationships and Related Transactions
The information required by this item is included
under the caption Certain Transactions in the
Companys Proxy Statement for the 2002 Annual Meeting of
Shareholders and is incorporated herein by reference.
Item 14.
Exhibits,
Financial Statement Schedules, and Reports on
Form 8-K
(a)
List of Documents filed as part of
this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
46
(b)
Reports on Form 8-K
No reports on Form 8-K were filed during the
last quarter of the fiscal year covered by this Annual Report on
Form 10-K.
47
SIGNATURES
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13
or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant
has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the
undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, on March 18, 2002.
POWER OF ATTORNEY
KNOW ALL PERSONS BY THESE PRESENTS, that each
person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints
Kevin Fairbairn and Charles B. Eddy III, and each of them, as
his true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full
power of substitution and resubstitution, for him and in his
name, place and stead, in any and all capacities, to sign any
and all amendments (including post-effective amendments) to this
Report on Form 10-K, and to file the same, with all
exhibits thereto, and other documents in connection therewith,
with the Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto said
attorneys-in-fact and agents, and each of them, full power and
authority to do and perform each and every act and thing
requisite and necessary to be done in connection therewith, as
fully to all intents and purposes as he might or could do in
person, hereby ratifying and confirming all that said
attorneys-in-fact and agents, or any of them, or their or his
substitute or substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done
by virtue hereof.
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the
following persons on behalf of the Registrant and in the
capacities and on the dates indicated.
48
SCHEDULE II VALUATION AND
QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS
INTEVAC, INC.
49
EXHIBIT INDEX
50
EXHIBIT 21.1
SUBSIDIARIES OF THE REGISTRANT
1. Lotus Technologies,
Inc. California
2. Intevac Foreign Sales
Corporation Barbados
3. Intevac Asia Private
Limited Singapore
4. Intevac Malaysia Sdn
Bhd Malaysia
5. IRPC, Inc. California
EXHIBIT 23.1
CONSENT OF GRANT THORNTON LLP, INDEPENDENT
AUDITORS
We consent to the incorporation by reference in
the Registration Statements (Form S-8 Nos. 33-99648,
333-35801, 333-65421, 333-96529 and 333-50166) pertaining to the
1995 Stock Option/ Stock Issuance Plan and the Employee Stock
Purchase Plan and in the Registration Statement (Form S-3
No. 333-24275) of Intevac, Inc. of our report dated
January 25, 2002, with respect to the consolidated
financial statements and schedule of Intevac, Inc. included in
the Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended
December 31, 2001.
EXHIBIT 23.2
CONSENT OF ERNST & YOUNG LLP, INDEPENDENT
AUDITORS
We consent to the incorporation by reference in
the Registration Statements (Form S-8 Nos. 33-99648,
333-35801, 333-65421, 333-96529 and 333-50166) pertaining to the
1995 Stock Option/ Stock Issuance Plan and the Employee Stock
Purchase Plan and in the Registration Statement (Form S-3
No. 333-24275) of Intevac, Inc. of our report dated
January 21, 2000, with respect to the consolidated
financial statements and schedule for the year ended
December 31, 1999 of Intevac, Inc. included in its Annual
Report (Form 10-K) for the year ended December 31,
2001, filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission.
San Jose, California
APPENDIX B
QUARTERLY REPORT ON FORM 10-Q
FORM 10-Q
Commission file number 0-26946
INTEVAC, INC.
3560 Bassett Street
Registrants telephone number, including
area code: (408) 986-9888
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant
(1) has filed all reports required to be filed by
Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934
during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period
that the registrant was required to file such reports), and
(2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the
past
90 days. Yes
x
No
o
APPLICABLE ONLY TO CORPORATE
ISSUERS:
On March 30, 2002, 12,060,003 shares of the
Registrants Common Stock, no par value, were outstanding.
INTEVAC, INC.
INDEX
1
PART I. FINANCIAL
INFORMATION
Item 1. Financial
Statements
INTEVAC, INC.
See accompanying notes.
2
INTEVAC, INC.
See accompanying notes.
3
INTEVAC, INC.
See accompanying notes.
4
INTEVAC, INC.
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS
1. Business
Activities and Basis of Presentation
Intevac, Inc.s businesses are the design,
manufacture and sale of complex capital equipment used to
manufacture products such as flat panel displays and thin-film
disks (Equipment) and the development of highly
sensitive electro-optical devices and systems
(Photonics).
Systems sold by the Equipment Division are
typically used to deposit highly engineered thin-films of
material on a substrate, or to modify the characteristics and
properties of thin-films already deposited on a substrate.
Systems manufactured by the Equipment Division generally utilize
proprietary manufacturing techniques and processes and operate
under high levels of vacuum. The systems are designed for
high-volume continuous operation and use precision robotics,
computerized controls and complex software programs to fully
automate and control the production process. Products
manufactured with these systems include cell phone color
displays, automotive displays, computer monitors and disks for
computer hard disk drives. The Equipment Division has also
designed ultra high vacuum automated equipment for Photonics to
be used for the future manufacture of low-cost low-light-level
cameras.
The Photonics Division is developing
electro-optical devices and systems that permit highly sensitive
detection of photons in the visible and short wave infrared
portions of the spectrum. This development work is aimed at
creating new products for both military and industrial
applications. Products include Laser Illuminated Viewing and
Ranging (LIVAR®) systems for positive target
identification at long range, low-cost low-light-level cameras
for use in security and military applications and photodiodes
for use in high-speed fiber optic systems.
The financial information at March 30, 2002
and for the three-month periods ended March 30, 2002 and
March 31, 2001 is unaudited, but includes all adjustments
(consisting only of normal recurring accruals) that the Company
considers necessary for a fair presentation of the financial
information set forth herein, in accordance with accounting
principles generally accepted in the United States of America
(U.S. GAAP) for interim financial information, the
instructions to Form 10-Q and Article 10 of
Regulation S-X. Accordingly, it does not include all of the
information and footnotes required by U.S. GAAP for annual
financial statements. For further information, refer to the
Consolidated Financial Statements and footnotes thereto included
in the Companys Annual Report on Form 10-K for the
fiscal year ended December 31, 2001.
The preparation of financial statements in
conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates
and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and
liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities
at the date of the financial statements and reported amounts of
revenue and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results
inevitably will differ from those estimates, and such
differences may be material to the financial statements.
The Company evaluates the collectibility of trade
receivables on an ongoing basis and provides reserves against
potential losses when appropriate.
The results for the three-month period ended
March 30, 2002 are not considered indicative of the results
to be expected for any future period or for the entire year.
5
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
2. Inventories
The components of inventory consist of the
following:
Finished goods inventory consists of completed
units at customer sites undergoing installation and acceptance
testing.
3. Net Income
(Loss) Per Share
The following table sets forth the computation of
basic and diluted earnings per share:
6
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
4. Segment
Reporting
Intevac, Inc. has two reportable operating
segments: Equipment and Photonics. The Companys Equipment
Division sells complex capital equipment used in the
manufacturing of flat panel displays and thin-film disks. The
Companys Photonics Division is developing devices and
systems utilizing electron sources that permit highly sensitive
detection of photons in the visible and the short-wave infrared
spectrum.
Included in corporate activities are general
corporate expenses less an allocation of corporate expenses to
operating units equal to 1% of net revenues.
7
NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS (Continued)
5. Income
Taxes
The Company accrued a $2.2 million tax
benefit for the three-month period ended March 30, 2002.
This resulted from recent federal tax law changes that allow
losses incurred in 2001 and 2002 to be carried back
5 years. The Company paid federal income taxes of
approximately $5.1 million for 1996 and $0.9 million
for 1997. The Company believes that at least $2.2 million
of taxes paid are recoverable based on the loss incurred in 2001
and that additional taxes may also be recoverable, but the
amount will not be determined and recorded until the Company
files its 2001 federal income tax return either in the second or
third quarter of 2002. For the three months ended March 31,
2001, the Company did not accrue a tax benefit due to the
inability at that time to realize additional refunds from loss
carry-backs. The Companys $16.5 million deferred tax
asset is fully offset by a $16.5 million valuation
allowance, resulting in a net deferred tax asset of zero at
March 30, 2002.
6. Capital
Transactions
During the three-month period ending
March 30, 2002, Intevac sold stock to its employees under
the Companys Employee Stock Purchase Plan. A total of
56,381 shares were issued for which the Company received
$144,000.
8
Item 2. Managements
Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
Operations
This Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q
contains forward-looking statements which involve risks and
uncertainties. Words such as believes,
expects, anticipates and the like
indicate forward-looking statements. The Companys actual
results may differ materially from those discussed in the
forward-looking statements. Factors that might cause such a
difference include, but are not limited to, the risk factors set
forth elsewhere in this Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q under
Certain Factors Which May Affect Future Operating
Results and in other documents the Company files from time
to time with the Securities and Exchange Commission, including
the Companys Annual Report on Form 10-K filed in
March 2002, Form 10-Qs and
Form 8-Ks.
Critical Accounting Policies and
Estimates
Managements discussion and analysis of our
financial condition and results of operations are based upon our
consolidated financial statements, which have been prepared in
accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the
United States of America (US GAAP). We review the
accounting policies we use in reporting our financial results on
a regular basis. The preparation of these financial statements
requires us to make estimates and judgments that affect the
reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenues and expenses
and related disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities. On
an ongoing basis, we evaluate our estimates, including those
related to revenue recognition, accounts receivable,
inventories, income taxes, warranty obligations, long-lived
assets, contingencies and litigation. We base our estimates on
historical experience and on various other assumptions that are
believed to be reasonable under the circumstances, the results
of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying
value of assets and liabilities. Results may differ from these
estimates due to actual outcomes being different from those on
which we based our assumptions. These estimates and judgments
are reviewed by management on an ongoing basis. The Audit
Committee and our auditors review significant estimates and
judgements prior to the public release of our financial results.
Our significant accounting policies are described
in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements included
in Item 8 of the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K. We believe the following critical accounting
policies affect the more significant judgments and estimates
made in the preparation of our consolidated financial statements.
Revenue Recognition
Intevac recognizes revenue using the guidance from SEC
Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 101 Revenue Recognition
in Financial Statements. Intevacs revenue
recognition policy requires that there be persuasive evidence of
a sales contract, that the price is fixed, that product title
has transferred, that product payment is not contingent on any
factors and is reasonably assured, and that the Company has
completed all the material tasks and deliverables required by
the contract.
Revenues for systems are recognized upon customer
acceptance. For large deposition and RTP systems shipped through
a distributor, revenue is typically recognized after the
distributor has accepted the system at Intevacs factory
and the system has been shipped. For large deposition and RTP
systems sold direct to end customers, revenue is recognized
after installation and acceptance of the system at the customer
site. When the Company believes that there may be higher than
normal end-user installation and acceptance issues for systems
shipped through a distributor, such as when the first unit of a
newly designed system is delivered, then the Company defers
revenue recognition until the distributors customer has
also accepted the system. Revenues for technology upgrades,
spare parts, consumable and prototype products built by the
Photonics Division are generally recognized upon shipment.
Service and maintenance contract revenue, which to date has been
insignificant, is recognized ratably over applicable contract
periods or as the service is performed.
The Company performs best efforts research and
development work under various research contracts. Revenue on
these contracts is recognized in accordance with contract terms,
typically as costs are incurred. Typically, for each contract,
the Company commits to perform certain research and development
efforts up to an agreed upon amount. In connection with these
contracts, the Company receives funding on an incremental basis
up to a ceiling. Some of these contracts are cost sharing in
nature, where Intevac is reimbursed for a portion of the total
costs expended. In addition, the Company has, from time to time,
negotiated with a third party to fund a portion of the
Companys costs in return for a joint interest to the
Companys rights at the end
9
Inventories
Intevac makes provisions for potentially excess and obsolete
inventory based on backlog and forecasted demand. However, order
backlog is subject to revisions, cancellations, and
rescheduling. Actual demand will inevitably differ from
forecasted demand due to a number of factors. For example, the
thin-film disk industry has suffered from over-capacity and poor
financial results, which has led to industry consolidation.
Consolidation can lead to the availability of used equipment
that competes at very low prices with the Companys
products. Financial stress and consolidation in the
Companys customer base can also lead to the cancellation
of orders for products after the Company has incurred
substantial costs related to those orders. Such problems have
resulted, and may continue to result, in excess and obsolete
inventory, and the provision of related reserves.
Warranty
The Companys standard warranty is twelve months from
customer acceptance. During this warranty period any necessary
non-consumable parts are supplied and installed. A provision for
the estimated warranty cost is recorded at the time revenue is
recognized.
Results of Operations
Three Months Ended March 30,
2002 and March 31, 2001
Net revenues.
Net
revenues consist primarily of sales of equipment used to
manufacture flat panel displays, equipment used to manufacture
thin-film disks, related equipment and system components, and
contract research and development related to the development of
electro-optical devices and systems. Net revenues decreased by
33% to $6.7 million for the three months ended
March 30, 2002 from $10.0 million for the three months
ended March 31, 2001. Net revenues from Equipment decreased
to $4.9 million for the three months ended March 30,
2002 from $7.9 million for the three months ended
March 31, 2001. The decrease in Equipment revenue was the
result of decreased shipments of flat panel manufacturing
equipment and of disk equipment spare parts. Equipment revenues
included the sale of a MDP 200 modular add-on system that was
integrated with a previously delivered MDP 250 disk
manufacturing system. Net revenues from Photonics decreased to
$1.7 million for the three months ended March 30, 2002
from $2.1 million for the three months ended March 31,
2001. The decrease in Photonics net revenues was the result of
lower research and development contract revenues in the
three-month period ended March 30, 2002, partially offset
by revenue from the sale of two Model 120 LIVAR Cameras.
International sales decreased by 65% to
$2.4 million for the three months ended March 30, 2002
from $6.9 million for the three months ended March 31,
2001. The decrease in international sales was due to a reduction
in net revenues from disk manufacturing equipment and from flat
panel manufacturing equipment. International sales constituted
37% of net revenues for the three months ended March 30,
2002 and 69% of net revenues for the three months ended
March 31, 2001.
Backlog.
The
Companys backlog of orders for its products was
$27.3 million at March 30, 2002 and $46.0 million
at March 31, 2001. The reduction was primarily due to a
lower backlog of flat panel deposition systems, five of which
were taken to revenue in the fourth quarter of 2001. The Company
includes in backlog the value of purchase orders for its
products that have scheduled delivery dates.
Gross margin.
Cost
of net revenues consists primarily of purchased materials,
fabrication, assembly, test and installation labor and overhead,
customer-specific engineering costs, warranty costs, royalties,
provisions for inventory reserves, scrap and costs attributable
to contract research and development. Gross margin decreased to
14.4% for the three months ended March 30, 2002 from 34.0%
for the three months ended March 31, 2001.
Equipment gross margins decreased to 15.5% for
the three-month period ended March 30, 2002 from 45.0% for
the three-month period ended March 31, 2001. Equipment
margins decreased primarily due to a reduction in shipments of
technology upgrades and high initial costs to complete
Intevacs first MDP 200 system. Photonics gross
margins increased to 11.3% during the three months ended
March 30, 2002 from (8.1%) during the three months ended
March 31, 2001. Photonics gross margins in the first
quarter of 2002
10
Research and development.
Research and development expense
consists primarily of prototype materials, salaries and related
costs of employees engaged in ongoing research, design and
development activities for flat panel manufacturing equipment,
disk manufacturing equipment, and research by the Photonics
Division. Company funded research and development expense
decreased to $3.1 million for the three months ended
March 30, 2002 from $3.5 million for the three months
ended March 31, 2001, representing 46.9% and 34.9%,
respectively, of net revenue. This decrease was primarily the
result of reduced spending for development of flat panel
manufacturing equipment, partially offset by increased spending
for photonics.
Research and development expenses do not include
costs of $1.3 million and $2.1 million, respectively,
for the three-month periods ended March 30, 2002 and
March 31, 2001 related to contract research and development
performed by the Companys Photonics business. These
expenses are included in cost of net revenues.
Research and development expenses also do not
include costs of $0.1 million in each of the three-month
periods ended March 30, 2002 and March 31, 2001,
reimbursed under the terms of various research and development
cost sharing agreements.
Selling, general and administrative.
Selling, general and administrative
expense consists primarily of selling, marketing, customer
support, production of customer samples, financial, travel,
management, legal and professional services and bad debt
expense. Domestic sales are made by the Companys direct
sales force, whereas international sales are made by
distributors and representatives that provide services such as
sales, installation, warranty and customer support. The Company
also has a subsidiary in Singapore to support customers in
Southeast Asia.
Selling, general and administrative expense was
$1.7 million for the both the three-month periods ended
March 30, 2002 and March 31, 2001, representing 25.6%
and 16.7%, respectively, of net revenue.
Interest expense.
Interest expense consists primarily of
interest on the Companys convertible notes. Interest
expense was $0.7 million in both of the three-month periods
ended March 30, 2002 and March 31, 2001.
Interest income and other, net.
Interest income and other, net totaled
$0.2 million and ($1.3) million for the three months ended
March 30, 2002 and March 31, 2001, respectively.
Interest income and other, net in 2002 consisted of
$0.2 million of interest and dividend income on
investments. Interest income and other, net in 2001 consisted of
$0.7 million of interest and dividend income on investments
offset by the establishment of a reserve related to the
Companys $2.0 million investment in commercial paper
issued by Pacific Gas and Electric Company, which had filed for
reorganization under Chapter 11 of the US Bankruptcy Code
in early 2001.
Provision for (benefit from) income taxes.
The Company accrued a
$2.2 million tax benefit for the three-month period ended
March 30, 2002. This resulted from recent federal tax law
changes that allow losses incurred in 2001 and 2002 to be
carried back 5 years. The Company paid federal income taxes
of approximately $5.1 million for 1996 and
$0.9 million for 1997. The Company believes that at least
$2.2 million of taxes paid are recoverable based on the
loss incurred in 2001 and that additional taxes may also be
recoverable, but the amount will not be determined and recorded
until the Company files its 2001 federal income tax return
either in the second or third quarter of 2002. For the three
months ended March 31, 2001, the Company did not accrue a
tax benefit due to the inability at that time to realize
additional refunds from loss carry-backs.
Liquidity and Capital Resources
The Companys operating activities used cash
of $3.7 million during the three months ended
March 30, 2002. The cash used was due primarily to the net
loss incurred and increases in receivables and inventory, which
were partially offset by increased customer advances and
depreciation and amortization. In the three
11
The Companys investing activities used cash
of $0.2 million for the three months ended March 30,
2002 as a result of the purchase of fixed assets. In the three
months ended March 31, 2001, the Companys investing
activities provided cash of $26.2 million as a result of
the net sale of investments. During the three months ended
March 31, 2001, the Company converted the majority of its
short-term investments into cash or cash equivalents.
The Companys financing activities provided
cash of $0.1 million and $0.2 million for the
three-month periods ended March 30, 2002 and March 31,
2001, respectively, as the result of the sale of the
Companys stock to its employees through the Companys
employee benefit plans.
Intevac has incurred operating losses each year
since 1998 and the Company cannot predict with certainty when it
will return to profitability. We anticipate generating positive
cash flow during the 2002 fiscal year, but that is dependent on
continued growth in the business and our continued ability to
obtain advances from our customers. Additionally, as of
March 30, 2002 we had $37.5 million of outstanding
Convertible Notes, which mature in March 2004. We do not
currently have the funds available to repay the debt and there
can be no assurance that the Company will be able to restructure
the debt or secure additional equity and/or debt financing to
redeem the Convertible Notes on terms favorable to the Company
and its shareholders, if the Convertible Notes are not converted
by their holders into Intevac common stock prior to their
maturity.
Certain Factors Which May Affect Future
Operating Results
$37.5 Million of
convertible notes are outstanding and will mature in
2004.
In connection with the sale of $57.5 million
of its 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes Due 2004 (the
Convertible Notes) in February 1997, Intevac
incurred a substantial increase in the ratio of long-term debt
to total capitalization (shareholders equity plus
long-term debt). At each noteholders option, the
Convertible Notes may be exchanged, prior to maturity, into
Intevac common shares at a price of $20.625 per share, which is
substantially above current market price. During 2001 and 1999
Intevac spent a total of $11.9 million to repurchase
$20.0 million of the Convertible Notes. The
$37.5 million of the Convertible Notes that remain
outstanding as of March 30, 2002 commit Intevac to
substantial principal and interest obligations that are
significantly in excess of the Companys $14.5 million
cash balance at March 30, 2002. Intevac may, from time to
time, repurchase and retire additional Convertible Notes prior
to their maturity date.
The degree to which Intevac is leveraged could
have an adverse effect on Intevacs ability to obtain
additional financing for working capital, acquisitions or other
purposes, and could make it more vulnerable to industry
downturns and competitive pressures. Intevacs ability to
meet its debt service obligations will be dependent on
Intevacs future performance, which will be subject to
financial, business and other factors affecting the operations
of Intevac, many of which are beyond its control. In the event
that the Companys noteholders do not choose to exchange
their Convertible Notes for Intevac common stock prior to the
Convertible Notes 2004 maturity date, the Company will be
required to repay the Convertible Notes at maturity. If this is
the case, then there can be no assurance that the Company will
have generated sufficient cash from operations to repay the
Convertible Notes without raising additional capital through the
sale of additional debt or equity. Additionally, there can be no
assurance that the Company will be able to secure additional
equity and/or debt financing on terms favorable to the Company
and its shareholders, or at all.
Intevac has invested heavily in the development
of products that address new markets. The Equipment Division has
developed a flexible deposition tool and a rapid thermal
processing tool to address growing segments of the flat panel
display equipment market that are intended to displace products
offered by competing manufacturers. The Photonics
Divisions LIVAR target identification system and low-cost
low-light level camera products are designed to offer
significantly improved capability relative to any products
currently offered in the marketplace. Additionally, the
Photonics Division is entering a new market for the
12
Intevac sells capital equipment to capital
intensive industries, which manufacture and sell commodity
products such as flat panel displays and disk drives. These
industries operate with high fixed costs. When demand for these
commodity products exceeds capacity, then demand for new capital
equipment such as Intevacs tends to be amplified. When
supply of these commodity products exceeds capacity, then demand
for new capital equipment such as Intevacs tends to be
depressed. The cyclical nature of the capital equipment industry
means that in some years sales of new systems by the Company
will be unusually high, and that in other years sales of new
systems by the Company will be severely depressed. Failure to
anticipate or respond quickly to the industry business cycle
could have an adverse effect on Intevacs business.
Intevacs ability to remain competitive
requires substantial investments in research and development.
The failure to develop, manufacture and market new systems, or
to enhance existing systems, will have an adverse effect on
Intevacs business. From time to time in the past, Intevac
has experienced delays in the introduction of, and technical
difficulties with, some of its systems and enhancements.
Intevacs future success in developing and selling
equipment will depend upon a variety of factors, including
accurate prediction of future customer requirements, technology
advances, cost of ownership, introduction of new products on
schedule, cost-effective manufacturing and product performance
in the field. Intevacs new product decisions and
development commitments must anticipate continuously evolving
industry requirements significantly in advance of sales. Any
failure to accurately predict customer requirements and to
develop new generations of products to meet those requirements
would have an adverse effect on Intevacs business.
Our
products are complex, constantly evolving and are often designed
and manufactured to individual customer requirements that
require additional engineering.
Intevacs Equipment Division products have a
large number of components and are highly complex. Intevac may
experience delays and technical and manufacturing difficulties
in future introductions or volume production of new systems or
enhancements. In addition, some of the systems built by Intevac
must be customized to meet individual customer site or operating
requirements. Intevac has limited manufacturing capacity and
engineering resources and may be unable to complete the
development, manufacture and shipment of its products, or to
meet the required technical specifications for its products in a
timely manner. Such delays could lead to rescheduling of orders
in backlog, or in extreme situations, to cancellation of orders.
In addition, Intevac may incur substantial unanticipated costs
early in a products life cycle, such as increased
engineering, manufacturing, installation and support costs which
may not be able to be passed on to the customer. In some
instances, Intevac is dependent upon a sole supplier or a
limited number of suppliers for complex components or
sub-assemblies utilized in its products. Any of these factors
could adversely affect Intevacs business.
To date the activities of the Photonics Division
have concentrated on the development of its technology and
prototype products that demonstrate this technology. Revenues
have been derived primarily from research and development
contracts funded by the United States Government and its
contractors. The Company continues to develop standard Photonics
products for sale to military and commercial customers. The
Photonics Division will require substantial further investment
in sales and marketing, in product development and in additional
production facilities to support the planned transition to
volume sales of Photonics products to military and commercial
customers. There can be no assurance that the Company will
succeed in these activities and generate significant sales of
products based on its Photonics technology.
13
The purchase of Intevacs systems, along
with the purchase of other related equipment and facilities,
requires extremely large capital expenditures by our customers.
These costs are far in excess of the cost of the Intevac systems
alone. The magnitude of such capital expenditures requires that
our customers have access to large amounts of capital and that
they be willing to invest that capital over long periods of time
to be able to purchase our equipment. Some of our customers may
not be willing, or able, to make the magnitude of capital
investment required.
Over the past few years the amount of data that
can be stored on a single thin-film computer disk has been
increasing at approximately 100% per year. Although the number
of disk drives produced has continued to increase each year, the
growth in areal density has resulted in a reduction in the
number of disks required per disk drive. TrendFocus, a market
research firm specializing in the disk drive industry, projects
that the number of thin-film disks used worldwide declined in
2001 from 2000 levels and are expected to remain at the same
level in 2002. Without a significant technological change or an
increase in the number of disks required, Intevacs disk
equipment sales are largely limited to upgrades of existing
systems, rather than capacity expansion or system replacement.
Intevac experiences intense competition in the
Equipment Division. For example, Intevacs equipment
products experience competition worldwide from competitors
including Anelva Corporation, Ulvac Japan, Ltd. and Unaxis
Holdings, Ltd., each of which have sold substantial numbers of
systems worldwide. Anelva, Ulvac and Unaxis all have
substantially greater financial, technical, marketing,
manufacturing and other resources than Intevac. There can be no
assurance that Intevacs competitors will not develop
enhancements to, or future generations of, competitive products
that will offer superior price or performance features or that
new competitors will not enter Intevacs markets and
develop such enhanced products.
Given the lengthy sales cycle and the significant
investment required to integrate equipment into the
manufacturing process, Intevac believes that once a manufacturer
has selected a particular suppliers equipment for a
specific application, that manufacturer generally relies upon
that suppliers equipment and frequently will continue to
purchase any additional equipment for that application from the
same supplier. Accordingly, competition for customers in the
equipment industry is intense, and suppliers of equipment may
offer substantial pricing concessions and incentives to attract
new customers or retain existing customers.
There can be no assurance that:
Failure to adequately protect Intevacs
intellectual property rights could have an adverse effect upon
Intevacs business.
14
From time to time Intevac has received claims
that it is infringing third parties intellectual property
rights. There can be no assurance that third parties will not in
the future claim infringement by Intevac with respect to current
or future patents, trademarks, or other proprietary rights
relating to Intevacs disk sputtering systems, flat panel
manufacturing equipment or other products. Any present or future
claims, with or without merit, could be time-consuming, result
in costly litigation, cause product shipment delays or require
Intevac to enter into royalty or licensing agreements. Such
royalty or licensing agreements, if required, may not be
available on terms acceptable to Intevac, or at all. Any of the
foregoing could have an adverse effect upon Intevacs
business.
Over the last nine quarters Intevacs
operating loss as a percentage of net revenues has fluctuated
between approximately (59%) and (1%) of net revenues. Over the
same period sales per quarter have fluctuated between $23.6
million and $5.9 million. Intevac anticipates that its
sales and operating margins will continue to fluctuate. As a
result, period-to-period comparisons of its results of
operations are not necessarily meaningful and should not be
relied upon as indications of future performance.
Intevacs operations are located in Santa
Clara, California. The cost of living in northern California is
extremely high, which increases both the cost of doing business
and the cost and difficulty of recruiting new employees.
Intevacs operating results depend in significant part upon
its ability to effectively manage costs and to retain and
attract qualified management, engineering, marketing,
manufacturing, customer support, sales and administrative
personnel. The failure to control costs and to attract and
retain qualified personnel could have an adverse effect on
Intevacs business.
Intevacs operations are vulnerable to
interruption by fire, earthquake, power loss, telecommunications
failure and other events beyond our control. Additionally, the
costs of electricity and natural gas have increased
significantly. Any further cost increases will impact the
Companys ability to achieve profitability.
Sales and operating activities outside of the
United States are subject to inherent risks, including
fluctuations in the value of the United States dollar relative
to foreign currencies, tariffs, quotas, taxes and other market
barriers, political and economic instability, restrictions on
the export or import of technology, potentially limited
intellectual property protection, difficulties in staffing and
managing international operations and potentially adverse tax
consequences. Intevac earns a significant portion of its revenue
from international sales, and there can be no assurance that any
of these factors will not have an adverse effect on
Intevacs business.
Intevac generally quotes and sells its products
in US dollars. However, in some cases, Intevac has quoted and
sold its products in Japanese Yen. In those cases Intevac may
enter into foreign currency contracts in an effort to reduce the
overall risk of currency fluctuations to Intevacs
business. However, there can be no assurance that the offer and
sale of products denominated in foreign currencies, and the
related foreign currency hedging activities will not adversely
affect Intevacs results of operations.
Intevacs two principal competitors for disk
sputtering equipment are based in foreign countries and have
cost structures based on foreign currencies. Accordingly,
currency fluctuations could cause Intevacs products to be
more, or less, competitive than its competitors products.
Currency fluctuations will decrease, or increase, Intevacs
cost structure relative to those of its competitors, which could
impact Intevacs competitive position.
15
Intevacs stock price has experienced both
significant increases in valuation, and significant decreases in
valuation, over short periods of time. Intevac believes that
factors such as announcements of developments related to
Intevacs business, fluctuations in Intevacs
operating results, failure to meet securities analysts
expectations, general conditions in the disk drive and thin-film
media manufacturing industries and the worldwide economy,
announcements of technological innovations, new systems or
product enhancements by Intevac or its competitors, fluctuations
in the level of cooperative development funding, acquisitions,
changes in governmental regulations, developments in patents or
other intellectual property rights and changes in Intevacs
relationships with customers and suppliers could cause the price
of Intevacs Common Stock to continue to fluctuate
substantially. In addition, in recent years the stock market in
general, and the market for small capitalization and high
technology stocks in particular, has experienced extreme price
fluctuations which have often been unrelated to the operating
performance of affected companies. Any of these factors could
adversely affect the market price of Intevacs Common Stock.
Intevac has completed multiple acquisitions as
part of its efforts to expand and diversify its business. For
example, Intevacs business was initially acquired from
Varian Associates in 1991. Additionally, Intevac acquired its
current gravity lubrication, CSS test equipment and rapid
thermal processing product lines in three acquisitions. Intevac
also acquired its RPC electron beam processing business in late
1997, and subsequently closed this business. Intevac intends to
continue to evaluate new acquisition candidates and
diversification strategies. Any acquisition will involve
numerous risks, including difficulties in the assimilation of
the acquired companys employees, operations and products,
uncertainties associated with operating in new markets and
working with new customers, and the potential loss of the
acquired companys key employees. Additionally,
unanticipated expenses, difficulties and consequences may be
incurred relating to the integration of technologies, research
and development, and administrative functions. Any future
acquisitions may result in potentially dilutive issuance of
equity securities, acquisition related write-offs and the
assumption of debt and contingent liabilities. Any of the above
factors could adversely affect Intevacs business.
Intevac is subject to a variety of governmental
regulations relating to the use, storage, discharge, handling,
emission, generation, manufacture, treatment and disposal of
toxic or otherwise hazardous substances, chemicals, materials or
waste. Any failure to comply with current or future regulations
could result in substantial civil penalties or criminal fines
being imposed on Intevac or its officers, directors or
employees, suspension of production, alteration of its
manufacturing process or cessation of operations. Such
regulations could require Intevac to acquire expensive
remediation or abatement equipment or to incur substantial
expenses to comply with environmental regulations. Any failure
by Intevac to properly manage the use, disposal or storage of,
or adequately restrict the release of, hazardous or toxic
substances could subject Intevac to significant liabilities.
Based on the shares outstanding on March 30,
2002, the current directors and their affiliates and executive
officers, in the aggregate, beneficially own a majority of the
outstanding shares of Common Stock. These shareholders, acting
together, are able to effectively control all matters requiring
approval by the shareholders of Intevac, including the election
of a majority of the directors and approval of significant
corporate transactions. The Companys officers and
directors also hold 7% of the outstanding Convertible Notes.
16
Item 3. Quantitative
and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
Interest rate risk.
The table below presents principal
amounts and related weighted-average interest rates by year of
maturity for the Companys debt obligations.
Foreign exchange risk.
From time to time, the Company enters
into foreign currency forward exchange contracts to economically
hedge certain of its anticipated foreign currency transaction,
translation and re-measurement exposures. The objective of these
contracts is to minimize the impact of foreign currency exchange
rate movements on the Companys operating results. At
March 30, 2002, the Company did not have foreign currency
forward exchange contracts.
17
PART II. OTHER
INFORMATION
Item 1. Legal
Proceedings
On June 12, 1996 two Australian Army Black
Hawk Helicopters collided in midair during nighttime maneuvers.
Eighteen Australian servicemen perished and twelve were injured.
The Company was named as a defendant in a lawsuit related to
this crash. The lawsuit was filed in Stamford, Connecticut
Superior Court on June 10, 1999 by Mark Durkin, the
administrator of the estates of the deceased crewmembers, the
injured crewmembers and the spouses of the deceased and/or
injured crewmembers. Included in the suits allegations are
assertions that the crash was caused by defective night vision
goggles. The suit names three US manufacturers of military
night vision goggles, of which Intevac was one. The suit also
names the manufacturer of the pilots helmets, two
manufacturers of night vision system test equipment and the
manufacturer of the helicopter. The suit claims damages for
13 personnel killed in the crash, 5 personnel injured
in the crash and spouses of those killed or injured. It is known
that the Australian Army established a Board of Inquiry to
investigate the accident and that the Board of Inquiry concluded
that the accident was not caused by defective night vision
goggles.
On July 27, 2000 the Connecticut Superior
Court disallowed the defendants motion to dismiss the
lawsuit. That decision was appealed to the Connecticut Supreme
Court. On October 30, 2001 the Connecticut Supreme Court
reversed the Superior Courts decision and remanded the
case to the trial court with the direction to grant the
defendants motions to dismiss the suit subject to
conditions already agreed to by the defendants. These conditions
agreed to by the defendants include (1) consenting to
jurisdiction in Australia; (2) accepting service of process
in connection with an action in Australia; (3) making their
personnel and records available for litigation in Australia;
(4) waiving any applicable statutes of limitation in
Australia up to six months from the date of dismissal of this
action or for such other reasonable time as may be required as a
condition of dismissing this action; (5) satisfying any
judgement that may be entered against them in Australia; and
(6) consenting to the reopening of the action in
Connecticut in the event the above conditions are not met as to
any proper defendant in the action. The plaintiffs have not
commenced litigation against the Company in Australia. Any such
action could expose Intevac to further risk, plus the expense
and uncertainties of defending the matter in a distant foreign
jurisdiction.
On June 12, 2001 the Company filed a
complaint in Santa Clara County Superior Court, State of
California, against Intarsia Corporation. The complaint related
to Intarsias cancellation of an order for a customized
sputtering system and sought damages of at least
$3.3 million. On July 26, 2001 Intarsia filed a
cross-complaint against the Company in the Santa Clara County
Superior Court. On August 14, 2001, the Company filed a
demurrer to the cross-complaint, and on October 11, 2001,
Intarsia filed an amended cross-complaint. The amended
cross-complaint included allegations of fraud, negligent
misrepresentation, breach of contract and breach of covenant of
good faith and fair dealing, and sought damages in the amount of
$349,000 plus additional relief as may have been deemed
appropriate by the court. On February 1, 2002 the Company
and Intarsia agreed to resolve the matter. The terms of the
settlement did not materially effect the Companys
financial results.
Item 2. Changes
in Securities
None.
Item 3. Defaults
upon Senior Securities
None.
Item 4. Submission
of Matters to a Vote of Security-Holders
None.
18
Item 5. Other
Information
None.
Item 6. Exhibits
and Reports on Form 8-K
None.
19
SIGNATURES
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report
to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned thereunto duly
authorized.
Date: April 26, 2002
Date: April 26, 2002
20
EXHIBIT INDEX
APPENDIX C
DEFINITIVE PROXY STATEMENT ON
SCHEDULE 14A
Dear Shareholder:
You are cordially invited to attend the Annual
Meeting of Shareholders of Intevac, Inc., a California
corporation which will be held May 15, 2002, at
6:30 p.m., local time, at the Companys headquarters,
3560 Bassett Street, Santa Clara, California 95054.
At the Annual Meeting, you will be asked to
consider and vote upon the following proposals: (i) to
elect seven (7) directors of the Company and (ii) to
ratify the appointment of Grant Thornton LLP as independent
accountants of the Company for the fiscal year ending
December 31, 2002.
The enclosed Proxy Statement more fully describes
the details of the business to be conducted at the Annual
Meeting. After careful consideration, the Companys Board
of Directors has unanimously approved the proposals and
recommends that you vote
FOR
each such proposal.
After reading the Proxy Statement, please mark,
date, sign and return the enclosed proxy card in the
accompanying reply envelope to ensure receipt by the
Companys Transfer Agent no later than May 12, 2002.
If you decide to attend the Annual Meeting and would prefer to
vote in person, please notify the Secretary of the Company that
you wish to vote in person and your proxy will not be voted.
YOUR SHARES CANNOT BE VOTED UNLESS YOU SIGN, DATE AND RETURN
THE ENCLOSED PROXY OR ATTEND THE ANNUAL MEETING IN PERSON.
A copy of the Companys 2001 Annual Report
has been mailed concurrently herewith to all shareholders
entitled to notice of and to vote at the Annual Meeting.
We look forward to seeing you at the Annual
Meeting. Please notify Sandra Thompson at (408) 496-2242 if
you plan to attend.
Santa Clara, California
IMPORTANT
Whether or not you plan to attend the meeting,
please mark, date and sign the enclosed proxy and return it at
your earliest convenience in the enclosed postage-prepaid return
envelope.
INTEVAC, INC.
NOTICE OF ANNUAL MEETING OF SHAREHOLDERS
TO OUR SHAREHOLDERS:
You are cordially invited to attend the Annual
Meeting of Shareholders of Intevac, Inc., a California
corporation, to be held May 15, 2002 at 6:30 p.m.,
local time, at the Companys headquarters, 3560 Bassett
Street, Santa Clara, California 95054, for the following
purposes:
The foregoing items of business are more fully
described in the Proxy Statement that accompanies this Notice.
Only shareholders of record at the close of
business March 15, 2002 are entitled to notice of and to
vote at the Annual Meeting and at any continuation or
adjournment thereof.
All shareholders are cordially invited and
encouraged to attend the Annual Meeting. In any event, to ensure
your representation at the meeting, please carefully read the
accompanying Proxy Statement which describes the matters to be
voted on at the Annual Meeting and sign, date and return the
enclosed proxy card in the reply envelope provided. Should you
receive more than one proxy because your shares are registered
in different names and addresses, each proxy should be returned
to ensure that all your shares will be voted. If you attend the
Annual Meeting and vote by ballot, your proxy will be revoked
automatically and only your vote at the Annual Meeting will be
counted. The prompt return of your proxy card will assist us in
preparing for the Annual Meeting.
We look forward to seeing you at the Annual
Meeting. Please notify Sandra Thompson at (408) 496-2242 if
you plan to attend.
Santa Clara, California
ALL SHAREHOLDERS
ARE CORDIALLY INVITED TO ATTEND THE ANNUAL MEETING IN PERSON. IN
ANY EVENT, TO ENSURE YOUR REPRESENTATION AT THE ANNUAL MEETING,
YOU ARE URGED TO VOTE, SIGN AND RETURN THE ENCLOSED PROXY AS
PROMPTLY AS POSSIBLE IN THE POSTAGE-PREPAID ENVELOPE
PROVIDED.
PROXY STATEMENT
FOR THE ANNUAL MEETING OF SHAREHOLDERS OF
GENERAL
This Proxy Statement is furnished in connection
with the solicitation by the Board of Directors of Intevac,
Inc., a California corporation, of proxies to be voted at the
Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held May 15, 2002, or
at any adjournment or postponement thereof, for the purposes set
forth in the accompanying Notice of Annual Meeting of
Shareholders. Shareholders of record March 15, 2002 will be
entitled to vote at the Annual Meeting. The Annual Meeting will
be held at 6:30 p.m., local time, at the Companys
headquarters, 3560 Bassett Street, Santa Clara, California
95054.
It is anticipated that this Proxy Statement and
the enclosed proxy card will be first mailed to shareholders on
or about April 2, 2002.
VOTING RIGHTS
The close of business March 15, 2002 was the
record date for shareholders entitled to notice of and to vote
at the Annual Meeting and any adjournments thereof. At the
record date, the Company had 12,060,003 shares of its Common
Stock outstanding and entitled to vote at the Annual Meeting,
held by approximately 150 shareholders of record. The
Company believes that approximately 1,700 beneficial owners hold
shares through brokers, fiduciaries and nominees. Holders of
Common Stock are entitled to one vote for each share of Common
Stock so held. A majority of the shares of Common Stock entitled
to vote will constitute a quorum for the transaction of business
at the Annual Meeting.
If any shareholder is unable to attend the Annual
Meeting, such shareholder may vote by proxy. The enclosed proxy
is solicited by the Companys Board of Directors, and, when
the proxy card is returned properly completed, it will be voted
as directed by the shareholder on the proxy card. Shareholders
are urged to specify their choices on the enclosed proxy card.
If a proxy card is signed and returned without choices
specified, in the absence of contrary instructions, the shares
of Common Stock represented by such proxy will be voted FOR
Proposals 1 and 2 and will be voted in the proxy holders
discretion as to other matters that may properly come before the
Annual Meeting.
The seven director nominees receiving the highest
number of affirmative votes will be elected. Votes against a
nominee, abstentions and brokers non-votes will have no effect
on the election of directors. Approval of Proposal 2
requires (i) the affirmative vote of a majority of those
shares present and voting, and (ii) the affirmative vote of
the majority of the required quorum. Thus in the case of
Proposal 2, abstentions and broker non-votes can have the effect
of preventing approval of a proposal where the number of
affirmative votes, though a majority of the votes cast, does not
constitute a majority of the required quorum. All votes will be
tabulated by the inspector of election appointed for the
meeting, who will separately tabulate affirmative and negative
votes, abstentions and broker non-votes.
REVOCABILITY OF PROXIES
Any person giving a proxy has the power to revoke
it at any time before its exercise. A proxy may be revoked by
filing with the Secretary of the Company an instrument of
revocation or a duly executed proxy bearing a later date, or by
attending the Annual Meeting and voting in person.
SOLICITATION OF PROXIES
The Company will bear the cost of soliciting
proxies. Copies of solicitation material will be furnished to
brokerage houses, fiduciaries and custodians holding shares in
their names that are beneficially owned by others to forward to
such beneficial owners. The Company may reimburse such persons
for their costs of forwarding the solicitation material to such
beneficial owners. The original solicitation of proxies by mail
may be supplemented by solicitation by telephone, telegram or
other means by directors, officers, employees or agents of the
Company. No additional compensation will be paid to these
individuals for any such services. Except as described above,
the Company does not intend to solicit proxies other than by
mail.
The Annual Report of the Company for the
fiscal year ended December 31, 2001 has been mailed
concurrently with the mailing of this Notice of Annual Meeting
and Proxy Statement to all shareholders entitled to notice of
and to vote at the Annual Meeting. The Annual Report is not
incorporated into this Proxy Statement and is not considered
proxy soliciting material.
PROPOSAL NO. 1:
ELECTION OF DIRECTORS
At the Annual Meeting, seven directors
(constituting the entire board) are to be elected to serve until
the next Annual Meeting of Shareholders and until a successor
for each such director is elected and qualified, or until the
death, resignation, or removal of such director. It is intended
that the proxies will be voted for the seven nominees named
below unless authority to vote for any such nominee is withheld.
All seven nominees are currently directors of the Company, and
all except Mr. Fairbairn and Mr. Farinsky were elected
to the Board by the shareholders at the last annual meeting.
Each person nominated for election has agreed to serve if
elected, and the Board of Directors has no reason to believe
that any nominee will be unavailable or will decline to serve.
In the event, however, that any nominee is unable or declines to
serve as a director at the time of the Annual Meeting, the
proxies will be voted for any other person who is designated by
the current Board of Directors to fill the vacancy. Unless
otherwise instructed, the proxyholders will vote the proxies
received by them for the nominees named below. The seven
candidates receiving the highest number of the affirmative votes
of the shares entitled to vote at the Annual Meeting will be
elected directors of the Company. The proxies solicited by this
Proxy Statement may not be voted for more than seven nominees.
NOMINEES
Set forth below is information regarding the
nominees to the Board of Directors.
BUSINESS EXPERIENCE OF NOMINEES FOR ELECTION
AS DIRECTORS
Mr. Pond
is a
founder of Intevac and has served as Chairman of the Board since
February 1991. Mr. Pond served as President and Chief
Executive Officer from February 1991 until July 2000 and again
from September 2001 through January 2002. Before joining
Intevac, from 1988 to 1990, Mr. Pond served as
2
Mr. Fairbairn
joined Intevac as President and Chief
Executive Officer in January 2002 and was appointed a Director
of the Company in February 2002. Before joining Intevac, from
July 1985 to January 2002, Mr. Fairbairn was employed by
Applied Materials, most recently as Vice-President and General
Manager of the Conductor Etch Organization with responsibility
for the Silicon and Metal Etch Divisions. From 1996 to 1999,
Mr. Fairbairn was General Manager of Applieds Plasma
Enhanced Chemical Vapor Deposition Business Unit and from 1993
to 1996, he was General Manager of Applieds Plasma Silane
CVD Product Business Unit. Mr. Fairbairn holds a MA in
engineering sciences from Cambridge University.
Mr. Durbin
has
served as a Director of Intevac since February 1991.
Mr. Durbin joined Kaiser Aerospace and Electronics
Corporation, a privately held manufacturer of electronic and
electro-optical systems, in 1975 and served as Vice Chairman
with responsibility for marketing and business development until
January 2001. Mr. Durbin holds a BS in electrical
engineering from The Cooper Union and a MS in electrical
engineering from the Polytechnic Institute of Brooklyn.
Mr. Farinsky
has served as a Director of Intevac
since May 2001. Mr. Farinsky has been an investor and consultant
since he retired as a corporate financial executive in 1991.
From 1987 to 1991 he was Executive Vice President and Chief
Financial Officer of Ashton-Tate Corporation. Prior to joining
Ashton-Tate, he held executive management positions at the Bank
of British Columbia, Dysan Corporation, Kaiser Resources, Ltd,.
Kaiser Industries Corporation, Mattel, Inc. and Teledyne, Inc.
Mr. Farinsky holds a BS in business administration from the
University of San Francisco and is a Certified Public Accountant
licensed in California, but is not engaged in public practice.
Mr. Farinsky is also a director of Broadcom Corporation.
Dr. Hempstead
has served as a Director of Intevac
since March 1997 and served as Chief Operating Officer of
Intevac from April 1996 through June 1999. Before joining
Intevac, Dr. Hempstead served as Executive Vice President
of Censtor Corp., a manufacturer of computer disk drive heads
and disks, from November 1994 to February 1996. He was a
self-employed consultant from 1989 to November 1994.
Dr. Hempstead is currently Chief Technology Officer at
Veeco Instruments. Dr. Hempstead holds a BS and MS in
electrical engineering from Massachusetts Institute of
Technology and a Ph.D. in physics from the University of
Illinois.
Dr. Lambeth
has
served as a Director of Intevac since May 1996. Dr. Lambeth has
been Professor of both Electrical and Computer Engineering and
Material Science Engineering at Carnegie Mellon University since
1989. Dr. Lambeth was Associate Director of the Data Storage
Systems at Carnegie Mellon University from 1989 to 1999. Since
1988, Dr. Lambeth has been the owner of Lambeth Systems, an
engineering consulting and research firm. From 1973 to 1988,
Dr. Lambeth worked at Eastman Kodak Companys Research
Laboratories, most recently as the head of the Magnetic
Materials Laboratory. Dr. Lambeth holds a BS in electrical
engineering from the University of Missouri and a Ph.D. in
physics from the Massachusetts Institute of Technology.
Dr. Smead
has
served as a Director of Intevac since February 1991.
Dr. Smead joined Kaiser Aerospace and Electronics
Corporation in 1974 and served as Kaisers President from
1974 until October 1997. Dr. Smead served as President and
Chairman of the Board of Directors of K Systems, Inc.,
Kaisers parent company, from 1977 until October 1997.
Dr. Smead served as Chairman of the Board of Directors of
Kaiser until December 1999. Dr. Smead resigned as a
director of Kaiser and its subsidiaries in December 2000.
Dr. Smead holds a BS in electrical engineering from the
University of Colorado, a MS in electrical engineering from the
University of Washington and a Ph.D. in electrical engineering
from Purdue University.
3
BOARD MEETINGS AND COMMITTEES
The Board of Directors held four meetings during
fiscal 2001. All members of the Board of Directors during fiscal
2001 attended at least seventy-five percent of the aggregate of
the total number of meetings of the Board of Directors held
during the fiscal year and the total number of meetings held by
all committees of the Board on which each such director served.
There are no family relationships among executive officers or
directors of the Company. The Board of Directors has an Audit
Committee and a Compensation Committee.
The Audit Committee of the Board of Directors
held four meetings during fiscal 2001. The Audit Committee,
which during 2001 comprised Mr. Durbin, Mr. Farinsky (after
his appointment in May 2001) and Dr. Lambeth, recommends
engagement of the Companys independent accountants,
approves services performed by such accountants, and reviews and
evaluates the Companys accounting system and its system of
internal controls.
The Compensation Committee of the Board of
Directors held one meeting during fiscal 2001. The Compensation
Committee, which during 2001 comprised Dr. Lambeth and
Dr. Smead, has overall responsibility for the
Companys compensation policies and determines the
compensation payable to the Companys executive officers,
including their participation in certain of the Companys
employee benefit and stock plans.
DIRECTOR COMPENSATION
Directors of the Company do not receive fees for
services provided as a director, but they are reimbursed for
reasonable expenses incurred in attending Board or committee
meetings. The Company also does not pay fees for committee
participation or special assignments of the Board of Directors.
However, the directors are eligible to receive periodic option
grants under the Discretionary Option Grant Programs in effect
under the Companys 1995 Stock Option/ Stock Issuance Plan
(the 1995 Plan). Under the Discretionary Option
Grant Program, all directors are eligible to receive option
grants, when and as determined by the Board of Directors. During
the 2001 fiscal year, Mr. Durbin, Dr. Hempstead and
Dr. Smead each received option grants of 5,000 shares, Dr.
Lambeth received options grants totaling 20,000 shares and
Mr. Farinsky received an option grant of 35,000 shares
under the Discretionary Option Grant Program.
The Board of Directors recommends that
shareholders vote FOR election of all of the above nominees for
election as directors.
PROPOSAL NO. 2:
RATIFICATION OF INDEPENDENT PUBLIC
ACCOUNTANTS
The Board of Directors has selected Grant
Thornton LLP as the Companys independent public
accountants for the fiscal year ending December 31, 2002.
Grant Thornton LLP began auditing the Companys financial
statements in 2000. Its representatives are expected to be
present at the Annual Meeting, will have an opportunity to make
a statement if they desire to do so, and will be available to
respond to appropriate questions.
Change in Independent Public Auditor
In June 2000, Intevac dismissed Ernst & Young
LLP as the Companys independent accountants and engaged
Grant Thornton LLP as its new independent accountant. The Audit
Committee of Intevacs Board of Directors participated in
and approved the decision to change independent accountants
June 5, 2000.
The reports of Ernst & Young LLP on the
financial statements of the Company for the fiscal year ended
December 31, 1999 contained no adverse opinion or
disclaimer of opinion and were not qualified or modified as to
uncertainty, audit scope or accounting principles. Intevac had
no disagreements with Ernst & Young LLP on any matter of
accounting principles or practices, financial statement
disclosure, or auditing scope or procedure, which disagreements,
if not resolved to the satisfaction of Ernst & Young LLP,
would have caused
4
During the fiscal year ended December 31,
1999, and the subsequent interim period ended June 7, 2000,
there were no reportable events as that term is defined in
Item 304(a)(1)(v) of Regulation S-K.
Fees Paid To Accountants For Services Rendered
During 2001
Audit fees billed to the Company by Grant
Thornton LLP during the Companys 2001 fiscal year for
review of the Companys annual financial statements and
those financial statements included in the Companys
quarterly reports on Form 10-Q totaled $163,000. The
Company also paid Grant Thorntons predecessor accountant,
Ernst & Young LLP $12,000 for their review of financial
statements included in the Companys annual report on
Form 10-K.
The Company did not engage Grant Thornton LLP to
provide advice to the Company regarding financial information
systems design and implementation during the year ended
December 31, 2001.
Fees billed to the Company by Grant Thornton LLP
during the 2001 fiscal year for all other non-audit services
rendered to the Company, including tax related services totaled
$36,000.
Shareholder ratification of the selection of
Grant Thornton LLP as the Companys independent public
accountants is not required by the Companys By-Laws or
other applicable legal requirement. However, the Board is
submitting the selection of Grant Thornton LLP to the
shareholders for ratification as a matter of good corporate
practice. If the shareholders fail to ratify the selection, the
Audit Committee and the Board will reconsider whether or not to
retain that firm. Even if the selection is ratified, the Board
at its discretion may direct the appointment of a different
independent accounting firm at any time during the year if it
determines that such a change would be in the best interests of
the Company and its shareholders.
The affirmative vote of the holders of a majority
of the shares represented and entitled to vote at the meeting,
provided that such a vote also constitutes a majority of the
required quorum, will be required to ratify the selection of
Grant Thornton LLP as the Companys independent public
accountants for the year ending December 31, 2002.
Abstentions will be counted toward the tabulation of votes cast
on proposals presented to the stockholders and will have the
same effect as the negative votes. Broker non-votes are counted
towards a quorum, but are not counted for any purpose in
determining whether this matter has been approved.
The Board of Directors recommends that
shareholders vote FOR the proposal to ratify the selection of
Grant Thornton LLP as the Companys independent public
accountants for the fiscal year ending December 31,
2002.
5
SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL
OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT
The following table sets forth certain
information regarding the ownership of the Companys Common
Stock as of March 15, 2002 by (i) all persons known by
the Company to be beneficial owners of five percent (5%) or more
of its outstanding Common Stock based upon a review of 13G
filings made with the Securities and Exchange Commission during
2001, (ii) each director of the Company and each nominee
for director, (iii) the Chairman of the Board and each of
the three other executive officers of the Company serving as
such as of the end of the last fiscal year whose compensation
for such year was in excess of $100,000, and (iv) all
executive officers and directors of the Company as a group.
6
SECTION 16(a) BENEFICIAL OWNERSHIP REPORTING
COMPLIANCE
Section 16(a) of the Securities and Exchange
Act of 1934 requires the Companys directors and executive
officers and persons who own more than ten percent (10%) of a
registered class of the Companys equity securities, to
file with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the
SEC) initial reports of ownership on Form 3 and
reports of changes in ownership on Form 4 or Form 5 of
Common Stock and other equity securities of the Company.
Officers, directors and greater than ten percent (10%)
shareholders are required by SEC regulations to furnish the
Company with copies of all Section 16(a) forms they file.
Based solely upon review of the copies of such
reports furnished to the Company and written representations
that no other reports were required, the Company believes that
during the fiscal year ended December 31, 2001, its
officers, directors and holders of more than 10% of the
Companys common stock complied with all Section 16(a)
filing requirements.
7
EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION AND RELATED
INFORMATION
Summary of Cash and Certain Other
Compensation
The following table provides certain summary
information concerning the compensation earned by (i) the
Companys Chief Executive Officer and (ii) each of the
three other executive officers of the Company whose salary and
bonus was in excess of $100,000 for the 2001 fiscal year, for
services rendered in all capacities to the Company and its
subsidiaries for each of the last three fiscal years. Such
individuals are referred to as the Named Executive
Officers. No executive officer who would have otherwise
been includible in such table on the basis of salary and bonus
earned for the 2001 fiscal year resigned or terminated
employment during that fiscal year.
Summary Compensation Table
8
Stock Options
The following table contains information
concerning the stock option grants made to each of the Named
Executive Officers during the fiscal year ended
December 31, 2001. Except for the limited stock
appreciation rights described in footnote (2) below, no
stock appreciation rights were granted to those individuals
during such year.
9
Aggregated Option Exercises in Last Fiscal
Year and Fiscal Year-End Option Values
The following table sets forth information
concerning option exercises and option holdings for the 2001
fiscal year by each of the Named Executive Officers. Except for
the limited stock appreciation rights described in footnote
(2) to the Stock Options table above, no stock appreciation
rights were outstanding at the end of that year.
10
REPORT OF THE COMPENSATION COMMITTEE ON
EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
The Compensation Committee of the Board of
Directors (the Committee) administers the
Companys compensation policies and programs and has
primary responsibility for executive compensation matters,
including the establishment of the base salaries of the
Companys executive officers, the approval of individual
bonuses and bonus programs for executive officers and the
administration of certain employee benefit programs. In
addition, the Committee has exclusive responsibility for
administering the Companys 1995 Stock Option/ Stock
Issuance Plan, under which stock option grants and direct stock
issuances may be made to executive officers and other employees.
The Committee during 2001 comprised two non-employee directors.
The following is a summary of policies which the Committee
applies in setting the compensation levels for the
Companys executive officers.
GENERAL COMPENSATION
POLICY.
The overall policy of the
Committee is to offer the Companys executive officers
competitive compensation opportunities based upon their personal
performance, the financial performance of the Company and their
contribution to that performance. Each executive officers
compensation package generally comprises base salary, which is
determined on the basis of the individuals position and
responsibilities with the Company, the level of his or her
performance, and the financial performance of the Company, and
incentive performance awards generally in the form of stock
options.
FACTORS.
The primary
factors which the Committee considers in establishing the
components of each executive officers compensation package
are summarized below.
Base Salary.
In
setting the base salary for each executive officer, the
Committee takes into account comparative compensation data for a
select group of companies. Companies are included within the
survey group on the basis of a number of factors, such as their
size and organizational structure, the nature of their
businesses, the geographic regions in which they operate, the
composition of their compensation programs (including the extent
to which they rely on other contingent forms of compensation),
the extent to which they compete with the Company for executive
talent and the availability of information concerning their
compensation practices. On the basis of the compiled data, the
Committee sets the base salary of each executive officer at a
level which is competitive with the salaries of individuals in
similar positions at the surveyed companies. The Committee also
takes into account the performance of the Company in setting the
base salary for each executive officer.
Incentive Compensation.
At the end of each fiscal year the
Compensation Committee evaluates each executive officers
base salary, the level of his performance, and the performance
of the Company, and determines for each individual executive
officer the amount of any cash incentive bonus to be paid to
such executive officer. For fiscal 2001, no year-end cash
incentive bonuses were paid.
Long-Term Stock-Based Incentive Compensation.
Long-term incentives are provided
through stock option grants. The grants are designed to align
the interests of each executive officer with those of the
shareholders and provide each individual with a significant
incentive to manage the Company from the perspective of an owner
with an equity stake in the business. Each grant allows the
officer to acquire shares of the Companys Common Stock at
a fixed price per share (the market price on the grant date)
over a specified period of time (up to ten years). Each option
generally becomes exercisable in installments over a five-year
period, contingent on the officers continued employment
with the Company. Accordingly, the option provides a return to
the executive officer only if the market price of the shares
appreciates over the option term and the officer continues in
the Companys employ.
The size of the option grant to each executive
officer is designed to create a meaningful opportunity for stock
ownership and is based upon the executive officers current
position with the Company, internal comparability with option
grants made to other Company executives, the executive
officers current level of performance and the executive
officers potential for future responsibility and promotion
over the option term. The Committee also takes into account the
number of vested and unvested options held by the executive
officer to maintain an appropriate level of equity incentive for
that individual. However, the Committee does not adhere to any
specific guidelines as to the relative option holdings of the
Companys executive officers.
11
CEO COMPENSATION.
The compensation payable to Dr. Rode, the Companys
Chief Executive Officer until September 28, 2001 was
determined by the Committee using a process similar to that
described above. His base salary was set at a level which the
Committee believed would be competitive with the base salary
levels in effect for chief executive officers at similarly-sized
companies within the industry.
COMPLIANCE WITH INTERNAL REVENUE CODE SECTION
162(m).
Section 162(m) of the
Internal Revenue Code, enacted in 1993, generally disallows a
tax deduction to publicly-held companies for compensation paid
to certain executive officers, to the extent that compensation
exceeds $1 million per officer in any year. The
compensation paid to any of the Companys executive
officers for the 2001 fiscal year did not exceed the
$1 million limit per officer, and it is not expected the
compensation to be paid to any of the Companys executive
officers for the 2002 fiscal year will exceed that limit. In
addition, the Companys 1995 Stock Option/ Stock Issuance
Plan is structured so that any compensation deemed paid to an
executive officer in connection with the exercise of his or her
outstanding options under the 1995 Plan will qualify as
performance-based compensation that will not be subject to the
$1 million limitation.
Submitted by the Compensation Committee of the
Companys Board of Directors:
David N. Lambeth & H. Joseph Smead,
Compensation Committee Members
The foregoing Compensation Committee Report
shall not be deemed to be soliciting material or to
be filed with the SEC, nor shall such information be
incorporated by reference into any past or future filing under
the Securities Act or the Exchange Act, except to the extent the
Company specifically incorporates it by reference into such
filing.
COMPENSATION COMMITTEE INTERLOCKS AND INSIDER
PARTICIPATION
The Compensation Committee of the Companys
Board of Directors was formed September 14, 1995 and during
2001 comprised David N. Lambeth and H. Joseph Smead. Neither of
these individuals was at any time during fiscal 2001, or at any
other time, an officer or employee of the Company. No executive
officer of the Company serves as a member of the board of
directors or compensation committee of any other entity that has
one or more executive officers serving as a member of the
Companys Board of Directors or Compensation Committee.
AUDIT COMMITTEE REPORT
The primary responsibility of the Audit Committee
is to oversee the Companys financial reporting process on
behalf of the board, to report the results of its activities to
the board and to maintain free and open communication among the
committee, independent and internal auditors and management.
While the Audit Committee has certain responsibilities and
powers, it is not the duty of the Audit Committee to plan or
conduct audits or to determine that the Companys financial
statements are complete and accurate and in accordance with
generally accepted accounting principles. Management is
responsible for preparing the Companys financial
statements, and the independent auditors are responsible for
auditing those financial statements. It is not the duty of the
Audit Committee to conduct investigations, to resolve
disagreements, if any, between management and the independent
auditor, or to assure compliance with laws and regulation and
the Companys Code of Conduct. The Audit Committee
comprises three independent directors, and is governed by a
written charter first adopted and approved by the Board of
Directors September 14, 1995. Each of the members of the Audit
Committee is independent as defined by Company policy and
Rule 4200(a)(15) of the National Association of Securities
Dealers listing standards.
The Audit Committee recommends to the Board an
accounting firm to serve as the Companys independent
accountants. The Audit Committee also, as appropriate, reviews,
evaluates, discusses and
12
This year the Audit Committee reviewed the Audit
Committee Charter and, after appropriate review and discussion,
determined that it had fulfilled its responsibilities thereunder.
The Audit Committee is responsible for
recommending to the Board that the Companys financial
statements be included in the Companys Annual Report on
Form 10-K. The Audit Committee discussed with Grant
Thornton, the Companys independent accountants for fiscal
2001, those matters Grant Thornton communicated to the Audit
Committee under applicable auditing standards, including
information concerning the scope and results of the audit. These
communications and discussions are intended to assist the Audit
Committee in overseeing the financial reporting and disclosure
process. The Audit Committee discussed Grant Thorntons
independence with Grant Thornton and received a letter from
Grant Thornton regarding independence as required under
applicable independence standards for auditors of public
companies, satisfying the Committee in evaluating such
independence. Finally, the Audit Committee reviewed and
discussed, with Company management and Grant Thornton, the
Companys audited consolidated balance sheets at
December 31, 2001 and 2000, and consolidated statements of
operations, cash flows and stockholders equity for the
three years ended December 31, 2001. Based on the
discussions with Grant Thornton and management concerning the
audit, the auditors independence, the financial statement
review, and additional matters deemed relevant and appropriate
by the Committee, the Audit Committee recommended to the Board
that the Companys Annual Report on Form 10-K include
these financial statements.
Submitted by the Audit Committee of the
Companys Board of Directors:
Edward Durbin, George L. Farinsky & David N.
Lambeth, Audit Committee Members
The foregoing Audit Committee Report shall not
be deemed to be soliciting material or to be filed
with the SEC, nor shall such information be incorporated by
reference into any past or future filing under the Securities
Act or the Exchange Act, except to the extent the Company
specifically incorporates it by reference into such
filing.
EMPLOYMENT CONTRACTS, TERMINATION OF
EMPLOYMENT
None of the Companys executive officers has
an employment agreement with the Company, and each
individuals employment may be terminated at any time at
the discretion of the Board of Directors. Pursuant to the
express provisions of the 1995 Stock Option/ Stock Issuance
Plan, the outstanding options under the 1995 Plan held by the
Chief Executive Officer and the Companys other executive
officers would immediately accelerate in full, and all unvested
shares of Common Stock at the time held by such individuals
under the 1995 Plan would immediately vest, if their employment
were to be terminated either involuntarily or through a forced
resignation within twelve (12) months after any acquisition
of the Company by merger or asset sale in which those options
and shares did not otherwise vest. In addition, the Compensation
Committee of the Board of Directors has the authority as
Administrator of the 1995 Plan to provide for the accelerated
vesting of the outstanding options under the 1995 Plan held by
the Chief Executive Officer and the Companys other
executive officers, and the immediate vesting of all unvested
shares of Common Stock at the time held by such individuals
under the 1995 Plan, if their employment were to be terminated
either involuntarily or through a forced resignation following a
hostile take-over of the Company effected through a successful
tender offer for
13
PERFORMANCE GRAPH
The following graph compares the cumulative total
shareholder return on the Common Stock of the Company with that
of the NASDAQ Stock Market Total Return Index, a broad market
index published by the Center for Research in Security Prices
(CRSP), and the NASDAQ Computer Manufacturers Stock
Total Return Index compiled by CRSP. The comparison for each of
the periods assumes that $100 was invested December 31,
1996 in the Companys Common Stock, the stocks included in
the NASDAQ Stock Market Total Return Index and the stocks
included in the NASDAQ Computer Manufacturers Stock Total Return
Index. These indices, which reflect formulas for dividend
reinvestment and weighting of individual stocks, do not
necessarily reflect returns that could be achieved by individual
investors.
COMPARISON OF CUMULATIVE TOTAL RETURN SINCE
DECEMBER 31, 1996
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary set
forth in any of the Companys previous filings under the
Securities Act of 1933 or the Exchange Act that might
incorporate future filings, including this Proxy Statement, in
whole or in part, the preceding Compensation Committee Report on
Executive Compensation, the preceding Audit Committee Report and
the preceding Performance Graph shall not be incorporated by
reference into any such filings; nor shall such reports or graph
be incorporated by reference into any future filings.
14
OTHER BUSINESS
The Board of Directors knows of no other business
that will be presented for consideration at the Annual Meeting.
If other matters are properly brought before the Annual Meeting,
however, it is the intention of the persons named in the
accompanying proxy to vote the shares represented thereby on
such matters in accordance with their best judgment.
SHAREHOLDER PROPOSALS
Proposals of shareholders which are intended to
be presented at the Companys annual meeting of
shareholders to be held in 2003 must be received by the Company
no later than December 3, 2002 to be included in the proxy
statement and proxy relating to that meeting. If a shareholder
intends to submit a proposal at our 2003 Annual Meeting of
Shareholders that is not eligible for inclusion in the proxy
statement relating to the meeting and the shareholder fails to
give us notice in accordance with the requirements set forth in
the Securities Exchange Act, no later than February 15,
2003, the proxy holders will be allowed to use their
discretionary authority when and if the proposal is raised at
our 2003 Annual Meeting.
March 25, 2002
15
APPENDIX D
TENDER OFFER STATEMENT ON
SCHEDULE TO
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Schedule TO
Tender Offer Statement under Section 14(d)(1) or
13(e)(1)
Intevac, Inc.
6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes Due
2004
4661148AA6
Kevin Fairbairn
Copies to:
Herbert P. Fockler, Esq.
CALCULATION OF FILING FEE
Amount Previously Paid: N/ A
Check the following box if the filing is a final
amendment reporting the results of the tender
offer:
o
This Schedule TO relates to the offer by
Intevac, Inc., a California corporation (Intevac or
the Company), to exchange (the Exchange
Offer) each $5,000 aggregate principal amount of its
outstanding 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2004
(the Existing Notes) tendered for (a) $2,000 in
cash, (b) 250 warrants, each to purchase one share of
Intevac Common Stock and (c) $1,000 principal amount of its
new 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2009 (the
Exchange Notes), up to a maximum of $18,000,000
principal amount of Existing Notes. Intevac reserves the right
to amend the Exchange Offer for any or no reason at any time
prior to the expiration date. Intevac expressly reserves the
absolute right to extend, subject to applicable law, the period
during which the Exchange Offer is open and thereby delay
acceptance of any Existing Notes by issuing a press release or
other public announcement no later than 9:00 a.m., Eastern Time,
on the next business day after the previously scheduled
expiration date. We reserve the right to terminate the Exchange
Offer if, in our judgment, any condition set forth in the
Offering Circular dated May 8, 2002 (the Offering
Circular) under the caption The Exchange
Offer Conditions to the Completion of the Exchange
Offer is not or will not be satisfied. The Offering
Circular and the related letter of transmittal (which, as either
may be amended or supplemented from time to time, together
constitute the Disclosure Documents) are attached to
this Schedule TO as Exhibits (a)(1)(a) and (a)(1)(b),
respectively.
The information in the Disclosure Documents,
including all schedules and annexes to the Disclosure Documents,
is incorporated by reference in answer to the items required in
this Schedule TO, except as otherwise set forth below.
The information set forth in the Offering
Circular under the title Summary Term Sheet is
incorporated herein by reference.
(a) Intevac is the issuer of the securities
subject to the Exchange Offer. Intevacs principal
executive offices are located at 3560 Bassett Street, Santa
Clara, California 95054. Intevacs telephone number is
(408) 986-9888.
(b) The subject class of securities is
Intevacs 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due
2004. As of April 30, 2002, $37,545,000 aggregate principal
amount of Existing Notes was outstanding.
(c) Although the Existing Notes trade in the
over-the-counter market, there is only limited trading for the
Existing Notes, and, accordingly, historical price information
is not available.
(a) Intevac is the filing person and subject
company. The business address and telephone number of Intevac
are set forth under Item 2(a) of this Schedule TO.
Pursuant to General Instruction C to
Schedule TO, the following persons are the directors and/or
executive officers of Intevac:
1
The business address and telephone number for all
of the above directors and executive officers is
c/o Intevac, Inc., 3560 Bassett Street, Santa Clara,
California 95054 and (408) 986-9888.
As of April 30, 2002, 46.4% of our
outstanding Common Stock was beneficially owned by Foster City
LLC, and therefore Foster City LLC may be deemed to be in
control of Intevac. Ed Durbin and H. Joseph Smead are directors
of Intevac and managing general members of Foster City LLC. Mr.
Durbin and Mr. Smead disclaim beneficial ownership of the
shares held by Foster City LLC, except to the extent of their
respective pecuniary interests therein arising from their
general membership interests in Foster City LLC. Further, the
current directors and executive officers of Intevac as a group
held 57.3% of the outstanding Common Stock of Intevac as of
April 30, 2002, including their deemed ownership of the
Foster City LLC shares, and therefore as a group those persons,
acting together, are able to effectively control all matters
requiring approval by the shareholders of Intevac. The business
address and telephone number for Foster City LLC is 395 Mill
Creek Circle, Vail, Colorado, 81657 and (970) 479-7492.
Item 4.
Terms
of the Transaction.
(a) The information set forth in the
sections of the Offering Circular titled Summary Term
Sheet, Capitalization, Unaudited Pro
Forma Consolidated Financial Data, The Exchange
Offer, Description of Exchange Notes,
Description of Existing Notes, Description of
Warrants, Book-Entry System The Depository
Trust Company and U.S. Federal Income Tax
Consequences are incorporated herein by reference.
(b) Norman H. Pond, our chairman of the
Board, Edward Durbin, a director of the Company and Chief
Operating Officer of Foster City LLC, an entity which holds
approximately 46.4% of our outstanding Common Stock, and Charles
B. Eddy III, our Vice President, Finance and Administration,
Chief Financial Officer, Treasurer and Secretary individually
own $1,490,000, $980,000 and $50,000, respectively, and together
own $2,520,000 of our Existing Notes, or 6.7% of the aggregate
outstanding principal amount. They have agreed to tender all of
their Existing Notes.
Item 5.
Past
Contacts, Transactions, Negotiations and
Agreements.
(e) The information set forth above in
Item 4(b) and in the sections of the Offering Circular
titled Financing Strategy, Description of
Exchange Notes, Description of Existing Notes,
and Description of Warrants, are incorporated herein
by reference. The Company has entered into an employment
agreement with Kevin Fairbairn, our President and Chief
Executive Officer, which provides that the vesting of
Mr. Fairbairns options may accelerate upon a change
of control of the Company. The Exchange Offer would not be
considered a change of control of the Company. Other than the
respective Indentures governing the Existing Notes and Exchange
Notes and the Warrant Agreement governing the Warrants, which
are filed as exhibits to this Schedule TO, no agreement,
arrangement or understanding exists between Intevac (including
any person specified in Instruction C of this Schedule TO)
and any other person with respect to any Existing Notes or
Exchange Notes or Warrants.
Item
6.
Purposes of the Transaction
and Plans or Proposals.
(a) The information set forth in the section
of the Offering Circular titled Summary Term Sheet
is incorporated herein by reference.
(b) The Existing Notes acquired pursuant to
the Exchange Offer will be retired.
(c)(1) None.
(c)(2) None.
(c)(3) The information set forth in the
sections of the Offering Circular titled Summary Term
Sheet, Selected Consolidated Financial Data,
Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Data,
Capitalization and Financing Strategy is
incorporated herein by reference.
2
(c)(4) One of our prior directors, George L.
Farinsky, resigned from our Board of Directors on May 2,
2002, leaving a vacancy. The Company intends to fill such
vacancy as soon as it locates a suitable replacement, although
it has not currently identified such an individual.
(c)(5) None.
(c)(6) None.
(c)(7) None.
(c)(8) None.
(c)(9) The information set forth in the
sections of the Offering Circular titled Summary Term
Sheet, The Exchange Offer and Financing
Strategy is incorporated herein by reference. The Company
maintains two stock option plans, the 1992 Stock Plan and the
1995 Stock Option/ Stock Issuance Plan, and an employee stock
purchase plan.
(c)(10) None.
Item 7.
Source
and Amount of Funds or Other Consideration.
(a) Intevac expects to obtain the cash
required to consummate the Exchange Offer, up to a maximum of
$7,200,000 if the maximum principal amount of Existing Notes are
tendered, from current cash reserves.
(b) All financing conditions required for
the issuance of new securities and cash pursuant to the Exchange
Offers have been satisfied.
(d) Not applicable.
(a) The following executive officers or
directors of Intevac hold the following amounts of the subject
securities:
(b) Not applicable.
(a) Not applicable.
(a) and (b) The information set forth in the
sections of the Offering Circular and the financial statements
titled Selected Consolidated Financial Data,
Unaudited Pro Forma Consolidated Financial Data and
Where You Can Find Additional Information are
incorporated herein by reference, and
3
(a)(1) Not applicable.
(a)(2) Intevac is required to qualify under
the Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as amended, the indenture
pursuant to which the New Securities will be issued. Intevac is
also required to comply with federal and state securities laws
and tender offer rules, including applicable state blue
sky laws.
(a)(3) Not applicable.
(a)(4) Not applicable.
(a)(5) Not applicable.
(b) Not applicable.
4
SIGNATURE
After due inquiry and to the best of my knowledge
and belief, I certify that the information set forth in this
Schedule TO is true, complete and correct.
Date: May 8, 2002
5
EXHIBIT INDEX
6
APPENDIX E
AMENDMENT NO. 2 TO SCHEDULE TO
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Amendment No. 2 to
Tender Offer Statement under Section 14(d)(1) or
13(e)(1)
Intevac, Inc.
6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes Due
2004
4661148AA6
Kevin Fairbairn
Copies to:
Herbert P. Fockler, Esq.
CALCULATION OF FILING FEE
(2) $1,656.00 was previously paid.
Check the following box if the filing is a final
amendment reporting the results of the tender
offer:
o
This Amendment No. 2 to a Tender Offer
Statement on Schedule TO (the Statement) amends
and supplements the Statement originally filed by Intevac, Inc.,
a California corporation (Intevac or the
Company), on May 8, 2002, as amended on
May 24, 2002, in connection with its offer to exchange (the
Exchange Offer) each $1,000 aggregate principal
amount of its outstanding 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated
Notes due 2004 (the Existing Notes) tendered for
$1,000 principal amount of its new 6 1/2% Convertible
Subordinated Notes due 2009 (the Exchange Notes). As
of the date of this amendment, $37,545,000 principal amount of
Existing Notes are outstanding. The Exchange Offer is subject to
the terms and conditions set forth in the Offering Circular
dated June 6, 2002 (the Offering Circular) and
the related letter of transmittal (which, as either may be
amended or supplemented from time to time, together constitute
the Disclosure Documents).
The information in the Disclosure Documents,
including all schedules and annexes to the Disclosure Documents,
is incorporated by reference in answer to the items required in
the Statement, except as otherwise indicated. Except as amended
by this amendment and the revised Disclosure Documents, all of
the terms of the Exchange Offer and all disclosure set forth in
the Statement remain unchanged.
Item 5 hereby is amended and restated as follows:
(e) The information set forth above in
Item 4(b) and in the sections of the Offering Circular
titled Financing Strategy, Description of
Exchange Notes, Description of Existing Notes,
and Description of Warrants, are incorporated herein
by reference. The Company has entered into an employment
agreement with Kevin Fairbairn, our President and Chief
Executive Officer, which provides that the vesting of
Mr. Fairbairns options may accelerate upon a change
of control of the Company. The Exchange Offer would not be
considered a change of control of the Company. Except as
described in the Offering Circular and other than the respective
Indentures governing the Existing Notes and Exchange Notes and
the Warrant Agreement governing the Warrants, which are filed as
exhibits to this Schedule TO, no agreement, arrangement or
understanding exists between Intevac (including any person
specified in Instruction C of this Schedule TO) and any
other person with respect to any Existing Notes or Exchange
Notes or Warrants.
Item 7.
Source
and Amount of Funds or Other Consideration.
Item 7 is hereby amended and restated as
follows:
(a) Not applicable.
(b) Not applicable.
(d) Not applicable.
Item 12 hereby is amended and restated as follows:
1
2
SIGNATURE
After due inquiry and to the best of my knowledge
and belief, I certify that the information set forth in this
Amendment No. 2 to Schedule TO is true, complete and
correct.
Date: June 6, 2002
EXHIBIT INDEX
APPENDIX F
AMENDMENT NO. 4 TO SCHEDULE TO
The exchange agent:
State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A.
In person by hand only:
2 Avenue de Lafayette
By facsimile transmission (for eligible
institutions only):
(617) 662-1451
For information or confirmation by
telephone:
Ralph Jones
Any questions or requests for assistance or
additional copies of this prospectus and the letter of
transmittal may be directed to the exchange agent at its
telephone number and location set forth above. You may also
contact your broker, dealer, commercial bank or trust company or
other nominee for assistance concerning the exchange offer.
Any questions about the exchange offer may be
directed to Intevac at the following address:
Mr. Charles Eddy, Vice President
Name
Age
Position
Executive Officers and Directors:
63
48
47
51
74
67
58
54
76
(1)
Member of Audit Committee
(2)
Member of Compensation Committee
High
Low
$
8.000
$
3.500
$
4.625
$
2.688
$
7.090
$
3.313
$
5.130
$
3.130
$
5.890
$
3.500
$
5.950
$
4.400
$
4.980
$
1.950
$
4.240
$
2.380
Year Ended December 31,
2001
2000
1999
1998
1997
(In thousands, except per share data)
$
51,484
$
36,049
$
42,962
$
95,975
$
133,207
41,729
34,059
40,410
71,717
91,255
9,755
1,990
2,552
24,258
41,952
14,478
10,576
14,136
12,473
10,716
6,745
4,415
7,226
10,879
11,399
(638
)
3,069
1,088
299
21,223
14,353
24,431
24,710
22,414
(11,468
)
(12,363
)
(21,879
)
(452
)
19,538
(2,912
)
(3,033
)
(3,711
)
(4,187
)
(3,581
)
1,065
3,072
3,632
3,176
3,268
(13,315
)
(12,324
)
(21,958
)
(1,463
)
19,225
4,424
(8,344
)
(882
)
6,728
(17,739
)
(12,324
)
(13,614
)
(581
)
12,497
1,005
803
3,844
$
(16,936
)
$
(12,324
)
$
(9,770
)
$
424
$
12,497
$
(1.48
)
$
(1.04
)
$
(1.16
)
$
(0.05
)
$
1.00
$
(1.42
)
$
(1.04
)
$
(0.83
)
$
0.04
$
1.00
11,955
11,803
11,777
12,052
12,514
$
(1.48
)
$
(1.04
)
$
(1.16
)
$
(0.05
)
$
0.94
$
(1.42
)
$
(1.04
)
$
(0.83
)
$
0.03
$
0.94
11,955
11,803
11,777
12,354
15,385
$
18,157
$
38,403
$
40,895
$
60,916
$
71,142
27,160
41,093
51,579
77,774
78,025
60,165
83,936
94,382
122,976
147,794
37,545
41,245
43,188
59,461
59,480
1,408
17,804
29,623
40,436
42,435
significant underperformance relative to expected
historical or projected future operating results;
significant changes in the manner of our use of
the acquired assets or the strategy for our overall business;
significant negative industry or economic trends;
significant decline in our stock price for a
sustained period; and
our market capitalization relative to net book
value.
Fair
2002
2003
2004
2005
2006
Beyond
Total
Value
(Dollars in thousands)
$
37,545
$
37,545
$
20,087
6.50
%
6.50
%
6.50
%
Page
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
GRANT THORNTON LLP
ERNST & YOUNG LLP
December 31,
2001
2000
ASSETS
$
18,157
$
4,616
33,787
8,046
9,593
21,691
15,833
478
844
1,307
48,372
65,980
5,873
5,705
21,096
19,836
26,969
25,541
18,105
14,481
8,864
11,060
2,431
2,431
7
495
774
3
3,684
$
60,165
$
83,936
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS
EQUITY
$
242
$
814
1,904
2,386
1,943
1,573
1,534
3,547
2,375
13,464
16,317
21,212
24,887
37,545
41,245
19,093
18,675
122
(17,807
)
(871
)
1,408
17,804
$
60,165
$
83,936
Years Ended December 31,
2001
2000
1999
$
51,484
$
36,049
$
42,962
41,729
34,059
40,410
9,755
1,990
2,552
14,478
10,576
14,136
6,745
4,415
7,226
(638
)
3,069
21,223
14,353
24,431
(11,468
)
(12,363
)
(21,879
)
(2,912
)
(3,033
)
(3,711
)
1,245
2,341
2,100
(180
)
731
1,532
(13,315
)
(12,324
)
(21,958
)
4,424
(8,344
)
(17,739
)
(12,324
)
(13,614
)
803
3,844
$
(16,936
)
$
(12,324
)
$
(9,770
)
122
122
$
(16,814
)
$
(12,324
)
$
(9,770
)
$
(1.48
)
$
(1.04
)
$
(1.16
)
$
(1.42
)
$
(1.04
)
$
(0.83
)
11,955
11,803
11,777
Accumulated
Retained
Common Stock
Other
Earnings
Total
Comprehensive
(Accum.
Shareholders
Shares
Amount
Income
Deficit)
Equity
11,887
$
17,917
$
122
$
22,397
$
40,436
27
38
38
122
684
684
(321
)
(491
)
(1,174
)
(1,665
)
22
22
(122
)
(122
)
(9,770
)
(9,770
)
11,715
$
18,170
$
$
11,453
$
29,623
20
58
58
109
418
418
29
29
(12,324
)
(12,324
)
11,844
$
18,675
$
$
(871
)
$
17,804
41
13
13
119
405
405
122
122
(16,936
)
(16,936
)
12,004
$
19,093
$
122
$
(17,807
)
$
1,408
Years Ending December 31,
2001
2000
1999
$
(17,739
)
$
(12,324
)
$
(13,614
)
803
3,844
(16,936
)
(12,324
)
(9,770
)
3,916
3,721
3,805
4,988
2,734
251
2,342
1,578
(1,408
)
(6,199
)
125
(39
)
856
428
803
8
2
336
1,547
1,614
(1,038
)
(3,536
)
(343
)
4,147
366
(332
)
586
443
929
(1,020
)
639
(5,768
)
1,287
(2,853
)
6,466
(1,779
)
5,164
12,346
2,092
(11,772
)
22
(7,678
)
(5,463
)
(116,271
)
(50,880
)
38,447
120,084
70,205
(4,050
)
(2,990
)
(1,736
)
28,934
823
17,589
418
476
722
(1,665
)
(2,257
)
(9,664
)
(1,904
)
(3,743
)
476
(10,607
)
122
13,541
1,321
(696
)
4,616
3,295
3,991
$
18,157
$
4,616
$
3,295
$
2,715
$
2,789
$
3,555
2
2
(5,803
)
(3,099
)
$
(2,322
)
$
304
$
1,942
29
22
Basis of Presentation
Revenue Recognition
Warranty
International Distribution Costs
Customer Advances
Cash, Cash Equivalents and Short-term
Investments
Valuation of Long-lived and Intangible Assets
and Goodwill
significant underperformance relative to expected
historical or projected future operating results;
significant changes in the manner of our use of
the acquired assets or the strategy for our overall business;
significant negative industry or economic trends;
significant decline in our stock price for a
sustained period; and
our market capitalization relative to net book
value.
Foreign Exchange Contracts
Financial Instruments
Inventories
December 31,
2001
2000
(In thousands)
$
5,659
$
4,591
11,962
8,209
4,070
3,033
$
21,691
$
15,833
Property, Plant and Equipment
Intangible Assets
Comprehensive Income
Employee Stock Plans
Financial Presentation
Net loss Per Share
2001
2000
1999
(In thousands)
$
(17,739
)
$
(12,324
)
$
(13,614
)
803
3,844
$
(16,936
)
$
(12,324
)
$
(9,770
)
$
(16,936
)
$
(12,324
)
$
(9,770
)
$
(16,936
)
$
(12,324
)
$
(9,770
)
11,955
11,803
11,777
11,955
11,803
11,777
(1)
Diluted EPS for the twelve-month periods ended
December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999 excludes as
converted treatment of the Convertible Notes as their
inclusion would be anti-dilutive. The number of as
converted shares excluded from the twelve-month periods
ended December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999 was 1,954,910,
1,999,758 and 2,345,273, respectively
(2)
Diluted EPS for the twelve-month periods ended
December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999 excludes the effect of
employee stock options as their inclusion would be
anti-dilutive. The number of employee stock options excluded
from the twelve-month periods ended December 31, 2001, 2000
and 1999 was 114,017, 156,504 and 169,564, respectively
Use of Estimates
New Accounting Pronouncements
Credit Risk and Significant
Customers
Products
601 California Avenue LLC
IMAT Inc.
$
2,634
2,953
3,070
3,192
3,318
838
$
16,005
Segment Description
Segment Profit or Loss and Segment
Assets
Business Segment Net Revenues
2001
2000
1999
(In thousands)
$
42,723
$
28,797
$
36,008
8,761
7,252
6,954
$
51,484
$
36,049
$
42,962
Business Segment Profit & Loss
2001
2000
1999
(In thousands)
$
(7,234
)
$
(8,048
)
$
(16,667
)
(2,595
)
(2,164
)
(935
)
(1,639
)
(2,151
)
(4,277
)
(11,468
)
(12,363
)
(21,879
)
(2,912
)
(3,033
)
(3,711
)
1,245
2,341
2,100
(180
)
731
1,532
$
(13,315
)
$
(12,324
)
$
(21,958
)
(1)
Includes restructuring and other charge of $1,639
in 1999.
(2)
Includes restructuring and other charge of $2,128
in 1999.
Business Segment Assets
2001
2000
1999
(In thousands)
$
31,843
$
32,207
$
29,871
7,253
4,404
4,483
21,069
47,325
60,028
$
60,165
$
83,936
$
94,382
Business Segment Property, Plant &
Equipment
Additions
2001
2000
1999
(In thousands)
$
692
$
2,237
$
4,230
3,010
656
794
348
401
278
$
4,050
$
3,294
$
5,302
(1)
Includes inventory transferred to fixed assets of
$304 and $1,942 in 2000 and 1999, respectively.
Depreciation
2001
2000
1999
(In thousands)
$
2,559
$
2,387
$
2,808
799
716
512
558
618
485
$
3,916
$
3,721
$
3,805
Geographic Area Net Trade Revenues
2001
2000
1999
(In thousands)
$
14,154
$
26,466
$
17,254
36,363
9,414
25,372
827
49
234
140
120
102
$
51,484
$
36,049
$
42,962
Stock Option/ Stock Issuance Plans
2001
2000
1999
(In thousands, except per share data)
$
(18,634
)
$
(13,143
)
$
(14,871
)
$
(17,831
)
$
(13,143
)
$
(11,027
)
$
(1.56
)
$
(1.11
)
$
(1.26
)
$
(1.49
)
$
(1.11
)
$
(0.94
)
2001
2000
1999
Weighted-Average
Weighted-Average
Weighted-Average
Options
Exercise Price
Options
Exercise Price
Options
Exercise Price
1,570,297
$
5.39
1,496,370
$
5.82
1,599,762
$
6.92
341,900
3.90
336,100
3.75
399,100
4.70
(41,149
)
0.30
(20,261
)
2.86
(26,497
)
1.45
(66,526
)
5.23
(241,912
)
5.99
(475,995
)
8.82
1,804,522
5.23
1,570,297
5.39
1,496,370
5.82
1,062,742
$
5.88
878,157
$
5.84
797,470
$
5.81
$
1.93
$
2.20
$
2.64
Options Outstanding
Options Exercisable
Number
Weighted Average
Weighted
Number
Weighted
Range of
Outstanding As of
Remaining
Average
Exercisable As of
Average
Exercise Prices
December 31, 2001
Contractual Life
Exercise Price
December 31, 2001
Exercise Price
101,312
3.40 yrs
$
2.02
96,112
$
1.97
206,400
9.80 yrs
$
3.20
500
$
3.20
220,000
8.47 yrs
$
3.38
60,000
$
3.38
191,950
8.14 yrs
$
3.85
68,070
$
3.84
260,300
8.41 yrs
$
5.13
131,000
$
5.16
353,161
3.61 yrs
$
6.00
353,161
$
6.00
189,000
6.74 yrs
$
6.46
119,760
$
6.47
181,899
4.88 yrs
$
7.48
164,439
$
7.51
100,500
6.14 yrs
$
10.45
69,700
$
11.48
1,804,522
6.67 yrs
$
5.23
1,062,742
$
5.88
Years Ended December 31,
2001
2000
1999
$
(492
)
$
$
(8,552
)
3,771
843
3,279
(7,709
)
(113
)
2
1,217
(637
)
1,104
(635
)
41
$
4,424
$
$
(8,344
)
December 31,
2001
2000
$
1,260
$
812
1,237
898
5,505
3,959
1,767
735
6,745
4,903
428
222
16,942
11,529
(16,890
)
(6,339
)
$
52
$
5,190
$
52
$
202
$
52
$
202
$
$
4,988
Years Ended December 31,
2001
2000
1999
$
(4,730
)
$
(4,314
)
$
(7,685
)
(408
)
(640
)
(413
)
(14
)
(467
)
713
366
(1,033
)
44
650
(145
)
10,551
3,605
$
4,424
$
$
(8,344
)
Building
RPC Operation
Closure
Discontinuance
Restructuring
Restructuring
(In thousands)
$
2,225
$
1,639
(511
)
(851
)
(97
)
1,617
788
(815
)
(365
)
(361
)
(615
)
187
62
(162
)
(61
)
25
1
(2
)
(1
)
(23
)
$
$
December 31,
2001
2000
(In thousands)
$
$
351
908
745
813
894
1,241
269
585
116
$
3,547
$
2,375
Three Months Ended
March 31,
June 30,
Sept. 29,
Dec. 31,
2001
2001
2001
2001
(In thousands, except per share data)
$
10,005
$
9,490
$
8,414
$
23,575
3,400
(181
)
1,682
4,854
(3,784
)
(4,540
)
(5,356
)
(3,256
)
$
(0.32
)
$
(0.38
)
$
(0.45
)
$
(0.27
)
Three Months Ended
April 1,
July 1,
Sept. 30,
Dec. 31,
2000
2000
2000
2000
(In thousands, except per share data)
$
5,892
$
9,191
$
11,036
$
9,930
651
1,808
604
(1,073
)
(2,861
)
(701
)
(3,409
)
(5,353
)
$
(0.24
)
$
(0.06
)
$
(0.29
)
$
(0.45
)
Item 9.
Changes In and Disagreements With
Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
1. The following
consolidated financial statements of Intevac, Inc. are filed in
Part II, Item 8 of this Report on Form 10-K:
Report of Grant Thornton LLP, Independent Auditors
Report of Ernst & Young LLP, Independent
Auditors
Consolidated Balance Sheets
December 31, 2001 and 2000
Consolidated Statements of Operations and
Comprehensive Loss for the years ended December 31, 2001,
2000 and 1999
Consolidated Statement of Shareholders
Equity for the years ended December 31, 2001, 2000
and 1999
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the
years ended December 31, 2001, 2000 and 1999
Notes to Consolidated Financial
Statements Years Ended December 31, 2001, 2000
and 1999
2.
Financial
Statement Schedules.
The following financial statement schedule of
Intevac, Inc. is filed in Part IV, Item 14(a) of this
Annual Report on Form 10-K:
Schedule II Valuation and
Qualifying Accounts
All other schedules have been omitted since the
required information is not present in amounts sufficient to
require submission of the schedule or because the information
required is included in the consolidated financial statements or
notes thereto.
3.
Exhibits
Exhibit
Number
Description
Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation of
the Registrant
Bylaws of the Registrant
Indenture, dated as of February 15, 1997,
between the Company and State Street Bank and Trust Company of
California, N.A. as Trustee, including the form of the
Convertible Notes
The Registrants 1991 Stock Option/ Stock
Issuance Plan
The Registrants 1995 Stock Option/ Stock
Issuance Plan, as amended
The Registrants Employee Stock Purchase
Plan, as amended
Lease, dated February 5, 2001 regarding the
space located at 3560, 3570 and 3580 Bassett Street, Santa
Clara, California
601 California Avenue LLC Limited Liability
Operating Agreement, dated July 28, 1995
The Registrants 401(k) Profit Sharing Plan
Stock Purchase Agreement by and among Lotus
Technologies, Inc., Lewis Lipton, Dennis Stark, Steve Romine and
Intevac, Inc., dated June 6, 1996
Subsidiaries of the Registrant
Consent of Grant Thornton LLP, Independent
Auditors
Consent of Ernst & Young LLP, Independent
Auditors
Power of Attorney (see page 46)
*
Previously filed as an exhibit to the
Registration Statement on Form S-1 (No. 33-97806)
**
Previously filed as an exhibit to the
Registration Statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-05531)
***
Previously filed as an exhibit to the
Registration Statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-24275)
****
Incorporated by reference to the Companys
Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended
December 31, 2000
INTEVAC, INC.
BY:
/s/ CHARLES B. EDDY III
Charles B. Eddy, III
Vice President, Finance and Administration,
Chief Financial Officer, Treasurer and Secretary (Principal
Financial and Accounting Officer)
Signature
Title
Date
/s/ KEVIN FAIRBAIRN
(Kevin Fairbairn)
President, Chief Executive Officer and Director
(Principal Executive Officer)
March 18, 2002
/s/ NORMAN H. POND
(Norman H. Pond)
Chairman of the Board
March 18, 2002
/s/ CHARLES B. EDDY III
(Charles B. Eddy III)
Vice President, Finance and Administration, Chief
Financial Officer Treasurer and Secretary (Principal Financial
and Accounting Officer)
March 18, 2002
/s/ EDWARD DURBIN
(Edward Durbin)
Director
March 18, 2002
/s/ GEORGE L. FARINSKY
(George L. Farinsky)
Director
March 18, 2002
/s/ ROBERT D. HEMPSTEAD
(Robert D. Hempstead)
Director
March 18, 2002
/s/ DAVID N. LAMBETH
(David N. Lambeth)
Director
March 18, 2002
/s/ H. JOSEPH SMEAD
(H. Joseph Smead)
Director
March 18, 2002
Additions (Reductions)
Charged
Charged
Balance at
(Credited)
(Credited)
Balance at
Beginning
to Costs and
to Other
End
Description
of Period
Expenses
Accounts
Deductions - Describe(1)
of Period
$
1,629,348
$
151,802
$
0
$
68,074
$
1,713,076
$
1,713,076
$
(1,544,172
)
$
(2,892
)
$
52,500
$
113,512
$
113,512
$
40,415
$
70,833
$
(484
)
$
225,344
(1)
Typically includes write-offs of amounts deemed
uncollectible.
Exhibit
Number
Description
* 3.1
Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation of
the Registrant
* 3.2
Bylaws of the Registrant
*** 4.2
Indenture, dated as of February 15, 1997,
between the Company and State Street Bank and Trust Company of
California, N.A. as Trustee, including the form of the
Convertible Notes
* 10.1
The Registrants 1991 Stock Option/ Stock
Issuance Plan
* 10.2
The Registrants 1995 Stock Option/ Stock
Issuance Plan, as amended
* 10.3
The Registrants Employee Stock Purchase
Plan, as amended
**** 10.5
Lease, dated February 5, 2001 regarding the
space located at 3560, 3570 and 3580 Bassett Street, Santa
Clara, California
* 10.8
601 California Avenue LLC Limited Liability
Operating Agreement, dated July 28, 1995
* 10.9
The Registrants 401(k) Profit Sharing Plan
** 10.13
Stock Purchase Agreement by and among Lotus
Technologies, Inc., Lewis Lipton, Dennis Stark, Steve Romine and
Intevac, Inc., dated June 6, 1996
21.1
Subsidiaries of the Registrant
23.1
Consent of Grant Thornton LLP, Independent
Auditors
23.2
Consent of Ernst & Young LLP, Independent
Auditors
24.1
Power of Attorney (see page 46)
*
Previously filed as an exhibit to the
Registration Statement on Form S-1 (No. 33-97806)
**
Previously filed as an exhibit to the
Registration Statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-05531)
***
Previously filed as an exhibit to the
Registration Statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-24275)
****
Incorporated by reference to the Companys
Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended
December 31, 2000.
/s/ GRANT THORNTON LLP
/s/ ERNST & YOUNG LLP
(MARK ONE)
x
QUARTERLY
REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE
SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the quarterly period ended March 30,
2002
OR
o
TRANSITION
REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE
SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
For the transition period
from to
94-3125814
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
(IRS Employer
Identification No.)
No.
Page
FINANCIAL INFORMATION
Financial Statements (unaudited)
Condensed Consolidated Balance Sheets
2
Condensed Consolidated Statements of Operations
and Comprehensive Loss
3
Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
4
Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial
Statements
5
Managements Discussion and Analysis of
Financial Condition and Results of Operations
9
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About
Market Risk
17
OTHER INFORMATION
Legal Proceedings
18
Changes in Securities
18
Defaults Upon Senior Securities
18
Submission of Matters to a Vote of
Security-Holders
18
Other Information
19
Exhibits and Reports on Form 8-K
19
SIGNATURES
20
March 30,
December 31,
2002
2001
(Unaudited)
ASSETS
$
14,464
$
18,157
10,078
8,046
2,214
23,222
21,691
711
478
50,689
48,372
7,735
8,864
2,431
2,431
441
498
$
61,296
$
60,165
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS
EQUITY
$
2,259
$
2,628
1,797
1,573
3,755
3,547
16,519
13,464
24,330
21,212
37,545
37,545
19,237
19,093
135
122
(19,951
)
(17,807
)
(579
)
1,408
$
61,296
$
60,165
Three months ended
March 30,
March 31,
2002
2001
$
6,670
$
10,005
5,707
6,605
963
3,400
3,129
3,496
1,710
1,669
4,839
5,165
(3,876
)
(1,765
)
(667
)
(738
)
185
(1,292
)
(4,358
)
(3,795
)
(2,214
)
$
(2,144
)
$
(3,795
)
13
11
$
(2,131
)
$
(3,784
)
$
(0.18
)
$
(0.32
)
12,041
11,896
Three months ended
March 30,
March 31,
2002
2001
$
(2,144
)
$
(3,795
)
841
1,128
(1
)
2,000
(2,378
)
(3,714
)
(1,537
)
(587
)
(3,681
)
(4,382
)
(5,463
)
32,277
(169
)
(582
)
(169
)
26,232
144
216
144
216
13
11
(3,693
)
22,077
18,157
4,616
$
14,464
$
26,693
$
1,220
$
1,374
March 30,
December 31,
2002
2001
(in thousands)
$
5,664
$
5,659
9,187
11,962
8,371
4,070
$
23,222
$
21,691
Three months ended
March 30,
March 31,
2002
2001
(in thousands)
(2,144
)
(3,795
)
$
(2,144
)
$
(3,795
)
12,041
11,896
12,041
11,896
(1)
Diluted EPS for the three-month periods ended
March 30, 2002 and March 31, 2001 exclude as
converted treatment of the convertible notes as their
inclusion would be anti-dilutive. The number of as
converted shares excluded for the three-month periods
ended March 30, 2002 and March 31, 2001 was 1,820,364
and 1,999,758, respectively.
(2)
Diluted EPS for the three-month periods ended
March 30, 2002 and March 31, 2001 exclude the effect
of employee stock options as their inclusion would be
anti-dilutive. The number of employee stock option shares
excluded for the three-month periods ended March 30, 2002
and March 31, 2001 was 59,882 and 173,590, respectively.
Segment Description
Business Segment Net Revenues
Three months ended
March 30,
March 31,
2002
2001
(in thousands)
$
4,935
$
7,932
1,735
2,073
$
6,670
$
10,005
Business Segment Profit & Loss
Three months ended
March 30,
March 31,
2002
2001
(in thousands)
$
(2,651
)
$
(563
)
(698
)
(662
)
(527
)
(540
)
(3,876
)
(1,765
)
(667
)
(738
)
74
581
111
(1,873
)
$
(4,358
)
$
(3,795
)
Geographic Area Net Trade Revenues
Three months ended
March 30,
March 31,
2002
2001
(in thousands)
$
4,237
$
3,101
2,133
6,704
300
60
140
$
6,670
$
10,005
The majority of Intevacs new products
address new and emerging markets.
Demand for capital equipment is
cyclical.
The Equipment Business is subject to rapid
technical change.
The Photonics Business does not yet generate
significant revenues from product sales.
The sales of our Equipment products are
dependent on substantial capital investment by our
customers.
Rapid increases in areal density are reducing
the number of thin-film disks required per disk drive.
Our competitors are large and well financed
and competition is intense.
Intevacs business is dependent on its
intellectual property.
any of Intevacs pending or future patent
applications will be allowed or that any of the allowed
applications will be issued as patents, or
any patent owned by Intevac will not be
invalidated, deemed unenforceable, circumvented or challenged, or
the rights granted under our patents will provide
competitive advantages to Intevac, or
any of Intevacs pending or future patent
applications will be issued with claims of the scope sought by
Intevac, if at all, or
others will not develop similar products,
duplicate Intevacs products or design around the patents
owned by Intevac, or
patent rights, intellectual property laws or
Intevacs agreements will adequately protect Intevacs
intellectual property rights.
Our operating results fluctuate
significantly.
Operating costs in northern California are
high.
Business interruptions could adversely affect
our business.
A majority of our sales are to international
customers.
Intevacs stock price is
volatile.
Intevac routinely evaluates acquisition
candidates and other diversification strategies.
Intevac uses hazardous materials.
A majority of the Common Stock outstanding is
controlled by the directors and executive officers of
Intevac.
Fair
2002
2003
2004
2005
2006
Beyond
Total
Value
(in thousands)
$
37,545
$
37,545
$
20,697
6.50
%
6.50
%
6.50
%
(a)
The following exhibits are filed herewith:
Exhibit
Number
Description
3.2
Revised Bylaws of the Registrant
10.10
Compensation Package for Kevin Fairbairn, dated
January 24, 2002
(b)
Reports on Form 8-K:
INTEVAC, INC.
By:
/s/ KEVIN FAIRBAIRN
Kevin Fairbairn
President, Chief Executive Officer and Director
(Principal Executive Officer)
By:
/s/ CHARLES B. EDDY III
Charles B. Eddy III
Vice President, Finance and Administration,
Chief Financial Officer, Treasurer and Secretary
(Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)
Exhibit
Description
3.2
Revised Bylaws of the Registrant
10.10
Compensation Package for Kevin Fairbairn, dated
January 24, 2002.
Sincerely yours,
/s/ KEVIN FAIRBAIRN
Kevin Fairbairn
President and Chief Executive
Officer
1. To elect directors to serve for the
ensuing year or until their respective successors are duly
elected and qualified. The nominees are Norman H. Pond, Kevin
Fairbairn, Edward Durbin, George L. Farinsky, Robert D.
Hempstead, David N. Lambeth and H. Joseph Smead.
2. To ratify the appointment of Grant
Thornton LLP as independent accountants of the Company for the
fiscal year ending December 31, 2002.
3. To transact such other business as
may properly come before the meeting or any adjournment thereof.
BY ORDER OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS
[-s- Charles B. Eddy]
CHARLES B. EDDY III
Vice President, Finance and
Administration,
Chief Financial Officer, Treasurer and
Secretary
Name
Position(s) with the Company
Age
Chairman of the Board
63
President and Chief Executive Officer
48
Director
74
Director
67
Director
58
Director
55
Director
76
(1)
Member of the Audit Committee
(2)
Member of the Compensation Committee
Audit Fees:
Financial Information Systems Design and
Implementation Fees:
All Other Fees:
Amount and Nature of
Beneficial Ownership(1)
Name and Address of Beneficial Owner
Number of Shares
Percent Owned(2)
5,600,000
46.4
%
395 Mill Creek Circle
Vail, CO 81657
1,109,675
9.0
%
3560 Basset Street
Santa Clara, CA 95054
906,700
7.5
%
P.O. Box 7842
Madison, WI 53707
2,000
*
167,182
1.4
%
82,615
*
5,682,015
46.8
%
35,000
*
138,799
1.1
%
45,000
*
5,637,683
46.7
%
7,299,969
57.3
%
*
Less than 1%.
(1)
Except as indicated in the footnotes to this
table and pursuant to applicable community property laws, the
persons named in the table have sole voting and investment power
with respect to all shares of Common Stock. The number of shares
beneficially owned includes Common Stock of which such
individual has the right to acquire beneficial ownership either
currently or within 60 days after March 15, 2002,
including, but not limited to, upon the exercise of an option or
conversion of convertible debt.
(2)
Percentage of beneficial ownership is based upon
12,060,003 shares of Common Stock that were outstanding
March 15, 2002. For each individual, this percentage
includes Common Stock of which such individual has the right to
acquire beneficial ownership either currently or within
60 days of March 15, 2002, including, but not limited
to, upon the exercise of an option or conversion of convertible
debt; however, such Common Stock is not considered outstanding
for the purpose of computing the percentage owned by any other
individual as required by General Rule 13d-3(d)(1)(i) under
the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.
(3)
Includes 818,100 shares held by the Norman Hugh
Pond and Natalie Pond Trust DTD 12/23/80; 37,500 shares plus
60,363 shares held in the form of Intevacs Convertible
Subordinated Notes due March 2004, both held by the Pond 1996
Charitable Remainder Unitrust, both of whose trustees are Norman
Hugh Pond and Natalie Pond; options exercisable for 163,333
shares of Common Stock outstanding under the Companys 1995
Plan and 11,879 shares held in the form of Intevacs
Convertible Subordinated Notes due March 2004.
(4)
Includes 84,141 shares held by the Eddy Family
Trust DTD 02/09/00, whose trustees are Charles Brown Eddy III
and Melissa White Eddy, options exercisable for 70,466 shares of
Common Stock under the 1995 Plan and 2,424 shares held in the
form of Intevacs Convertible Subordinated Notes due March
2004.
(5)
Includes options exercisable for 40,399 shares of
Common Stock under the 1995 Plan.
(6)
Includes options exercisable for 32,500 shares of
Common Stock under the 1995 Plan, 47,515 shares held in the form
of Intevacs Convertible Subordinated Notes due March 2004
and 5,600,000 shares held by Foster City LLC. Mr. Durbin is
a director of the Company and a managing member of Foster City.
Mr. Durbin disclaims beneficial ownership in the shares of
the Company held by Foster City except to the extent of his
pecuniary interest therein arising from his interest in Foster
City.
(7)
Includes options exercisable for 35,000 shares of
Common Stock under the 1995 Plan.
(8)
Includes options exercisable for 134,999 shares
of Common Stock under the 1995 Plan.
(9)
Includes options exercisable for 45,000 shares of
Common Stock under the 1995 Plan.
(10)
Includes options exercisable for 22,500 shares of
Common Stock under the 1995 Plan and 5,600,000 shares held by
Foster City LLC. Dr. Smead is a director of the Company and
a managing member of Foster City. Dr. Smead disclaims
beneficial ownership in the shares of the Company held by Foster
City except to the extent of his pecuniary interest therein
arising from his interest in Foster City.
(11)
Includes options exercisable for 542,197 shares
of Common Stock under the 1995 Plan and 122,181 shares held in
the form of Intevacs Convertible Subordinated Notes due
March 2004.
Long-Term
Compensation
Awards
Annual Compensation
Securities
Underlying
All Other
Name and Principal Position
Years
Salary($)(1)
Bonus
Options(#)
Compensation(2)
2001
$
349,313
$
4,456
2000
292,724
2,966
1999
262,432
3,579
2001
289,016
2,427
2000
111,064
50,000
200,000
907
1999
2001
181,456
5,000
2,359
2000
173,664
1,094
1999
157,498
7,000
1,028
2001
183,914
5,000
2,238
2000
176,243
975
1999
156,801
10,000
1,022
(1)
Includes salary deferral contributions to the
Companys 401(k) Plan.
(2)
The indicated amount for each Named Executive
Officer comprises the contributions made by the Company on
behalf of such individual to the Companys 401(k) Plan,
which match part of such officers salary deferral
contributions to that plan, plus the cost of any life insurance
in excess of $50,000 paid by the Company.
(3)
Dr. Rode joined the Company in June 2000 as
Chief Executive Officer and President of the Equipment Division.
He was paid a bonus upon beginning employment with the Company.
Dr. Rode resigned his position with the Company in
September 2001.
Individual Grants
Potential Realizable
Value at Assumed Annual
Number of
Percent of
Rates of Stock Price
Securities
Total Options
Appreciation for Option
Underlying
Granted to
Exercise or
Term(1)
Options
Employees in
Base Price
Expiration
Name
Granted(2)
2001
($/Share)(3)
Date
5%
10%
5,000
1.6
%
$
3.200
10/19/11
$
10,062
$
25,500
5,000
1.6
%
3.200
10/19/11
10,062
25,500
(1)
There can be no assurance that the actual stock
price appreciation over the 10-year option term will be at the
5% and 10% assumed annual rates of compounded stock price
appreciation or at any other defined level. Unless the market
price of the Common Stock appreciates over the option term, no
value will be realized from the option grants made to the Named
Executive Officer.
(2)
Option shares generally vest in a series of five
(5) successive equal annual installments upon the
optionees completion of each year of service over the
five-year period measured from the grant date. In addition, the
option shares vest in full upon an acquisition of the Company by
merger or asset sale, unless such option is assumed by the
acquiring entity. Each option has a maximum term of
10 years measured from the option grant date, subject to
earlier termination following the optionees cessation of
service with the Company. Each option also includes a limited
stock appreciation right which provides the optionee with a
right, exercisable upon the successful completion of a hostile
tender offer for fifty percent or more of the Companys
outstanding voting securities, to surrender the option to the
Company, to the extent the option is at that time exercisable
for vested shares, in return for a cash distribution per
surrendered option share equal to the excess of (i) the
highest price per share of Common Stock paid in the hostile
tender offer over (ii) the option exercise price payable
per share.
(3)
The exercise price may be paid in cash, in shares
of the Companys Common Stock valued at fair market value
on the exercise date, or through a cashless exercise procedure
involving a same-day sale of the purchased shares. The Company
may also finance the option exercise by loaning the optionee
sufficient funds to pay the exercise price for the purchased
shares, plus any Federal and state income tax liability incurred
by the optionee in connection with such exercise.
Number of
Securities
Value of
Underlying
Unexercised
Unexercised
In-the-Money
Options/SARs at
Options/SARs at
Fiscal Year-End(#)
Fiscal Year-End
Shares Acquired
Value
Exercisable/
Exercisable/
Name
on Exercise(#)
Realized(1)
Unexercisable
Unexercisable(2)
163,333/0
$
0/0
40,000/160,000
$
0/0
69,466/12,200
$
1,811/0
39,399/18,000
$
1,995/0
(1)
Equal to the fair market value of the purchased
shares on the option exercise date less the exercise price paid
for those shares.
(2)
Based on the market price of $2.380 per share,
which was the closing selling price per share of the
Companys Common Stock on the Nasdaq National Market on the
last day of the 2001 fiscal year, less the exercise price
payable for such shares. Options for which the exercise price is
greater than $2.380 are excluded from this calculation.
the plan for, and the independent auditors
report on, each audit of the Companys financial statements;
the Companys financial disclosure
documents, including the financial statements and reports
included in filings with the SEC or sent to shareholders, as
well as the Companys internal accounting controls, and
accounting and financial personnel;
changes in the Companys accounting
practices, principles, controls or methodologies, or in the
presentations contained in the Companys financial
statements, and recent developments in accounting rules.
BY ORDER OF THE BOARD OF DIRECTORS
-s- Charles B. Eddy III
CHARLES B. EDDY III
Vice President, Finance and
Administration,
Chief Financial Officer, Treasurer and
Secretary
Transaction Valuation*
Amount of Filing Fee
$1,656.00
*
Estimated for the purpose of calculating the
amount of the filing fee only. Intevac, Inc. is offering to
exchange each $5,000 aggregate principal amount of its
outstanding 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2004
(the Existing Notes) tendered for (a) $2,000 in
cash, (b) 250 warrants, each to purchase one share of
Intevac Common Stock, and (c) $1,000 principal amount of
its new 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2009 (the
Exchange Notes) up to a maximum of $18,000,000
principal amount of Existing Notes tendered. The estimated
transaction value is the value of the maximum amount of Existing
Notes that Intevac may receive from tendering holders in the
exchange offer above, which value, calculated in accordance with
Rule 0-11(b) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended, is the book value as of April 30, 2002 of the
Exchange Notes issued as above. The amount of the filing fee,
calculated in accordance with Rule 0-11(b) of the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, equals one-fiftieth
of one percent of the transaction value.
o
Check the box if any part of the fee is offset as
provided by Rule 0-11(a)(2) and identify the filing with
which the offsetting fee was previously paid. Identify the
previous filing by registration statement number, or the Form or
Schedule and the date of its filing.
o
Check the box if the filing relates solely to
preliminary communications made before the commencement of a
tender offer.
Check the appropriate boxes below to designate
any transactions to which the statement relates:
o
third-party tender offer subject to
Rule 14d-1.
x
issuer tender offer subject to Rule 13e-4.
o
going-private transaction subject to
Rule 13e-3.
o
amendment to Schedule 13D under
Rule 13d-2
Name
Position
Chairman of the Board
President, Chief Executive Officer and Director
President of Photonics Division
Vice President, Finance and Administration, Chief
Financial Officer, Treasurer and Secretary
Director
Director
Director
Director
Item 8.
Interest in Securities of the Subject
Company.
Amount Held
No. of Shares of
Common Stock
Issuable upon
Principal
Conversion of
Amount of
the Existing
Existing
Percentage of Existing
Name and Position
Notes
Notes Value
Notes Held
72,242
$
1,490,000
4.0
%
Chairman of the Board
2,424
$
50,000
0.1
%
Vice President, Finance and Administration,
Chief Financial Officer, Treasurer and Secretary
47,515
$
980,000
2.6
%
Director
Item 9.
Person/Assets, Retained, Employed,
Compensated or Used.
Item 10.
Financial Statements.
Item 11.
Additional Information.
Item 12.
Exhibits.
Exhibit
No.
Description
Offering Circular dated May 8, 2002.(1)
Letter of Transmittal.(1)
Letter to Broker-Dealers.(1)
Letter to Clients.(1)
Notice of Guaranteed Delivery.(1)
Guidelines for Certification of Taxpayer
Identification Number on Substitute IRS Form W-9.(1)
Press release dated May 8, 2002.(1)
Investor Presentation.(1)
Indenture, dated as of February 15, 1997,
between Intevac and State Street Bank and Trust Company of
California, N.A.(2)
Form of Indenture between Intevac and State
Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A.(1)
Form of Warrant Agreement between Intevac and
State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A.(1)
(1)
Filed herewith.
(2)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to
Intevacs Registration Statement on Form S-3
(File No. 333-24275).
INTEVAC, INC.
By:
/s/ KEVIN FAIRBAIRN
Name: Kevin Fairbairn
Title: President and Chief Executive Officer
Exhibit
No.
Description
Offering Circular dated May 8, 2002.(1)
Letter of Transmittal.(1)
Letter to Broker-Dealers.(1)
Letter to Clients.(1)
Notice of Guaranteed Delivery.(1)
Guidelines for Certification of Taxpayer
Identification Number on Substitute IRS Form W-9.(1)
Press release dated May 8, 2002.(1)
Investor Presentation.(1)
Indenture, dated as of February 15, 1997,
between Intevac and State Street Bank and Trust Company of
California, N.A.(2)
Form of Indenture between Intevac and State
Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A.(1)
Form of Warrant Agreement between Intevac and
State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A.(1)
(1)
Filed herewith.
(2)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to
Intevacs Registration Statement on Form S-3
(File No. 333-24275).
Transaction Valuation(1)
Amount of Filing Fee(2)
$3,454.14
(1)
Estimated for the purpose of calculating the
amount of the filing fee only. Intevac, Inc. is offering to
exchange each $1,000 aggregate principal amount of its
outstanding 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2004
(the Existing Notes) tendered for $1,000 principal
amount of its new 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due
2009 (the Exchange Notes). The estimated transaction
value is the value of the maximum amount of Existing Notes that
Intevac may receive from tendering holders in the exchange offer
above, which value, calculated in accordance with
Rule 0-11(b) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as
amended, is the book value as of April 30, 2002 of the
Exchange Notes issued as above. The amount of the filing fee,
calculated in accordance with the Securities Exchange Act of
1934, as amended, equals $92 for each $1,000,000 of value.
o
Check the box if any part of the fee is offset as
provided by Rule 0-11(a)(2) and identify the filing with
which the offsetting fee was previously paid. Identify the
previous filing by registration statement number, or the Form or
Schedule and the date of its filing.
o
Check the box if the filing relates solely to
preliminary communications made before the commencement of a
tender offer.
Check the appropriate boxes below to designate
any transactions to which the statement relates:
o
third-party tender offer subject to
Rule 14d-1.
x
issuer tender offer subject to Rule 13e-4.
o
going-private transaction subject to
Rule 13e-3.
o
amendment to Schedule 13D under
Rule 13d-2
Item 5.
Past Contracts, Transactions, Negotiations
and Agreements.
Item 12.
Exhibits.
Exhibit
No.
Description
(a)(1)(a)
Offering Circular dated June 6, 2002.(1)
(a)(1)(b)
Letter of Transmittal.(1)
(a)(1)(c)
Letter to Broker-Dealers.(1)
(a)(1)(d)
Letter to Clients.(1)
(a)(1)(e)
Notice of Guaranteed Delivery.(1)
(a)(1)(f)
Guidelines for Certification of Taxpayer
Identification Number on Substitute IRS Form W-9.(2)
(a)(5)(a)
Press release dated May 8, 2002.(2)
Exhibit
No.
Description
(a)(5)(b)
Investor Presentation.(2)
(a)(5)(c)
Press release dated June 6, 2002.(1)
(d)(1)
Indenture, dated as of February 15, 1997,
between Intevac and State Street Bank and Trust Company of
California, N.A.(3)
(d)(2)
Form of Indenture between Intevac and State
Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A.(4)
(1)
Filed herewith.
(2)
Incorporated by reference to Intevacs
Tender Offer Statement on Schedule T-O (file
no. 5-484501, filed on May 8, 2002)
(3)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to
Intevacs Registration Statement on Form S-3
(file no. 333-24275).
(4)
To be filed by amendment.
INTEVAC, INC.
By:
/s/ KEVIN FAIRBAIRN
Name: Kevin Fairbairn
Title: President and Chief Executive Officer
Exhibit
No.
Description
(a)(1)(a)
Offering Circular dated June 6, 2002.(1)
(a)(1)(b)
Letter of Transmittal.(1)
(a)(1)(c)
Letter to Broker-Dealers.(1)
(a)(1)(d)
Letter to Clients.(1)
(a)(1)(e)
Notice of Guaranteed Delivery.(1)
(a)(1)(f)
Guidelines for Certification of Taxpayer
Identification Number on Substitute IRS Form W-9.(2)
(a)(5)(a)
Press release dated May 8, 2002.(2)
(a)(5)(b)
Investor Presentation.(2)
(a)(5)(c)
Press release dated June 6, 2002.(1)
(d)(1)
Indenture, dated as of February 15, 1997,
between Intevac and State Street Bank and Trust Company of
California, N.A.(3)
(d)(2)
Form of Indenture between Intevac and State
Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A.(4)
(1)
Filed herewith.
(2)
Incorporated by reference to Intevacs
Tender Offer Statement on Schedule T-O (file
no. 5-484501, filed on May 8, 2002)
(3)
Incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to
Intevacs Registration Statement on Form S-3
(file no. 333-24275).
(4)
To be filed by amendment.
INTEVAC, INC.
LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL
Exchange Offer for Outstanding
Pursuant to the Offering Circular dated June 21, 2002
THE EXCHANGE OFFER WILL EXPIRE AT 12:00 MIDNIGHT, EASTERN TIME, ON JULY 9, 2002 UNLESS EXTENDED (THE EXPIRATION DATE). TENDERS MAY BE WITHDRAWN PRIOR TO 12:00 MIDNIGHT, EASTERN TIME, ON THE EXPIRATION DATE.
Delivery To:
State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A.
For Information or Confirmation by Telephone Call:
(617) 662-1548
By Facsimile Transmission (for Eligible Institutions only):
(617) 662-1451
DELIVERY OF THIS INSTRUMENT AND ALL OTHER DOCUMENTS TO AN ADDRESS OTHER THAN AS SET FORTH ABOVE, OR TRANSMISSION OF INSTRUCTIONS VIA FACSIMILE OTHER THAN AS SET FORTH ABOVE, WILL NOT CONSTITUTE A VALID DELIVERY. THE INSTRUCTIONS SET FORTH IN THIS LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL SHOULD BE READ CAREFULLY BEFORE COMPLETING THIS LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL.
By signing this revised Letter of Transmittal (the Letter), you acknowledge that you have received and reviewed the Offering Circular, dated June 21, 2002 (the Offering Circular), of Intevac, Inc., a California corporation (Intevac or the Company), and this Letter, which together constitute Intevacs offer (the Exchange Offer) to exchange for each $1,000 principal amount of its 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2004 (the Existing Notes) the following:
| $185 in cash, and | |
| $815 of its new 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2009 (the Exchange Notes). |
The Exchange Notes will be issued in denominations of $1,000 principal amount or integral multiple thereof. We will pay cash for any fractional portion of an Exchange Note that is less than $1,000 principal amount as a result of the exchange, after aggregating all Existing Notes tendered.
The Exchange Offer is conditioned on at least $30 million principal amount of Existing Notes being tendered in the Exchange Offer by the registered holders thereof (the Holders) and is also subject to a number of other conditions set forth in The Exchange Offer Conditions to the Completion of the Exchange Offer section of the Offering Circular. Capitalized terms used but not defined herein have the meanings assigned to them in the Offering Circular.
To tender Existing Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer, the Exchange Agent must, prior to the Expiration Date, receive at the address listed above:
| with respect to Existing Notes held in certificated form, a properly completed and duly executed Letter and all other documents required by this Letter and the certificates for the Existing Notes being tendered, in proper form for transfer, and | |
| with respect to beneficial interests in Existing Notes held in global form, delivery of such Existing Notes pursuant to the procedures for book-entry transfer described in the Offering Circular under the caption The Exchange Offer Procedures for Tendering Existing Notes as well as a confirmation of such delivery including an Agents Message, as defined below, or in lieu of such Agents Message, a properly completed and duly executed Letter. |
This Letter is to be completed by any Holder (i) if certificates representing Existing Notes are to be forwarded herewith or (ii) if delivery of Existing Notes is to be made by book-entry transfer to the account maintained by the Exchange Agent at the Depository Trust Company (DTC) and the Holder elects to submit this Letter to the Exchange Agent in lieu of an Agents Message. Holders who desire to tender their Existing Notes for exchange and (i) whose Existing Notes are not immediately available, (ii) who cannot deliver their Existing Notes and all other documents required hereby to the Exchange Agent on or prior to the Expiration Date, or (iii) who are unable to deliver confirmation of the book-entry tender of their Existing Notes into the Exchange Agents account at DTC (a Book-Entry Confirmation) and all other documents required by this Letter to the Exchange Agent on or prior to the Expiration Date, in each case, must tender their Existing Notes, according to the guaranteed delivery procedures set forth in The Exchange Offer Guaranteed Delivery Procedures section of the Offering Circular. The term Agents Message means a message, transmitted by DTC and received by the Exchange Agent, that forms part of a Book-Entry Confirmation and states that DTC has received an express acknowledgment from the Holder tendering the Existing Notes that are the subject of the Book-Entry Confirmation that the Holder has received and agrees to be bound by the terms of this Letter, and that we may enforce such agreement against the Holder.
Delivery of documents to DTCs book-entry transfer facility does not constitute delivery to the Exchange Agent.
This Letter must be executed by the Holder of the Existing Notes listed herein. Tenders with respect to any Existing Notes only will be valid if the Holder tendering such Existing Notes has not previously revoked such tender in accordance with the procedures described below.
Any beneficial owner whose Existing Notes are registered in the name of a broker, dealer, commercial bank, trust company or other nominee and who wishes to tender such Existing Notes in the Exchange Offer should promptly contact such registered Holder and instruct such registered Holder to tender on behalf of the beneficial owner. If such beneficial owner desires to tender on his or her own behalf, such beneficial owner must prior to completing and executing this Letter and delivering his Existing Notes, either make appropriate arrangements to register ownership of the Existing Notes in such beneficial owners name or obtain a properly completed bond power from the registered Holder. The transfer of record ownership may take considerable time.
2
In order to properly complete this Letter, a Holder must (i) complete the box entitled Description of Existing Notes; (ii) if appropriate, check and complete the boxes relating to book entry transfer, guaranteed delivery, Special Issuance Instructions and Special Delivery Instructions; (iii) sign this Letter by completing the box entitled Sign Here, and (iv) complete the Substitute Form W-9. Each Holder should carefully read the detailed Instructions below prior to completing this Letter.
The undersigned has completed the appropriate boxes below and signed this Letter to indicate the action the undersigned desires to take with respect to the Exchange Offer.
List below the Existing Notes to which this Letter relates. If the space provided below is inadequate, the certificate numbers and principal amount of Existing Notes represented by such certificates, as well as the principal amount tendered, should be listed and attached on a separate signed schedule.
1. | Need not be completed by Holders tendering Existing Notes for exchange by book entry transfer. |
2. | Unless otherwise indicated in this column, a Holder will be deemed to have tendered ALL of the Existing Notes represented by certificate(s) listed in column 2. See Instruction 2. Existing Notes tendered hereby must be in denominations of principal amount of $1,000 and any integral multiple thereof. See Instruction 1. |
Please check the appropriate box below and provide the requested information.
o | CHECK HERE IF TENDERED EXISTING NOTES ARE BEING ENCLOSED HEREWITH. |
o | CHECK HERE IF TENDERED EXISTING NOTES ARE BEING DELIVERED BY BOOK-ENTRY TRANSFER MADE TO THE ACCOUNT MAINTAINED BY THE EXCHANGE AGENT WITH DTC AND COMPLETE THE FOLLOWING: |
Name of Tendering Institution
|
DTC Account Number
|
Transaction Code Number
|
o | CHECK HERE IF TENDERED EXISTING NOTES ARE BEING DELIVERED PURSUANT TO A NOTICE OF GUARANTEED DELIVERY PREVIOUSLY SENT TO THE EXCHANGE AGENT AND COMPLETE THE FOLLOWING: |
Name(s) of Registered Holder(s)
|
Window Ticket Number (if any) |
|
Date of Execution of Notice of Guaranteed Delivery |
|
Name of Institution which Guaranteed Delivery |
|
For Book-Entry Transfer, Complete the Following: |
DTC Account Number
|
Transaction Code Number
|
PLEASE READ THE ACCOMPANYING INSTRUCTIONS CAREFULLY
3
Ladies and Gentlemen:
Upon the terms and subject to the conditions of the Exchange Offer, the undersigned hereby tenders to Intevac the principal amount of Existing Notes indicated above in the box entitled Description of Existing Notes. Subject to, and effective upon, the acceptance for exchange of the Existing Notes tendered hereby, in accordance with the terms of the Exchange Offer, the undersigned hereby sells, assigns and transfers to, or upon the order of, Intevac all right, title and interest in and to such Existing Notes as are being tendered hereby.
For each $1,000 principal amount of Existing Notes accepted for exchange, the exchanging Holder will receive (assuming that at least $30 million principal amount of Existing Notes are tendered by Holders in the Exchange Offer and the other conditions described in the Offering Circular under the section entitled, The Exchange Offer Conditions to the Completion of the Exchange Offer are satisfied) $185 in cash and $815 of the Exchange Notes (collectively, the Exchange Consideration). The Exchange Notes will be issued in denominations of $1,000 principal amount or integral multiple thereof. Intevac will pay cash for any fractional portion of an Exchange Note that is less than $1,000 principal amount as a result of the exchange, after aggregating all Existing Notes tendered.
The undersigned hereby irrevocably constitutes and appoints the Exchange Agent as the undersigneds true and lawful agent and attorney-in-fact with full knowledge that the exchange agent is also acting as the agent of Intevac in connection with the exchange offer with respect to such tendered Existing Notes, with full power of substitution, such power of attorney being deemed to be an irrevocable power coupled with an interest, subject only to the right of withdrawal described in the Offering Circular and in Instruction 9 of this Letter, to (i) deliver certificates representing such Existing Notes, or transfer ownership of such Existing Notes on the account books maintained by DTC (together in any such case, with all accompanying evidences of transfer and authenticity), to or upon the order of Intevac, (ii) present and deliver such Existing Notes for transfer and transfer the tendered Existing Notes on the books of Intevac, and (iii) receive for the account of Intevac all benefits or otherwise exercise all rights and incidents of beneficial ownership with respect to such Existing Notes. The undersigned hereby represents and warrants that the undersigned has full power and authority to tender, sell, assign and transfer the Existing Notes, and to acquire the Exchange Notes issuable upon the exchange of such tendered Existing Notes and to acquire the Exchange Consideration issuable upon the exchange of such tendered Existing Notes, and that, when the same are accepted for exchange, Intevac will acquire good and unencumbered title to the tendered Existing Notes, free and clear of all liens, restrictions, charges and encumbrances and not subject to any adverse claim when the same are accepted by Intevac. The undersigned hereby further represents that it is not engaged in, and does not intend to engage in, a distribution of the Exchange Notes and has no arrangement or understanding to participate in a distribution of the Exchange Notes.
The name(s) and address(es) of the Holder(s) of the Existing Notes tendered by this Letter are printed above as they appear on the certificate(s) representing the Existing Notes. The certificate number(s) and the Existing Notes that the undersigned wishes to tender are indicated in the appropriate boxes above.
The undersigned will, upon request, execute and deliver any additional documents deemed by the Exchange Agent or Intevac to be necessary or desirable to complete the exchange, sale, assignment and transfer of the Existing Notes tendered by this Letter. All authority conferred or agreed to be conferred in this Letter and every obligation of the undersigned hereunder shall be binding upon the successors, assigns, heirs, executors, administrators, trustees in bankruptcy and legal representatives of the undersigned and shall not be affected by, and shall survive, the death or incapacity of the undersigned. This tender may be withdrawn only in accordance with the procedures set forth in The Exchange Offer Withdrawal Rights and Non-Acceptance section of the Offering Circular. Except as otherwise stated in the Offering Circular or this Letter, this tender for exchange of the Existing Notes is irrevocable.
The undersigned acknowledges that Intevacs acceptance of the Existing Notes validly tendered for exchange pursuant to any one of the procedures described in the section of the Offering Circular entitled The Exchange Offer Procedures for Tendering Existing Notes and in the instructions to this Letter will constitute a binding agreement between the undersigned and Intevac upon the terms and subject to the conditions of the Exchange Offer.
Unless the undersigned has otherwise indicated by completing the boxes entitled Special Issuance Instructions or Special Delivery Instructions below, the undersigned hereby directs that the Exchange Notes and any instrument representing the cash payment to be made in the Exchange Offer be issued in the name(s) of the undersigned, if applicable, and delivered to the address shown below the signature of the undersigned or, in the case of a book-entry
4
If the undersigned has (i) tendered certificates for any Existing Notes that are not exchanged in the Exchange Offer for any reason or (ii) submitted certificates for more Existing Notes than the undersigned wishes to tender, unless the undersigned has otherwise indicated by completing the boxes entitled Special Issuance Instructions or Special Delivery Instructions, the undersigned hereby directs that certificates for any Existing Notes that are not tendered or not exchanged should be issued in the name of the undersigned, if applicable, and delivered to the address shown below the signature of the undersigned or, in the case of a book-entry transfer of Existing Notes, that Existing Notes that are not exchanged be credited to the account indicated above maintained with DTC, in each case at Intevacs expense promptly following the expiration or termination of the Exchange Offer.
A tender for exchange of Existing Notes pursuant to any one of the procedures set forth in the section of the Offering Circular entitled The Exchange Offer Procedures for Tendering Existing Notes will constitute the tendering Holders acceptance of the terms and conditions of the Exchange Offer.
Unless otherwise indicated herein in the box entitled Special Issuance Instructions below, please credit the account indicated above maintained at DTC.
THE UNDERSIGNED, BY COMPLETING THE BOX ABOVE ENTITLED DESCRIPTION OF EXISTING NOTES AND BY SIGNING THIS LETTER, WILL BE DEEMED TO HAVE TENDERED THE EXISTING NOTES AS SET FORTH IN SUCH BOX ABOVE.
5
SPECIAL ISSUANCE INSTRUCTIONS
To be completed ONLY if (i) Exchange Notes and any instrument representing the cash payment to be made in the Exchange Offer (collectively, the Exchange Consideration) or (ii) Existing Notes not tendered or exchanged, in either case, are to be issued in the name of someone other than the Holder of the Existing Notes whose name(s) appear above, or credited to an account maintained at DTC other than the account indicated above.
Issue (check appropriate box(es))
o Exchange Consideration to:
Name(s)
|
Address
|
Credit (check appropriate box(es))
o Exchange Consideration to:
the following account at DTC:
SPECIAL DELIVERY INSTRUCTIONS
To be completed ONLY if (i) certificates for the Exchange Notes and the instrument representing the cash payment issued in exchange for Existing Notes, (ii) certificates for Existing Notes in principal amount not exchanged for the Exchange Consideration, or (iii) certificates for Existing Notes (if any) not tendered for exchange, in any such case, are to be mailed or delivered to someone other than the undersigned or to the undersigned at an address other than the address shown below the undersigneds signature in the box entitled Sign Here.
Mail to:
Name(s)
|
Address
|
6
SIGN HERE
If a Holder is tendering any Existing Notes, this
Letter must be signed by the registered Holder(s) exactly as the
name(s) appear(s) on the certificate(s) representing the
Existing Notes or on a security position listing or by any
person(s) authorized to become registered Holder(s) by
endorsements and documents transmitted herewith. If signature is
by a trustee, executor, administrator, guardian,
attorney-in-fact, officer of a corporation or other person
acting in a fiduciary or representative capacity, please set
forth full title. See Instruction 3.
Name(s)
Capacity (full title):
Address
Area Code and Telephone Number:
Taxpayer Identification or Social Security
No.:
SIGNATURE GUARANTEE
Signature(s) Guaranteed by
7
INSTRUCTIONS
Forming Part of the Terms and Conditions of
the Exchange Offer for the Outstanding
of
INTEVAC, INC.
1. Delivery of
this Letter; Guaranteed Delivery Procedures.
This Letter is to be completed by Holders of
Existing Notes if certificates for Existing Notes are to be
forwarded herewith or a Book-Entry Confirmation (including an
Agents Message) pursuant to DTCs Automated Tender
Offer Program, or ATOP system, shall be delivered if tenders of
Existing Notes are to be made pursuant to the procedures for
delivery by book-entry transfer set forth in The Exchange
Offer Procedures for Tendering Existing Notes
section of the Offering Circular. Certificates for all
physically tendered Existing Notes, or a Book-Entry Confirmation
of delivery of the tendered Existing Notes into the Exchange
Agents account at DTC, as well as a properly completed and
duly executed copy of this Letter (or manually signed facsimile
hereof) or an Agents Message pursuant to DTCs ATOP
system, and all other required documents, must be received by
the Exchange Agent at the address set forth on the cover of this
Letter on or prior to the Expiration Date, or the tendering
Holder must comply with the guaranteed delivery procedures set
forth below. Existing Notes tendered hereby must be in
denominations of principal amount of $1,000 and any integral
multiple thereof.
Holders (i) whose Existing Notes are not
immediately available, (ii) who cannot deliver their
Existing Notes and all other required documents to the Exchange
Agent on or prior to the Expiration Date, or (iii) who
cannot complete the procedure for book-entry transfer and
deliver all other required documents to the Exchange Agent on or
prior to the Expiration Date, in any such case, may tender their
Existing Notes pursuant to the guaranteed delivery procedures
set forth in The Exchange Offer Guaranteed
Delivery Procedures section of the Offering Circular.
Pursuant to such procedures, (i) such tender must be made
through an Eligible Institution, (ii) prior to 12:00
midnight, Eastern Time, on the Expiration Date, the Exchange
Agent must receive from such Eligible Institution a properly
completed and duly executed Letter (or a facsimile thereof), or
an Agents Message, and a Notice of Guaranteed Delivery,
substantially in the form provided by the Company (by facsimile
transmission, mail or hand delivery), setting forth the name and
address of the Holder of Existing Notes and the principal amount
of Existing Notes tendered for exchange, stating that the tender
is being made thereby and guaranteeing that within three trading
days after the Expiration Date the certificates representing
such Existing Notes (or a Book-Entry Confirmation), in proper
form for transfer, and any other required documents will be
deposited by the Eligible Institution with the Exchange Agent,
and (iii) certificates for all tendered Existing Notes or a
Book-Entry Confirmation, together with a copy of the previously
executed Letter (or a facsimile thereof) or an Agents
Message and all other required documents, must be received by
the Exchange Agent within three trading days after the
Expiration Date. The term Eligible Institution means
any member firm of a registered national securities exchange or
of the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc., a
commercial bank or trust company having an office or
correspondent in the United States, or an eligible
guarantor institution within the meaning of
Rule 17Ad-15 under the Exchange Act.
THE METHOD OF DELIVERY OF EXISTING NOTES, THIS
LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL AND ALL OTHER REQUIRED DOCUMENTS IS AT THE
ELECTION AND RISK OF THE TENDERING HOLDER, EXCEPT AS OTHERWISE
PROVIDED BELOW, THE DELIVERY WILL BE DEEMED MADE ONLY WHEN
ACTUALLY RECEIVED OR CONFIRMED BY THE EXCHANGE AGENT. IF
DELIVERY IS BY MAIL, REGISTERED MAIL WITH RETURN RECEIPT
REQUESTED, PROPERLY INSURED, IS RECOMMENDED. NEITHER THIS LETTER
OF TRANSMITTAL NOR ANY EXISTING NOTES SHOULD BE SENT TO THE
COMPANY OR THE TRUSTEE.
See The Exchange Offer section of the
Offering Circular.
8
2. Tenders.
(a) Tenders of Existing Notes will be
accepted only in integral multiples of $1,000 principal amount.
(b) If a tender for exchange is to be made
with respect to less than the entire principal amount of an
Existing Note evidenced by a submitted certificate, the
tendering Holder(s) should fill in the aggregate principal
amount of such Existing Note to be tendered in the box above
entitled Description of Existing Notes
Principal Amount Tendered.
(c) The entire principal amount of the
Existing Note tendered to the Exchange Agent will be deemed to
have been tendered unless otherwise indicated.
(d) A reissued certificate representing the
non-tendered portion of an Existing Note will be sent to the
Holder of such Existing Note, unless otherwise provided in the
appropriate box above entitled Special Issuance
Instructions and/or Special Delivery
Instructions, promptly after the Expiration Date. All of
the Existing Notes delivered to the Exchange Agent will be
deemed to have been tendered unless otherwise indicated.
3. Signatures on
this Letter; Bond Powers and Endorsements; Guarantee of
Signatures.
If this Letter is signed by the registered Holder
of the Existing Notes tendered hereby, the signature must
correspond exactly with the name as it appears on the face of
the Existing Notes or on the security position listing the
Holder as the holder of such Existing Notes on the records of
DTC, in either case, without any change whatsoever.
If any tendered Existing Notes are owned of
record by two or more joint owners, all of such owners must sign
this Letter.
If any tendered Existing Notes are registered in
different names on several certificates, it will be necessary to
complete, sign and submit as many separate copies of this Letter
and any other required documents as there are different
registrations.
When this Letter is signed by the registered
Holder or Holders of the Existing Notes specified herein and
tendered hereby, no endorsements of the Existing Notes or
separate bond powers are required. If, however, Existing Notes
not tendered or not accepted or the Exchange Notes are to be
issued in the name of or returned to a person other than the
registered Holder, then the Existing Notes transmitted hereby
must be endorsed or accompanied by appropriate powers of
attorney in a form satisfactory to the Company and, in either
case, signed exactly as the name(s) of the Holder(s) appears on
the Existing Notes. Signatures on such Existing Notes or powers
of attorney must be guaranteed by an Eligible Institution
(unless signed by an Eligible Institution).
If this Letter or certificates for Existing Notes
or any bond powers are signed by trustees, executors,
administrators, guardians, attorneys-in-fact, officers of
corporations or others acting in a fiduciary or representative
capacity, such persons should so indicate when signing, and,
unless waived by the Company, proper evidence satisfactory to
the Company of their authority to so act must be submitted to
the Exchange Agent.
If this Letter is signed by a person other than
the registered Holder(s) of the Existing Notes tendered hereby,
the Existing Notes must be endorsed or accompanied by
appropriate powers of attorney, in either case, signed exactly
as the name(s) of the registered Holder(s) appear(s) on the
certificates. Signatures on such Existing Notes or powers of
attorney must be guaranteed by an Eligible Institution (unless
signed by an Eligible Institution).
Except as otherwise provided herein, all
signatures on this Letter must be guaranteed by a an Eligible
Institution.
Signatures on this Letter need not be guaranteed
by an Eligible Institution if (i) this Letter is signed by
the registered Holder(s) of the Existing Notes (including any
DTC participant whose name appears on a security position
listing such participant as the Holder of such Existing Notes)
tendered herewith and such
9
4. Special
Issuance and Delivery Instructions.
If the Exchange Notes are to be issued or sent,
or if any Existing Notes not tendered or accepted for exchange
are to be issued or sent, to someone other than the Holder or to
an address other than that shown above, the appropriate box
entitled Special Issuance Instructions or
Special Delivery Instructions above should be
completed. Holders tendering Existing Notes by book-entry
transfer may request that Existing Notes not exchanged be
credited to such account maintained at DTC as such Holder may
designate hereon. If no such instructions are given, such
Existing Notes not exchanged will be credited to the proper
account maintained at DTC.
In the case of issuance in a different name, the
employer identification or social security number of the person
to whom the securities are to be issued must also be indicated.
5. Taxpayer
Identification Number.
Federal income tax law generally requires that a
tendering Holder whose Existing Notes are accepted for exchange
must provide the Company (as payor) with such Holders
correct Taxpayer Identification Number (TIN) on
Substitute Form W-9 below, which in the case of a tendering
Holder who is an individual, is his or her social security
number. If the Company is not provided with the current TIN or
an adequate basis for an exemption from backup withholding, such
tendering Holder may be subject to a $50 penalty imposed by the
Internal Revenue Service. In addition, the Exchange Agent may be
required to withhold 30% of the amount of any reportable
payments made after the exchange to such tendering Holder of the
Exchange Notes. Backup withholding is not an additional U.S.
federal income tax. Rather, the U.S. federal income tax
liability of a person subject to backup withholding will be
reduced by the amount of tax withheld. If withholding results in
an overpayment of taxes, a refund may be obtained.
Exempt Holders of Existing Notes (including,
among others, all corporations and certain foreign individuals)
are not subject to these backup withholding and reporting
requirements. See the enclosed Guidelines for Certification of
Taxpayer Identification Number on Substitute IRS Form W-9
(the W-9 Guidelines) for additional instructions.
To prevent backup withholding, each tendering
Holder of Existing Notes must provide its correct TIN by
completing the Substitute Form W-9 set forth below,
certifying, under penalties of perjury, that the TIN provided is
correct, (or that such Holder is awaiting a TIN) and that
(i) the Holder is exempt from backup withholding, or
(ii) the Holder has not been notified by the Internal
Revenue Service that such Holder is subject to backup
withholding as a result of a failure to report all interest or
dividends or (iii) the Internal Revenue Service has
notified the Holder that such Holder is no longer subject to
backup withholding. If the tendering Holder of Existing Notes is
a non-resident alien or foreign entity not subject to backup
withholding, such Holder must give the Exchange Agent a
completed Form W-8, Certificate of Foreign Status. These
forms may be obtained from the Exchange Agent. If the Existing
Notes are in more than one name or are not in the name of the
actual owner, such Holder should consult the W-9 Guidelines for
information on which TIN to report. If such Holder does not have
a TIN, such Holder should consult the W-9 Guidelines for
instructions on applying for a TIN, check the box in Part 2 of
the Substitute Form W-9 and write applied for
in lieu of its TIN. Note: Checking this box and writing
applied for on the form means that such Holder has
already applied for a TIN or that such Holder intends to apply
for one in the near future. If the box in Part 2 of the
Substitute Form W-9 is checked, the Exchange Agent will
retain 30% of the reportable payments made to a Holder during
the 60-day period following the date of the Substitute
Form W-9. If the Holder furnishes the Exchange Agent with
his or her TIN within 60 days of the date of the Substitute
Form W-9, the Exchange Agent will remit such amounts
retained during such 60-day period to such Holder and no further
amounts will be retained or withheld from payments made to the
Holder thereafter. If, however, such Holder does not provide its
TIN to the Exchange Agent within such 60-day period, the
Exchange Agent will remit
10
6. Transfer
Taxes.
The Company will pay all transfer taxes, if any,
applicable to the transfer of Existing Notes to it or its order
pursuant to the Exchange Offer. If, however, Exchange Notes
and/or substitute Existing Notes not exchanged are to be
registered or issued in the name of any person other than the
registered Holder of the Existing Notes tendered hereby, or if a
transfer tax is imposed for any reason other than the transfer
of Existing Notes to the Company or its order pursuant to the
Exchange Offer, the amount of any such transfer taxes (whether
imposed on the registered Holder or any other persons) will be
payable by the tendering Holder. If satisfactory evidence of
payment of such taxes or exemption therefrom is not submitted
herewith, the amount of such transfer taxes will be billed
directly to such tendering Holder or withheld from the cash
consideration due such holder pursuant to the Exchange Offer.
7. Waiver of
Conditions.
All of the conditions to the Exchange Offer
enumerated in the Offering Circular, other than those dependent
upon receipt of necessary government approvals, must be
satisfied or waived by us before the Expiration Date.
8. No Conditional
Tenders.
No alternative, conditional, irregular or
contingent tenders will be accepted. All tendering Holders of
Existing Notes, by execution of this Letter or the delivery of
an Agents Message, shall waive any right to receive notice
of the acceptance of their Existing Notes for exchange.
9. Withdrawal
Rights.
Tenders of Existing Notes may be withdrawn at any
time prior to 12:00 midnight, Eastern Time, on the Expiration
Date.
For such a withdrawal to be effective, a written
notice of withdrawal must be received by the Exchange Agent at
the address set forth above prior to 12:00 midnight,
Eastern Time, on the Expiration Date. Any such notice of
withdrawal must (i) specify the name of the person having
tendered the Existing Notes to be withdrawn (the
Depositor), (ii) identify the Existing Notes to
be withdrawn by specifying the certificate number(s) and
principal amount of such Existing Notes or, in the case of
Existing Notes tendered by book-entry transfer, specify the
number of the account at the Book-Entry Transfer Facility from
which the Existing Notes were tendered and specify the name and
number of the account at the Book-Entry Transfer Facility to be
credited with the withdrawn Existing Notes and otherwise
complying with the procedures of such facility,
(iii) contain a statement that such Holder is withdrawing
his election to have such Existing Notes exchanged, (iv) be
signed by the Holder in the same manner as the original
signature on the Letter by which such Existing Notes were
tendered (including any required signature guarantees) or be
accompanied by documents of transfer to have the Trustee with
respect to the Existing Notes register the transfer of such
Existing Notes in the name of the person withdrawing the tender
and (v) specify the name in which such Existing Notes are
to be registered, if different from that of the Depositor. All
questions as to the validity, form, eligibility and time of
receipt of such notices will be determined by the Company in its
sole and absolute discretion, whose determination shall be final
and binding on all parties. Any Existing Notes so withdrawn will
be deemed not to have been validly tendered for exchange for
purposes of the Exchange Offer and no Exchange Consideration
will be issued with respect thereto unless the Existing Notes so
withdrawn are validly retendered. Any Existing Notes that have
been tendered for exchange but are not exchanged for any reason
will be returned to the tendering Holder thereof, at our
expense, in the case of physically tendered Existing Notes, or
will be credited to the Exchange Agents account at the
Book-Entry Transfer Facility pursuant to the book-entry transfer
procedures of the Book-Entry Transfer Facility, in the case of
book-entry transfer, such Existing Notes will be
11
10. Requests for
Assistance or Additional Copies.
Questions relating to the procedure for tendering
Existing Notes, as well as requests for additional copies of the
Offering Circular and this Letter, and requests for Notices of
Guaranteed Delivery and other related documents may be directed
to the Exchange Agent, at the address or telephone number set
forth on the cover of this Letter.
11. Irregularities.
All questions as to the form of documents and the
validity, eligibility, time of receipt, acceptance and
withdrawal of Existing Notes will be resolved by the Company, in
its sole discretion, whose determination shall be final and
binding. The Company reserves the absolute right to reject any
or all Existing Notes not properly tendered or tenders of
Existing Notes that, if accepted for exchange would, in the
opinion of counsel to the Company, be unlawful. The Company
reserves the absolute right to waive any defects or
irregularities or conditions of tender for exchange as to
particular Existing Notes. The Companys interpretation of
the terms of, and conditions to, the Exchange Offer (including
the instructions herein) will be final and binding on all
parties. Unless waived, any defects or irregularities in
connection with tenders of Existing Notes must be cured within
such time as the Company shall determine. Neither the Company,
the Exchange Agent nor any other person shall be under any duty
to give notice of any defects or irregularities with respect to
tenders of Existing Notes, nor shall any of them incur any
liability for failure to give any such notice. A tender of such
Existing Notes will not be deemed to have been made until all
defects and irregularities have been cured or waived. Any
Existing Notes received by the exchange agent that are not
properly tendered and as to which the defects or irregularities
have not been cured or waived will be returned, at our expense,
by the Exchange Agent to such holder, unless otherwise provided
in this Letter, promptly following the expiration date.
12. Mutilated,
Lost, Stolen or Destroyed Existing Notes.
Any Holder whose Existing Notes have been
mutilated, lost, stolen or destroyed should contact the Exchange
Agent at the address or telephone number set forth on the cover
of this Letter for further instructions.
12
YOU MUST COMPLETE THE FOLLOWING CERTIFICATE IF
YOU CHECKED THE BOX
CERTIFICATE OF AWAITING TAXPAYER
IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
I
certify under penalties of perjury that a taxpayer
identification number has not been issued to me, and either
(a) I have mailed or delivered an application to receive a
taxpayer identification number to the appropriate Internal
Revenue Service Center or Social Security Administration Office
or (b) I intend to mail or deliver an application in the
near future. I understand that if I do not provide a taxpayer
identification number by the time of the exchange, 30% of all
reportable payments made to me thereafter will be withheld until
I provide a number.
13
, 2002
, 2002
(Date)
Dated:
PAYORS NAME:
SUBSTITUTE
Form W-9
Part
1
PLEASE PROVIDE YOUR TIN
IN THE BOX AT RIGHT AND CERTIFY BY SIGNING AND DATING
BELOW.
TIN:
Social Security Number
or
Employer Identification Number
Department of the Treasury
Internal Revenue Service
Part
2
TIN Applied
For
o
Payors Request for
Taxpayer Identification Number (TIN) and
Certification
CERTIFICATION:
UNDER THE PENALTIES OF PERJURY, I
CERTIFY THAT:
(1) the number shown on this form is my correct TIN (or I
am waiting for a number to be issued to me),
(2) I am not subject to backup withholding either
because: (a) I am exempt from backup withholding, or
(b) I have not been notified by the Internal Revenue
Service (the IRS) that I am subject to backup
withholding as a result of a failure to report all interest or
dividends, or (c) the IRS has notified me that I am no
longer subject to backup withholding, and
(3) I am a U.S. person (including a U.S. resident
alien).
SIGNATURE DATE
You must cross out
item (2) of the above certification if you have been
notified by the IRS that you are subject to backup withholding
because of underreporting of interest or dividends on your tax
return and you have
not been notified by the IRS that you are no longer subject to
backup withholding.
NOTE:
FAILURE TO COMPLETE AND RETURN THIS FORM MAY
RESULT IN BACKUP WITHHOLDING OF 30% OF ANY PAYMENT MADE TO YOU
PURSUANT TO THE EXCHANGE OFFER. PLEASE REVIEW THE ENCLOSED
GUIDELINES FOR CERTIFICATION OF TAXPAYER IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
ON SUBSTITUTE IRS FORM W-9 FOR ADDITIONAL
INSTRUCTIONS.
Date
INTEVAC, INC.
Exchange Offer for Outstanding
Pursuant to the Offering Circular dated June 21, 2002
To: | Brokers, Dealers, Commercial Banks, |
Intevac, Inc., a California corporation (the Company), is offering, upon and subject to the terms and conditions set forth in the Offering Circular, dated June 21, 2002 (the Offering Circular), and the enclosed revised Letter of Transmittal (the Letter of Transmittal), to exchange for each $1,000 principal amount of its 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2004 (the Existing Notes) the following:
$185 in cash, and
| $815 of its new 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2009 (the Exchange Notes). |
The Exchange Notes will be issued in denominations of $1,000 principal amount or integral multiple thereof. We will pay cash for any fractional portion of an Exchange Note that is less than $1,000 principal amount as a result of the exchange, after aggregating all Existing Notes tendered.
We are requesting that you contact your clients for whom you hold Existing Notes regarding the Exchange Offer. For your information and for forwarding to your clients for whom you hold Existing Notes registered in your name or in the name of your nominee, or who hold Existing Notes registered in their own names, we are enclosing the following documents:
1. Offering Circular dated June 21, 2002; | |
2. The Letter of Transmittal for your use and for the information of your clients; | |
3. A revised Notice of Guaranteed Delivery; | |
4. A revised form of letter that may be sent to your clients for whose account you hold existing Notes registered in your name or the name of your nominee, with space provided for obtaining such clients instructions with regard to the Exchange Offer; | |
5. Guidelines for Certification of Taxpayer Identification Number on Substitute IRS Form W-9; and | |
6. Return envelopes addressed to State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A., 2 Avenue de Lafayette, 5th Floor, Corporate Trust Operations, Boston, MA 02110, the Exchange Agent for the Exchange Offer. |
Your prompt action is requested. The Exchange Offer will expire at 12:00 midnight, Eastern Time, on July 9, 2002, unless extended by the Company (the Expiration Date). Existing Notes tendered pursuant to the Exchange Offer may be withdrawn at any time before the Expiration Date.
To tender Existing Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer, the Exchange Agent must, prior to the Expiration Date, receive at the address listed on the front of the Letter of Transmittal:
| with respect to Existing Notes held in certificated form, a properly completed and duly executed Letter of Transmittal and all other documents required by the Letter of Transmittal and the certificates for the Existing Notes being tendered, in proper form for transfer, and | |
| with respect to beneficial interests in Existing Notes held in global form, delivery of such Existing Notes pursuant to the procedures for book-entry transfer described in the Offering Circular under the caption The Exchange Offer Procedures for Tendering Existing Notes as well as a confirmation of |
such delivery including an agents message, or in lieu of such agents message, a properly completed and duly executed Letter of Transmittal. |
If a registered holder of Existing Notes desires to tender its Existing Notes for exchange and (i) the Existing Notes are not immediately available, (ii) such holder cannot deliver the Existing Notes and all other documents required by the Letter of Transmittal to the Exchange Agent on or prior to the Expiration Date, or (iii) such holder is unable to deliver confirmation of the book-entry tender of their Existing Notes into the Exchange Agents account at DTC and all other documents required by the Letter of Transmittal to the Exchange Agent on or prior to the Expiration Date, in each case, such holder must tender their Existing Notes, according to the guaranteed delivery procedures set forth in The Exchange Offer Guaranteed Delivery Procedures section of the Offering Circular.
The Company will not pay any fee or commission to any broker, dealer, nominee or other person for soliciting tenders of the Existing Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer. The Company will, upon request, reimburse brokers, dealers, commercial banks, trust companies and other nominees for reasonable and necessary costs and expenses incurred by them in forwarding the Offering Circular and the related documents to the beneficial owners of Existing Notes held by them as nominee or in a fiduciary capacity. The Company will pay or cause to be paid all stock transfer taxes incident to the transfer of Existing Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer from the holder thereof to the Company, except as set forth in the Instructions to the Letter of Transmittal.
Any inquiries you may have with respect to the Exchange Offer, or requests for additional copies of the enclosed materials, should be directed to State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A., the Exchange Agent for the Exchange Offer, at its address and telephone number set forth on the front of the Letter of Transmittal.
Very truly yours, | |
INTEVAC, INC. |
NOTHING HEREIN OR IN THE ENCLOSED DOCUMENTS SHALL CONSTITUTE YOU OR ANY PERSON AS AN AGENT OF THE COMPANY OR THE EXCHANGE AGENT, OR AUTHORIZE YOU OR ANY OTHER PERSON TO USE ANY DOCUMENT OR MAKE ANY STATEMENTS ON BEHALF OF EITHER OF THEM WITH RESPECT TO THE EXCHANGE OFFER, EXCEPT FOR STATEMENTS EXPRESSLY MADE IN THE OFFERING CIRCULAR OR THE LETTER OF TRANSMITTAL.
Enclosures
2
INTEVAC, INC.
Exchange Offer for Outstanding
Pursuant to the Offering Circular dated June 21, 2002
To Our Clients:
Enclosed for your consideration is an Offering Circular, dated June 21, 2002 (the Offering Circular), and the related revised Letter of Transmittal (the Letter of Transmittal), relating to the offer (the Exchange Offer) of Intevac, Inc., a California corporation (the Company), to exchange for each $1,000 principal amount of its 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2004 (the Existing Notes) the following:
| $185 in cash, and | |
| $815 of its new 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2009 (the Exchange Notes). |
The Exchange Notes will be issued in denominations of $1,000 principal amount or integral multiple thereof. We will pay cash for any fractional portion of an Exchange Note that is less than $1,000 principal amount as a result of the exchange, after aggregating all Existing Notes tendered.
The Exchange Offer will be made upon the terms and subject to the conditions described in the Offering Circular and the Letter of Transmittal.
This material is being forwarded to you as the beneficial owner of the Existing Notes held by us for your account but not registered in your name. A tender of such Existing Notes may only be made by us as the holder of record and pursuant to your instructions.
Accordingly, we request instructions as to whether you wish us to tender on your behalf the Existing Notes held by us for your account, pursuant to the terms and conditions set forth in the enclosed Offering Circular and Letter of Transmittal.
Your instructions should be forwarded to us as promptly as possible in order to permit us to tender the Existing Notes on your behalf in accordance with the provisions of the Exchange Offer. The Exchange Offer will expire at 12:00 midnight, Eastern Time, on July 9, 2002 (the Expiration Date) unless extended by the Company. Any Existing Notes tendered pursuant to the Exchange Offer may be withdrawn at any time before the Expiration Date.
Your attention is directed to the following:
1. The Exchange Offer is for up to all of the Existing Notes. | |
2. The Exchange Offer is subject to the conditions set forth in the Offering Circular in the section captioned The Exchange Offer Conditions to the Completion of the Exchange Offer, including that at least $30 million principal amount of the Existing Notes are tendered in the Exchange Offer. | |
3. The Company expressly reserves the right to amend the Exchange Offer for any or no reason at any time prior to the Expiration Date. | |
4. Any transfer taxes incident to the transfer of Existing Notes from the holder to the Company will be paid by the Company, except as otherwise provided in the Instructions in the Letter of Transmittal. | |
5. The Exchange Offer expires at 12:00 midnight, Eastern Time, on July 9, 2002, unless extended by the Company. |
If you wish to have us tender your Existing Notes, please so instruct us by completing, executing and returning to us the instruction form on the back of this letter. The Letter of Transmittal is furnished to you for information only and may not be used directly by you to tender Existing Notes.
INSTRUCTIONS WITH RESPECT TO THE EXCHANGE OFFER
The undersigned acknowledge(s) receipt of your letter and the enclosed material referred to therein relating to the Exchange Offer made by Intevac, Inc. with respect to its Existing Notes.
This will instruct you to tender the Existing Notes held by you for the account of the undersigned, upon and subject to the terms and conditions set forth in the Offering Circular and the Letter of Transmittal. Please tender the Existing Notes held by you for my account as indicated below:
SIGN HERE
Dated: , 2002
Signature(s):
Print name(s)
here:
Print
Address(es):
Area Code and Telephone
Number(s):
Tax Identification or Social Security
Number(s):
None of the Existing Notes held by us for your account will be tendered unless we receive written instructions from you to do so. After receipt of instructions to tender, unless we receive specific contrary instructions prior to the Expiration Date, we will tender all the Existing Notes held by us for your account.
2
INTEVAC, INC.
Notice of Guaranteed Delivery
Pursuant to the Offering Circular dated June 21, 2002
THE EXCHANGE OFFER EXPIRES AT 12:00 MIDNIGHT, EASTERN TIME, ON JULY 9, 2002 UNLESS EXTENDED (THE EXPIRATION DATE).
You must use this form or a substantially equivalent form if you wish to tender any of the 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2004 (the Existing Notes) of Intevac, Inc., a California corporation (the Company), in accordance with the Exchange Offer made pursuant to the Offering Circular dated June 21, 2002 (the Offering Circular) and the accompanying revised Letter of Transmittal (the Letter of Transmittal), and (i) your Existing Notes are not immediately available, (ii) you cannot deliver your Existing Notes and all other required documents to State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A., as exchange agent (the Exchange Agent), prior to 12:00 midnight, Eastern Time, on the Expiration Date, or (iii) you are unable to deliver confirmation of the book-entry tender of your Existing Notes into the Exchange Agents account at the Depository Trust Company (DTC) and all other required documents to the Exchange Agent prior to 12:00 midnight, Eastern Time, on the Expiration Date. Such form may be delivered or transmitted by facsimile transmission, if applicable, mail or hand delivery to the Exchange Agent as set forth below. In addition, in order to utilize the guaranteed delivery procedure to tender Existing Notes pursuant to the Exchange Offer, a Letter of Transmittal (or facsimile thereof) or an agents message pursuant to DTCs ATOP system, with any required signature guarantees and any other required documents must also be received by the Exchange Agent prior to 12:00 midnight, Eastern Time, on the Expiration Date. Capitalized terms used herein but not defined herein are defined as set forth in the Offering Circular or the Letter of Transmittal.
Delivery To:
State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A.
For Confirmation by Telephone Call:
(617) 662-1548
By Facsimile Transmission (for Eligible Institutions only):
(617) 662-1451
DELIVERY OF THIS INSTRUMENT TO AN ADDRESS OTHER THAN AS SET FORTH ABOVE, OR TRANSMISSION OF INSTRUCTIONS VIA A FACSIMILE NUMBER OTHER THAN AS SET FORTH ABOVE, WILL NOT CONSTITUTE A VALID DELIVERY.
Ladies and Gentlemen:
Upon the terms and conditions set forth in the
Offering Circular and the accompanying Letter of Transmittal,
the receipt of both of which is hereby acknowledged, the
undersigned hereby tenders to the Company the principal amount
of Existing Notes set forth below in the applicable box pursuant
to the guaranteed delivery procedures described in The
Exchange Offer Guaranteed Delivery Procedures
section of the Offering Circular.
Principal Amount of Existing Notes Tendered:*
Certificate Numbers
(if available):
For book-entry transfer to DTC, please provide
account number.
Name of Tendering Institution
Account Number ---------------, at DTC
* | Must be in denominations of $1,000 principal amount and any integral multiple thereof. |
All authority herein conferred or agreed to be conferred shall survive the death or incapacity of the undersigned and every obligation of the undersigned hereunder shall be binding upon the heirs, personal representatives, successors and assigns of the undersigned.
PLEASE SIGN HERE
x
|
|
|
||
x
|
|
|
||
Signature(s) of Owners or Authorized Signatory | Date |
Area Code and Telephone Number:
Must be signed by the Holder(s) of the Existing Notes as their name(s) appear(s) on the face of the Existing Notes or on a security position listing, or by person(s) authorized to become registered Holder(s) by endorsement and documents transmitted with this Notice of Guaranteed Delivery. If signature is by a trustee, executor, administrator, guardian, attorney-in-fact, officer or other person acting in a fiduciary or representative capacity, such person must set forth his or her full title below:
Please print names(s) and address(es)
Names(s): |
|
Address(es): |
|
2
GUARANTEE
The undersigned, a member firm of a registered national securities exchange or of the National Association of Securities Dealers, Inc., or a commercial bank or trust company having an office or a correspondent in the United States, and a participant in an authorized signature guarantee program, hereby guarantees that, within three trading days after the Expiration Date, a properly completed and duly executed Letter of Transmittal (or a facsimile thereof), together with certificates representing the Existing Notes covered hereby in proper form for transfer (or confirmation of the book-entry transfer of such Existing Notes into the Exchange Agents account at DTC, together with an Agents Message, pursuant to the procedure for book-entry transfer set forth in the Offering Circular) and all other required documents will be deposited by the undersigned with the Exchange Agent.
The undersigned acknowledges that it must deliver the Letter of Transmittal and Existing Notes tendered hereby to the Exchange Agent within the time period set forth above and that failure to do so could result in financial loss to the undersigned.
Name of Firm:
|
X
Authorized Signature |
|
Address:
|
Name: | |
Title: | ||
Area Code and Telephone
No.:
|
Date: |
Do not send Existing Notes with this form. Existing Notes should be sent to the Exchange Agent together with a properly completed and duly executed Letter of Transmittal.
This form is not to be used to guarantee signatures. If a signature on a Letter of Transmittal is required to be guaranteed by an Eligible Institution under the instructions thereto, such signature guarantee must appear in the applicable space provided in the signature box on the Letter of Transmittal.
3
INSTRUCTIONS
1. Delivery of this Notice of Guaranteed Delivery. A properly completed and duly executed copy of this Notice of Guaranteed Delivery and any other documents required by this Notice of Guaranteed Delivery must be received by the Exchange Agent at its address set forth on the cover hereof on or prior to the Expiration Date. The method of delivery of this Notice of Guaranteed Delivery and all other required documents to the Exchange Agent is at the election and risk of the Holder but, except as otherwise provided below, the delivery will be deemed made only when actually received by the Exchange Agent. If such delivery is by mail, it is recommended that the Holder use properly insured, registered mail with return receipt requested. For a full description of the guaranteed delivery procedures, see the section of the Offering Circular entitled The Exchange Offer Guaranteed Delivery Procedures. In all cases, sufficient time should be allowed to assure timely delivery. No Notice of Guaranteed Delivery should be sent to the Company.
2. Signatures on this Notice of Guaranteed Delivery; Guarantee of Signatures. If this Notice of Guaranteed Delivery is signed by the registered Holder(s) of the Existing Notes referred to herein, the signature must correspond with the name(s) as written on the face of the Existing Notes without alteration, enlargement or any change whatsoever.
If this Notice of Guaranteed Delivery is signed by a person other than the registered Holder(s) of any Existing Notes listed, this Notice of Guaranteed Delivery must be accompanied by appropriate bond powers signed as the name of the registered Holder(s) appear(s) on the face of the Existing Notes without alteration, enlargement or any change whatsoever or as appearing on a security position listing, as applicable.
If this Notice of Guaranteed Delivery is signed by a trustee, executor, administrator, guardian, attorney-in-fact, officer of a corporation or other person acting in a fiduciary or representative capacity, such person should so indicate when signing, and, unless waived by the Company, evidence satisfactory to the Company of their authority so to act must be submitted with this Notice of Guaranteed Delivery.
3. Request for Assistance or Additional Copies. Questions and requests for assistance or for additional copies of the Offering Circular and the Letter of Transmittal may be directed to the Exchange Agent at the address or telephone number set forth on the cover hereof.
4
INTEVAC, INC.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Page | |||||||
|
|||||||
ARTICLE I Definitions and Incorporation by Reference | 1 | ||||||
SECTION 1.01
|
Definitions | 1 | |||||
SECTION 1.02
|
Other Definitions | 5 | |||||
SECTION 1.03
|
Incorporation by Reference of Trust Indenture Act | 6 | |||||
SECTION 1.04
|
Rules of Construction | 6 | |||||
ARTICLE II The Securities | 6 | ||||||
SECTION 2.01
|
Form and Dating | 6 | |||||
SECTION 2.02
|
Execution and Authentication | 7 | |||||
SECTION 2.03
|
Registrar, Paying Agent and Conversion Agent | 7 | |||||
SECTION 2.04
|
Paying Agent to Hold Money in Trust | 8 | |||||
SECTION 2.05
|
Securityholder | 8 | |||||
SECTION 2.06
|
Transfer and Exchange | 8 | |||||
SECTION 2.07
|
Replacement Securities | 8 | |||||
SECTION 2.08
|
Outstanding Securities | 9 | |||||
SECTION 2.09
|
Treasury Securities | 9 | |||||
SECTION 2.10
|
Temporary Securities: Exchange of Global Security for Certificated Securities | 9 | |||||
SECTION 2.11
|
Cancellation | 9 | |||||
SECTION 2.12
|
Defaulted Interest | 10 | |||||
ARTICLE III Redemption | 10 | ||||||
SECTION 3.01
|
Notices to Trustee | 10 | |||||
SECTION 3.02
|
Selection of Securities to be Redeemed | 10 | |||||
SECTION 3.03
|
Notice of Redemption | 10 | |||||
SECTION 3.04
|
Effect of Notice of Redemption | 11 | |||||
SECTION 3.05
|
Deposit of Redemption Price | 11 | |||||
SECTION 3.06
|
Securities Redeemed in Part | 11 | |||||
SECTION 3.07
|
Optional Redemption | 11 | |||||
SECTION 3.08
|
Change of Control Offer | 11 | |||||
SECTION 3.09
|
Conversion Arrangement on Underwritten Call for Redemption | 13 | |||||
ARTICLE IV Covenants | 13 | ||||||
SECTION 4.01
|
Payment of Securities | 13 | |||||
SECTION 4.02
|
SEC Reports | 13 | |||||
SECTION 4.03
|
Compliance Certificate | 13 | |||||
SECTION 4.04
|
Stay, Extension and Usury Law | 14 | |||||
SECTION 4.05
|
Corporate Existence | 14 | |||||
SECTION 4.06
|
Maintenance of Properties | 14 | |||||
SECTION 4.07
|
Payment of Taxes and Other Claims | 14 | |||||
SECTION 4.08
|
Change of Control | 15 | |||||
SECTION 4.09
|
Triggering Distribution | 15 | |||||
SECTION 4.10
|
Further Instruments and Acts | 15 |
i
Page | |||||||
|
|||||||
ARTICLE V Conversion | 15 | ||||||
SECTION 5.01
|
Conversion Privilege | 15 | |||||
SECTION 5.02
|
Conversion Procedure | 15 | |||||
SECTION 5.03
|
Fractional Shares | 16 | |||||
SECTION 5.04
|
Taxes on Conversion | 16 | |||||
SECTION 5.05
|
Company to Provide Stock | 16 | |||||
SECTION 5.06
|
Adjustment of Conversion Price | 17 | |||||
SECTION 5.07
|
No Adjustment | 19 | |||||
SECTION 5.08
|
Other Adjustments | 19 | |||||
SECTION 5.09
|
Adjustments for Tax Purposes | 19 | |||||
SECTION 5.10
|
Adjustments by the Company | 19 | |||||
SECTION 5.11
|
Notice of Adjustment | 19 | |||||
SECTION 5.12
|
Notice of Certain Transactions | 20 | |||||
SECTION 5.13
|
Effect of Reclassifications, Consolidations, Mergers or Sales on Conversion Privilege | 20 | |||||
SECTION 5.14
|
Trustees Disclaimer | 20 | |||||
SECTION 5.15
|
Automatic Conversion | 21 | |||||
ARTICLE VI Subordination | 22 | ||||||
SECTION 6.01
|
Agreement to Subordinate | 22 | |||||
SECTION 6.02
|
No Payment on Securities if Senior Debt in Default | 22 | |||||
SECTION 6.03
|
Distribution on Acceleration of Securities; Dissolution and Reorganization: Subrogation of Securities | 23 | |||||
SECTION 6.04
|
Reliance by Holders of Senior Debt on Subordination Provisions | 25 | |||||
SECTION 6.05
|
No Waiver of Subordination Provisions | 25 | |||||
SECTION 6.06
|
Trustees Relation to Senior Debt | 25 | |||||
SECTION 6.07
|
Other Provisions Subject Hereto | 26 | |||||
SECTION 6.08
|
Certain Conversions and Repurchases Deemed Payment | 26 | |||||
ARTICLE VII Successors | 26 | ||||||
SECTION 7.01
|
Merger, Consolidation or Sale of Assets | 26 | |||||
SECTION 7.02
|
Successor Corporate Entity Substituted | 26 | |||||
ARTICLE VIII Defaults and Remedies | 27 | ||||||
SECTION 8.01
|
Events of Default | 27 | |||||
SECTION 8.02
|
Acceleration | 28 | |||||
SECTION 8.03
|
Other Remedies | 28 | |||||
SECTION 8.04
|
Waiver of Past Defaults | 28 | |||||
SECTION 8.05
|
Control by Majority | 28 | |||||
SECTION 8.06
|
Limitation on Suits | 28 | |||||
SECTION 8.07
|
Rights of Securityholders to Receive Payment | 29 | |||||
SECTION 8.08
|
Collection Suit by Trustee | 29 | |||||
SECTION 8.09
|
Trustee May File Proofs of Claim | 29 | |||||
SECTION 8.10
|
Priorities | 29 | |||||
SECTION 8.11
|
Undertaking for Costs | 29 |
ii
Page | |||||||
|
|||||||
ARTICLE IX Trustee | 30 | ||||||
SECTION 9.01
|
Duties of Trustee | 30 | |||||
SECTION 9.02
|
Rights of Trustee | 30 | |||||
SECTION 9.03
|
Individual Rights of Trustee | 30 | |||||
SECTION 9.04
|
Trustees Disclaimer | 31 | |||||
SECTION 9.05
|
Notice of Defaults | 31 | |||||
SECTION 9.06
|
Reports by Trustee to Securityholders | 31 | |||||
SECTION 9.07
|
Compensation and Indemnity | 31 | |||||
SECTION 9.08
|
Replacement of Trustee | 31 | |||||
SECTION 9.09
|
Successor Trustee by Merger, Etc. | 32 | |||||
SECTION 9.10
|
Eligibility; Disqualification | 32 | |||||
SECTION 9.11
|
Preferential Collection of Claims Against Company | 32 | |||||
SECTION 9.12
|
Sections Applicable to Registrar, Paying Agent and Conversion Agent | 32 | |||||
ARTICLE X Discharge of Indenture | 33 | ||||||
SECTION 10.01
|
Termination of Companys Obligation | 33 | |||||
SECTION 10.02
|
Repayment to Company | 33 | |||||
ARTICLE XI Amendments, Supplements and Waivers | 33 | ||||||
SECTION 11.01
|
Without Consent of Securityholders | 33 | |||||
SECTION 11.02
|
With Consent of Securityholders | 33 | |||||
SECTION 11.03
|
Compliance with Trust Indenture Act | 34 | |||||
SECTION 11.04
|
Revocation and Effect of Consents | 34 | |||||
SECTION 11.05
|
Notation on or Exchange of Securities | 35 | |||||
SECTION 11.06
|
Trustee Protected | 35 | |||||
ARTICLE XII Miscellaneous | 35 | ||||||
SECTION 12.01
|
Trust Indenture Act Controls | 35 | |||||
SECTION 12.02
|
Notices | 35 | |||||
SECTION 12.03
|
Communication by Securityholders with Other Securityholders | 35 | |||||
SECTION 12.04
|
Certificate and Opinion as to Conditions Precedent | 36 | |||||
SECTION 12.05
|
Statements Required in Certificate or Opinion | 36 | |||||
SECTION 12.06
|
Rules by Trustee and Agents | 36 | |||||
SECTION 12.07
|
Legal Holidays | 36 | |||||
SECTION 12.08
|
No Recourse Against Others | 36 | |||||
SECTION 12.09
|
Counterparts | 36 | |||||
SECTION 12.10
|
Variable Provisions | 36 | |||||
SECTION 12.11
|
Governing Law | 37 | |||||
SECTION 12.12
|
No Adverse Interpretation of Other Agreements | 37 | |||||
SECTION 12.13
|
Successors | 37 | |||||
SECTION 12.14
|
Severability | 37 | |||||
SECTION 12.15
|
Table of Contents, Headings, Etc. | 37 |
iii
Page | |||||||
|
|||||||
ARTICLE XIII Repurchase Offer | 37 | ||||||
SECTION 13.01
|
Repurchase Offer | 37 | |||||
SECTION 13.02
|
Repurchase Notice | 38 | |||||
SECTION 13.03
|
Deposit of Repurchase Offer Amount | 38 | |||||
SECTION 13.04
|
Compliance with Applicable Laws | 39 | |||||
EXHIBIT A FORM OF CONVERTIBLE SUBORDINATED NOTE | A-1 |
iv
INDENTURE dated as of , 2002 between Intevac, Inc., a California corporation (the Company) and State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A., a national banking association under the laws of the United States of America, as Trustee (the Trustee).
Each party agrees as follows for the benefit of the other party and for the equal and ratable benefit of the Securityholders of the Companys 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2009 (the Securities):
ARTICLE I
DEFINITIONS AND INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE
SECTION 1.01 Definitions.
Affiliate of any specified person means any other person directly or indirectly controlling or controlled by or under direct or indirect common control with such specified person. For the purposes of this definition, control (including, with correlative meanings, the terms controlling, controlled by and under common control with), as used with respect to any person, shall mean the possession, directly or indirectly, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management or policies of such person, whether through the ownership of voting securities or by agreement or otherwise.
Agent means any Registrar, Paying Agent, Conversion Agent or co-registrar.
Board of Directors means the Board of Directors of the Company or any authorized committee of the Board.
Board Resolution means a copy of a resolution of the Board of Directors certified by the Secretary or an Assistant Secretary of the Company to be in full force and effect on the date of such certification and delivery to the Trustee.
Business Day means any day that is not a Legal Holiday.
Capital Stock means with respect to any entity any and all shares, interests, participations, rights or other equivalents (however designated) of equity interests in entity, including, without limitation, corporate stock and partnership interests.
Change of Control means any event where: (i) any person or group (as such terms are used in Section 13(d) and 14(d) of the Exchange Act) other than a Permitted Holder is or becomes the beneficial owner (as defined in Rules 13d-3 and 13d-5 under the Exchange Act) of shares representing more than 50% of the combined voting power of the then-outstanding securities entitled to vote generally in elections of directors of the Company (Voting Stock), (ii) the Company consolidates with or merges into any other corporation, or any other corporation merges into the Company, and, in the case of any such transaction, the outstanding Common Stock of the Company is reclassified into or exchanged for any other property or security, unless the shareholders of the Company immediately before such transaction own, directly or indirectly immediately following such transaction, at least a majority of the combined voting power of the outstanding voting securities of the Corporate Entity resulting from such transaction in substantially the same proportion as their ownership of the Voting Stock immediately before such transaction, (iii) the Company conveys, transfers or leases all or substantially all of its assets to any person, unless such conveyance, transfer or lease is to a corporation and the shareholders of the Company immediately before such conveyance, transfer or lease own, directly or indirectly immediately following such transaction, at least a majority of the combined voting power of the Corporate Entity to which such assets are so conveyed, transferred or leased in the same proportion as their ownership of the Voting Stock immediately before such transaction, or (iv) any time the Continuing Directors do not constitute a majority of the Board of Directors of the Company (or, if applicable, a successor corporation to the Company); provided, that a Change of Control shall not be deemed to have occurred if at least 90% of the consideration (excluding cash payments for fractional shares) in the transaction or transactions constituting the Change of Control consists of shares of common stock that are, or upon issuance will be, traded on a United States national securities exchange or approved for trading on an established automated over-the-counter trading market in the United States.
-1-
Common Stock means the common stock of the Company as the same exists at the date of the execution of this Indenture or as such stock may be constituted from time to time.
Company means the party named as such above until a successor replaces it in accordance with Article VI and thereafter means the successor.
Continuing Directors means, as of any date of determination, any member of the Board of Directors of the Company who (i) was a member of such Board of Directors on the date of this Indenture or (ii) was nominated for election or elected to such Board of Directors with the approval of a majority of the Continuing Directors who were members of such board at the time of such nomination or election.
Corporate Entity shall be any corporation, limited liability company or other business entity.
Custodian means State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A., as custodian with respect to the Global Securities, or any successor entity thereto.
Daily Market Price means the price of a share of Common Stock on the relevant date, determined (a) on the basis of the last reported sale price regular way of the Common Stock as reported on the NNM, or if the Common Stock is not then listed on the NNM, as reported on such national securities exchange upon which the Common Stock is listed, or (b) if there is no such reported sale on the day in question, on the basis of the average of the closing bid and asked quotations regular way as so reported, or (c) if the Common Stock is not listed on the NNM or on any national securities exchange, on the basis of the average of the high bid and low asked quotations regular way on the day in question in the over-the-counter market as reported by the National Association of Securities Dealers Automated Quotation System, or if not so quoted, as reported by National Quotation Bureau, Incorporated, or a similar organization.
Default means any event that is, or with the passage of time or the giving of notice or both, would be an Event of Default.
Depositary means The Depository Trust Company, its nominees and their respective successors.
Designated Senior Debt means any Senior Debt which, at the date of determination, has an aggregate principal amount outstanding of, or commitments to lend up to, at least $10.0 million and is specifically designated by the Company in the instrument evidencing or governing such Senior Debt as Designated Senior Debt for purposes of this Indenture (provided, that such instrument may place limitations and conditions on the right of such Senior Debt to exercise the rights of Designated Senior Debt).
Exchange Act means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended.
Excess Payment means the excess of (A) the aggregate of the cash and fair market value of other consideration paid by the Company or any of its Subsidiaries with respect to the shares acquired in a tender offer or other negotiated transaction over (B) the Daily Market Price on the Trading Day immediately following the completion of such tender offer or other negotiated transaction multiplied by the number of acquired shares.
GAAP means generally accepted accounting principles set forth in the opinions and pronouncements of the Accounting Principles Board of the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants and statements and pronouncements of the Financial Accounting Standards Board or in such other statements by such other entity as may be approved by a significant segment of the accounting profession in the United States, which are in effect from time to time.
Guarantee means a guarantee (other than by endorsement of negotiable instruments for collection in the ordinary course of business), direct or indirect, in any manner (including, without limitation, letters of credit and reimbursement agreements in respect thereof), of all or any part of any Indebtedness.
Indebtedness means, with respect to any person, all obligations, whether or not contingent, of such person (i)(a) for borrowed money (including, but not limited to, any indebtedness secured by a security interest, mortgage or other lien on the assets of such person which is (1) given to secure all or part of the purchase price of property subject thereto, whether given to the vendor of such property or to another, or
-2-
Indenture means this Indenture as amended from time to time.
Issuance Date means the date on which the Securities are first authenticated and issued.
Material Subsidiary means any Subsidiary of the Company which at the date of determination is a significant subsidiary as defined in Rule 1-02(w) of Regulation S-X under the Securities Act and the Exchange Act (as such Regulation is in effect on the date hereof).
NNM means the Nasdaq Stock Markets National Market.
Obligations means any principal, interest, penalties, fees, indemnifications, reimbursements, damages and other liabilities payable under the documentation governing any Indebtedness.
Offering Circular means the Offering Circular relating to the Securities dated June 6, 2002, as the same may be amended or supplemented from time to time.
Officers Certificate means a certificate signed by two Officers, one of whom must be the Chairman of the Board, the President, the Chief Financial Officer, the Treasurer or a Vice-President of the Company. See Sections 12.04 and 12.05 hereof.
Opinion of Counsel means a written opinion from legal counsel who is acceptable to the Trustee. The counsel may be an employee of or counsel to the Company or the Trustee. See Sections 12.04 and 12.05 hereof.
person means any individual, corporation, partnership, joint venture, association, joint stock company, trust, unincorporated organization or government or any agency or political subdivision thereof.
Permitted Holder means Foster City LLC, any Subsidiary or Affiliate thereof, the legal representative of any of the foregoing, or any entity of which any of the foregoing, individually or collectively beneficially own (as defined in Rules 13d-3 and 13d-5 under the Exchange Act) voting securities representing at least a majority of the total voting power of all classes of capital stock of such entity (exclusive of any matters as to which class voting rights exist).
Photonics Business means the design, development, manufacture and service of the Photonic Products by the Company or one of its Subsidiaries.
Photonics Products means:
(i) the Companys Electron Bombarded Charge Coupled Device (EBCCD) that is a sensor that has a transparent glass window on one side through which photons are focused onto a photocathode grown on the vacuum side of the window, such that when these photons strike the photocathode through the window, electrons are emitted into the vacuum and these electrons are then electrically accelerated |
-3-
through the vacuum and strike a charge coupled device (CCD) imager, which in turn outputs a high resolution, low noise video signal; | |
(ii) the Companys Electron Bombarded Active Pixel Sensor (EBAPS) that incorporates the same basic technology as described in clause (i) above but contains a Complementary Metal-Oxide-Semiconductor (CMOS) imager instead of a CCD chip; | |
(iii) the Companys Laser Illuminated Viewing and Ranging system (LIVAR) that is an EBCCD sensor with a laser illuminator that operates in a manner similar to RADAR, but utilizing an eye safe laser, rather than a longer wavelength microwave source, and displaying the reflected signal as a digital video image, rather than as a blip; and | |
(iv) any products derived from the devices specified in (i) through (iii) above. |
principal of a debt security means the principal of the security plus the premium, if any, on the security.
Representative means the trustee, agent or representative (if any) for an issue of Senior Debt.
SEC means the Securities and Exchange Commission.
Securities means the Securities described in the preamble above that are issued, authenticated and delivered under this Indenture.
Securities Act means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.
Securityholder or holder means a person in whose name a Security is registered.
Senior Debt means the principal of, premium, if any, interest, on, and fees, costs and expenses in connection with, and other amounts due on Indebtedness of the Company, whether outstanding on the date of the Indenture or thereafter created, incurred, assumed or guaranteed by the Company, unless, in the instrument creating or evidencing or pursuant to which Indebtedness is outstanding, it is expressly provided that such Indebtedness is not senior in right of payment to the Securities. Senior Debt includes, with respect to the obligations described above, interest accruing, pursuant to the terms of such Senior Debt, on or after the filing of any petition in bankruptcy or for reorganization relating to the Company, whether or not post-filing interest is allowed in such proceeding, at the rate specified in the instrument governing the relevant obligation. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the foregoing, Senior Debt shall not include: (a) Indebtedness of the Company to a Subsidiary of the Company; (b) the Securities; (c) the Companys 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2004; (d) Indebtedness of or amount owned by the Company for compensation to employees, or for goods, services or material purchased in the ordinary course of business; or (e) any liability for federal, state, local or other taxes owed or owing by the Company. For the purposes of this definition of Senior Debt under this Indenture, it is the intent of the parties hereto that the Securities issued under this Indenture be Senior Debt (as defined under that certain Indenture, dated February 15, 1997, between the Company and State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A. (the 2004 Indenture)) for purposes of the 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2004 (the Existing Notes) issued under the 2004 Indenture, and in furtherance thereof, the parties hereto agree that nothing contained in this Indenture or in the definition of Senior Debt under this Indenture is meant to or shall be construed to expressly provide that the Securities issued under this Indenture are not superior to the Existing Notes.
Subsidiary means any corporation, association or other business entity of which more than 50% of the total voting power of shares of Capital Stock entitled (without regard to the occurrence of any contingency) to vote in the election of directors, managers or trustees thereof is at the time owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by any person or one or more of the other Subsidiaries of that person or a combination thereof.
TIA means the Trust Indenture Act of 1939, and rules and regulations thereunder as so amended as in effect on the date of execution of this Indenture; provided, however, in the event that Trust Indenture Act of 1939 is amended after such date, Trust Indenture Act means, to the extent required by any such amendment, the Trust Indenture Act of 1939 as so amended.
-4-
Trading Day shall mean (A) if the applicable security is quoted on the NNM, a day on which trades may be made thereon, (B) if the applicable security is listed or admitted for trading on the New York Stock Exchange or another national securities exchange, a day on which the New York Stock Exchange or such other national securities exchange is open for business or (C) if the applicable security is not so listed, admitted for trading or quoted, any day other than a Saturday or Sunday or a day on which banking institutions in the State of New York or the State of California are authorized or obligated by law or executive order to close.
Triggering Distribution means an event where the Company declares or makes any dividend or other distribution to all of the holders of the Common Stock of shares of Capital Stock of any Subsidiary that at the time constitutes the Companys Photonics Business.
Trustee means the party named as such above until a successor replaces it in accordance with the applicable provisions of this Indenture and thereafter means the successor.
Trust
Officer
means any officer or
assistant officer of the Trustee assigned by the Trustee to
administer this Indenture.
SECTION
1.02
Other Definitions.
Defined in
Term Section
2.01
15.15
15.15
8.01
8.01
4.08
4.08
3.08
3.08
2.03
5.02
5.01
5.06(e)
8.01
2.01
12.07
3.08
12.10
2.03
6.02
6.02
8.01
2.01
5.06
2.03
13.01
4.09
13.01
4.09
-5-
Defined in
Term Section
4.09
2.01
3.08
SECTION 1.03 Incorporation by Reference of Trust Indenture Act. Whenever this Indenture refers to a provision of the TIA, the provision is incorporated by reference in and made a part of this Indenture.
The following TIA terms used in this Indenture have the following meanings:
indenture securities means the Securities; | |
indenture security holder means a Securityholder; | |
indenture to be qualified means this Indenture; | |
indenture trustee or institutional trustee means the Trustee; and | |
obligor on the Securities means the Company or any other obligor on the Securities. |
All other terms used in this Indenture that are defined by the TIA, defined by TIA reference to another statute or defined by SEC rule under the TIA have the meanings so assigned to them.
SECTION 1.04 Rules of Construction. Unless the context otherwise requires:
(a) a term has the meaning assigned to it; | |
(b) an accounting term not otherwise defined has the meaning assigned to it in accordance with GAAP consistently applied; | |
(c) or is not exclusive; | |
(d) words in the singular include the plural, and words in the plural include the singular; and | |
(e) provisions apply to successive events and transactions. |
ARTICLE II
THE SECURITIES
SECTION 2.01 Form and Dating. The Securities and the Trustees certificate of authentication shall be substantially in the form of Exhibit A which is hereby incorporated in and expressly made a part of this Indenture.
The Securities may have notations, legends or endorsements required by law, stock exchange rule, agreements to which the Company is subject, if any, or usage (provided that any such notation, legend or endorsement is in a form acceptable to the Company). The Company shall furnish any such legend not contained in Exhibit A to the Trustee in writing. The Securities shall be dated the date of their authentication. The terms and provisions of the Securities set forth in Exhibit A are part of the terms of this Indenture and to the extent applicable, the Company and the Trustee, by their execution and delivery of this Indenture, expressly agree to such terms and provisions and to be bound thereby.
(a) Global Securities. The Securities shall be issued in the form of one or more global Securities in definitive, fully registered form without interest coupons with the global securities legend set forth in Exhibit A hereto (a Global Security). The Global Securities shall be deposited on behalf of the purchasers of the Securities represented thereby with the Trustee as Custodian for the Depositary, and registered in the name of the Depositary or a nominee of the Depositary, duly executed by the Company and authenticated by the Trustee as hereinafter provided. The aggregate principal amount of the Global Security may from time to time be increased or decreased by adjustments made on the records of the Trustee and the Depositary or its nominee as hereinafter provided in this Article II. |
-6-
(b) Book-Entry Provisions. This Section 2.01(b) shall apply only to a Global Security deposited with or on behalf of the Depositary. |
The Company shall execute and the Trustee shall, in accordance with this Section 2.01(b) and the written order of the Company, authenticate and deliver initially one or more Global Securities that (i) shall be registered in the name of Cede & Co. or other nominee of such Depositary and (ii) shall be delivered by the Trustee to such Depositary or pursuant to such Depositarys instructions or held by the Trustee as Custodian for the Depositary pursuant to a FAST Balance Certificate Agreement between the Depositary and the Trustee.
Members of, or participants in, the Depositary (Agent Members) shall have no rights under this Indenture with respect to any Global Security held on their behalf by the Depositary or by the Trustee as the Custodian for the Depositary or under such Global Security, and the Depositary or its nominee, as the case may be, may be treated by the Company, the Trustee and any agent of the Company or the Trustee as the absolute owner of such Global Security for all purposes whatsoever. Notwithstanding the foregoing, nothing herein shall prevent the Company, the Trustee or any agent of the Company or the Trustee from giving effect to any written certification, proxy or other authorization furnished by the Depositary or impair, as between the Depositary and its Agent Members, the operation of customary practices of such Depositary governing the exercise of the rights of a holder of a beneficial interest in any Global Security.
SECTION 2.02 Execution and Authentication. Two Officers shall sign the Securities for the Company by manual or facsimile signature.
If an Officer whose signature is on a Security no longer holds that office at the time the Security is authenticated, the Security shall nevertheless be valid.
A Security shall not be valid until authenticated by the manual signature of an authorized officer of the Trustee. The signature shall be conclusive evidence that the Security has been authenticated under this Indenture.
Upon a written order of the Company signed by two Officers, the Trustee shall authenticate the Securities for original issue up to an aggregate principal amount of $ . The aggregate principal amount of Securities outstanding at any time shall not exceed such aggregate amount of $ except as provided in Section 2.07.
The Trustee may appoint an authenticating agent acceptable to the Company to authenticate Securities. An authenticating agent may authenticate Securities whenever the Trustee may do so. Each reference in this Indenture to authentication by the Trustee includes authentication by such agent. An authenticating agent has the same rights as an Agent to deal with the Company or an Affiliate.
SECTION 2.03 Registrar, Paying Agent and Conversion Agent. The Company shall maintain in the Borough of Manhattan, City of New York, State of New York (i) an office or agency where Securities may be presented for registration of transfer or for exchange (Registrar), (ii) an office or agency where Securities may be presented for payment (Paying Agent) and (iii) an office or agency where Securities may be presented for conversion (Conversion Agent). The Registrar shall keep a register of the Securities and of their transfer and exchange. The Company may appoint the Registrar, the Paying Agent and the Conversion Agent. The Company may appoint one or more co-registrars, one or more additional paying agents and one or more additional conversion agents in such other locations as it shall determine; provided that no such designation shall in any manner relieve the Company of its obligation to maintain an office or agency in the Borough of Manhattan, The City of New York, State of New York, for such purposes. The term Paying Agent includes any additional paying agent and the term Conversion Agent includes any additional conversion agent. The Company may change any Paying Agent, Registrar, co-registrar or Conversion Agent without prior notice to any Securityholder. The Company shall notify the Trustee of the name and address of any Agent not a party to this Indenture. If the Company fails to appoint or maintain another entity as Registrar, Paying Agent or Conversion Agent, the Trustee shall act as such. The Company or any of its Affiliates may act as Paying Agent, Registrar, co-registrar or Conversion Agent. The Company initially appoints the Trustee as Paying Agent, Registrar, Conversion Agent and Custodian and the Trustee hereby
-7-
SECTION 2.04 Paying Agent to Hold Money in Trust. The Company shall require each Paying Agent other than the Trustee to agree in writing that the Paying Agent will hold in trust for the benefit of Securityholders or the Trustee all money held by the Paying Agent for the payment of principal or interest, and will notify the Trustee of any default by the Company in making any such payment. While any such default continues, the Trustee may require a Paying Agent to pay all money held by it to the Trustee. The Company at any time may require a Paying Agent to pay all money held by it to the Trustee and to account for any money disbursed by it. Upon payment over to the Trustee, the Paying Agent (if other than the Company or an Affiliate of the Company) shall have no further liability for the money. If the Company or an Affiliate of the Company acts as Paying Agent, it shall segregate and hold in a separate trust fund for the benefit of the Securityholders all money held by it as Paying Agent.
SECTION 2.05 Securityholder. The Trustee shall preserve in as current a form as is reasonably practicable the most recent list available to it of the names and addresses of Securityholders. If the Trustee is not the Registrar, the Company shall furnish to the Trustee on or before each interest payment date and at such other times as the Trustee may request in writing a list in such form and as of such date as the Trustee may reasonably require of the names and addresses of Securityholders.
SECTION 2.06 Transfer and Exchange. When Securities are presented to the Registrar or a co-registrar with a request to register a transfer or to exchange them for an equal principal amount of Securities of other denominations, the Registrar shall register the transfer or make the exchange if its requirements for such transactions are met. To permit registrations of transfers and exchanges, the Company shall issue and the Trustee shall authenticate Securities at the Registrars request. No service charge shall be made for any registration of transfer or exchange (except as otherwise expressly permitted herein), but the Company may require payment of a sum sufficient to cover any transfer tax or similar governmental charge payable in connection therewith (other than any such transfer tax or similar governmental charge payable upon exchanges pursuant to Sections 2.10, 3.06, 3.08, 5.02 or 11.05 hereof).
The Company shall not be required (i) to register the transfer of or exchange Securities during a period beginning at the opening of business 15 days before the day of any selection of Securities for redemption under Section 3.02 hereof and ending at the close of business on the day of selection, or (ii) to exchange or register the transfer of any Security so selected for redemption in whole or in part, except the unredeemed portion of any Security being redeemed in part or (iii) to register the transfer of or exchange Securities submitted for repurchase (and not withdrawn) under Sections 4.08 or 4.09 hereof.
The Trustee shall have no responsibility for any actions taken or not taken by the Depositary.
SECTION 2.07 Replacement Securities. If the holder of a Security claims that the Security has been lost, destroyed or wrongfully taken or if such Security is mutilated and is surrendered to the Trustee, the Company shall issue and the Trustee shall authenticate a replacement Security if the Trustees and the Companys requirements are met. If required by the Trustee or the Company, an indemnity bond must be sufficient in the judgment of both to protect the Company, the Trustee, any Agent or any authenticating agent from any loss which any of them may suffer if a Security is replaced. The Company may charge for its expenses in replacing a Security.
In case any such mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Security has become or is about to become due and payable, or is about to be redeemed or purchased by the Company pursuant to Article III hereof or converted into shares of Common Stock pursuant to Article V hereof, the Company in its discretion may, instead of issuing a new Security, pay, redeem, purchase or convert such Security, as the case may be.
Every replacement Security is an additional obligation of the Company.
-8-
SECTION 2.08 Outstanding Securities. The Securities outstanding at any time are all the Securities authenticated by the Trustee except for those canceled by it, those delivered to it for cancellation, and those described in this Section as not outstanding.
If a Security is replaced, paid, redeemed, or purchased or converted pursuant to Section 2.07 hereof, it ceases to be outstanding unless, in the case of a replaced Security, the Trustee receives proof satisfactory to it that the replaced Security is held by a bona fide purchaser.
If Securities are considered paid under Section 4.01 hereof, they cease to be outstanding and interest on them ceases to accrue.
A Security does not cease to be outstanding because the Company or an Affiliate of the Company holds the Security.
SECTION 2.09 Treasury Securities. In determining whether the Securityholders of the required principal amount of Securities have concurred in any direction, waiver or consent, Securities owned by the Company or an Affiliate of the Company shall be considered as though they are not outstanding, except that for the purposes of determining whether the Trustee shall be protected in relying on any such direction, waiver or consent, only Securities which a Trust Officer knows are so owned shall be so disregarded.
SECTION 2.10 Temporary Securities: Exchange of Global Security for Certificated Securities.
(a) Until definitive Securities are ready for delivery, the Company may prepare and the Trustee shall authenticate temporary Securities. Temporary Securities shall be substantially in the form of definitive securities but may have variations that the Company considers appropriate for temporary Securities. Without unreasonable delay, the Company shall prepare and the Trustee shall authenticate definitive Securities in exchange for temporary Securities.
(b) Any Global Security or Securities deposited with the Depositary or with the Trustee as Custodian for the Depositary pursuant to Section 2.01 shall be transferred to the beneficial owners thereof in the form of certificated securities only if such transfer complies with Section 2.06 and (i) the Depositary notifies the Company that it is unwilling or unable to continue as Depositary for such Global Security or if at any time such Depositary ceases to be a clearing agency registered under the Exchange Act and a successor Depositary is not appointed by the Company within 90 days of such notice, or (ii) an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing.
(c) Any Global Security that is transferable to the beneficial owners thereof in the form of certificated Securities pursuant to this Section 2.10 shall be surrendered by the Depositary to the Trustee to be so transferred, in whole or from time to time in part, without charge, and the Trustee shall authenticate and deliver, upon such transfer of each portion of such Global Security, an equal aggregate principal amount at maturity of Securities of authorized denominations in the form of certificated Securities. Any portion of a Global Security transferred pursuant to this Section shall be executed, authenticated and delivered only in denominations of $1,000 and any integral multiple thereof and registered in such names as the Depositary shall direct.
(d) Prior to any transfer pursuant to Section 2.10(b), the registered holder of a Global Security may grant proxies and otherwise authorize any person, including Agent Members and persons that may hold interests through Agent Members, to take any action which a holder is entitled to take under this Indenture or the Securities.
(e) In the event of the occurrence of either of the events specified in Section 2.10(b), the Company will promptly make available to the Trustee a reasonable supply of certificated Securities in definitive form without interest coupons.
SECTION 2.11 Cancellation. The Company at any time may deliver Securities to the Trustee for cancellation. The Registrar, Paying Agent and Conversion Agent shall forward to the Trustee any Securities surrendered to them for registration of transfer, redemption, purchase, conversion, exchange or payment. The Trustee shall promptly cancel all Securities surrendered for registration of transfer, redemption, purchase,
-9-
SECTION 2.12 Defaulted Interest. If the Company fails to make a payment of interest, it shall pay such defaulted interest plus any interest payable on the defaulted interest, in any lawful manner. It may pay such defaulted interest, plus any such interest payable thereon, to the persons who are Securityholders on a subsequent special record date. The Company shall fix any such record date and payment date. At least 15 days before any such record date, the Company shall mail to Securityholders a notice that states the record date, payment date, and amount of such interest to be paid.
ARTICLE III
REDEMPTION
SECTION 3.01 Notices to Trustee. If the Company elects to redeem Securities pursuant to Section 3.07 hereof, it shall notify the Trustee of the redemption date and the principal amount of Securities to be redeemed. The Company shall give each notice provided for in this Section 3.01 to the Trustee at least 20 days before the redemption date (unless a shorter notice period shall be satisfactory to the Trustee).
SECTION 3.02 Selection of Securities to be Redeemed. If less than all the Securities are to be redeemed, the Trustee shall select the Securities to be redeemed by a method that complies with the requirements of the principal national securities exchange, if any, on which the Securities are listed, or, if the Securities are not so listed, on a pro rata basis. The Trustee shall make the selection not more than 60 days and not less than 15 days before the redemption date from Securities outstanding not previously called for redemption. The Trustee may select for redemption portions of the principal of Securities that have denominations larger than $1,000. Securities and portions of them it selects shall be in amounts of $1,000 or integral multiples of $1,000. Provisions of this Indenture that apply to Securities called for redemption also apply to portions of Securities called for redemption. The Trustee shall notify the Company promptly of the Securities or portions of Securities to be called for redemption.
If any Security selected for partial redemption is converted in part after such selection, the converted portion of such Security shall be deemed (so far as may be) to be the portion to be selected for redemption. The Securities (or portions thereof) so selected shall be deemed duly selected for redemption for all purposes hereof, notwithstanding that any such Security is converted in whole or in part before the mailing of the notice of redemption. Upon any redemption of less than all the Securities, the Company and the Trustee may treat as outstanding any Securities surrendered for conversion during the period 15 days next preceding the mailing of a notice of redemption and need not treat as outstanding any Security authenticated and delivered during such period in exchange for the unconverted portion of any Security converted in part during such period.
SECTION 3.03 Notice of Redemption. At least 15 days but not more than 60 days before a redemption date, the Company shall mail a notice of redemption to each holder whose Securities are to be redeemed at such holders registered address.
The notice shall identify the Securities to be redeemed and shall state:
(a) the redemption date; | |
(b) the redemption price; | |
(c) if any Security is being redeemed in part, the portion of the principal amount of such Security to be redeemed and that, after the redemption date, upon cancellation of such Security, a new Security or Securities in principal amount equal to the unredeemed portion will be issued in the name of the holder thereof; | |
(d) the name and address of the Paying Agent; |
-10-
(e) that Securities called for redemption must be surrendered to the Paying Agent to collect the redemption price plus accrued interest; | |
(f) that, unless the Company defaults in making such redemption payment or the Paying Agent is prohibited from making such payment pursuant to the terms of this Indenture, by law or otherwise, interest on Securities called for redemption ceases to accrue on and after the redemption date; and | |
(g) the paragraph of the Securities pursuant to which the Securities called for redemption are being redeemed. |
Such notice shall also state the current Conversion Price and the date on which the right to convert such Securities or portions thereof into Common Stock of the Company will expire.
At the Companys request, the Trustee shall give notice of redemption in the Companys name and at its expense.
SECTION 3.04 Effect of Notice of Redemption. Once notice of redemption is mailed, Securities called for redemption become due and payable on the redemption date at the price set forth in the Security.
SECTION 3.05 Deposit of Redemption Price. On or before the redemption date, the Company shall deposit with the Trustee or with the Paying Agent money sufficient to pay the redemption price of and accrued interest, up to but not including the redemption date on all Securities to be redeemed on that date (subject to the right of holders of record on the relevant record date to receive interest, due on an interest payment date) unless theretofore converted into Common Stock pursuant to the provisions hereof. The Trustee or the Paying Agent shall return to the Company any money not required for that purpose.
SECTION 3.06 Securities Redeemed in Part. Upon surrender of a Security that is redeemed in part, the Company shall issue and the Trustee shall authenticate for the holder at the expense of the Company a new Security equal in principal amount to the unredeemed portion of the Security surrendered.
SECTION 3.07 Optional Redemption. The Company may redeem all or any portion of the Securities, upon the terms and at the redemption price set forth in each of the Securities. Any redemption pursuant to this Section 3.07 shall be made pursuant to the provisions of Section 3.01 through 3.06 hereof.
SECTION 3.08 Change of Control Offer.
(a) In the event that, pursuant to Section 4.08 hereof, the Company shall commence a Change of Control Offer, the Company shall follow the procedures in this Section 3.08.
(b) The Change of Control Offer shall remain open for a period specified by the Company which shall be no less than 30 calendar days and no more than 40 calendar days following its commencement on the date of the mailing of notice in accordance with Section 4.08(b) hereof (the Commencement Date), except to the extent that a longer period is required by applicable law (the Tender Period). Upon the expiration of the Tender Period (the Change of Control Payment Date), the Company shall purchase the principal amount of Securities required to be purchased pursuant to Section 4.08 hereof (the Offer Amount).
(c) If the Change of Control Payment Date is on or after an interest payment record date and on or before the related interest payment date, any accrued interest, to the related interest payment date will be paid to the person in whose name a Security is registered at the close of business on such record date, and no additional interest, will be payable to Securityholders who tender Securities pursuant to the Change of Control Offer.
(d) The Company shall provide the Trustee with written notice of the Change of Control Offer at least 10 Business Days before the Commencement Date.
-11-
(e) On or before the Commencement Date, the Company or the Trustee (at the request and expense of the Company) shall send, by first class mail, a notice to each of the Securityholders, which shall govern the terms of the Change of Control Offer and shall state:
(i) that the Change of Control Offer is being made pursuant to this Section 3.08 and Section 4.08 hereof and that all Securities tendered will be accepted for payment; | |
(ii) the purchase price (as determined in accordance with Section 4.08 hereof), the length of time the Change of Control Offer will remain open and the Change of Control Payment Date; | |
(iii) that any Security or portion thereof not tendered or accepted for payment will continue to accrue interest; | |
(iv) that, unless the Company defaults in the payment of the Change of Control Payment, any Security or portion thereof accepted for payment pursuant to the Change of Control Offer shall cease to accrue interest, after the Change of Control Payment Date; | |
(v) that Securityholders electing to have a Security or portion thereof purchased pursuant to any Change of Control Offer will be required to surrender the Security, with the form entitled Option of Securityholder To Elect Purchase on the reverse of the Security completed, to the Paying Agent at the address specified in the notice prior to the close of business on the third Business Day preceding the Change of Control Payment Date; | |
(vi) that Securityholders will be entitled to withdraw their election if the Paying Agent receives, not later than the close of business on the second Business Day preceding the Change of Control Payment Date, or such longer period as may be required by law, a letter or a telegram, telex, facsimile transmission (receipt of which is confirmed and promptly followed by a letter) setting forth the name of the Securityholder, the principal amount of the Security or portion thereof the Securityholder delivered for purchase and a statement that such Securityholder is withdrawing his election to have the Security or portion thereof purchased; and | |
(vii) that Securityholders whose Securities are being purchased only in part will be issued new Securities equal in principal amount to the unpurchased portion of the Securities surrendered, which unpurchased portion must be equal to $1,000 in principal amount or an integral multiple thereof. |
In addition, the notice shall contain all instructions and materials that the Company shall reasonably deem necessary to enable such Securityholders to tender Securities pursuant to the Change of Control Offer.
(f) On or prior to the Change of Control Payment Date, the Company shall irrevocably deposit with the Trustee or a Paying Agent in immediately available funds an amount equal to the Offer Amount to be held for payment in accordance with the terms of this Section 3.08. On the Change of Control Payment Date, the Company shall, to the extent lawful, (i) accept for payment the Securities or portions thereof tendered pursuant to the Change of Control Offer, (ii) deliver or cause to be delivered to the Trustee Securities so accepted and (iii) deliver to the Trustee an Officers Certificate stating such Securities or portions thereof have been accepted for payment by the Company in accordance with the terms of this Section 3.08. The Paying Agent shall promptly (but in any case not later than five calendar days after the Change of Control Payment Date) mail or deliver to each tendering Securityholder an amount equal to the purchase price of the Securities tendered by such Securityholder, and the Trustee shall promptly authenticate and mail or deliver to such Securityholders a new Security equal in principal amount to any unpurchased portion of the Security surrendered, if any; provided, that each new Security shall be in a principal amount of $1,000 or an integral multiple thereof. Any Securities not so accepted shall be promptly mailed or delivered by or on behalf of the Company to the holder thereof. The Company will publicly announce the results of the Change of Control Offer on, or as soon as practicable after, the Change of Control Payment Date.
(g) The Change of Control Offer shall be made by the Company in compliance with all applicable provisions of the Exchange Act, and all applicable tender offer rules promulgated thereunder, and shall include all instructions and materials that the Company shall reasonably deem necessary to enable such Securityholders to tender their Securities.
-12-
SECTION 3.09 Conversion Arrangement on Underwritten Call for Redemption. In connection with any redemption of Securities, the Company may arrange for the purchase and conversion of any Securities by an arrangement with one or more investment bankers or other purchasers to purchase such Securities by paying to the Trustee in trust for the holders, on or before the date fixed for redemption, an amount not less than the applicable redemption price, together with interest accrued to (but excluding) the date fixed for redemption, of such Securities. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in this Article III, the obligation of the Company to pay the redemption price of such Securities, together with interest accrued to (but excluding) the date fixed for redemption, shall be deemed to be satisfied and discharged to the extent such amount is so paid by the purchasers. If such an agreement is entered into, a copy of which will be filed with the Trustee prior to the date fixed for redemption, any Securities not duly surrendered for conversion by the holders thereof may, at the option of the Company, be deemed, to the fullest extent permitted by law, acquired by such purchasers from such holders and (notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in Article V) surrendered by such purchasers for conversion, all as of immediately prior to the close of business on the date fixed for redemption (and the right to convert any such Securities shall be deemed to have been extended through such time), subject to payment of the above amount as aforesaid. At the direction of the Company, the Trustee shall hold and dispose of any such amount paid to it in the same manner as it would monies deposited with it by the Company for the redemption of Securities. Without the Trustees prior written consent, no arrangement between the Company and such purchasers for the purchase and conversion of any Securities shall increase or otherwise affect any of the powers, duties, responsibilities or obligations of the Trustee as set forth in this Indenture, and the Company agrees to indemnify the Trustee from, and hold it harmless against, any loss, liability or expense arising out of or in connection with any such arrangement for the purchase and conversion of any Securities between the Company and such purchasers to which the Trustee has not consented in writing, including the costs and expenses incurred by the Trustee in the defense of any claim or liability arising out of or in connection with the exercise or performance of any of its powers, duties, responsibilities or obligations under this Indenture.
ARTICLE IV
COVENANTS
SECTION 4.01 Payment of Securities. The Company shall pay the principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the dates and in the manner provided in the Securities. Principal, premium, if any, and interest, shall be considered paid on the date due if the Paying Agent (other than the Company or an Affiliate of the Company) holds on that date money designated for and sufficient to pay all principal, premium, if any, and interest, then due and such Paying Agent is not prohibited from paying such money to the Securityholders on that date pursuant to the terms of this Indenture. To the extent lawful, the Company shall pay interest (including post-petition interest in any proceeding under any Bankruptcy Law) on overdue installments of interest (without regard to any applicable grace period) at the rate borne by the Securities, compounded semiannually.
SECTION 4.02 SEC Reports. Whether or not required by the rules and Regulations of the SEC, so long as any Securities are outstanding, the Company will file with the SEC and the Trustee, and if requested by any holders of Securities, the Trustee shall furnish to the holders of Securities all quarterly and annual financial information required to be contained in a filing with the SEC on Forms 10-Q and 10-K, including a Managements Discussion and Analysis of Financial Conditions and Results of Operations and, with respect to annual information only, a report thereon by the Companys certified independent accountants.
SECTION 4.03 Compliance Certificate. The Company shall deliver to the Trustee, within 120 days after the end of each fiscal year of the Company, an Officers Certificate stating that a review of the activities of the Company and its subsidiaries during the preceding fiscal year has been made under the supervision of the signing Officers with a view to determining whether the Company has kept, observed, performed and fulfilled its obligations under, and complied with the covenants and conditions contained in, this Indenture, and further stating, as to each such Officer signing such certificate, that to the best of such Officers knowledge the Company has kept, observed, performed and fulfilled each and every covenant, and complied with the
-13-
One of the Officers signing such Officers Certificate shall be either the Companys principal executive officer, principal financial officer or principal accounting officer.
The Company will, so long as any of the Securities are outstanding, deliver to the Trustee, forthwith upon becoming aware of:
(a) any Default, Event of Default or default in the performance of any covenant, agreement or condition contained in this Indenture; or | |
(b) any event of default under any other mortgage, indenture or instrument as that term is used in Section 8.01(f), an Officers Certificate specifying such Default, Event of Default or default. |
SECTION 4.04 Stay, Extension and Usury Law. The Company covenants (to the extent that it may lawfully do so) that it will not at any time insist upon, plead, or in any manner whatsoever claim or take the benefit or advantage of, any stay, extension or usury law wherever enacted, now or at any time hereafter in force, which may affect the covenants or the performance of this Indenture; and the Company (to the extent it may lawfully do so) hereby expressly waives all benefit or advantage of any such law, and covenants that it will not, by resort to any such law, hinder, delay or impede the execution of any power herein granted to the Trustee, but will suffer and permit the execution of every such power as though no such law has been enacted.
SECTION 4.05 Corporate Existence. Except as provided in Article VII hereof, the Company will do or cause to be done all things necessary to preserve and keep in full force and effect its corporate existence and the corporate, partnership or other existence of each Subsidiary of the Company in accordance with the respective organizational documents of each Subsidiary and the rights (charter and statutory), licenses and franchises of the Company and its Subsidiaries; provided, however, that the Company shall not be required to preserve any such right, license or franchise, or the corporate, partnership or other existence of any Subsidiary, if the Company shall determine that the preservation thereof is no longer desirable in the conduct of the business of the Company and its Subsidiaries taken as a whole and that the loss thereof is not adverse in any material respect to the Securityholders.
SECTION 4.06 Maintenance of Properties. The Company will cause all properties used or useful in the conduct of its business or the business of any Subsidiary to be maintained and kept in good condition, repair and working order and supplied with all necessary equipment and will cause to be made all necessary repairs, renewals, replacements, betterments and improvements thereof, all as in the judgment of the Company may be necessary so that the business carried on in connection therewith may be properly and advantageously conducted at all times; provided, however, that nothing in this Section shall prevent the Company from discontinuing the operation or maintenance of any of such properties if such discontinuance is, in the judgment of the Company, desirable in the conduct of its business or the business of any Subsidiary and not disadvantageous in any material respect to the holders.
SECTION 4.07 Payment of Taxes and Other Claims. The Company will pay or discharge, or cause to be paid or discharged, before the same may become delinquent, (i) all taxes, assessments and governmental charges levied or imposed upon the Company or any Subsidiary or upon the income, profits or property of the Company or any Subsidiary, (ii) all claims for labor, materials and supplies which, if unpaid, might by law become a lien or charge upon the property of the Company or any Subsidiary, and (iii) all stamps and other duties, if any, which may be imposed by the United States or any political subdivision thereof or therein in connection with the issuance, transfer, exchange or conversion of any Securities or with respect to this Indenture; provided, however, that, in the case of clauses (i) and (ii), the Company shall not be required to pay or discharge or cause to be paid or discharged any such tax, assessment, charge or claim (A) if the failure to do so will not, in the aggregate, have a material adverse impact on the Company, or (B) if the amount, applicability or validity is being contested in good faith by appropriate proceedings.
-14-
SECTION 4.08 Change of Control. Upon the occurrence of a Change of Control, each holder of Securities shall have the right, in accordance with this Section 4.08 and Section 3.08 hereof, to require the Company to repurchase all or any part (equal to $1,000 or an integral multiple thereof) of such holders Securities pursuant to the terms of Section 3.08 (the Change of Control Offer) at a purchase price equal to 101% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest to the Change of Control Payment Date (the Change of Control Payment).
(a) Within 30 days following Change of Control, the Company shall mail to each holder the notice provided by Section 3.08(e). |
SECTION 4.09 Triggering Distribution. Upon the occurrence of a Triggering Distribution, each holder of Securities shall have the right, in accordance with this Section 4.09 and Article XIII hereof, to require the Company to repurchase all or any part (equal to $1,000 or an integral multiple thereof) of such holders Securities pursuant to the terms of Article XIII hereof (the Repurchase Offer) at a purchase price equal to 100% of the principal amount thereof, together with any accrued and unpaid interest (the Repurchase Payment) to the repurchase date, which repurchase date shall be on or prior to the distribution date for such Triggering Distribution (the Repurchase Payment Date). Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, in the event that such Triggering Distribution is not so paid or made, all of such holders rights to require the Company to repurchase their Securities pursuant to this Section 4.09 and Article XIII hereof as a result of such Triggering Distribution shall terminate and any pending Repurchase Offer shall be rescinded.
SECTION 4.10 Further Instruments and Acts. Upon request of the Trustee, the Company will execute and deliver such further instruments and do such further acts as may be reasonably necessary or proper to carry out more effectively the purposes of this Indenture.
ARTICLE V
CONVERSION
SECTION 5.01 Conversion Privilege. A holder of a Security may convert the principal amount thereof (or any portion thereof that is an integral multiple of $1,000) into fully paid and nonassessable shares of Common Stock of the Company at any time prior to the close of business (New York time) on the maturity date of the Security at the Conversion Price then in effect, except that, with respect to any Security called for redemption, such conversion right shall terminate at the close of business (New York time) on the Business Day immediately preceding the redemption date (unless the Company shall default in making the redemption payment when it becomes due, in which case the conversion price shall terminate on the date such default is cured). A Security in respect of which a holder has delivered an Option of Securityholder to Elect Purchase form set forth on Exhibit A hereto exercising the option of such holder to require the Company to purchase such Security may be converted only if the notice of exercise is withdrawn as provided in accordance with Section 3.08 hereof. The number of shares of Common Stock issuable upon conversion of a Security is determined by dividing the principal amount of the Security converted by the conversion price in effect on the Conversion Date (the Conversion Price).
The initial Conversion Price is stated in paragraph 10 of the Securities and is subject to adjustment as provided in this Article V.
Provisions of this Indenture that apply to conversion of all of a Security also apply to conversion of a portion of it. A holder of Securities is not entitled to any rights of a holder of Common Stock until such holder of Securities has converted such Securities into Common Stock, and only to the extent that such Securities are deemed to have been converted into Common Stock under this Article V.
SECTION 5.02 Conversion Procedure. To convert a Security, a holder must satisfy the requirements in paragraph 10 of the Securities. The date on which the holder satisfies all of those requirements is the conversion date (the Conversion Date). As soon as practicable after the Conversion Date, the Company shall deliver to the holder through the Conversion Agent a certificate for the number of whole shares of Common Stock issuable upon the conversion and a check for any fractional share determined pursuant to
-15-
No payment or adjustment will be made for accrued and unpaid interest on a converted Security or for dividends or distributions on shares of Common Stock issued upon conversion of a Security, but if any holder surrenders a Security for conversion after the close of business on the record date for the payment of an installment of interest and prior to the opening of business on the next interest payment date, then, notwithstanding such conversion, the interest payable on such interest payment date shall be paid to the holder of such Security on such record date. In such event, unless such Security has been called for redemption on or prior to such interest payment date, such Security, when surrendered for conversion, must be accompanied by payment in funds acceptable to the Company of an amount equal to the interest payable on such interest payment date on the portion so converted.
If a holder converts more than one Security at the same time, the number of whole shares of Common Stock issuable upon the conversion shall be based on the total principal amount of Securities converted.
Upon surrender of a Security that is converted in part, the Trustee shall authenticate for the holder a new Security equal in principal amount to the unconverted portion of the Security surrendered.
SECTION 5.03 Fractional Shares. The Company will not issue fractional shares of Common Stock upon conversion of a Security. In lieu thereof, the Company will pay an amount in cash based upon the Daily Market Price of the Common Stock on the Trading Day prior to the date of conversion.
SECTION 5.04 Taxes on Conversion. The issuance of certificates for shares of Common Stock upon the conversion of any Security shall be made without charge to the converting Securityholder for such certificates or for any tax in respect of the issuance of such certificates, and such certificates shall be issued in the respective names of, or in such names as may be directed by, the holder or holders of the converted Security; provided, however, that in the event that certificates for shares of Common Stock are to be issued in a name other than the name of the holder of the Security converted, such Security, when surrendered for conversion, shall be accompanied by an instrument of transfer, in form satisfactory to the Company, duly executed by the registered holder thereof or his duly authorized attorney; and provided further, however, that the Company shall not be required to pay any tax which may be payable in respect of any transfer involved in the issuance and delivery of any such certificates in a name other than that of the holder of the converted Security, and the Company shall not be required to issue or deliver such certificates unless or until the person or persons requesting the issuance thereof shall have paid to the Company the amount of such tax or shall have established to the satisfaction of the Company that such tax has been paid or is not applicable.
SECTION 5.05 Company to Provide Stock. The Company shall at all times reserve and keep available, free from preemptive rights, out of its authorized but unissued Common Stock, solely for the purpose of issuance upon conversion of Securities as herein provided, a sufficient number of shares of Common Stock to permit the conversion of all outstanding Securities for shares of Common Stock.
All shares of Common Stock which may be issued upon conversion of the Securities shall be duly authorized, validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable when so issued.
-16-
SECTION 5.06 Adjustment of Conversion Price. The Conversion Price shall be subject to adjustment from time to time as follows:
(a) In case the Company shall (1) pay a dividend in shares of Common Stock to holders of Common Stock, (2) make a distribution in shares of Common Stock to holders of Common Stock, (3) subdivide its outstanding shares of Common Stock into a greater number of shares of Common Stock or (4) combine its outstanding shares of Common Stock into a smaller number of shares of Common Stock, the Conversion Price in effect immediately prior to such action shall be adjusted so that the holder of any Security thereafter surrendered for conversion shall be entitled to receive the number of shares of Common Stock which he would have owned immediately following such action had such Securities been converted immediately prior thereto. Any adjustment made pursuant to this subsection (a) shall become effective immediately after the record date in the case of a dividend or distribution and shall become effective immediately after the effective date in the case of a subdivision or combination. | |
(b) In case the Company shall issue rights or warrants to substantially all holders of Common Stock entitling them (for a period commencing no earlier than the record date for the determination of holders of Common Stock entitled to receive such rights or warrants and expiring not more than 45 days after such record date) to subscribe for or purchase shares of Common Stock (or securities convertible into Common Stock) at a price per share less than the Current Market Price (as determined pursuant to subsection (f) below) of the Common Stock on such record date, the Conversion Price shall be adjusted so that the same shall equal the price determined by multiplying the Conversion Price in effect immediately prior to such record date by a fraction of which the numerator shall be the number of shares of Common Stock outstanding on such record date, plus the number of shares of Common Stock which the aggregate offering price of the offered shares of Common Stock (or the aggregate conversion price of the convertible securities so offered) would purchase at such Current Market Price, and of which the denominator shall be the number of shares of Common Stock outstanding on such record date plus the number of additional shares of Common Stock offered (or into which the convertible securities so offered are convertible). Such adjustments shall become effective immediately after such record date. | |
(c) In case the Company shall distribute to all holders of Common Stock shares of any class of Capital Stock of the Company (other than Common Stock referred to in subsection (a) above), evidences of indebtedness or other assets (other than cash dividends out of current or retained earnings), or shall distribute to substantially all holders of Common Stock rights or warrants to subscribe for securities (other than those Securities referred to in subsection (b) above), then in each such case the Conversion Price shall be adjusted so that the same shall equal the price determined by multiplying the Conversion Price in effect immediately prior to the date of such distribution by a fraction of which the numerator shall be the Current Market Price (determined as provided in subsection (f) below) of the Common Stock on the record date mentioned below less the then fair market value (as determined by the Board of Directors, whose determination shall be conclusive evidence of such fair market value and described in a Board Resolution) of the portion of the assets so distributed or of such subscription rights or warrants applicable to one share of Common Stock, and of which the denominator shall be such Current Market Price of the Common Stock. Such adjustment shall become effective immediately after the record date for the determination of the holders of Common Stock entitled to receive such distribution. Notwithstanding the foregoing, in case the Company shall issue rights or warrants to subscribe for additional shares of the Companys capital stock (other than those referred to in subsection (b) above) (Rights) to substantially all holders of Common Stock, the Company may, in lieu of making any adjustment pursuant to this Section 5.06, make proper provision so that each holder of a Security who converts such Security (or any portion thereof) after the record date for such distribution and prior to the expiration or redemption of the Rights shall be entitled to receive upon such conversion, in addition to the shares of Common Stock issuable upon such conversion (the Conversion Shares), a number of Rights to be determined as follows: (i) if such conversion occurs on or prior to the date for the distribution to the holders of Rights of separate certificates evidencing such Rights (the Distribution Date), the same number of Rights to which a holder of a number of shares of Common Stock equal to the number of Conversion Shares is entitled at the time of such conversion in accordance with the terms |
-17-
and provisions of and applicable to the Rights; and (ii) if such conversion occurs after the Distribution Date, the same number of Rights to which a holder of the number of shares of Common Stock into which the principal amount of the Security so converted was convertible immediately prior to the Distribution Date would have been entitled on the Distribution Date in accordance with the terms and provisions of and applicable to the Rights. In the event the Company implements a shareholder rights plan, such rights plan must provide that upon conversion of the Securities the holders will receive, in addition to the Common Stock issuable upon such conversion, such rights (whether or not such rights have separated from the Common Stock at the time of such conversion). | |
(d) In case the Company shall, by dividend or otherwise, at any time distribute to all holders of its Common Stock cash (including any distributions of cash out of current or retained earnings of the Company but excluding any cash that is distributed as part of a distribution requiring a Conversion Price adjustment pursuant to paragraph (c) of this Section) in an aggregate amount that, together with the sum of (x) the aggregate amount of any other distributions to all holders of its Common Stock made in cash plus (y) all Excess Payments, in each case made within the 12 months preceding the date fixed for determining the shareholders entitled to such distribution (the Distribution Record Date) and in respect of which no Conversion Price adjustment pursuant to paragraphs (c) or (e) of this Section or this paragraph (d) has been made, exceeds 15% of the product of the Current Market Price per share (determined as provided in paragraph (f) of this Section) of the Common Stock on the Distribution Record Date multiplied by the number of shares of Common Stock outstanding on the Distribution Record Date (excluding shares held in the treasury of the Company), the Conversion Price shall be reduced so that the same shall equal the price determined by multiplying such Conversion Price in effect immediately prior to the effectiveness of the Conversion Price reduction contemplated by this paragraph (d) by a fraction of which the numerator shall be the Current Market Price per share (determined as provided in paragraph (f) of this Section) of the Common Stock on the Distribution Record Date less the amount of such cash and other consideration (including any Excess Payments) so distributed applicable to one share of Common Stock (equal to the aggregate amount of such cash and other consideration (including any Excess Payments) divided by the number of shares of Common Stock outstanding on the Distribution Record Date) and the denominator shall be such Current Market Price per share (determined as provided in paragraph (f) of this Section) of the Common Stock on the Distribution Record Date, such reduction to become effective immediately prior to the opening of business on the day following the Distribution Record Date. | |
(e) In case a tender offer or other negotiated transaction made by the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company for all or any portion of the Common Stock shall be consummated, if an Excess Payment is made in respect of such tender offer or other negotiated transaction and the amount of such Excess Payment, together with the sum of (x) the aggregate amount of all Excess Payments plus (y) the aggregate amount of all distributions to all holders of the Common Stock made in cash (including any distributions of cash out of current or retained earnings of the Company), in each case made within the 12 months preceding the date of payment of such current negotiated transaction consideration or expiration of such current tender offer, as the case may be (the Purchase Date), and as to which no adjustment pursuant to paragraph (c) or paragraph (d) of this Section or this paragraph (e) has been made, exceeds 15% of the product of the Current Market Price per share (determined as provided in paragraph (f) of this Section) of the Common Stock on the Purchase Date multiplied by the number of shares of Common Stock outstanding (including any tendered shares but excluding any shares held in the treasury of the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company) on the Purchase Date, the Conversion Price shall be reduced so that the same shall equal the price determined by multiplying such Conversion Price in effect immediately prior to the effectiveness of the Conversion Price reduction contemplated by this paragraph (e) by a fraction of which the numerator shall be the Current Market Price per share (determined as provided in paragraph (f) of this Section) of the Common Stock on the Purchase Date less the amount of such Excess Payments and such cash distributions, if any, applicable to one share of Common Stock (equal to the aggregate amount of such Excess Payments and such cash distributions divided by the number of shares of Common Stock outstanding on the Purchase Date) and the denominator shall be such Current Market Price per share (determined as provided in paragraph (f) of |
-18-
this Section) of the Common Stock on the Purchase Date, such reduction to become effective immediately prior to the opening of business on the day following the Purchase Date. | |
(f) The Current Market Price per share of Common Stock on any date shall be deemed to be the average of the Daily Market Prices for the shorter of (i) 30 consecutive Business Days ending on the last full Trading Day on the exchange or market referred to in determining such Daily Market Prices prior to the time of determination or (ii) the period commencing on the date next succeeding the first public announcement of the issuance of such rights or such warrants or such other distribution or such negotiated transaction through such last full Trading Day on the exchange or market referred to in determining such Daily Market Prices prior to the time of determination. | |
(g) In any case in which this Section 5.06 shall require that an adjustment be made immediately following a record date for an event, the Company may elect to defer, until such event, issuing to the holder of any Security converted after such record date the shares of Common Stock and other Capital Stock of the Company issuable upon such conversion over and above the shares of Common Stock and other Capital Stock of the Company issuable upon such conversion only on the basis of the Conversion Price prior to adjustment; and, in lieu of the shares the issuance of which is so deferred, the Company shall issue or cause its transfer agents to issue due bills or other appropriate evidence of the right to receive such shares. |
SECTION 5.07 No Adjustment. No adjustment in the Conversion Price shall be required until cumulative adjustments amount to 1% or more of the Conversion Price as last adjusted; provided, however, that any adjustments which by reason of this Section 5.07 are not required to be made shall be carried forward and taken into account in any subsequent adjustment. All calculations under this Article V shall be made to the nearest cent or to the nearest one-hundredth of a share, as the case may be. No adjustment need be made for rights to purchase Common Stock pursuant to a Company plan for reinvestment of dividends or interest. No adjustment need be made for a change in the par value or no par value of the Common Stock.
SECTION 5.08 Other Adjustments. In the event that, as a result of an adjustment made pursuant to Section 5.06 above, the holder of any Security thereafter surrendered for conversion shall become entitled to receive any shares of Capital Stock of the Company other than shares of its Common Stock, thereafter the Conversion Price of such other shares so receivable upon conversion of any Securities shall be subject to adjustment from time to time in a manner and on terms as nearly equivalent as practicable to the provisions with respect to Common Stock contained in this Article V.
In the event that shares of Common Stock are not delivered after the expiration of any of the rights or warrants referred to in Section 5.06(b) and Section 5.06(c) hereof, the Conversion Price shall be readjusted to the Conversion Price which would otherwise be in effect had the adjustment made upon the issuance of such rights or warrants been made on the basis of delivery of only the number of shares of Common Stock actually delivered.
SECTION 5.09 Adjustments for Tax Purposes. The Company may, at its option, make such reductions in the Conversion Price, in addition to those required by Section 5.06 above, as it determines to be advisable in order that any stock dividend, subdivision of shares, distribution of rights to purchase stock or securities or distribution of securities convertible into or exchangeable for stock made by the Company to its shareholders will not be taxable to the recipients thereof
SECTION 5.10 Adjustments by the Company. The Company from time to time may, to the extent permitted by law, reduce the Conversion Price by any amount for any period of at least 20 days, in which case the Company shall give at least 15 days notice of such reduction in accordance with Section 5.11, if the Board of Directors has made a determination that such reduction would be in the best interests of the Company, which determination shall be conclusive.
SECTION 5.11 Notice of Adjustment. Whenever the Conversion Price is adjusted, the Company shall promptly mail to Securityholders at the addresses appearing on the Registrars books a notice of the adjustment and file with the Trustee an Officers Certificate briefly stating the facts requiring the adjustment
-19-
SECTION 5.12 Notice of Certain Transactions. In the event that:
(1) the Company takes any action which would require an adjustment in the Conversion Price; | |
(2) the Company takes any action that would require a supplemental indenture pursuant to Section 5.13; or | |
(3) there is a dissolution or liquidation of the Company; a holder of a Security may wish to convert such Security into shares of Common Stock prior to the record date for or the effective date of the transaction so that he may receive the rights, warrants, securities or assets which a holder of shares of Common Stock on that date may receive. Therefore, the Company shall mail a notice to Securityholders at the addresses appearing on the Registrars books and deliver to the Trustee an Officers Certificate, in each case stating the proposed record or effective date, as the case may be. The Company shall mail the notice and deliver such Officers Certificate at least 15 days before such date; however, failure to mail such notice or any defect therein shall not affect the validity of any transaction referred to in clause (1), (2) or (3) of this Section 5.12. |
SECTION 5.13 Effect of Reclassifications, Consolidations, Mergers or Sales on Conversion Privilege. If any of the following shall occur, namely: (i) any reclassification or change of outstanding shares of Common Stock issuable upon conversion of Securities (other than a change in par value, or from par value to no par value, or from no par value to par value, or as a result of a subdivision or combination), (ii) any consolidation or merger to which the Company is a party other than a merger in which the Company is the continuing corporation and which does not result in any reclassification of, or change (other than a change in name, or par value, or from par value to no par value, or from no par value to par value or as a result of a subdivision or combination) in, outstanding shares of Common Stock or (iii) any sale or conveyance of all or substantially all of the property or business of the Company as an entirety, then the Company, or such successor or purchasing Corporate Entity, as the case may be, shall, as a condition precedent to such reclassification, change, consolidation, merger, sale or conveyance, execute and deliver to the Trustee a supplemental indenture in form satisfactory to the Trustee providing that the holder of each Security then outstanding shall have the right to convert such Security into the kind and amount of shares of stock and other securities and property (including cash) receivable upon such reclassification, change, consolidation, merger, sale or conveyance by a holder of the number of shares of Common Stock deliverable upon conversion of such Security immediately prior to such reclassification, change, consolidation, merger, sale or conveyance. Such supplemental indenture shall provide for adjustments of the Conversion Price which shall be as nearly equivalent as may be practicable to the adjustments of the Conversion Price provided for in this Article V. The foregoing, however, shall not in any way affect the right a holder of a Security may otherwise have, pursuant to clause (ii) of the last sentence of subsection (c) of Section 5.06, to receive Rights upon conversion of a Security. If, in the case of any such consolidation, merger, sale or conveyance, the stock or other securities and property (including cash) receivable thereupon by a holder of Common Stock includes shares of stock or other securities and property of a corporation other than the successor or purchasing corporation, as the case may be, in such consolidation, merger, sale or conveyance, then such supplemental indenture shall also be executed by such other corporation and shall contain such additional provisions to protect the interests of the holders of the Securities as the Board of Directors shall reasonably consider necessary by reason of the foregoing. The provision of this Section 5.13 shall similarly apply to successive consolidations, mergers, sales or conveyances.
In the event the Company shall execute a supplemental indenture pursuant to this Section 5.13, the Company shall promptly file with the Trustee an Officers Certificate briefly stating the reasons therefor, the kind or amount of shares of stock or securities or property (including cash) receivable by holders of the Securities upon the conversion of their Securities after any such reclassification, change, consolidation, merger, sale or conveyance and any adjustment to be made with respect thereto.
SECTION 5.14 Trustees Disclaimer. The Trustee has no duty to determine when an adjustment under this Article V should be made, how it should be made or what such adjustment should be, but may accept as
-20-
The Trustee shall not be under any responsibility to determine the correctness of any provisions contained in any supplemental indenture executed pursuant to Section 5.13, but may accept as conclusive evidence of the correctness thereof, and shall be protected in relying upon, the Officers Certificate with respect thereto which the Company is obligated to file with the Trustee pursuant to Section 5.13.
SECTION 5.15 Automatic Conversion. The Company may elect to automatically convert (Automatic Conversion) the Securities on or prior to maturity if the Daily Market Price of the Common Stock has exceeded 150% of the Conversion Price for at least 20 Trading Days out of the 30 consecutive Trading Days ending within five Trading Days prior to the date of (the Notice Date) the notice of automatic conversion (the Automatic Conversion Notice).
In order to effect an Automatic Conversion, the Company shall give to the holder of each Security to be so converted an Automatic Conversion Notice. Such Automatic Conversion Notice shall state:
(i) the date on which the Securities identified in the Automatic Conversion Notice will be converted (the Automatic Conversion Date); | |
(ii) the CUSIP number or numbers of such Securities; | |
(iii) the place or places where such Securities in certificated form are to be surrendered for exchange of the shares of Common Stock to be issued upon conversion thereof; | |
(iv) the lowest Daily Market Price of the Common Stock for at least 20 Trading Days out of the 30 consecutive Trading Days ending within five Trading Days prior to the giving of the Automatic Conversion Notice; and | |
(v) the Conversion Price at which such Automatic Conversion is to be effected. |
If the Company elects to effect an Automatic Conversion Notice in respect of fewer than all the Securities, the Automatic Conversion Notice relating to such Automatic Conversion shall reference this Section 5.15 and shall identify the Securities to be converted. In case any Security is to be converted in part only, the Automatic Conversion Notice relating thereto shall state the portion of the principal amount thereof to be converted and shall state that on and after the date fixed for conversion, upon surrender of such Security, a new Securities in principal amount equal to the portion thereof not converted will be issued. In the case where the Company elects to effect an Automatic Conversion in respect of any portion of the Security evidenced by the Global Security, the beneficial interests in the Global Security to be subject to such Automatic Conversion shall be selected by the Depositary in accordance with the applicable standing procedures of the Depositarys book-entry conversion program, and in connection with such Automatic Conversion the Depositary shall arrange in accordance with such procedures for appropriate endorsements and transfer documents, if required by the Company or the Trustee or conversion agent, and payment of any transfer taxes if required hereunder.
The Company or, at the request and expense of the Company, the Trustee, upon ten Business Days notice prior to the date of the requested mailing (or upon such shorter notice period as may be reasonably acceptable to the Trustee) shall give to each holder of Securities to be converted in an Automatic Conversion, at its last address as the same shall appear on the Registrar, an Automatic Conversion Notice in respect thereof. The date of Automatic Conversion of the Securities shall be not less than 7 days nor more than 15 days from the Notice Date. Such Automatic Conversion Notice shall be irrevocable and shall be mailed by first class mail and, if mailed in the manner herein provided, shall be conclusively presumed to have been given, whether or not the holder receives it. In any case, failure to give such notice or any defect in the notice
-21-
ARTICLE VI
SUBORDINATION
SECTION 6.01 Agreement to Subordinate. The Company, for itself and its successors, and each Securityholder, by his acceptance of Securities, agree that the payment of the principal of, premium, if any, or interest or any other amounts due on the Securities is subordinated in right of payment, to the extent and in the manner stated in this Article VI, to the prior payment in full of all existing and future Senior Debt.
SECTION 6.02 No Payment on Securities if Senior Debt in Default. Anything in this Indenture to the contrary notwithstanding, no payment on account of principal of, premium, if any, or interest, or any other amounts due on the Securities (including, without limitation, any Change of Control Payments), and no redemption, purchase, or other acquisition of the Securities (including, without limitation, pursuant to a Change of Control Offer or Repurchase Offer), shall be made by or on behalf of the Company (i) unless full payment of amounts then due for principal and interest and of all other amounts then due on all Senior Debt has been made or duly provided for pursuant to the terms of the instrument governing such Senior Debt, (ii) if, at the time of such payment, redemption, purchase or other acquisition, or immediately after giving effect thereto, there shall exist under any Senior Debt, or any agreement pursuant to which any Senior Debt is issued, any default, which default shall not have been cured or waived and which default shall have resulted in the full amount of such Senior Debt being declared due and payable or (iii) if, at the time of such payment, redemption, purchase or other acquisition, the Trustee shall have received written notice from the holders of Designated Senior Debt or a Representative of such holders (a Payment Blockage Notice) that there exists under such Designated Senior Debt, or any agreement pursuant to which such Designated Senior Debt is issued, any default, which default shall not have been cured or waived, permitting the holders thereof to declare any amounts of such Designated Senior Debt due and payable, but only for the period (the Payment Blockage Period) commencing on the date of receipt of the Payment Blockage Notice and ending (unless earlier terminated by notice given to the Trustee by the Representative of the holders of such Designated Senior Debt) on the earlier of (a) the date on which such event of default shall have been cured or waived or (b) 180 days from the receipt of the Payment Blockage Notice. Notwithstanding the provisions described in the immediately preceding sentence (other than in clauses (i) and (ii)), unless the holders of such Designated Senior Debt or the Representative of such holders shall have accelerated the maturity of such Designated Senior Debt, the Company may resume payments on the Securities after the end of such Payment Blockage Period. Not more than one Payment Blockage Notice may be given in any consecutive 360-day period, irrespective of the number of defaults with respect to Senior Debt during such period.
In the event that, notwithstanding the provisions of this Section 6.02, payments are made by or on behalf of the Company in contravention of the provisions of this Section 6.02, such payments shall be held by the Trustee, any Paying Agent or the holders, as applicable, in trust for the benefit of, and shall be paid over to and delivered to the holders of Senior Debt or the Representative under the indenture or other agreement (if any) pursuant to which any instruments evidencing any Senior Debt may have been issued for application to the payment of all Senior Debt ratably according to the aggregate amounts remaining unpaid to the extent necessary to pay all Senior Debt in full in accordance with the terms of such Senior Debt, after giving effect to any concurrent payment or distribution to or for the holders of Senior Debt.
The Company shall give prompt written notice to the Trustee and any Paying Agent of any default or event of default under any Senior Debt or under any agreement pursuant to which any Senior Debt may have been issued. The Trustee and the Paying Agent may assume that all payments have been made with respect to all Senior Debt unless the Trustee or the Paying Agent, as the case may be, has received written notice that payment has not been made and three (3) Business Days have expired.
-22-
SECTION 6.03 Distribution on Acceleration of Securities; Dissolution and Reorganization: Subrogation of Securities.
(a) If the Securities are declared due and payable because of the occurrence of an Event of Default, the Company shall give prompt written notice to the holders of all Senior Debt or to the trustee(s) for such Senior Debt of such acceleration. The Company may not pay the principal of or interest or any other amounts due on the Securities until five Business Days after such holders or trustee(s) of Senior Debt receive such notice and, thereafter, the Company may pay the principal of or interest or any other amounts due on the Securities only if the provisions of this Article VI permit such payment.
(b) Upon (i) any acceleration of the principal amount due on the Securities because of an Event of Default or (ii) any direct or indirect distribution of assets of the Company upon any dissolution, winding up, liquidation or reorganization of the Company (whether in bankruptcy, insolvency or receivership proceedings or upon an assignment for the benefit of creditors or any other dissolution, winding up, liquidation or reorganization of the Company):
(1) the holders of all Senior Debt shall first be entitled to receive payment in full of the principal thereof, the interest thereon and any other amounts due thereon before the holders are entitled to receive payment on account of the principal of or interest or any other amounts due on the Securities; | |
(2) any payment or distribution of assets of the Company of any kind or character, whether in cash, property or securities (other than securities of the Company as reorganized or readjusted or securities of the Company or any other corporation provided for by a plan of reorganization or readjustment the payment of which is subordinate, at least to the extent provided in this Article with respect to the Securities, to the payment in full without diminution or modification by such plan of all Senior Debt), to which the holders or the Trustee would be entitled except for the provisions of this Article, shall be paid by the liquidating trustee or agent or other person making such a payment or distribution, directly to the holders of Senior Debt (or Representative acting on their behalf), ratably according to the aggregate amounts remaining unpaid on account of the principal of or interest on and other amounts due on the Senior Debt held or represented by each, to the extent necessary to make payment in full of all Senior Debt remaining unpaid, after giving effect to any concurrent payment or distribution to the holders of such Senior Debt; and | |
(3) in the event that, notwithstanding the foregoing, any payment or distribution of assets of the Company of any kind or character, whether in cash, property or securities (other than securities of the Company as reorganized or readjusted, or securities of the Company or any other corporation provided for by a plan of reorganization or readjustment the payment of which is subordinate, at least to the extent provided in this Article with respect to the Securities, to the payment in full without diminution or modification by such plan of Senior Debt), shall be received by the Trustee or the holders before all Senior Debt is paid in full, such payment or distribution shall be held in trust for the benefit of, and be paid over to upon request by a holder of the Senior Debt, the holders of the Senior Debt remaining unpaid (or their Representative acting on their behalf), ratably as aforesaid, for application to the payment of such Senior Debt until all such Senior Debt shall have been paid in full, after giving effect to any concurrent payment or distribution to the holders of such Senior Debt. |
Subject to the payment in full of all Senior Debt, the holders shall be subrogated to the rights of the holders of Senior Debt to receive payments or distributions of cash, property or securities of the Company applicable to the Senior Debt until the principal of and interest shall be paid in full and, for purposes of such subrogation, no such payments or distributions to the holders of Senior Debt of cash, property or securities which otherwise would have been payable or distributable to holders shall, as among the Company, its creditors other than the holders of Senior Debt, and the holders, be deemed to be a payment by the Company to or on account of the Senior Debt, it being understood that the provisions of this Article are and are intended solely for the purpose of defining the relative rights of the holders, on the one hand, and the holders of Senior Debt, on the other hand.
Nothing contained in this Article or elsewhere in this Indenture or in the Securities is intended to or shall (i) impair, as between the Company and its creditors other than the holders of Senior Debt, the obligation of
-23-
Upon distribution of assets of the Company referred to in this Article, the Trustee, subject to the provisions of Section 9.01 hereof, and the holders shall be entitled to rely upon a certificate of the liquidating trustee or agent or other person making any distribution to the Trustee or to the holders for the purpose of ascertaining the persons entitled to participate in such distribution, the holders of the Senior Debt and other indebtedness of the Company, the amount thereof or payable thereon, the amount or amounts paid or distributed thereon and all other facts pertinent thereto or to this Article. The Trustee, however, shall not be deemed to owe any fiduciary duty to the holders of Senior Debt. Nothing contained in this Article or elsewhere in this Indenture, or in any of the Securities, shall prevent the good faith application by the Trustee of any moneys which were deposited with it hereunder, prior to its receipt of written notice of facts which would prohibit such application, for the purpose of the payment of or on account of the principal of, or interest unless, prior to the date on which such application is made by the Trustee, the Trustee shall be charged with actual notice under Section 6.03(d) hereof of the facts which would prohibit the making of such application.
(c) The provisions of this Article shall not be applicable to any cash, properties or securities received by the Trustee or by any holder when received as a holder of Senior Debt and nothing in Section 9.11 hereof or elsewhere in this Indenture shall deprive the Trustee or such holder of any of its rights as such holder of Senior Debt.
(d) The Company shall give prompt written notice to the Trustee of any fact known to the Company which would prohibit the making of any payment of money to or by the Trustee in respect of the Securities pursuant to the provisions of this Article. The Trustee, subject to the provisions of Section 9.01 hereof, shall be entitled to assume that no such fact exists unless the Company or any holder of Senior Debt or any Representative therefor has given written notice thereof to the Trustee. Notwithstanding the provisions of this Article or any other provisions of this Indenture, the Trustee shall not be charged with knowledge of the existence of any fact which would prohibit the making of any payment of moneys to or by the Trustee in respect of the Securities pursuant to the provisions in this Article, unless, and until three Business Days after, the Trustee shall have received written notice thereof from the Company or any holder or holders of Senior Debt or from any Representative therefor; and, prior to the receipt of any such written notice, the Trustee, subject to the provisions of Section 9.01 hereof, shall be entitled in all respects conclusively to assume that no such facts exist; provided that if on a date not less than three Business Days immediately preceding the date upon which, by the terms hereof, any such moneys may become payable for any purpose (including, without limitation, the principal of or interest), the Trustee shall not have received with respect to such moneys the notice provided for in this Section 6.03(d), then anything herein contained to the contrary notwithstanding, the Trustee shall have full power and authority to receive such moneys and to apply the same to the purpose for which they were received, and shall not be affected by any notice to the contrary which may be received by it on or after such prior date.
The Trustee shall be entitled to conclusively rely on the delivery to it of a written notice by a person representing himself to be a holder of Senior Debt (or a Representative on behalf of such holder) to establish that such notice has been given by a holder of Senior Debt (or a Representative on behalf of any such holder or holders). In the event that the Trustee determines in good faith that further evidence is required with respect to the right of any person as a holder of Senior Debt to participate in any payment or distribution pursuant to this Article, the Trustee may request such person to furnish evidence to the reasonable satisfaction of the Trustee as to the amount of Senior Debt held by such person, the extent to which such person is entitled to participate in such payment or distribution and any other facts pertinent to the rights of such person under this Article, and, if such evidence is not furnished, the Trustee may defer any payment to such person pending judicial determination as to the right of such person to receive such payment; nor shall the Trustee be charged
-24-
(e) The provisions of this Section 6.03 applicable to the Trustee shall (unless the context requires otherwise) also apply to any Paying Agent for the Company.
SECTION 6.04 Reliance by Holders of Senior Debt on Subordination Provisions. Each holder of any Security by his acceptance thereof acknowledges and agrees that the foregoing subordination provisions are, and are intended to be, an inducement and a consideration for each holder of any Senior Debt, whether such Senior Debt was created or acquired before or after the issuance of the Securities, to acquire and continue to hold, or to continue to hold, such Senior Debt, and such holder of Senior Debt shall be deemed conclusively to have relied on such subordination provisions in acquiring and continuing to hold, or in continuing to hold, such Senior Debt. Notice of any default in the payment of any Senior Debt, except as expressly stated in this Article, and notice of acceptance of the provisions hereof are hereby expressly waived. Except as otherwise expressly provided herein, no waiver, forbearance or release by any holder of Senior Debt under such Senior Debt or under this Article shall constitute a release of any of the obligations or liabilities of the Trustee or holders of the Securities provided in this Article.
SECTION 6.05 No Waiver of Subordination Provisions. Except as otherwise expressly provided herein, no right of any present or future holder of any Senior Debt to enforce subordination as herein provided shall at any time in any way be prejudiced or impaired by any act or failure to act on the part of the Company or by any act or failure to act, in good faith, by any such holder, or by any noncompliance by the Company with the terms, provisions and covenants of this Indenture, regardless of any knowledge thereof any such holder may have or be otherwise charged with.
Without in any way limiting the generality of the foregoing paragraph, the holders of Senior Debt may, at any time and from time to time, without the consent of, or notice to, the Trustee or the holders of the Securities, without incurring responsibility to the holders of the Securities and without impairing or releasing the subordination provided in this Article VI or the obligations hereunder of the holders of the Securities to the holders of Senior Debt, do any one or more of the following: (i) change the manner, place or terms of payment of, or renew or alter, Senior Debt, or otherwise amend or supplement in any manner Senior Debt or any instrument evidencing the same or any agreement under which Senior Debt is outstanding; (ii) sell, exchange, release or otherwise dispose of any property pledged, mortgaged or otherwise securing Senior Debt; (iii) release any person liable in any manner for the collection of Senior Debt; and (iv) exercise or refrain from exercising any rights against the Company or any other person.
SECTION 6.06 Trustees Relation to Senior Debt. The Trustee in its individual capacity shall be entitled to all the rights set forth in this Article in respect of any Senior Debt at any time held by it, to the same extent as any holder of Senior Debt, and nothing in Section 9.11 hereof or elsewhere in this Indenture shall deprive the Trustee of any of its rights as such holder.
With respect to the holders of Senior Debt, the Trustee undertakes to perform or to observe only such of its covenants and obligations, as are specifically set forth in this Article, and no implied covenants or obligations with respect to the holders of Senior Debt shall be read into this Indenture against the Trustee. The Trustee shall not owe any fiduciary duty to the holders of Senior Debt but shall have only such obligations to such holders as are expressly set forth in this Article.
Each holder of a Security by his acceptance thereof authorizes and directs the Trustee on his behalf to take such action as may be necessary or appropriate to effectuate the subordination provided in this Article and appoints the Trustee his attorney-in-fact for any and all such purposes, including, in the event of any dissolution, winding up or liquidation or reorganization under any applicable bankruptcy law of the Company (whether in bankruptcy, insolvency or receivership proceedings or otherwise), the timely filing of a claim for the unpaid balance of such holders Securities in the form required in such proceedings and the causing of such claim to be approved. If the Trustee does not file a claim or proof of debt in the form required in such proceedings prior to 30 days before the expiration of the time to file such claims or proofs, then any holder or
-25-
SECTION 6.07 Other Provisions Subject Hereto. Except as expressly stated in this Article, notwithstanding anything contained in this Indenture to the contrary, all the provisions of this Indenture and the Securities are subject to the provisions of this Article. However, nothing in this Article shall apply to or adversely affect the claims of, or payment to, the Trustee pursuant to Section 9.07. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the failure to make a payment on account of principal of or interest by reason of any provision of this Article VI shall not be construed as preventing the occurrence of an Event of Default under Section 8.01.
SECTION 6.08 Certain Conversions and Repurchases Deemed Payment. For the purposes of this Article only, (i) the issuance and delivery of junior securities upon conversion of Securities in accordance with Article V shall not be deemed to constitute a payment or distribution on account of the principal of or premium or interest or on account of the purchase or other acquisition of Securities, and (ii) the payment, issuance or delivery of cash (except in satisfaction of fractional shares pursuant to Section 5.03), property or securities (other than junior securities) upon conversion of a Security shall be deemed to constitute payment on account of the principal of such Security. For the purposes of this Section, the term junior securities means (a) shares of any stock of any class of the Company and securities into which the Securities are convertible pursuant to Article V and (b) securities of the Company which are subordinated in right of payment to all Senior Debt which may be outstanding at the time of issuance or delivery of such securities to substantially the same extent as, or to a greater extent than, the Securities are so subordinated as provided in this Article. Nothing contained in this Article or elsewhere in this Indenture or in the Securities is intended to or shall impair, as among the Company, its creditors other than holders of Senior Debt and the holders of the Securities, the right, which is absolute and unconditional, of the holder of any Security to convert such Security in accordance with Article V.
ARTICLE VII
SUCCESSORS
SECTION 7.01 Merger, Consolidation or Sale of Assets. The Company may not consolidate or merge with or into any person (whether or not the Company is the surviving entity), or sell, assign, transfer, lease, convey or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of its properties or assets unless:
(a) the Company is the surviving Corporate Entity or the Corporate Entity formed by or surviving any such consolidation or merger (if other than the Company) or to which such sale, assignment, transfer, lease, conveyance or other disposition shall have been made is a Corporate Entity organized or existing under the laws of the United States, any state thereof or the District of Columbia; | |
(b) the Corporate Entity formed by or surviving any such consolidation or merger (if other than the Company) or the Corporate Entity to which such sale, assignment, transfer, lease, conveyance or other disposition will have been made assumes all the Obligations of the Company, pursuant to a supplemental indenture in a form reasonably satisfactory to the Trustee, under the Securities and the Indenture; | |
(c) immediately after such transaction no Default or Event of Default exists; and | |
(d) the Company or such person shall have delivered to the Trustee an Officers Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel, each stating that such transaction and the supplemental indenture comply with the Indenture and that all conditions precedent in the Indenture relating to such transaction have been satisfied. |
SECTION 7.02 Successor Corporate Entity Substituted. Upon any consolidation or merger, or any sale, assignment, transfer, lease, conveyance or other disposition of all or substantially all of the assets of the
-26-
ARTICLE VIII
DEFAULTS AND REMEDIES
SECTION 8.01 Events of Default. An Event of Default occurs if:
(a) the Company defaults in the payment of interest when the same becomes due and payable, and the Default continues for a period of 30 days after the date due and payable; | |
(b) the Company defaults in the payment of the principal of any Security when the same becomes due and payable at maturity, upon redemption or otherwise; | |
(c) the Company defaults in the payment of the Change of Control Payment when the same becomes due and payable, whether or not such payment may be prohibited by Article VI; | |
(d) the Company fails to provide timely notice of any Change of Control in accordance with Section 4.08; | |
(e) the Company fails to observe or perform any other covenant or agreement contained in this Indenture or the Securities required by it to be performed and the Default continues for a period of 60 days after the receipt of written notice from the Trustee to the Company or from the holders of 25% in aggregate principal amount of the then outstanding Securities to the Company and the Trustee stating that such notice is a Notice of Default; | |
(f) there is a default under any mortgage, indenture or instrument under which there may be issued or by which there may be secured or evidenced any Indebtedness for money borrowed by the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company (or the payment of which is guaranteed by the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company), whether such Indebtedness or guarantee now exists or is created after the Issuance Date, which default (i) is caused by a failure to pay when due principal of or interest on such Indebtedness within the grace period provided for in such Indebtedness (which failure continues beyond any applicable grace period) (a Payment Default) or (ii) results in the acceleration of such Indebtedness prior to its express maturity (without such acceleration being rescinded or annulled) and, in each case, the principal amount of any such Indebtedness, together with the principal amount of any other such Indebtedness under which there is a Payment Default or the maturity of which has been so accelerated, aggregates $10 million or more; | |
(g) a final non-appealable judgment or final non-appealable judgments (other than any judgment as to which a reputable insurance company has accepted full liability) for the payment of money are entered by a court or courts of competent jurisdiction against the Company or any Subsidiary of the Company and remain undischarged for a period (during which execution shall not be effectively stayed) of 60 days, provided that the aggregate of all such judgments exceeds $10 million; | |
(h) the Company or any Material Subsidiary pursuant to or within the meaning of any Bankruptcy Law: (i) commences a voluntary case, (ii) consents to the entry of an order for relief against it in an involuntary case in which it is the debtor, (iii) consents to the appointment of a Bankruptcy Custodian of it or for all or substantially all of its property, (iv) makes a general assignment for the benefit of its creditors, or (v) makes the admission in writing that it generally is unable to pay its debts as the same become due; or |
-27-
(i) a court of competent jurisdiction enters an order or decree under any Bankruptcy Law that: (i) is for relief against the Company or any Material Subsidiary in an involuntary case, (ii) appoints a Bankruptcy Custodian of the Company or any Material Subsidiary or for all or substantially all of its property, and the order or decree remains unstayed and in effect for 60 days or (iii) orders the liquidation of the Company or any Material Subsidiary, and the order or decree remains unstayed and in effect for 60 days. |
The term Bankruptcy Law means Title 11, U.S. Code or any similar Federal or state law for the relief of debtors. The term Bankruptcy Custodian means any receiver, trustee, assignee, liquidator or similar official under any Bankruptcy Law.
SECTION 8.02 Acceleration. If an Event of Default (other than an Event of Default specified in clauses (h) and (i) of Section 8.01 hereof with respect to the Company) occurs and is continuing, the Trustee by notice to the Company, or the Securityholders of at least 25% in principal amount of the then-outstanding Securities by notice to the Company and the Trustee, may declare all the Securities to be due and payable. Upon such declaration, the principal of, premium, if any, and accrued and unpaid interest shall be due and payable immediately. If an Event of Default specified in clause (h) or (i) of Section 8.01 hereof occurs with respect to the Company, such an amount shall ipso facto become and be immediately due and payable without any declaration or other act on the part of the Trustee or any Securityholder. The Securityholders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the then-outstanding Securities by notice to the Trustee may rescind an acceleration and its consequences if the rescission would not conflict with any judgment or decree, if all amounts payable to the Trustee pursuant to Section 9.07 hereof have been paid and if all existing Events of Default have been cured or waived except nonpayment of principal or interest that has become due solely because of the acceleration.
SECTION 8.03 Other Remedies. If an Event of Default occurs and is continuing, the Trustee may pursue any available remedy to collect the payment of principal or interest or to enforce the performance of any provision of the Securities or this Indenture.
The Trustee may maintain a proceeding even if it does not possess any of the Securities or does not produce any of them in the proceeding. A delay or omission by the Trustee or any Securityholder in exercising any right or remedy accruing upon an Event of Default shall not impair the right or remedy or constitute a waiver of or acquiescence in the Event of Default. All remedies are cumulative to the extent permitted by law.
SECTION 8.04 Waiver of Past Defaults. The Securityholders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the then-outstanding Securities by notice to the Trustee may waive an existing Default or Event of Default and its consequences except a continuing Default or Event of Default in the payment of the Change of Control Payment or the principal of, or interest. When a Default or Event of Default is waived, it is cured and ceases; but no such waiver shall extend to any subsequent or other Default or impair any right consequent thereon.
SECTION 8.05 Control by Majority. The Securityholders of a majority in principal amount of the then-outstanding Securities may direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee or exercising any trust or power conferred on it. However, the Trustee may refuse to follow any direction that conflicts with law or this Indenture, is unduly prejudicial to the rights of other Securityholders, or would involve the Trustee in personal liability.
SECTION 8.06 Limitation on Suits. A Securityholder may pursue a remedy with respect to this Indenture or the Securities only if:
(a) the Securityholder gives to the Trustee notice of a continuing Event of Default; | |
(b) the Securityholders of at least 25% in principal amount of the then-outstanding Securities make a request to the Trustee to pursue the remedy; | |
(c) such Securityholder or Securityholders offer to the Trustee indemnity satisfactory to the Trustee against any loss, liability or expense; |
-28-
(d) the Trustee does not comply with the request within 60 days after receipt of the request and the offer of indemnity; and | |
(e) during such 60-day period the Securityholders of a majority in principal amount of the then-outstanding Securities do not give the Trustee a direction inconsistent with the request. |
A Securityholder may not use this Indenture to prejudice the rights of another Securityholder or to obtain a preference or priority over another Securityholder.
SECTION 8.07 Rights of Securityholders to Receive Payment. Notwithstanding any other provision of this Indenture, the right of any Securityholder of a Security to receive payment of principal and interest on or after the respective due dates expressed in the Security, or to bring suit for the enforcement of any such payment on or after such respective dates, shall not be impaired or affected without the consent of the Securityholder made pursuant to this Section.
SECTION 8.08 Collection Suit by Trustee. If an Event of Default specified in Section 8.01 (a), (b) or (c) occurs and is continuing, the Trustee may recover judgment in its own name and as trustee of an express trust against the Company for the whole amount of principal and interest and such further amount as shall be sufficient to cover the costs and, to the extent lawful, expenses of collection, including the reasonable compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel.
SECTION 8.09 Trustee May File Proofs of Claim. The Trustee may file such proofs of claim and other papers or documents as may be necessary or advisable in order to have the claims of the Trustee and the Securityholders allowed in any judicial proceedings relative to the Company, its creditors or its property. Nothing contained herein shall be deemed to authorize the Trustee to authorize or consent to or accept or adopt on behalf of any Securityholder any plan of reorganization, arrangement, adjustment or composition affecting the Securities or the rights of any Securityholder thereof, or to authorize the Trustee to vote in respect of the claim of any Securityholder in any such proceeding.
SECTION 8.10 Priorities. If the Trustee collects any money pursuant to this Article, it shall pay out the money in the following order:
First: to the Trustee for amounts due under Section 9.07 hereof; | |
Second: to the holders of Senior Debt to the extent required by Article VI; |
Third: to the Securityholders, for amounts due and unpaid on the Securities for principal and interest, ratably, according to the amounts due and payable on the Securities for principal and interest, respectively; and
Fourth: to the Company. |
Except as otherwise provided in Section 2.12 hereof, the Trustee may fix a record date and payment date for any payment to Securityholders made pursuant to this Section.
SECTION 8.11 Undertaking for Costs. In any suit for the enforcement of any right or remedy under this Indenture or in any suit against the Trustee for any action taken or omitted by it as a Trustee, a court in its discretion may require the filing by any party litigant in the suit of an undertaking to pay the costs of the suit, and the court in its discretion may assess reasonable costs, including reasonable attorneys fees, against any party litigant in the suit, having due regard to the merits and good faith of the claims or defenses made by the party litigant. This Section does not apply to a suit by the Trustee, a suit by a holder pursuant to Section 8.07 hereof, or a suit by Securityholders of more than 10% in principal amount of the then-outstanding Securities.
-29-
ARTICLE IX
TRUSTEE
SECTION 9.01 Duties of Trustee.
(a) If an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, the Trustee shall exercise such of the rights and powers vested in it by this Indenture, and use the same degree of care and skill in their exercise, as a prudent man would exercise or use under the circumstances in the conduct of his own affairs.
(b) Except during the continuance of an Event of Default: (i) the Trustee need perform only those duties that are specifically set forth in this Indenture and no others and (ii) in the absence of bad faith on its part, the Trustee may conclusively rely, as to the truth of the statements and the correctness of the opinions expressed therein, upon certificates or opinions furnished to the Trustee and, if required by the terms hereof, conforming to the requirements of this Indenture. However, the Trustee shall examine the certificates and opinions to determine whether or not they conform to the requirements of this Indenture.
(c) The Trustee may not be relieved from liability for its own negligent action, its own negligent failure to act, or its own willful misconduct, except that: (i) this paragraph does not limit the effect of paragraph (b) of this Section 9.01; (ii) the Trustee shall not be liable for any error of judgment made in good faith by a Trust Officer, unless it is proved that the Trustee was negligent in ascertaining the pertinent facts and (iii) the Trustee shall not be liable with respect to any action it takes or omits to take in good faith in accordance with a direction received by it pursuant to Section 8.05 hereof.
(d) Every provision of this Indenture that in any way relates to the Trustee is subject to paragraphs (a), (b) and (c) of this Section 9.01. No provision of this Indenture shall require the Trustee to expend or risk its own funds or otherwise incur any financial liability in the performance of any of its duties hereunder, or in the exercise of any of its rights or powers, if it shall have reasonable grounds for believing that repayment of such funds or adequate indemnity against such risk or liability is not reasonably assured to it.
(e) The Trustee may refuse to perform any duty or exercise any right or power unless it receives indemnity satisfactory to it against any loss, liability or expense.
(f) The Trustee shall not be liable for interest on any money received by it except as the Trustee may agree in writing with the Company. Money held in trust by the Trustee need not be segregated from other funds except to the extent required by law.
SECTION 9.02 Rights of Trustee.
(a) The Trustee may rely on any document believed by it to be genuine and to have been signed or presented by the proper person. The Trustee need not investigate any fact or matter stated in the document.
(b) Before the Trustee acts or refrains from acting, it (unless other evidence be herein specifically prescribed) may require an Officers Certificate or an Opinion of Counsel, or both. The Trustee shall not be liable for any action it takes or omits to take in good faith in reliance on such Officers Certificate or Opinion of Counsel.
(c) The Trustee may act through agents and nominees and shall not be responsible for the misconduct or negligence of any agent appointed with due care.
(d) The Trustee shall not be liable for any action it takes or omits to take in good faith which it believes to be authorized or within its rights or powers.
(e) The Trustee shall not be charged with knowledge of any Event of Default under subsection (d), (e), (f), (g), (h) or (i) of Section 8.01 unless either (1) a Trust Officer assigned to its Corporate Trust Department shall have actual knowledge thereof, or (2) the Trustee shall have received notice thereof in accordance with Section 12.02 hereof from the Company or any holder.
SECTION 9.03 Individual Rights of Trustee. The Trustee in its individual or any other capacity may become the owner or pledgee of Securities and may otherwise deal with the Company or an Affiliate with the
-30-
SECTION 9.04 Trustees Disclaimer. The Trustee makes no representation as to the validity or adequacy of this Indenture or the Securities, it shall not be accountable for the Companys use of the proceeds from the Securities, and it shall not be responsible for any statement of the Company in the Indenture or any statement in the Securities other than its authentication.
SECTION 9.05 Notice of Defaults. If a Default or Event of Default occurs and is continuing and if it is known to the Trustee, the Trustee shall mail to Securityholders a notice of the Default or Event of Default within 90 days after it occurs. Except in the case of a Default or Event of Default in payment on any Security, the Trustee may withhold the notice if and so long as a committee of its Trust Officers in good faith determines that withholding the notice is in the interests of Securityholders.
SECTION 9.06 Reports by Trustee to Securityholders. Within 60 days after the reporting date stated in Section 12.10, the Trustee shall mail to Securityholders a brief report dated as of such reporting date that complies with TIA § 313(a) if and to the extent required by such § 313(a). The Trustee also shall comply with TIA § 313(b)(2). The Trustee shall also transmit by mail all reports as required by TIA § 313(c).
A copy of each report at the time of its mailing to Securityholders shall be filed with the SEC and each stock exchange on which the Securities are listed. The Company shall notify the Trustee when the Securities are listed on any stock exchange or automated quotation system.
SECTION 9.07 Compensation and Indemnity. The Company shall pay to the Trustee from time to time reasonable compensation for its services hereunder. The Trustees compensation shall not be limited by any law on compensation of a trustee of an express trust. The Company shall reimburse the Trustee upon request for all reasonable disbursements, expenses and advances incurred or made by it. Such disbursements and expenses may include the reasonable disbursements, compensation and expenses of the Trustees agents and counsel.
The Company shall indemnify the Trustee and its officers, directors, employees and agents against any loss or liability incurred by it except as set forth in the next paragraph. The Trustee shall notify the Company promptly of any claim for which it may seek indemnity. The Company shall defend the claim and the Trustee shall cooperate in the defense. The Trustee may have separate counsel and the Company shall pay the reasonable fees, disbursements and expenses of such counsel. The Company need not pay for any settlement made without its consent, which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld.
The Company need not reimburse any expense or indemnify against any loss or liability incurred by the Trustee through negligence, bad faith or willful misconduct.
To secure the Companys payment obligations in this Section, the Trustee shall have a lien prior to the Securities on all money or property held or collected by the Trustee, except money or property held in trust to pay principal and interest.
When the Trustee incurs expenses or renders services after an Event of Default specified in Section 8.01(h) or (i) occurs, the expenses and the compensation for the services are intended to constitute expenses of administration under any Bankruptcy Law.
The provisions of this Section 9.07 shall survive the termination of this Indenture, as provided by Section 10.01 hereof.
SECTION 9.08 Replacement of Trustee. A resignation or removal of the Trustee and appointment of a successor Trustee shall become effective only upon the successor Trustees acceptance of appointment as provided in this Section.
-31-
The Trustee may resign by so notifying the Company. The Securityholders of a majority in principal amount of the then-outstanding Securities may remove the Trustee by so notifying the Trustee and the Company. The Company may remove the Trustee if:
(a) the Trustee fails to comply with Section 9.10 hereof, unless the Trustees duty to resign is stayed as provided in TIA § 310(b); | |
(b) the Trustee is adjudged a bankrupt or an insolvent or an order for relief is entered with respect to the Trustee under any Bankruptcy Law; | |
(c) a Bankruptcy Custodian or public officer takes charge of the Trustee or its property, or | |
(d) the Trustee becomes incapable of acting. |
If the Trustee resigns or is removed or if a vacancy exists in the office of Trustee for any reason, the Company shall promptly appoint a successor Trustee. Within one year after the successor Trustee takes office, the Securityholders of a majority in principal amount of the then-outstanding Securities may appoint a successor Trustee to replace the successor Trustee appointed by the Company.
If a successor Trustee does not take office within 60 days after the retiring Trustee resigns or is removed, the retiring Trustee, the Company or the Securityholders of at least 10% in principal amount of the then-outstanding Securities may petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the appointment of a successor Trustee.
If the Trustee fails to comply with Section 9.10 hereof, unless the Trustees duty to resign is stayed as provided in TIA § 310(b), any Securityholder who has been a bona fide holder of a Security for at least six months may petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the removal of the Trustee and the appointment of a successor Trustee.
A successor Trustee shall deliver a written acceptance of its appointment to the retiring Trustee and to the Company. Thereupon the resignation or removal of the retiring Trustee shall become effective, the Company shall promptly pay all amounts due and payable to the retiring Trustee, and the successor Trustee shall have all the rights, powers and duties of the Trustee under this Indenture. The successor Trustee shall mail a notice of its succession to Securityholders. The retiring Trustee shall promptly transfer all property held by it as Trustee to the successor Trustee, subject to the lien provided for in Section 9.07 hereof. Notwithstanding the resignation or replacement of the Trustee pursuant to this Section 9.08, the Companys obligations under Section 9.07 hereof shall continue for the benefit of the retiring Trustee with respect to expenses and liabilities incurred by it prior to such resignation or replacement.
SECTION 9.09 Successor Trustee by Merger, Etc. If the Trustee consolidates, merges or converts into, or transfers all or substantially all of its corporate trust business (including the administration of the Indenture) to, another corporation, the successor corporation without any further act shall be the successor Trustee.
SECTION 9.10 Eligibility; Disqualification. This Indenture shall always have a Trustee who satisfies the requirements of TIA § 310(a)(1) and (5). The Trustee (or if the Trustee is a member of a bank holding system, its bank holding company) shall always have a combined capital and surplus as stated in Section 12.10 hereof. The Trustee is subject to TIA § 310(b).
SECTION 9.11 Preferential Collection of Claims Against Company. The Trustee is subject to TIA § 311(a), excluding any credit or relationship listed in TIA § 311(b). A Trustee who has resigned or been removed shall be subject to TIA § 311(a) to the extent indicated therein.
SECTION 9.12 Sections Applicable to Registrar, Paying Agent and Conversion Agent. The term Trustee as used in Sections 6.3, 9.1, 9.2, 9.3, 9.4 and 9.7 hereof shall (unless the context requires otherwise) be construed as extending to and including the Trustee acting in its capacity, if any, as Registrar, Paying Agent and Conversion Agent.
-32-
ARTICLE X
DISCHARGE OF INDENTURE
SECTION 10.01 Termination of Companys Obligation. This Indenture shall cease to be of further effect (except that the Companys obligations under Sections 9.07 and 10.02 hereof shall survive) when all outstanding Securities theretofore authenticated and issued have been delivered to the Trustee for cancellation and the Company has paid all sums payable hereunder.
Thereupon, the Trustee upon request of the Company, shall acknowledge in writing the discharge of the Companys obligations under this Indenture, except for those surviving obligations specified above.
SECTION 10.02 Repayment to Company. The Trustee and the Paying Agent shall promptly pay to the Company upon request any excess money or securities held by them at any time.
The Trustee and the Paying Agent shall pay to the Company upon request any money held by them for the payment of principal or interest that remains unclaimed for two years after the date upon which such payment shall have become due; provided, however, that the Company shall have first caused notice of such payment to the Company to be mailed to each Securityholder entitled thereto no less than 30 days prior to such payment. After payment to the Company, the Trustee and the Paying Agent shall have no further liability with respect to such money and Securityholders entitled to the money must look to the Company for payment as general creditors unless any applicable abandoned property law designates another person.
ARTICLE XI
AMENDMENTS, SUPPLEMENTS AND WAIVERS
SECTION 11.01 Without Consent of Securityholders. The Company and the Trustee may amend or supplement this Indenture or the Securities without the consent of any Securityholder:
(a) to cure any ambiguity, defect or inconsistency; | |
(b) to comply with Sections 5.13 and 7.01 hereof; | |
(c) to provide for uncertificated Securities in addition to certificated Securities; | |
(d) to make any change that does not adversely affect the legal rights hereunder of any Securityholder; | |
(e) to qualify this Indenture under the TIA or to comply with the requirements of the SEC in order to maintain the qualification of the Indenture under the TIA; or | |
(f) to make any change that provides any additional rights or benefits to the holders of Securities. |
An amendment under this Section may not make any change that adversely affects the rights under Article VI of any holder of Senior Debt then outstanding unless the holders of such Senior Debt (or any group or Representative thereof authorized to give a consent) consent to such change.
SECTION 11.02 With Consent of Securityholders. Subject to Section 8.07 hereof, the Company and the Trustee may amend or supplement this Indenture or the Securities with the written consent (including consents obtained in connection with any tender or exchange offer for Securities) of the Securityholders of at least a majority in principal amount of the then-outstanding Securities. Subject to Sections 8.04 and 8.07 hereof, the Securityholders of a majority in principal amount of the Securities then outstanding may also by their written consent (including consents obtained in connection with any tender offer or exchange offer for Securities) waive any existing Default as provided in Section 8.04 or waive compliance in a particular instance by the Company with any provision of this Indenture or the Securities. However, without the consent of each
-33-
(a) reduce the amount of Securities whose Securityholders must consent to an amendment, supplement or waiver; | |
(b) reduce the rate of or change the time for payment of interest on any Security; | |
(c) reduce the principal of or change the fixed maturity of any Security or alter the redemption provisions with respect thereto; | |
(d) make any Security payable in money other than that stated in the Security; | |
(e) make any change in Section 8.04, 8.07 or 11.02 hereof (this sentence); | |
(f) waive a default in the payment of principal of, premium, if any, or interest (other than as provided in Section 8.04); | |
(g) waive a redemption payment payable on any Security; | |
(h) make any change that impairs the right of Securityholders to convert Securities into Common Stock of the Company; or | |
(i) modify the conversion or subordination provisions set forth in Article V and Article VI, respectively, in a manner adverse to the holders of the Securities. |
To secure a consent of the Securityholders under this Section 11.02, it shall not be necessary for the Securityholders to approve the particular form of any proposed amendment, supplement or waiver, but it shall be sufficient if such consent approves the substance thereof.
An amendment under this Section may not make any change that adversely affects the rights under Article VI of any holder of Senior Debt then outstanding unless the holders of such Senior Debt (or any group or Representative thereof authorized to give a consent) consent to such change.
Neither the Company nor any of its Subsidiaries shall, directly or indirectly, pay or cause to be paid any consideration, whether by way of interest, fee or otherwise, to any holder of Securities or as an inducement to any consent, waiver or amendment of any of the terms or provisions of this Indenture or the Securities unless such consideration is offered to be paid or agreed to be paid to all holders of the Securities that consent, waive or agree to amend in the time frame set forth in the solicitation documents relating to such consent, waiver or agreement.
After an amendment, supplement or waiver under this Section becomes effective, the Company shall mail Securityholders a notice briefly describing the amendment or waiver.
SECTION 11.03 Compliance with Trust Indenture Act. Every amendment to this Indenture or the Securities shall be set forth in a supplemental indenture that complies with the TIA as then in effect.
SECTION 11.04 Revocation and Effect of Consents. Until an amendment, supplement or waiver becomes effective, a consent to it by a Securityholder of a Security is a continuing consent by the Securityholder and every subsequent Securityholder of a Security or portion of a Security that evidences the same debt as the consenting Securityholders Security, even if notation of the consent is not made on any Security. However, any such Securityholder or subsequent Securityholder may revoke the consent as to such Securityholders Security or portion of a Security if the Trustee receives the notice of revocation before the date on which the Trustee receives an Officers Certificate certifying that the Securityholders of the requisite principal amount of Securities have consented to the amendment, supplement or waiver.
The Company may, but shall not be obligated to, fix a record date for the purpose of determining the Securityholders entitled to consent to any amendment, supplement or waiver. If a record date is fixed, then notwithstanding the provisions of the immediately preceding paragraph, those persons who were Securityholders at such record date (or their duly designated proxies), and only those persons, shall be entitled to consent to such amendment, supplement or waiver or to revoke any consent previously given, whether or not
-34-
After an amendment, supplement or waiver becomes effective it shall bind every Securityholder, unless it is of the type described in any of clauses (a) through (i) of Section 11.02 hereof. In such case, the amendment or waiver shall bind each Securityholder who has consented to it and every subsequent Securityholder that evidences the same debt as the consenting Securityholders Security.
SECTION 11.05 Notation on or Exchange of Securities. The Trustee may place an appropriate notation about an amendment or waiver on any Security thereafter authenticated. The Company in exchange for all Securities may issue and the Trustee shall authenticate new Securities that reflect the amendment or waiver.
SECTION 11.06 Trustee Protected. The Trustee shall sign all supplemental indentures, except that the Trustee may, but need not, sign any supplemental indenture that adversely affects its rights. As a condition to executing, or accepting the additional trusts created by, any supplemental indenture permitted by this Article or the modifications thereby of the trust created by this Indenture, the Trustee shall be entitled to receive (in addition to those documents required by Section 12.04), and (subject to Section 315 of the TIA) shall be fully protected in relying upon, an Opinion of Counsel stating that the execution of such supplemental indenture is authorized or permitted by this Indenture.
ARTICLE XII
MISCELLANEOUS
SECTION 12.01 Trust Indenture Act Controls. If any provision of this Indenture limits, qualifies or conflicts with another provision which is deemed to be incorporated in this Indenture by the TIA, the incorporated provision shall control.
SECTION 12.02 Notices. Any notice or communication by the Company or the Trustee to the other is duly given if in writing and delivered in person or mailed by first-class mail or overnight delivery to the others address stated in Section 12.10 hereof. The Company or the Trustee by notice to the other may designate additional or different addresses for subsequent notices or communications.
Any notice or communication to a Securityholder shall be mailed by first-class mail or overnight delivery to his address shown on the register kept by the Registrar. Failure to mail a notice or communication to a Securityholder or any defect in it shall not affect its sufficiency with respect to other Securityholders.
If a notice or communication is mailed in the manner provided above within the time prescribed, it is duly given, whether or not the addressee receives it.
If the Company mails a notice or communication to Securityholders, it shall mail a copy to the Trustee and each Agent at the same time.
All other notices or communications shall be in writing.
In case by reason of the suspension of regular mail service, or by reason of any other cause, it shall be impossible to mail any notice as required by the Indenture, then such method of notification as shall be made with the approval of the Trustee shall constitute a sufficient mailing of such notice.
SECTION 12.03 Communication by Securityholders with Other Securityholders. Securityholders may communicate pursuant to TIA § 312(b) with other Securityholders with respect to their rights under this Indenture or the Securities. The Company, the Trustee, the Registrar and anyone else shall have the protection of TIA § 312(c).
-35-
SECTION 12.04 Certificate and Opinion as to Conditions Precedent. Upon any request or application by the Company to the Trustee to take any action under this Indenture, the Company shall furnish to the Trustee:
(a) an Officers Certificate stating that, in the opinion of the signers, all conditions precedent, if any, provided for in this Indenture relating to the proposed action have been complied with; and | |
(b) an Opinion of Counsel stating that, in the opinion of such counsel, all such conditions precedent have been complied with. |
SECTION 12.05 Statements Required in Certificate or Opinion. Each certificate or opinion with respect to compliance with a condition or covenant provided for in this Indenture (other than pursuant to Section 4.03) shall include:
(a) a statement that the person signing such certificate or rendering such opinion has read such covenant or condition; | |
(b) a brief statement as to the nature and scope of the examination or investigation upon which the statements or opinions contained in such certificate or opinion are based; | |
(c) a statement that, in the opinion of such person, such person has made such examination or investigation as is necessary to enable such person to express an informed opinion as to whether or not such covenant or condition has been complied with; and | |
(d) a statement as to whether or not, in the opinion of such person, such condition or covenant has been complied with. |
SECTION 12.06 Rules by Trustee and Agents. The Trustee may make reasonable rules for action by, or a meeting of, the Securityholders. The Registrar or Paying Agent may make reasonable rules and set reasonable requirements for its functions.
SECTION 12.07 Legal Holidays. A Legal Holiday is a Saturday, a Sunday or a day on which banking institutions in the State of New York or the State of California are not required to be open. If a payment date is a Legal Holiday at a place of payment, payment may be made at that place on the next succeeding day that is not a Legal Holiday, and no interest shall accrue for the intervening period. If any other operative date for purposes of this Indenture shall occur on a Legal Holiday then for all purposes the next succeeding day that is not a Legal Holiday shall be such operative date.
SECTION 12.08 No Recourse Against Others. A director, officer, employee or shareholder, as such, of the Company shall not have any liability for any obligations of the Company under the Securities or the Indenture or for any claim based on, in respect of or by reason of such obligations or their creation. Each Securityholder by accepting a Security waives and releases all such liability. The waiver and release are part of the consideration for the issue of the Securities.
SECTION 12.09 Counterparts. This Indenture may be executed in any number of counterparts and by the parties hereto in separate counterparts, each of which when so executed shall be deemed to be an original and all of which taken together shall constitute one and the same agreement.
SECTION 12.10 Variable Provisions. Officer means the Chairman of the Board, the President, any Vice-President (whether or not designated by a number or a word or words added before or after the title Vice President), the Chief Financial Officer, the Treasurer, the Secretary, any Assistant Treasurer or any Assistant Secretary of the Company.
The first certificate pursuant to Section 4.03 hereof shall be for the fiscal year ending on December 31, 2002.
The reporting date for Section 9.06 hereof is March 15 of each year. The first reporting date is March 15, 2003.
-36-
The Trustee (or if the Trustee is a member of a bank holding company system, its bank holding company) shall always have a combined capital and surplus of at least $50,000,000 as set forth in its most recent published annual report of condition.
The Companys address for purposes of the Indenture is:
Chief Financial Officer | |
Intevac, Inc. | |
3550 Bassett Street | |
Santa Clara, California 95054 | |
Telephone Number: (408) 986-9888 | |
Telefax Number: (408) 988-8145 |
The Trustees address is:
State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N. A. | |
633 West 5th Street, 12th Floor | |
Los Angeles, CA 90071 | |
Attention: Corporate Trust Administration | |
(Intevac, Inc. 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2009) | |
Telephone Number: (213) 362-7334 | |
Telefax Number: (213) 362-7357 |
The Company or the Trustee may change its address for purposes of this Indenture by written notice to the other. |
SECTION 12.11 GOVERNING LAW. THIS INDENTURE AND THE SECURITIES ISSUED HEREUNDER SHALL BE GOVERNED BY AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.
SECTION 12.12 No Adverse Interpretation of Other Agreements. This Indenture may not be used to interpret another indenture, loan or debt agreement of the Company or an Affiliate. Any such indenture, loan or debt agreement may not be used to interpret this Indenture.
SECTION 12.13 Successors. All agreements of the Company in this Indenture and the Securities shall bind its successor. All agreements of the Trustee in this Indenture shall bind its successor.
SECTION 12.14 Severability. In case any provision in this Indenture or in the Securities shall be invalid, illegal or unenforceable, the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions shall not in any way be affected or impaired thereby.
SECTION 12.15 Table of Contents, Headings, Etc. The Table of Contents and headings of the Articles and Sections of this Indenture have been inserted for convenience of reference only, are not to be considered a part hereof, and shall in no way modify or restrict any of the terms or provisions hereof.
ARTICLE XIII
REPURCHASE OFFER
SECTION 13.01 Repurchase Offer.
(a) In the event that, pursuant to Section 4.09 hereof, the Company shall commence a Repurchase Offer, the Company shall follow the procedures in this Section 13.01.
(b) The Repurchase Offer shall remain open for a period specified by the Company which shall be no less than 30 calendar days and no more than 40 calendar days prior to the Repurchase Payment Date, except to the extent that a longer period is required by applicable law. The first day of such period is referred to as the Repurchase Commencement Date. On the Repurchase Payment Date the Company shall purchase the
-37-
(c) If the Repurchase Payment Date is on or after an interest payment record date and on or before the related interest payment date, any accrued interest, to the related interest payment date, will be paid to the person in whose name a Security is registered at the close of business on such record date, and no additional interest, will be payable to Securityholders who tender Securities pursuant to the Repurchase Offer.
SECTION 13.02 Repurchase Notice
(a) The Company shall provide the Trustee with written notice of the Repurchase Offer at least 10 Business Days prior to the mailing of the notice of the Repurchase Offer to the Securityholders.
(b) On or before the date that is 90 days prior to the Repurchase Payment Date the Company or the Trustee (at the request and expense of the Company) shall send, by first class mail, a notice to each of the Securityholders, which shall govern the terms of the Repurchase Offer and shall state:
(i) that the Repurchase Offer is being made pursuant to Section 13.01 and Section 4.09 hereof and that all Securities tendered will be accepted for payment; | |
(ii) the Repurchase Payment (as determined in accordance with Section 4.09 hereof), the length of time the Repurchase Offer will remain open and the Repurchase Payment Date; | |
(iii) that any Security or portion thereof not tendered or accepted for payment will continue to accrue interest; | |
(iv) that, unless the Company defaults in the payment of the Repurchase Payment, any Security or portion thereof accepted for payment pursuant to the Repurchase Offer shall cease to accrue interest after the Repurchase Payment Date; | |
(v) that Securityholders electing to have a Security or portion thereof purchased pursuant to any Repurchase Offer will be required to surrender the Security, with the form entitled Option of Securityholder To Elect Purchase on the reverse of the Security completed, to the Paying Agent at the address specified in the notice prior to the close of business on the third Business Day preceding the Repurchase Payment Date; | |
(vi) that Securityholders will be entitled to withdraw their election if the Paying Agent receives, not later than the close of business on the second Business Day preceding the Repurchase Payment Date, or such longer period as may be required by law, a letter or a telegram, telex, facsimile transmission (receipt of which is confirmed and promptly followed by a letter) setting forth the name of the Securityholder, the principal amount of the Security or portion thereof the Securityholder delivered for purchase and a statement that such Securityholder is withdrawing his election to have the Security or portion thereof purchased; and | |
(vii) that Securityholders whose Securities are being purchased only in part will be issued new Securities equal in principal amount to the unpurchased portion of the Securities surrendered, which unpurchased portion must be equal to $1,000 in principal amount or an integral multiple thereof. |
In addition, the notice shall contain all instructions and materials that the Company shall reasonably deem necessary to enable such Securityholders to tender Securities pursuant to the Repurchase Offer.
SECTION 13.03 Deposit of Repurchase Offer Amount.
On or prior to the Repurchase Payment Date, the Company shall irrevocably deposit with the Trustee or a Paying Agent in immediately available funds an amount equal to the Repurchase Payment to be held for payment in accordance with the terms of this Section 13.03. On the Repurchase Payment Date, the Company shall, to the extent lawful, (i) accept for payment the Securities or portions thereof tendered pursuant to the Repurchase Offer, (ii) deliver or cause to be delivered to the Trustee Securities so accepted and (iii) deliver to the Trustee an Officers Certificate stating that such Securities or portions thereof have been accepted for payment by the Company in accordance with the terms of this Section 13.03. The Paying Agent shall
-38-
SECTION 13.04 Compliance with Applicable Laws.
The repurchase Offer shall be made by the Company in compliance with all applicable provisions of the Exchange Act, and all applicable tender offer rules promulgated thereunder, and shall include all instructions and materials that the Company shall reasonably deem necessary to enable such Securityholders to tender their Securities.
[Remainder of page intentionally left blank]
-39-
IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Indenture to be duly executed, all as of the date first written above.
INTEVAC, INC., | |
As Company, | |
By:
|
|
Name: | |
Title: | |
STATE STREET BANK AND TRUST | |
COMPANY OF CALIFORNIA, N.A., | |
As Trustee, | |
By:
|
|
Name: | |
Title: |
-40-
EXHIBIT A
FORM OF CONVERTIBLE SUBORDINATED NOTE
[FORM OF FACE OF NOTE]
[Global Securities Legend]
UNLESS THIS CERTIFICATE IS PRESENTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF THE DEPOSITORY TRUST COMPANY, A NEW YORK CORPORATION (DTC), TO THE COMPANY OR ITS AGENT FOR REGISTRATION OF TRANSFER, EXCHANGE OR PAYMENT, AND ANY CERTIFICATE ISSUED IS REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF CEDE & CO. OR SUCH OTHER NAME AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC (AND ANY PAYMENT IS MADE TO CEDE & CO., OR TO SUCH OTHER ENTITY AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC) ANY TRANSFER, PLEDGE OR OTHER USE HEREOF FOR VALUE OR OTHERWISE BY OR TO ANY PERSON IS WRONGFUL INASMUCH AS THE REGISTERED OWNER HEREOF, CEDE & CO., HAS AN INTEREST HEREIN.
TRANSFERS OF THIS GLOBAL SECURITY SHALL BE LIMITED TO TRANSFERS IN WHOLE, BUT NOT IN PART, TO NOMINEES OF DTC OR TO A SUCCESSOR THEREOF OR SUCH SUCCESSORS NOMINEE AND TRANSFERS OF PORTIONS OF THIS GLOBAL SECURITY SHALL BE LIMITED TO TRANSFERS MADE IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE RESTRICTIONS SET FORTH IN THE INDENTURE REFERRED TO ON THE REVERSE HEREOF.
A-1
No.
|
Cusip No. |
INTEVAC, INC.
6 1/2% CONVERTIBLE SUBORDINATED NOTE DUE 2009
Intevac, Inc., a California corporation (the Company) for value received promises to pay to ________________________________________________________________________________ or registered assigns, the principal sum [indicated on Schedule A hereof]* [of ____________ Dollars]** on March 1, 2009 at the office or agency of the Company maintained for that purpose in the Borough of Manhattan, The City of New York, State of New York, and to pay interest on said principal sum at the rate of 6 1/2% per annum, as more specifically described on the reverse hereof.
Interest Payment Dates:
|
March 1 and September 1, commencing September 1, 2002. | |
Record Dates:
|
February 15 and August 15. |
Reference is hereby made to the further provisions of this Note set forth on the reverse hereof, which further provisions shall for all purposes have the same effect as if set forth at this place.
* | Applicable to Global Securities only. |
** | Applicable to certificated Securities only. |
A-2
IN WITNESS WHEREOF, Intevac, Inc. has caused this Note to be signed manually or by facsimile by its duly authorized Officers.
Dated:
INTEVAC, INC. | |
By:
|
|
By:
|
[SEAL]
TRUSTEES CERTIFICATE OF AUTHENTICATION
This is one of the 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2009 described in the within-mentioned Indenture.
State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A., as Trustee
By:
|
Authorized Officer |
A-3
INTEVAC, INC.
6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Note Due 2009
1. Interest. INTEVAC, INC., a California corporation (the Company), is the issuer of the 6 1/2% Convertible Subordinated Notes due 2009 (the Notes), of which this Note is a part. The Company promises to pay interest on the Notes in cash semiannually on each March 1 and September 1, commencing on September 1, 2002, to holders of record on the immediately preceding February 15 and August 15.
Interest on the Notes will accrue from the most recent date to which interest has been paid or duly provided for, or if no interest has been paid or duly provided for, from , 2002 until payment of said principal sum has been made or duly provided for. Interest will be computed on the basis of a 360-day year of twelve 30-day months. To the extent lawful, the Company shall pay interest (including post-petition interest in any proceeding under any Bankruptcy Law) on overdue installments of interest (without regard to any applicable grace period) at the rate borne by the Notes, compounded annually.
2. Method of Payment. The Company will pay interest on the Notes (except defaulted interest) to the persons who are registered holders of the Notes at the close of business on the record date for the next interest payment date even though Notes are canceled after the record date and on or before the interest payment date. The Securityholder hereof must surrender Notes to a Paying Agent to collect principal payments. The Company will pay principal and interest in money of the United States that at the time of payment is legal tender for payment of public and private debts. However, the Company may pay principal and interest by check payable in such money. It may mail a check for interest to a holders registered address; provided that a holder of Notes with an aggregate principal amount in excess of $2,000,000 will be paid by wire transfer in immediately available funds at the election of the holder.
3. Paying Agent and Registrar. The Trustee will act initially as Paying Agent, Registrar and Conversion Agent. The Company may change any Paying Agent, Registrar, co-registrar or Conversion Agent without prior notice. The Company or any of its Affiliates may act in any such capacity.
4. Indenture. The Company issued the Notes under an indenture, dated as of , 2002 (the Indenture), between the Company and State Street Bank and Trust Company of California, N.A., as Trustee. The terms of the Notes include those stated in the Indenture and those incorporated into the Indenture from the Trust Indenture Act of 1939, and rules and regulations thereunder. The Notes are subject to, and qualified by, all such terms, certain of which are summarized hereon, and Securityholders are referred to the Indenture and such Act for a statement of such terms. The Notes are general unsecured obligations of the Company limited to an aggregate principal amount at maturity of $ . The Indenture does not limit the ability of the Company or any of its Subsidiaries to incur indebtedness or to grant security interests or liens in respect of their assets.
5. Optional Redemption. The Notes are subject to redemption at the option of the Company, in whole or from time to time in part (in any integral multiple of $1,000), on any date on or after March 1, 2005 at 100% of the principal amount, but excluding the redemption date (subject to the right of holders of record on the relevant record date to receive interest due on an interest payment date). On or after the redemption date, interest will cease to accrue on the Notes, or portion thereof, called for redemption.
6. Notice of Redemption. Notice of redemption will be mailed at least 15 days but not more than 60 days before the redemption date to each holder of the Notes to be redeemed at his address of record. The Notes in denominations larger than $1,000 may be redeemed in part but only in integral multiples of $1,000. In the event of a redemption of less than all of the Notes, the Notes will be chosen for redemption by the Trustee in accordance with the Indenture. Unless the Company defaults in making such redemption payment, or the Paying Agent is prohibited from making such payment pursuant to the Indenture, by law or otherwise, interest cease to accrue on the Notes or portions of them called for redemption on and after the redemption date.
A-4
If this Note is redeemed subsequent to a record date with respect to any interest payment date specified above and on or prior to such interest payment date, then any accrued interest will be paid to the person in whose name this Note is registered at the close of business on such record date.
7. Mandatory Redemption. The Company will not be required to make mandatory redemption payments with respect to the Notes. There are no sinking fund payments with respect to the Notes.
8. Repurchase at Option of Holder. If there is a Change of Control, the Company shall be required to offer to purchase on the Change of Control Payment Date all outstanding Notes at a purchase price equal to 101% of the principal amount thereof on the date of purchase, plus accrued and unpaid interest to the Change of Control Payment Date. Holders of Notes that are subject to an offer to purchase will be mailed a Change of Control Offer from the Company prior to any related Change of Control Payment Date and may elect to have such Notes or portions thereof in authorized denominations purchased by completing the form entitled Option of Securityholder To Elect Purchase appearing below. Securityholders have the right to withdraw their election by delivering a written notice of withdrawal to the Company or the Paying Agent in accordance with the terms of the Indenture.
If there is a Triggering Distribution (as defined in the Indenture), the Company shall be required to offer to purchase on the Repurchase Payment Date all outstanding Notes at a purchase price equal to 100% of the principal amount thereof, together with any accrued and unpaid interest to the Repurchase Payment Date. Holders of Notes that are subject to an offer to purchase will be mailed a Repurchase Offer from the Company on or before the date that is 90 days prior to any related Repurchase Payment Date and may elect to have such Notes or portions thereof in authorized denominations purchased by completing the form entitled Option of Securityholder To Elect Purchase appearing below. Securityholders have the right to withdraw their election by delivering a written notice of withdrawal to the Company or the Paying Agent in accordance with the terms of the Indenture.
9. Subordination. The payment of the principal of, interest on or any other amounts due on the Notes is subordinated in right of payment to all existing and future Senior Debt of the Company, as described in the Indenture. Each Securityholder, by accepting a Note, agrees to such subordination and authorizes and directs the Trustee on its behalf to take such action as may be necessary or appropriate to effectuate the subordination so provided and appoints the Trustee as its attorney-in-fact for such purpose.
10. Conversion. The holder of any Note has the right, exercisable at any time prior to the close of business on the Notes maturity, to convert the principal amount thereof (or any portion thereof that is an integral multiple of $1,000) into shares of Common Stock at the initial Conversion Price of $7.00 per share, subject to adjustment under certain circumstances, except that if a Note is called for redemption, the conversion right will terminate at the close of business (New York time) on the Business Day immediately preceding the date fixed for redemption.
To convert a Note, a holder must (1) complete and sign a notice of election to convert substantially in the form set forth below, (2) surrender the Note to a Conversion Agent, (3) furnish appropriate endorsements or transfer documents if required by the Registrar or Conversion Agent and (4) pay any transfer or similar tax, if required. Upon conversion, no adjustment or payment will be made for interest or dividends, but if any Securityholder surrenders a Note for conversion after the close of business on the record date for the payment of an installment of interest and prior to the opening of business on the next interest payment date, then, notwithstanding such conversion, the interest payable on such interest payment date will be paid to the registered holder of such Note on such record date. In such event, such Note, when surrendered for conversion, must be accompanied by payment in funds acceptable to the Company of an amount equal to the interest payable on such interest payment date on the portion so converted, unless such Security has been called for redemption on or prior to such interest payment date. The number of shares of Common Stock issuable upon conversion of a Note is determined by dividing the principal amount of the Note converted by the Conversion Price in effect on the Conversion Date. No fractional shares will be issued upon conversion but a cash adjustment will be made for any fractional interest.
A-5
A Note in respect of which a holder has delivered an Option of Securityholder to Elect Purchase form appearing below exercising the option of such holder to require the Company to purchase such Note may be converted only if the notice of exercise is withdrawn as provided above and in accordance with the terms of the Indenture. The above description of conversion of the Notes is qualified by reference to, and is subject in its entirety by, the more complete description thereof contained in the Indenture.
11. Automatic Conversion. The Company may elect to automatically convert the Notes on or prior to maturity if the Daily Market Price of the Common Stock has exceeded 150% of the Conversion Price for at least 20 Trading Days out of the 30 consecutive Trading Days ending within five Trading Days prior to the Automatic Conversion Notice.
12. Denominations Transfer, Exchange. The Notes are in registered form, without coupons, in denominations of $1,000 and integral multiples of $1,000. The transfer of Notes may be registered, and Notes may be exchanged, as provided in the Indenture. The Registrar may require a Securityholder, among other things, to furnish appropriate endorsements and transfer documents and to pay any taxes and fees required by law or permitted by the Indenture. The Company is not required to exchange or register the transfer of (i) any Note for a period of 15 days next preceding any selection of Notes to be redeemed, (ii) any Note or portion thereof selected for redemption or (iii) any Note or portion thereof surrendered for repurchase (and not withdrawn) in connection with a Change of Control.
13. Persons Deemed Owners. Except as provided in paragraph 2 of this Note, the registered Securityholder of a Note may be treated as its owner for all purposes.
14. Unclaimed Money. If money for the payment of principal or interest remains unclaimed for two years, the Trustee and the Paying Agent shall pay the money back to the Company at its request. After that, Securityholders of Notes entitled to the money must look to the Company for payment, unless an abandoned property law designates another person, and all liability of the Trustee and such Paying Agent with respect to such money shall cease.
15. Defaults and Remedies. The Notes shall have the Events of Default as set forth in Section 8.01 of the Indenture. Subject to certain limitations in the Indenture, if an Event of Default occurs and is continuing, the Trustee by notice to the Company or the Securityholders of at least 25% in aggregate principal amount of the then-outstanding Notes by notice to the Company and the Trustee may declare all the Notes to be due and payable immediately, except that in the case of an Event of Default arising from certain events of bankruptcy or insolvency, Notes shall become due and payable immediately without further action or notice. Upon acceleration as described in either of the preceding sentences, the subordination provisions of the Indenture preclude any payment being made to Securityholders for at least 5 Business Days after holders of Senior Debt receive notice of such acceleration except as otherwise provided in the Indenture.
The Securityholders of a majority in principal amount of the Notes then outstanding by written notice to the Trustee may rescind an acceleration and its consequences if the rescission would not conflict with any judgment or decree and if all existing Events of Default have been cured or waived except nonpayment of principal or interest that has become due solely because of the acceleration. Securityholders may not enforce the Indenture or the Notes except as provided in the Indenture. Subject to certain limitations, Securityholders of a majority in principal amount of the then-outstanding Notes issued under the Indenture may direct the Trustee in its exercise of any trust or power. The Company must furnish compliance certificates to the Trustee annually. The above description of Events of Default and remedies is qualified by reference to, and subject in its entirety by, the more complete description thereof contained in the Indenture.
16. Amendments, Supplements and Waivers. Subject to certain exceptions, the Indenture or the Notes may be amended or supplemented with the consent of the Securityholders of at least a majority in principal amount of the then-outstanding Notes (including consents obtained in connection with a tender offer or exchange offer for Notes), and any existing default may be waived with the consent of the Securityholders of a majority in principal amount of the then-outstanding Notes, including consents obtained in connection with a tender offer or exchange offer for Notes. Without the consent of any Securityholder, the Indenture or the Notes may be amended, among other things, to cure any ambiguity, defect or inconsistency, to provide for
A-6
17. Trustee Dealings with the Company. The Trustee, in its individual or any other capacity, may become the owner or pledgee of the Notes and may otherwise deal with the Company or an Affiliate with the same rights it would have, as if it were not Trustee, subject to certain limitations provided for in the Indenture and in the TIA. Any Agent may do the same with like rights.
18. No Recourse Against Others. A director, officer, employee or shareholder, as such, of the Company shall not have any liability for any obligations of the Company under the Notes or the Indenture or for any claim based on, in respect of or by reason of such obligations or their creation. Each Securityholder, by accepting a Note, waives and releases all such liability. The waiver and release are part of the consideration for the issue of the Notes.
19. Governing Law. THE INDENTURE AND THE SECURITIES ISSUED HEREUNDER SHALL BE GOVERNED BY AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.
20. Authentication. The Notes shall not be valid until authenticated by the manual signature of an authorized officer of the Trustee or an authenticating agent.
21. Abbreviations. Customary abbreviations may be used in the name of a Securityholder or an assignee, such as: TEN COM (for tenants in common), TENANT (for tenants by the entireties), JT TEN (for joint tenants with right of survivorship and not as tenants in common), CUST (for Custodian), and U/G/M/A (for Uniform Gifts to Minors Act).
22. Definitions. Capitalized terms not defined in this Note have the meaning given to them in the Indenture.
The Company will furnish to any Securityholder of the Notes upon written request and without charge a copy of the Indenture and the Registration Agreement. Request may be made to:
Investor Relations
A-7
ASSIGNMENT AND CERTIFICATE OF TRANSFER FORM
To assign this Note, fill in the form below:
(I) or (we) assign and transfer this Note to
and irrevocably appoint agent to transfer this Note on the books of the Company. The agent may substitute another to act for him.
Your
Signature:
|
|
(Sign exactly as your name appears on the other side of this Note) | |
Date: | |
Signature
Guarantee:***
|
*** | Signature must be guaranteed by a commercial bank, trust company or member firm of the New York Stock Exchange. |
A-8
Signature
Signature
* | Signature must be guaranteed by a commercial bank, trust company or member firm of the New York Stock Exchange. |
A-9
[TO BE ATTACHED TO GLOBAL
SECURITIES]
SCHEDULE A
The initial principal amount at maturity of this
Global Security shall be
$ .
The following increases or decreases in the principal amount of
this Global Security have been made:
Amount of Increase in
Principal Amount of this
Principal Amount of
Global Security Including
Amount of Decrease
this Global Security
Signature of
Upon Exercise of
in Principal Amount of
Following Such Decrease
Authorized Officer
Date Made
Overallotment Option
this Global Security
or Increase
of Trustee or Custodian
A-10
OPTION OF SECURITYHOLDER TO ELECT PURCHASE
If you want to elect to have this Note or a portion thereof repurchased by the Company pursuant to Section 3.08 or 4.08 of the Indenture, check the box: o
If you want to elect to have this Note or a portion thereof repurchased by the Company pursuant to Article XIII and Section 4.09 of the Indenture, check the box: o
If the purchase is in part, indicate the portion ($1,000 or any integral multiple thereof) to be purchased:
Your Signature:
Date:
Signature Guarantee:*
* | Signature must be guaranteed by a commercial bank, trust company or member firm of the New York Stock Exchange. |
A-11
ELECTION TO CONVERT
To: Intevac, Inc.
The undersigned owner of this Note hereby irrevocably exercises the option to convert this Note, or the portion below designated, into Common Stock of Intevac, Inc. in accordance with the terms of the Indenture referred to in this Note, and directs that the shares issuable and deliverable upon conversion, together with any check in payment for fractional shares, be issued in the name of and delivered to the undersigned, unless a different name has been indicated in the assignment below. If shares are to be issued in the name of a person other than the undersigned, the undersigned will pay all transfer taxes payable with respect thereto.
The undersigned agrees to be bound by the terms
of the Registration Agreement relating to the Common Stock
issuable upon conversion of the Notes.
Date:
or
Portion of Note to be converted
($1,000 or any integral multiple thereof):
$
Your Signature:
(Sign exactly as your name appears on the
other side of this Note)
Please print or typewrite name and address,
including zip code, and Social Security or other identifying
number
Signature Guarantee:*
* | Signature must be guaranteed by a commercial bank, trust company or member firm of the New York Stock Exchange. |
A-12